Provided by: qemu-system-common_10.0.2+ds-1ubuntu2_amd64 bug

NAME

       qemu-qmp-ref - QEMU QMP Reference Manual

       • IntroductionQMP errorsCommon data typesSocket data typesVM run stateCryptographyBackground jobsBlock devicesBlock core (VM unrelated)Additional block stuff (VM related)Block device exportsCharacter devicesDump guest memoryNet deviceseBPF ObjectsRocker switch deviceTPM (trusted platform module) devicesRemote desktopSpiceVNCInputUser authorizationMigrationTransactionsTracingCompatibility policyQMP monitor controlQMP introspectionQEMU Object Model (QOM)Device infrastructure (qdev)Common machine typesMachinesRecord/replayYank featureMiscellaneaAudioACPIPCIStatisticsVirtio devicesVFIO devicesCryptography devicesCXL devicesUEFI Variable Store

INTRODUCTION

       This manual describes the commands and events supported by the QEMU Monitor Protocol (QMP).

       For locating a particular item, please see the QMP Index.

       The following notation is used in examples:

          Example:

              -> ... text sent by client (commands) ...
              <- ... text sent by server (command responses and events) ...

       Example  text  is  formatted for readability.  However, in real protocol usage, its commonly emitted as a
       single line.

       Please refer to the QEMU Machine Protocol Specification for the general format  of  commands,  responses,
       and events.

QMP ERRORS

       Enum QapiErrorClass (Since: 1.2)
              QEMU error classes

              ValuesGenericError  -- this is used for errors that don't require a specific error class.  This
                       should be the default case for most errors

                     • CommandNotFound -- the requested command has not been found

                     • DeviceNotActive -- a device has failed to be become active

                     • DeviceNotFound -- the requested device has not been found

                     • KVMMissingCap -- the requested operation  can't  be  fulfilled  because  a  required  KVM
                       capability is missing

COMMON DATA TYPES

       Enum IoOperationType (Since: 2.1)
              An enumeration of the I/O operation types

              Valuesread -- read operation

                     • write -- write operation

       Enum OnOffAuto (Since: 2.2)
              An enumeration of three options: on, off, and auto

              Valuesauto -- QEMU selects the value between on and off

                     • on -- Enabled

                     • off -- Disabled

       Enum OnOffSplit (Since: 2.6)
              An enumeration of three values: on, off, and split

              Valueson -- Enabled

                     • off -- Disabled

                     • split -- Mixed

       Alternate StrOrNull (Since: 2.10)
              This  is  a string value or the explicit lack of a string (null pointer in C).  Intended for cases
              when 'optional absent' already has a different meaning.

              Alternativess (string) -- the string value

                     • n (null) -- no string value

       Enum OffAutoPCIBAR (Since: 2.12)
              An enumeration of options for specifying a PCI BAR

              Valuesoff -- The specified feature is disabled

                     • auto -- The PCI BAR for the feature is automatically selected

                     • bar0 -- PCI BAR0 is used for the feature

                     • bar1 -- PCI BAR1 is used for the feature

                     • bar2 -- PCI BAR2 is used for the feature

                     • bar3 -- PCI BAR3 is used for the feature

                     • bar4 -- PCI BAR4 is used for the feature

                     • bar5 -- PCI BAR5 is used for the feature

       Enum PCIELinkSpeed (Since: 4.0)
              An enumeration of PCIe link speeds in units of GT/s

              Values2_5 -- 2.5GT/s

                     • 5 -- 5.0GT/s

                     • 8 -- 8.0GT/s

                     • 16 -- 16.0GT/s

                     • 32 -- 32.0GT/s (since 9.0)

                     • 64 -- 64.0GT/s (since 9.0)

       Enum PCIELinkWidth (Since: 4.0)
              An enumeration of PCIe link width

              Values1 -- x1

                     • 2 -- x2

                     • 4 -- x4

                     • 8 -- x8

                     • 12 -- x12

                     • 16 -- x16

                     • 32 -- x32

       Enum HostMemPolicy (Since: 2.1)
              Host memory policy types

              Valuesdefault -- restore default policy, remove any nondefault policy

                     • preferred -- set the preferred host nodes for allocation

                     • bind -- a strict policy that restricts memory allocation to the host nodes specified

                     • interleave -- memory allocations are interleaved across the set of host nodes specified

       Enum NetFilterDirection (Since: 2.5)
              Indicates whether a netfilter is attached to a netdev's transmit queue or receive queue or both.

              Valuesall -- the filter is attached both to the receive and the transmit queue  of  the  netdev
                       (default).

                     • rx  --  the  filter is attached to the receive queue of the netdev, where it will receive
                       packets sent to the netdev.

                     • tx -- the filter is attached to the transmit queue of the netdev, where it  will  receive
                       packets sent by the netdev.

       Enum GrabToggleKeys (Since: 4.0)
              Key combinations to toggle input-linux between host and guest.

              Valuesctrl-ctrl -- left and right control key

                     • alt-alt -- left and right alt key

                     • shift-shift -- left and right shift key

                     • meta-meta -- left and right meta key

                     • scrolllock -- scroll lock key

                     • ctrl-scrolllock -- either control key and scroll lock key

       Object HumanReadableText (Since: 6.2)

              Membershuman-readable-text (string) -- Formatted output intended for humans.

       Enum EndianMode (Since: 10.0)

              Valuesunspecified -- Endianness not specified

                     • little -- Little endianness

                     • big -- Big endianness

SOCKET DATA TYPES

       Enum NetworkAddressFamily (Since: 2.1)
              The network address family

              Valuesipv4 -- IPV4 family

                     • ipv6 -- IPV6 family

                     • unix -- unix socket

                     • vsock -- vsock family (since 2.8)

                     • unknown -- otherwise

       Object InetSocketAddressBase

              Membershost (string) -- host part of the address

                     • port (string) -- port part of the address

       Object InetSocketAddress (Since: 1.3)
              Captures a socket address or address range in the Internet namespace.

              Membersnumeric  (boolean, optional) -- true if the host/port are guaranteed to be numeric, false
                       if name resolution should be attempted.  Defaults to false.  (Since 2.9)

                     • to (int, optional) -- If present, this is range of possible addresses, with port  between
                       port and to.

                     • ipv4  (boolean,  optional) -- whether to accept IPv4 addresses, default try both IPv4 and
                       IPv6

                     • ipv6 (boolean, optional) -- whether to accept IPv6 addresses, default try both  IPv4  and
                       IPv6

                     • keep-alive  (boolean, optional) -- enable keep-alive when connecting to this socket.  Not
                       supported for passive sockets.  (Since 4.2)

                     • mptcp (boolean, optional) -- enable multi-path TCP.  (Since 6.1)

                     • The members of InetSocketAddressBase.

       Object UnixSocketAddress (Since: 1.3)
              Captures a socket address in the local ("Unix socket") namespace.

              Memberspath (string) -- filesystem path to use

                     • abstract (boolean, optional) -- if true, this is a Linux abstract socket  address.   path
                       will  be  prefixed  by  a  null byte, and optionally padded with null bytes.  Defaults to
                       false.  (Since 5.1)

                     • tight (boolean, optional) -- if false, pad an abstract socket address  with  enough  null
                       bytes to make it fill struct sockaddr_un member sun_path.  Defaults to true.  (Since 5.1)

       Object VsockSocketAddress (Since: 2.8)
              Captures a socket address in the vsock namespace.

              Memberscid (string) -- unique host identifier

                     • port (string) -- port

              NOTE:
                 String types are used to allow for possible future hostname or service resolution support.

       Object FdSocketAddress (Since: 1.2)
              A file descriptor name or number.

              Membersstr  (string)  -- decimal is for file descriptor number, otherwise it's a file descriptor
                       name.  Named file descriptors are permitted in monitor commands, in combination with  the
                       'getfd'  command.   Decimal  file  descriptors are permitted at startup or other contexts
                       where no monitor context is active.

       Object InetSocketAddressWrapper (Since: 1.3)

              Membersdata (InetSocketAddress) -- internet domain socket address

       Object UnixSocketAddressWrapper (Since: 1.3)

              Membersdata (UnixSocketAddress) -- UNIX domain socket address

       Object VsockSocketAddressWrapper (Since: 2.8)

              Membersdata (VsockSocketAddress) -- VSOCK domain socket address

       Object FdSocketAddressWrapper (Since: 1.3)

              Membersdata (FdSocketAddress) -- file descriptor name or number

       Object SocketAddressLegacy (Since: 1.3)
              Captures the address of a socket, which could also be a named file descriptor

              Memberstype (SocketAddressType) -- Transport type

                     • When type is inet: The members of InetSocketAddressWrapper.

                     • When type is unix: The members of UnixSocketAddressWrapper.

                     • When type is vsock: The members of VsockSocketAddressWrapper.

                     • When type is fd: The members of FdSocketAddressWrapper.

       Enum SocketAddressType (Since: 2.9)
              Available SocketAddress types

              Valuesinet -- Internet address

                     • unix -- Unix domain socket

                     • vsock -- VMCI address

                     • fd -- Socket file descriptor

       Object SocketAddress (Since: 2.9)
              Captures the address of a socket, which could also be a socket file descriptor

              Memberstype (SocketAddressType) -- Transport type

                     • When type is inet: The members of InetSocketAddress.

                     • When type is unix: The members of UnixSocketAddress.

                     • When type is vsock: The members of VsockSocketAddress.

                     • When type is fd: The members of FdSocketAddress.

VM RUN STATE

       Enum RunState
              An enumeration of VM run states.

              Valuesdebug -- QEMU is running on a debugger

                     • finish-migrate -- guest is paused to finish the migration process

                     • inmigrate -- guest is paused waiting for an incoming migration.   Note  that  this  state
                       does  not  tell whether the machine will start at the end of the migration.  This depends
                       on the command-line -S option and any invocation of 'stop' or 'cont'  that  has  happened
                       since QEMU was started.

                     • internal-error -- An internal error that prevents further guest execution has occurred

                     • io-error -- the last IOP has failed and the device is configured to pause on I/O errors

                     • paused -- guest has been paused via the 'stop' command

                     • postmigrate -- guest is paused following a successful 'migrate'

                     • prelaunch -- QEMU was started with -S and guest has not started

                     • restore-vm -- guest is paused to restore VM state

                     • running -- guest is actively running

                     • save-vm -- guest is paused to save the VM state

                     • shutdown -- guest is shut down (and -no-shutdown is in use)

                     • suspended -- guest is suspended (ACPI S3)

                     • watchdog -- the watchdog action is configured to pause and has been triggered

                     • guest-panicked -- guest has been panicked as a result of guest OS panic

                     • colo  --  guest  is paused to save/restore VM state under colo checkpoint, VM can not get
                       into this state unless colo capability is enabled for migration.  (since 2.8)

       Enum ShutdownCause
              An enumeration of reasons for a Shutdown.

              Valuesnone -- No shutdown request pending

                     • host-error -- An error prevents further use of guest

                     • host-qmp-quit -- Reaction to the QMP command 'quit'

                     • host-qmp-system-reset -- Reaction to the QMP command 'system_reset'

                     • host-signal -- Reaction to a signal, such as SIGINT

                     • host-ui -- Reaction to a UI event, like window close

                     • guest-shutdown -- Guest shutdown/suspend request, via  ACPI  or  other  hardware-specific
                       means

                     • guest-reset -- Guest reset request, and command line turns that into a shutdown

                     • guest-panic -- Guest panicked, and command line turns that into a shutdown

                     • subsystem-reset  --  Partial  guest  reset  that  does not trigger QMP events and ignores
                       --no-reboot.  This is useful for sanitizing hypercalls  on  s390  that  are  used  during
                       kexec/kdump/boot

                     • snapshot-load -- A snapshot is being loaded by the record & replay subsystem.  This value
                       is used only within QEMU.  It doesn't occur in QMP.  (since 7.2)

       Object StatusInfo (Since: 0.14)
              Information about VM run state

              Membersrunning (boolean) -- true if all VCPUs are runnable, false if not runnable

                     • status (RunState) -- the virtual machine RunState

       Command query-status (Since: 0.14)
              Query the run status of the VM

              Return StatusInfo -- StatusInfo reflecting the VM

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-status" }
                     <- { "return": { "running": true,
                                      "status": "running" } }

       Event SHUTDOWN (Since: 0.12)
              Emitted when the virtual machine has shut down, indicating that qemu is about to exit.

              Membersguest  (boolean)  --  If  true,  the shutdown was triggered by a guest request (such as a
                       guest-initiated ACPI shutdown request or other hardware-specific action)  rather  than  a
                       host request (such as sending qemu a SIGINT).  (since 2.10)

                     • reason (ShutdownCause) -- The ShutdownCause which resulted in the SHUTDOWN.  (since 4.0)

              NOTE:
                 If  the  command-line  option  -no-shutdown  has been specified, qemu will not exit, and a STOP
                 event will eventually follow the SHUTDOWN event.

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "SHUTDOWN",
                          "data": { "guest": true, "reason": "guest-shutdown" },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267040730, "microseconds": 682951 } }

       Event POWERDOWN (Since: 0.12)
              Emitted when the virtual machine is powered down through the power control  system,  such  as  via
              ACPI.

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "POWERDOWN",
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267040730, "microseconds": 682951 } }

       Event RESET (Since: 0.12)
              Emitted when the virtual machine is reset

              Membersguest  (boolean)  --  If  true,  the  reset  was  triggered by a guest request (such as a
                       guest-initiated ACPI reboot request or other hardware-specific action) rather than a host
                       request (such as the QMP command system_reset).  (since 2.10)

                     • reason (ShutdownCause) -- The ShutdownCause of the RESET.  (since 4.0)

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "RESET",
                          "data": { "guest": false, "reason": "guest-reset" },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267041653, "microseconds": 9518 } }

       Event STOP (Since: 0.12)
              Emitted when the virtual machine is stopped

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "STOP",
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267041730, "microseconds": 281295 } }

       Event RESUME (Since: 0.12)
              Emitted when the virtual machine resumes execution

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "RESUME",
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1271770767, "microseconds": 582542 } }

       Event SUSPEND (Since: 1.1)
              Emitted when guest enters a hardware suspension state, for example, S3 state, which  is  sometimes
              called standby state

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "SUSPEND",
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344456160, "microseconds": 309119 } }

       Event SUSPEND_DISK (Since: 1.2)
              Emitted  when  guest  enters  a hardware suspension state with data saved on disk, for example, S4
              state, which is sometimes called hibernate state

              NOTE:
                 QEMU shuts down (similar to event SHUTDOWN) when entering this state.

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "SUSPEND_DISK",
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344456160, "microseconds": 309119 } }

       Event WAKEUP (Since: 1.1)
              Emitted when the guest has woken up from suspend state and is running

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "WAKEUP",
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344522075, "microseconds": 745528 } }

       Event WATCHDOG (Since: 0.13)
              Emitted when the watchdog device's timer is expired

              Membersaction (WatchdogAction) -- action that has been taken

              NOTE:
                 If action is "reset", "shutdown", or "pause" the WATCHDOG event is followed respectively by the
                 RESET, SHUTDOWN, or STOP events.

              NOTE:
                 This event is rate-limited.

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "WATCHDOG",
                          "data": { "action": "reset" },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267061043, "microseconds": 959568 } }

       Enum WatchdogAction (Since: 2.1)
              An enumeration of the actions taken when the watchdog device's timer is expired

              Valuesreset -- system resets

                     • shutdown -- system shutdown, note that it is similar to powerdown, which tries to set  to
                       system status and notify guest

                     • poweroff -- system poweroff, the emulator program exits

                     • pause -- system pauses, similar to stopdebug -- system enters debug state

                     • none -- nothing is done

                     • inject-nmi -- a non-maskable interrupt is injected into the first VCPU (all VCPUS on x86)
                       (since 2.4)

       Enum RebootAction (Since: 6.0)
              Possible QEMU actions upon guest reboot

              Valuesreset -- Reset the VM

                     • shutdown -- Shutdown the VM and exit, according to the shutdown action

       Enum ShutdownAction (Since: 6.0)
              Possible QEMU actions upon guest shutdown

              Valuespoweroff -- Shutdown the VM and exit

                     • pause -- pause the VM

       Enum PanicAction (Since: 6.0)

              Valuesnone -- Continue VM execution

                     • pause -- Pause the VM

                     • shutdown -- Shutdown the VM and exit, according to the shutdown action

                     • exit-failure -- Shutdown the VM and exit with nonzero status (since 7.1)

       Command watchdog-set-action (Since: 2.11)
              Set watchdog action.

              Argumentsaction (WatchdogAction) -- WatchdogAction action taken when watchdog timer expires.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "watchdog-set-action",
                          "arguments": { "action": "inject-nmi" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command set-action (Since: 6.0)
              Set the actions that will be taken by the emulator in response to guest events.

              Argumentsreboot (RebootAction, optional) -- RebootAction action taken on guest reboot.

                     • shutdown (ShutdownAction, optional) -- ShutdownAction action taken on guest shutdown.

                     • panic (PanicAction, optional) -- PanicAction action taken on guest panic.

                     • watchdog  (WatchdogAction,  optional)  -- WatchdogAction action taken when watchdog timer
                       expires.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "set-action",
                          "arguments": { "reboot": "shutdown",
                                         "shutdown" : "pause",
                                         "panic": "pause",
                                         "watchdog": "inject-nmi" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Event GUEST_PANICKED (Since: 1.5)
              Emitted when guest OS panic is detected

              Membersaction (GuestPanicAction) -- action that has been taken, currently always "pause"

                     • info (GuestPanicInformation, optional) -- information about a panic (since 2.9)

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "GUEST_PANICKED",
                          "data": { "action": "pause" },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1648245231, "microseconds": 900001 } }

       Event GUEST_CRASHLOADED (Since: 5.0)
              Emitted when guest OS crash loaded is detected

              Membersaction (GuestPanicAction) -- action that has been taken, currently always "run"

                     • info (GuestPanicInformation, optional) -- information about a panic

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "GUEST_CRASHLOADED",
                          "data": { "action": "run" },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1648245259, "microseconds": 893771 } }

       Event GUEST_PVSHUTDOWN (Since: 9.1)
              Emitted when guest submits a shutdown request via pvpanic interface

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "GUEST_PVSHUTDOWN",
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1648245259, "microseconds": 893771 } }

       Enum GuestPanicAction (Since: 2.1)
              An enumeration of the actions taken when guest OS panic is detected

              Valuespause -- system pauses

                     • poweroff -- system powers off (since 2.8)

                     • run -- system continues to run (since 5.0)

       Enum GuestPanicInformationType (Since: 2.9)
              An enumeration of the guest panic information types

              Valueshyper-v -- hyper-v guest panic information type

                     • s390 -- s390 guest panic information type (Since: 2.12)

       Object GuestPanicInformation (Since: 2.9)
              Information about a guest panic

              Memberstype (GuestPanicInformationType) -- Crash  type  that  defines  the  hypervisor  specific
                       information

                     • When type is hyper-v: The members of GuestPanicInformationHyperV.

                     • When type is s390: The members of GuestPanicInformationS390.

       Object GuestPanicInformationHyperV (Since: 2.9)
              Hyper-V specific guest panic information (HV crash MSRs)

              Membersarg1 (int) -- for Windows, STOP code for the guest crash.  For Linux, an error code.

                     • arg2 (int) -- for Windows, first argument of the STOP.  For Linux, the guest OS ID, which
                       has the kernel version in bits 16-47 and 0x8100 in bits 48-63.

                     • arg3  (int)  -- for Windows, second argument of the STOP.  For Linux, the program counter
                       of the guest.

                     • arg4 (int) -- for Windows, third argument of the STOP.  For Linux, the RAX register (x86)
                       or the stack pointer (aarch64) of the guest.

                     • arg5 (int) -- for Windows, fourth argument of the STOP.  For x86 Linux, the stack pointer
                       of the guest.

       Enum S390CrashReason (Since: 2.12)
              Reason why the CPU is in a crashed state.

              Valuesunknown -- no crash reason was set

                     • disabled-wait -- the CPU has entered a disabled wait state

                     • extint-loop -- clock comparator or cpu timer interrupt with new PSW enabled for  external
                       interrupts

                     • pgmint-loop -- program interrupt with BAD new PSW

                     • opint-loop  --  operation  exception interrupt with invalid code at the program interrupt
                       new PSW

       Object GuestPanicInformationS390 (Since: 2.12)
              S390 specific guest panic information (PSW)

              Memberscore (int) -- core id of the CPU that crashed

                     • psw-mask (int) -- control fields of guest PSW

                     • psw-addr (int) -- guest instruction address

                     • reason (S390CrashReason) -- guest crash reason

       Event MEMORY_FAILURE (Since: 5.2)
              Emitted when a memory failure occurs on host side.

              Membersrecipient (MemoryFailureRecipient) -- recipient is defined as MemoryFailureRecipient.

                     • action (MemoryFailureAction) -- action that has been taken.

                     • flags (MemoryFailureFlags) -- flags for MemoryFailureAction.

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "MEMORY_FAILURE",
                          "data": { "recipient": "hypervisor",
                                    "action": "fatal",
                                    "flags": { "action-required": false,
                                               "recursive": false } },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267061043, "microseconds": 959568 } }

       Enum MemoryFailureRecipient (Since: 5.2)
              Hardware memory failure occurs, handled by recipient.

              Valueshypervisor -- memory failure at QEMU process address space.  (none guest memory, but used
                       by QEMU itself).

                     • guest -- memory failure at guest memory,

       Enum MemoryFailureAction (Since: 5.2)
              Actions taken by QEMU in response to a hardware memory failure.

              Valuesignore -- the memory  failure  could  be  ignored.   This  will  only  be  the  case  for
                       action-optional failures.

                     • inject  --  memory  failure  occurred  in  guest  memory,  the guest enabled MCE handling
                       mechanism, and QEMU could inject the MCE into the guest successfully.

                     • fatal -- the failure is unrecoverable.  This occurs for action-required failures  if  the
                       recipient is the hypervisor; QEMU will exit.

                     • reset  --  the  failure  is  unrecoverable but confined to the guest.  This occurs if the
                       recipient is a guest guest which is not ready to handle memory failures.

       Object MemoryFailureFlags (Since: 5.2)
              Additional information on memory failures.

              Membersaction-required (boolean) --  whether  a  memory  failure  event  is  action-required  or
                       action-optional (e.g. a failure during memory scrub).

                     • recursive  (boolean) -- whether the failure occurred while the previous failure was still
                       in progress.

       Enum NotifyVmexitOption (Since: 7.2)
              An enumeration of the options specified when enabling notify VM exit

              Valuesrun -- enable the feature, do nothing and continue if the notify VM exit happens.

                     • internal-error -- enable the feature, raise a  internal  error  if  the  notify  VM  exit
                       happens.

                     • disable -- disable the feature.

CRYPTOGRAPHY

       Enum QCryptoTLSCredsEndpoint (Since: 2.5)
              The type of network endpoint that will be using the credentials.  Most types of credential require
              different setup / structures depending on whether they will be used in a server versus a client.

              Valuesclient -- the network endpoint is acting as the client

                     • server -- the network endpoint is acting as the server

       Enum QCryptoSecretFormat (Since: 2.6)
              The data format that the secret is provided in

              Valuesraw -- raw bytes.  When encoded in JSON only valid UTF-8 sequences can be used

                     • base64 -- arbitrary base64 encoded binary data

       Enum QCryptoHashAlgo (Since: 2.6)
              The supported algorithms for computing content digests

              Valuesmd5 -- MD5.  Should not be used in any new code, legacy compat only

                     • sha1 -- SHA-1.  Should not be used in any new code, legacy compat only

                     • sha224 -- SHA-224.  (since 2.7)

                     • sha256 -- SHA-256.  Current recommended strong hash.

                     • sha384 -- SHA-384.  (since 2.7)

                     • sha512 -- SHA-512.  (since 2.7)

                     • ripemd160 -- RIPEMD-160.  (since 2.7)

                     • sm3 -- SM3. (since 9.2.0)

       Enum QCryptoCipherAlgo (Since: 2.6)
              The supported algorithms for content encryption ciphers

              Valuesaes-128 -- AES with 128 bit / 16 byte keys

                     • aes-192 -- AES with 192 bit / 24 byte keys

                     • aes-256 -- AES with 256 bit / 32 byte keys

                     • des -- DES with 56 bit / 8 byte keys.  Do not use except in VNC.  (since 6.1)

                     • 3des -- 3DES(EDE) with 192 bit / 24 byte keys (since 2.9)

                     • cast5-128 -- Cast5 with 128 bit / 16 byte keys

                     • serpent-128 -- Serpent with 128 bit / 16 byte keys

                     • serpent-192 -- Serpent with 192 bit / 24 byte keys

                     • serpent-256 -- Serpent with 256 bit / 32 byte keys

                     • twofish-128 -- Twofish with 128 bit / 16 byte keys

                     • twofish-192 -- Twofish with 192 bit / 24 byte keys

                     • twofish-256 -- Twofish with 256 bit / 32 byte keys

                     • sm4 -- SM4 with 128 bit / 16 byte keys (since 9.0)

       Enum QCryptoCipherMode (Since: 2.6)
              The supported modes for content encryption ciphers

              Valuesecb -- Electronic Code Book

                     • cbc -- Cipher Block Chaining

                     • xts -- XEX with tweaked code book and ciphertext stealing

                     • ctr -- Counter (Since 2.8)

       Enum QCryptoIVGenAlgo (Since: 2.6)
              The  supported  algorithms  for  generating  initialization vectors for full disk encryption.  The
              'plain' generator should not be used for disks with sector numbers larger than 2^32, except  where
              compatibility with pre-existing Linux dm-crypt volumes is required.

              Valuesplain -- 64-bit sector number truncated to 32-bits

                     • plain64 -- 64-bit sector number

                     • essiv -- 64-bit sector number encrypted with a hash of the encryption key

       Enum QCryptoBlockFormat (Since: 2.6)
              The supported full disk encryption formats

              Valuesqcow  --  QCow/QCow2  built-in AES-CBC encryption.  Use only for liberating data from old
                       images.

                     • luks -- LUKS encryption format.  Recommended for new images

       Object QCryptoBlockOptionsBase (Since: 2.6)
              The common options that apply to all full disk encryption formats

              Membersformat (QCryptoBlockFormat) -- the encryption format

       Object QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow (Since: 2.6)
              The options that apply to QCow/QCow2 AES-CBC encryption format

              Memberskey-secret (string,  optional)  --  the  ID  of  a  QCryptoSecret  object  providing  the
                       decryption key.  Mandatory except when probing image for metadata only.

       Object QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS (Since: 2.6)
              The options that apply to LUKS encryption format

              Memberskey-secret  (string,  optional)  --  the  ID  of  a  QCryptoSecret  object  providing the
                       decryption key.  Mandatory except when probing image for metadata only.

       Object QCryptoBlockCreateOptionsLUKS (Since: 2.6)
              The options that apply to LUKS encryption format initialization

              Memberscipher-alg (QCryptoCipherAlgo, optional) -- the  cipher  algorithm  for  data  encryption
                       Currently defaults to 'aes-256'.

                     • cipher-mode  (QCryptoCipherMode,  optional)  --  the  cipher  mode  for  data  encryption
                       Currently defaults to 'xts'

                     • ivgen-alg (QCryptoIVGenAlgo, optional) -- the initialization vector  generator  Currently
                       defaults to 'plain64'

                     • ivgen-hash-alg  (QCryptoHashAlgo,  optional)  -- the initialization vector generator hash
                       Currently defaults to 'sha256'

                     • hash-alg (QCryptoHashAlgo, optional) -- the master key hash algorithm Currently  defaults
                       to 'sha256'

                     • iter-time  (int,  optional)  --  number  of  milliseconds  to  spend  in PBKDF passphrase
                       processing.  Currently defaults to 2000.  (since 2.8)

                     • The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS.

       Object QCryptoBlockOpenOptions (Since: 2.6)
              The options that are available for all encryption formats when opening an existing volume

              Members

                     • The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsBase.

                     • When format is qcow: The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow.

                     • When format is luks: The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS.

       Object QCryptoBlockCreateOptions (Since: 2.6)
              The options that are available for all encryption formats when initializing a new volume

              Members

                     • The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsBase.

                     • When format is qcow: The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow.

                     • When format is luks: The members of QCryptoBlockCreateOptionsLUKS.

       Object QCryptoBlockInfoBase (Since: 2.7)
              The common information that applies to all full disk encryption formats

              Membersformat (QCryptoBlockFormat) -- the encryption format

       Object QCryptoBlockInfoLUKSSlot (Since: 2.7)
              Information about the LUKS block encryption key slot options

              Membersactive (boolean) -- whether the key slot is currently in use

                     • key-offset (int) -- offset to the key material in bytes

                     • iters (int, optional) -- number of PBKDF2 iterations for key material

                     • stripes (int, optional) -- number of stripes for splitting key material

       Object QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS (Since: 2.7)
              Information about the LUKS block encryption options

              Memberscipher-alg (QCryptoCipherAlgo) -- the cipher algorithm for data encryption

                     • cipher-mode (QCryptoCipherMode) -- the cipher mode for data encryption

                     • ivgen-alg (QCryptoIVGenAlgo) -- the initialization vector generator

                     • ivgen-hash-alg (QCryptoHashAlgo, optional) -- the initialization vector generator hash

                     • hash-alg (QCryptoHashAlgo) -- the master key hash algorithm

                     • detached-header (boolean) -- whether the LUKS header is detached (Since 9.0)

                     • payload-offset (int) -- offset to the payload data in bytes

                     • master-key-iters (int) -- number of PBKDF2 iterations for key material

                     • uuid (string) -- unique identifier for the volume

                     • slots ([QCryptoBlockInfoLUKSSlot]) -- information about each key slot

       Object QCryptoBlockInfo (Since: 2.7)
              Information about the block encryption options

              Members

                     • The members of QCryptoBlockInfoBase.

                     • When format is luks: The members of QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS.

       Enum QCryptoBlockLUKSKeyslotState (Since: 5.1)
              Defines state of keyslots that are affected by the update

              Valuesactive -- The slots contain the given password and marked as active

                     • inactive -- The slots are erased (contain garbage) and marked as inactive

       Object QCryptoBlockAmendOptionsLUKS (Since: 5.1)
              This struct defines the update parameters that activate/de-activate set of keyslots

              Membersstate (QCryptoBlockLUKSKeyslotState) -- the desired state of the keyslots

                     • new-secret (string, optional) -- The ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the  password
                       to be written into added active keyslots

                     • old-secret  (string,  optional)  --  Optional  (for  deactivation  only)  If  given  will
                       deactivate all keyslots that match password located in QCryptoSecret with this ID

                     • iter-time (int, optional) -- Optional (for activation only)  Number  of  milliseconds  to
                       spend in PBKDF passphrase processing for the newly activated keyslot.  Currently defaults
                       to 2000.

                     • keyslot (int, optional) --

                       Optional.   ID  of  the  keyslot to activate/deactivate.  For keyslot activation, keyslot
                       should not be active already (this is unsafe to update an active keyslot),  but  possible
                       if  'force'  parameter  is  given.   If  keyslot is not given, first free keyslot will be
                       written.

                       For keyslot deactivation, this parameter specifies the exact keyslot to deactivate

                     • secret (string, optional) -- Optional.  The ID of a QCryptoSecret  object  providing  the
                       password  to  use  to  retrieve current master key.  Defaults to the same secret that was
                       used to open the image

       Object QCryptoBlockAmendOptions (Since: 5.1)
              The options that are available for all encryption formats when amending encryption settings

              Members

                     • The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsBase.

                     • When format is luks: The members of QCryptoBlockAmendOptionsLUKS.

       Object SecretCommonProperties (Since: 2.6)
              Properties for objects of classes derived from secret-common.

              Membersformat (QCryptoSecretFormat, optional) -- the data format that the secret is provided  in
                       (default: raw)

                     • keyid (string, optional) -- the name of another secret that should be used to decrypt the
                       provided data.  If not present, the data is assumed to be unencrypted.

                     • iv  (string,  optional)  --  the random initialization vector used for encryption of this
                       particular secret.  Should be a base64 encrypted string of the 16-byte IV.  Mandatory  if
                       keyid is given.  Ignored if keyid is absent.

       Object SecretProperties (Since: 2.6)
              Properties for secret objects.

              Either data or file must be provided, but not both.

              Membersdata (string, optional) -- the associated with the secret from

                     • file (string, optional) -- the filename to load the data associated with the secret from

                     • The members of SecretCommonProperties.

       Object SecretKeyringProperties (Since: 5.1)
              Availability: CONFIG_SECRET_KEYRING

              Properties for secret_keyring objects.

              Membersserial (int) -- serial number that identifies a key to get from the kernel

                     • The members of SecretCommonProperties.

       Object TlsCredsProperties (Since: 2.5)
              Properties for objects of classes derived from tls-creds.

              Membersverify-peer (boolean, optional) -- if true the peer credentials will be verified once the
                       handshake is completed.  This is a no-op for anonymous credentials.  (default: true)

                     • dir (string, optional) -- the path of the directory that contains the credential files

                     • endpoint  (QCryptoTLSCredsEndpoint,  optional)  --  whether the QEMU network backend that
                       uses the credentials will be acting as a client or as a server (default: client)

                     • priority  (string,  optional)  --  a  gnutls  priority   string   as   described   at   ‐
                       https://gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html

       Object TlsCredsAnonProperties (Since: 2.5)
              Properties for tls-creds-anon objects.

              Members

                     • The members of TlsCredsProperties.

       Object TlsCredsPskProperties (Since: 3.0)
              Properties for tls-creds-psk objects.

              Membersusername  (string,  optional)  --  the  username  which  will be sent to the server.  For
                       clients only.  If absent, "qemu" is sent and the property will  read  back  as  an  empty
                       string.

                     • The members of TlsCredsProperties.

       Object TlsCredsX509Properties (Since: 2.5)
              Properties for tls-creds-x509 objects.

              Memberssanity-check  (boolean, optional) -- if true, perform some sanity checks before using the
                       credentials (default: true)

                     • passwordid (string, optional) -- For the server-key.pem and  client-key.pem  files  which
                       contain  sensitive  private keys, it is possible to use an encrypted version by providing
                       the passwordid parameter.  This provides the ID of a  previously  created  secret  object
                       containing the password for decryption.

                     • The members of TlsCredsProperties.

       Enum QCryptoAkCipherAlgo (Since: 7.1)
              The supported algorithms for asymmetric encryption ciphers

              Valuesrsa -- RSA algorithm

       Enum QCryptoAkCipherKeyType (Since: 7.1)
              The type of asymmetric keys.

              Valuespublic -- public key

                     • private -- private key

       Enum QCryptoRSAPaddingAlgo (Since: 7.1)
              The padding algorithm for RSA.

              Valuesraw -- no padding used

                     • pkcs1 -- pkcs1#v1.5

       Object QCryptoAkCipherOptionsRSA (Since: 7.1)
              Specific parameters for RSA algorithm.

              Membershash-alg (QCryptoHashAlgo) -- QCryptoHashAlgo

                     • padding-alg (QCryptoRSAPaddingAlgo) -- QCryptoRSAPaddingAlgo

       Object QCryptoAkCipherOptions (Since: 7.1)
              The   options  that  are  available  for  all  asymmetric  key  algorithms  when  creating  a  new
              QCryptoAkCipher.

              Membersalg (QCryptoAkCipherAlgo) -- encryption cipher algorithm

                     • When alg is rsa: The members of QCryptoAkCipherOptionsRSA.

BACKGROUND JOBS

       Enum JobType (Since: 1.7)
              Type of a background job.

              Valuescommit -- block commit job type, see "block-commit"

                     • stream -- block stream job type, see "block-stream"

                     • mirror -- drive mirror job type, see "drive-mirror"

                     • backup -- drive backup job type, see "drive-backup"

                     • create -- image creation job type, see "blockdev-create" (since 3.0)

                     • amend -- image options amend job type, see "x-blockdev-amend" (since 5.1)

                     • snapshot-load -- snapshot load job type, see "snapshot-load" (since 6.0)

                     • snapshot-save -- snapshot save job type, see "snapshot-save" (since 6.0)

                     • snapshot-delete -- snapshot delete job type, see "snapshot-delete" (since 6.0)

       Enum JobStatus (Since: 2.12)
              Indicates the present state of a given job in its lifetime.

              Valuesundefined -- Erroneous, default state.  Should not ever be visible.

                     • created -- The job has been created, but not yet started.

                     • running -- The job is currently running.

                     • paused -- The job is running, but paused.  The pause may be requested by either  the  QMP
                       user or by internal processes.

                     • ready  --  The  job  is running, but is ready for the user to signal completion.  This is
                       used for long-running jobs like mirror that are designed to run indefinitely.

                     • standby -- The job is ready, but paused.  This is nearly identical to  paused.   The  job
                       may return to ready or otherwise be canceled.

                     • waiting  --  The  job  is  waiting  for  other jobs in the transaction to converge to the
                       waiting state.  This status will likely not be visible for the last job in a transaction.

                     • pending -- The job has finished its work, but has finalization steps  that  it  needs  to
                       make   prior   to  completing.   These  changes  will  require  manual  intervention  via
                       job-finalize if auto-finalize was set to false.  These pending changes may still fail.

                     • aborting -- The job is in the process of being aborted, and will finish  with  an  error.
                       The  job  will afterwards report that it is concluded.  This status may not be visible to
                       the management process.

                     • concluded -- The job has finished all work.  If auto-dismiss was set to  false,  the  job
                       will remain in the query list until it is dismissed via job-dismiss.

                     • null  --  The  job  is in the process of being dismantled.  This state should not ever be
                       visible externally.

       Enum JobVerb (Since: 2.12)
              Represents command verbs that can be applied to a job.

              Valuescancel -- see job-cancelpause -- see job-pauseresume -- see job-resumeset-speed -- see block-job-set-speedcomplete -- see job-completedismiss -- see job-dismissfinalize -- see job-finalizechange -- see block-job-change (since 8.2)

       Event JOB_STATUS_CHANGE (Since: 3.0)
              Emitted when a job transitions to a different status.

              Membersid (string) -- The job identifier

                     • status (JobStatus) -- The new job status

       Command job-pause (Since: 3.0)
              Pause an active job.

              This command returns immediately after marking the active job for  pausing.   Pausing  an  already
              paused job is an error.

              The  job will pause as soon as possible, which means transitioning into the PAUSED state if it was
              RUNNING, or into STANDBY if it was READY.   The  corresponding  JOB_STATUS_CHANGE  event  will  be
              emitted.

              Cancelling a paused job automatically resumes it.

              Argumentsid (string) -- The job identifier.

       Command job-resume (Since: 3.0)
              Resume a paused job.

              This  command returns immediately after resuming a paused job.  Resuming an already running job is
              an error.

              Argumentsid (string) -- The job identifier.

       Command job-cancel (Since: 3.0)
              Instruct an active background job to  cancel  at  the  next  opportunity.   This  command  returns
              immediately after marking the active job for cancellation.

              The  job  will  cancel  as soon as possible and then emit a JOB_STATUS_CHANGE event.  Usually, the
              status will change to ABORTING, but it  is  possible  that  a  job  successfully  completes  (e.g.
              because it was almost done and there was no opportunity to cancel earlier than completing the job)
              and transitions to PENDING instead.

              Argumentsid (string) -- The job identifier.

       Command job-complete (Since: 3.0)
              Manually trigger completion of an active job in the READY state.

              Argumentsid (string) -- The job identifier.

       Command job-dismiss (Since: 3.0)
              Deletes  a  job  that is in the CONCLUDED state.  This command only needs to be run explicitly for
              jobs that don't have automatic dismiss enabled.

              This command will refuse to operate on any job that  has  not  yet  reached  its  terminal  state,
              JOB_STATUS_CONCLUDED.   For jobs that make use of JOB_READY event, job-cancel or job-complete will
              still need to be used as appropriate.

              Argumentsid (string) -- The job identifier.

       Command job-finalize (Since: 3.0)
              Instructs all jobs in a transaction (or a single job if it is not  part  of  any  transaction)  to
              finalize  any graph changes and do any necessary cleanup.  This command requires that all involved
              jobs are in the PENDING state.

              For jobs in a transaction, instructing one job to finalize will force ALL jobs in the  transaction
              to finalize, so it is only necessary to instruct a single member job to finalize.

              Argumentsid (string) -- The identifier of any job in the transaction, or of a job that is not part
                       of any transaction.

       Object JobInfo (Since: 3.0)
              Information about a job.

              Membersid (string) -- The job identifier

                     • type (JobType) -- The kind of job that is being performed

                     • status (JobStatus) -- Current job state/status

                     • current-progress  (int)  -- Progress made until now.  The unit is arbitrary and the value
                       can only meaningfully be used for the ratio of current-progress to  total-progress.   The
                       value is monotonically increasing.

                     • total-progress  (int)  --  Estimated current-progress value at the completion of the job.
                       This value can arbitrarily change while the job is running, in both directions.

                     • error (string, optional) --

                       If this field is present, the job failed; if it is still missing in the CONCLUDED  state,
                       this indicates successful completion.

                       The  value  is a human-readable error message to describe the reason for the job failure.
                       It should not be parsed by applications.

       Command query-jobs (Since: 3.0)
              Return information about jobs.

              Return [JobInfo] -- a list with a JobInfo for each active job

BLOCK DEVICES

   Block core (VM unrelated)
       Object SnapshotInfo (Since: 1.3)

              Membersid (string) -- unique snapshot id

                     • name (string) -- user chosen name

                     • vm-state-size (int) -- size of the VM state

                     • date-sec (int) -- UTC date of the snapshot in seconds

                     • date-nsec (int) -- fractional part in nano seconds to be used with date-sec

                     • vm-clock-sec (int) -- VM clock relative to boot in seconds

                     • vm-clock-nsec (int) -- fractional part in nano seconds to be used with vm-clock-sec

                     • icount  (int,  optional)  --  Current  instruction   count.    Appears   when   execution
                       record/replay  is enabled.  Used for "time-traveling" to match the moment in the recorded
                       execution with the snapshots.  This counter may be obtained through query-replay  command
                       (since 5.2)

       Object ImageInfoSpecificQCow2EncryptionBase (Since: 2.10)

              Membersformat (BlockdevQcow2EncryptionFormat) -- The encryption format

       Object ImageInfoSpecificQCow2Encryption (Since: 2.10)

              Members

                     • The members of ImageInfoSpecificQCow2EncryptionBase.

                     • When format is luks: The members of QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS.

       Object ImageInfoSpecificQCow2 (Since: 1.7)

              Memberscompat (string) -- compatibility level

                     • data-file  (string, optional) -- the filename of the external data file that is stored in
                       the image and used as a default for opening the image (since: 4.0)

                     • data-file-raw (boolean, optional) -- True if the external data file must stay valid as  a
                       standalone (read-only) raw image without looking at qcow2 metadata (since: 4.0)

                     • extended-l2  (boolean, optional) -- true if the image has extended L2 entries; only valid
                       for compat >= 1.1 (since 5.2)

                     • lazy-refcounts (boolean, optional) -- on or off; only valid for compat >= 1.1

                     • corrupt (boolean, optional) -- true if the image has been marked corrupt; only valid  for
                       compat >= 1.1 (since 2.2)

                     • refcount-bits (int) -- width of a refcount entry in bits (since 2.3)

                     • encrypt   (ImageInfoSpecificQCow2Encryption,   optional)   --  details  about  encryption
                       parameters; only set if image is encrypted (since 2.10)

                     • bitmaps ([Qcow2BitmapInfo], optional) -- A list of qcow2 bitmap details (since 4.0)

                     • compression-type (Qcow2CompressionType) -- the image cluster  compression  method  (since
                       5.1)

       Object ImageInfoSpecificVmdk (Since: 1.7)

              Memberscreate-type (string) -- The create type of VMDK image

                     • cid (int) -- Content id of image

                     • parent-cid (int) -- Parent VMDK image's cid

                     • extents ([VmdkExtentInfo]) -- List of extent files

       Object VmdkExtentInfo (Since: 8.0)
              Information about a VMDK extent file

              Membersfilename (string) -- Name of the extent file

                     • format (string) -- Extent type (e.g. FLAT or SPARSE)

                     • virtual-size (int) -- Number of bytes covered by this extent

                     • cluster-size (int, optional) -- Cluster size in bytes (for non-flat extents)

                     • compressed (boolean, optional) -- Whether this extent contains compressed data

       Object ImageInfoSpecificRbd (Since: 6.1)

              Membersencryption-format (RbdImageEncryptionFormat, optional) -- Image encryption format

       Object ImageInfoSpecificFile (Since: 8.0)

              Membersextent-size-hint (int, optional) -- Extent size hint (if available)

       Enum ImageInfoSpecificKind (Since: 1.7)

              Valuesluks -- Since 2.7

                     • rbd -- Since 6.1

                     • file -- Since 8.0

                     • qcow2 -- Not documented

                     • vmdk -- Not documented

       Object ImageInfoSpecificQCow2Wrapper (Since: 1.7)

              Membersdata (ImageInfoSpecificQCow2) -- image information specific to QCOW2

       Object ImageInfoSpecificVmdkWrapper (Since: 6.1)

              Membersdata (ImageInfoSpecificVmdk) -- image information specific to VMDK

       Object ImageInfoSpecificLUKSWrapper (Since: 2.7)

              Membersdata (QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS) -- image information specific to LUKS

       Object ImageInfoSpecificRbdWrapper (Since: 6.1)

              Membersdata (ImageInfoSpecificRbd) -- image information specific to RBD

       Object ImageInfoSpecificFileWrapper (Since: 8.0)

              Membersdata (ImageInfoSpecificFile) -- image information specific to files

       Object ImageInfoSpecific (Since: 1.7)
              A discriminated record of image format specific information structures.

              Memberstype (ImageInfoSpecificKind) -- block driver name

                     • When type is qcow2: The members of ImageInfoSpecificQCow2Wrapper.

                     • When type is vmdk: The members of ImageInfoSpecificVmdkWrapper.

                     • When type is luks: The members of ImageInfoSpecificLUKSWrapper.

                     • When type is rbd: The members of ImageInfoSpecificRbdWrapper.

                     • When type is file: The members of ImageInfoSpecificFileWrapper.

       Object BlockNodeInfo (Since: 8.0)
              Information about a QEMU image file

              Membersfilename (string) -- name of the image file

                     • format (string) -- format of the image file

                     • virtual-size (int) -- maximum capacity in bytes of the image

                     • actual-size (int, optional) -- actual size on disk in bytes of the image

                     • dirty-flag (boolean, optional) -- true if image is not cleanly closed

                     • cluster-size (int, optional) -- size of a cluster in bytes

                     • encrypted (boolean, optional) -- true if the image is encrypted

                     • compressed (boolean, optional) -- true if the image is compressed (Since 1.7)

                     • backing-filename (string, optional) -- name of the backing file

                     • full-backing-filename (string, optional) -- full path of the backing file

                     • backing-filename-format (string, optional) -- the format of the backing file

                     • snapshots ([SnapshotInfo], optional) -- list of VM snapshots

                     • format-specific   (ImageInfoSpecific,   optional)   --   structure  supplying  additional
                       format-specific information (since 1.7)

       Object ImageInfo (Since: 1.3)
              Information about a QEMU image file, and potentially its backing image

              Membersbacking-image (ImageInfo, optional) -- info of the backing image

                     • The members of BlockNodeInfo.

       Object BlockChildInfo (Since: 8.0)
              Information about all nodes in the block graph starting at some node, annotated  with  information
              about that node in relation to its parent.

              Membersname (string) -- Child name of the root node in the BlockGraphInfo struct, in its role as
                       the child of some undescribed parent node

                     • info (BlockGraphInfo) -- Block graph information starting at this node

       Object BlockGraphInfo (Since: 8.0)
              Information  about  all  nodes  in a block (sub)graph in the form of BlockNodeInfo data.  The base
              BlockNodeInfo struct contains the information for the (sub)graph's root node.

              Memberschildren ([BlockChildInfo]) -- Array of links to this node's child nodes' information

                     • The members of BlockNodeInfo.

       Object ImageCheck (Since: 1.4)
              Information about a QEMU image file check

              Membersfilename (string) -- name of the image file checked

                     • format (string) -- format of the image file checked

                     • check-errors (int) -- number of unexpected errors occurred during check

                     • image-end-offset (int, optional) -- offset (in bytes) where the image ends, this field is
                       present if the driver for the image format supports it

                     • corruptions (int, optional) -- number of corruptions found during the check if any

                     • leaks (int, optional) -- number of leaks found during the check if any

                     • corruptions-fixed (int, optional) -- number of corruptions fixed during the check if any

                     • leaks-fixed (int, optional) -- number of leaks fixed during the check if any

                     • total-clusters (int, optional) -- total number of clusters, this field is present if  the
                       driver for the image format supports it

                     • allocated-clusters  (int,  optional) -- total number of allocated clusters, this field is
                       present if the driver for the image format supports it

                     • fragmented-clusters (int, optional) -- total number of fragmented clusters, this field is
                       present if the driver for the image format supports it

                     • compressed-clusters (int, optional) -- total number of compressed clusters, this field is
                       present if the driver for the image format supports it

       Object MapEntry (Since: 2.6)
              Mapping information from a virtual block range to a host file range

              Membersstart (int) -- virtual (guest) offset of the first byte described by this entry

                     • length (int) -- the number of bytes of the mapped virtual range

                     • data (boolean) -- reading the image will actually read data from a file  (in  particular,
                       if offset is present this means that the sectors are not simply preallocated, but contain
                       actual data in raw format)

                     • zero (boolean) -- whether the virtual blocks read as zeroes

                     • compressed (boolean) -- true if the data is stored compressed (since 8.2)

                     • depth  (int) -- number of layers (0 = top image, 1 = top image's backing file, ..., n - 1
                       = bottom image (where n is the number of images in the chain)) before  reaching  one  for
                       which the range is allocated

                     • present  (boolean)  --  true  if  this layer provides the data, false if adding a backing
                       layer could impact this region (since 6.1)

                     • offset (int, optional) -- if present, the image file stores the data for  this  range  in
                       raw format at the given (host) offset

                     • filename (string, optional) -- filename that is referred to by offset

       Object BlockdevCacheInfo (Since: 2.3)
              Cache mode information for a block device

              Memberswriteback (boolean) -- true if writeback mode is enabled

                     • direct (boolean) -- true if the host page cache is bypassed (O_DIRECT)

                     • no-flush (boolean) -- true if flush requests are ignored for the device

       Object BlockDeviceInfo (Since: 0.14)
              Information about the backing device for a block device.

              Membersfile (string) -- the filename of the backing device

                     • node-name (string, optional) -- the name of the block driver node (Since 2.0)

                     • ro (boolean) -- true if the backing device was open read-only

                     • drv (string) -- the name of the block format used to open the backing device.  As of 0.14
                       this  can  be: 'blkdebug', 'bochs', 'cloop', 'cow', 'dmg', 'file', 'file', 'ftp', 'ftps',
                       'host_cdrom',  'host_device',  'http',  'https',  'luks',  'nbd',  'parallels',   'qcow',
                       'qcow2',  'raw',  'vdi',  'vmdk',  'vpc', 'vvfat' 2.2: 'archipelago' added, 'cow' dropped
                       2.3:  'host_floppy'  deprecated  2.5:  'host_floppy'  dropped  2.6:  'luks'  added   2.8:
                       'replication' added, 'tftp' dropped 2.9: 'archipelago' dropped

                     • backing_file (string, optional) -- the name of the backing file (for copy-on-write)

                     • backing_file_depth (int) -- number of files in the backing file chain (since: 1.2)

                     • active  (boolean)  --  true if the backend is active; typical cases for inactive backends
                       are on the migration source instance after migration completes  and  on  the  destination
                       before it completes. (since: 10.0)

                     • encrypted (boolean) -- true if the backing device is encrypted

                     • detect_zeroes  (BlockdevDetectZeroesOptions)  --  detect  and optimize zero writes (Since
                       2.1)

                     • bps (int) -- total throughput limit in bytes per second is specified

                     • bps_rd (int) -- read throughput limit in bytes per second is specified

                     • bps_wr (int) -- write throughput limit in bytes per second is specified

                     • iops (int) -- total I/O operations per second is specified

                     • iops_rd (int) -- read I/O operations per second is specified

                     • iops_wr (int) -- write I/O operations per second is specified

                     • image (ImageInfo) -- the info of image used (since: 1.6)

                     • bps_max (int, optional) -- total throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)

                     • bps_rd_max (int, optional) -- read throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)

                     • bps_wr_max (int, optional) -- write throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)

                     • iops_max (int, optional) -- total I/O operations  per  second  during  bursts,  in  bytes
                       (Since 1.7)

                     • iops_rd_max  (int,  optional)  --  read I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes
                       (Since 1.7)

                     • iops_wr_max (int, optional) -- write I/O operations per second during  bursts,  in  bytes
                       (Since 1.7)

                     • bps_max_length (int, optional) -- maximum length of the bps_max burst period, in seconds.
                       (Since 2.6)

                     • bps_rd_max_length  (int,  optional)  -- maximum length of the bps_rd_max burst period, in
                       seconds.  (Since 2.6)

                     • bps_wr_max_length (int, optional) -- maximum length of the bps_wr_max  burst  period,  in
                       seconds.  (Since 2.6)

                     • iops_max_length  (int,  optional) -- maximum length of the iops burst period, in seconds.
                       (Since 2.6)

                     • iops_rd_max_length (int, optional) -- maximum length of the iops_rd_max burst period,  in
                       seconds.  (Since 2.6)

                     • iops_wr_max_length  (int, optional) -- maximum length of the iops_wr_max burst period, in
                       seconds.  (Since 2.6)

                     • iops_size (int, optional) -- an I/O size in bytes (Since 1.7)

                     • group (string, optional) -- throttle group name (Since 2.4)

                     • cache (BlockdevCacheInfo) -- the cache mode used for the block device (since: 2.3)

                     • write_threshold (int) -- configured write threshold  for  the  device.   0  if  disabled.
                       (Since 2.3)

                     • dirty-bitmaps  ([BlockDirtyInfo], optional) -- dirty bitmaps information (only present if
                       node has one or more dirty bitmaps) (Since 4.2)

       Enum BlockDeviceIoStatus (Since: 1.0)
              An enumeration of block device I/O status.

              Valuesok -- The last I/O operation has succeeded

                     • failed -- The last I/O operation has failed

                     • nospace -- The last I/O operation has failed due to a no-space condition

       Object BlockDirtyInfo (Since: 1.3)
              Block dirty bitmap information.

              Membersname (string, optional) -- the name of the dirty bitmap (Since 2.4)

                     • count (int) -- number of dirty bytes according to the dirty bitmap

                     • granularity (int) -- granularity of the dirty bitmap in bytes (since 1.4)

                     • recording (boolean) -- true if the bitmap is recording new writes from the guest.  (since
                       4.0)

                     • busy (boolean) -- true if the bitmap is in-use by some operation (NBD or jobs) and cannot
                       be modified via QMP or used by another operation.  (since 4.0)

                     • persistent (boolean) -- true if the bitmap was stored on disk, is scheduled to be  stored
                       on disk, or both.  (since 4.0)

                     • inconsistent  (boolean,  optional)  --  true  if  this  is  a  persistent bitmap that was
                       improperly stored.  Implies persistent to be true; recording and busy to be false.   This
                       bitmap cannot be used.  To remove it, use block-dirty-bitmap-remove.  (Since 4.0)

       Enum Qcow2BitmapInfoFlags (Since: 4.0)
              An enumeration of flags that a bitmap can report to the user.

              Valuesin-use  -- This flag is set by any process actively modifying the qcow2 file, and cleared
                       when the updated bitmap is flushed to the qcow2 image.  The presence of this flag  in  an
                       offline image means that the bitmap was not saved correctly after its last usage, and may
                       contain inconsistent data.

                     • auto  --  The bitmap must reflect all changes of the virtual disk by any application that
                       would write to this qcow2 file.

       Object Qcow2BitmapInfo (Since: 4.0)
              Qcow2 bitmap information.

              Membersname (string) -- the name of the bitmap

                     • granularity (int) -- granularity of the bitmap in bytes

                     • flags ([Qcow2BitmapInfoFlags]) -- flags of the bitmap

       Object BlockLatencyHistogramInfo (Since: 4.0)
              Block latency histogram.

              Membersboundaries ([int]) -- list of interval boundary values in nanoseconds, all  greater  than
                       zero  and in ascending order.  For example, the list [10, 50, 100] produces the following
                       histogram intervals: [0, 10), [10, 50), [50, 100), [100, +inf).

                     • bins ([int]) --

                       list of io request counts corresponding to histogram intervals,  one  more  element  than
                       boundaries  has.   For  the  example  above, bins may be something like [3, 1, 5, 2], and
                       corresponding histogram looks like:

                          5|           *
                          4|           *
                          3| *         *
                          2| *         *    *
                          1| *    *    *    *
                           +------------------
                               10   50   100

       Object BlockInfo (Since: 0.14)
              Block device information.  This structure describes  a  virtual  device  and  the  backing  device
              associated with it.

              Membersdevice (string) -- The device name associated with the virtual device.

                     • qdev  (string,  optional)  --  The  qdev ID, or if no ID is assigned, the QOM path of the
                       block device.  (since 2.10)

                     • type (string) -- This field is returned only for compatibility reasons, it should not  be
                       used (always returns 'unknown')

                     • removable (boolean) -- True if the device supports removable media.

                     • locked  (boolean)  --  True  if  the  guest  has locked this device from having its media
                       removed

                     • tray_open (boolean, optional) -- True if the device's tray is open (only  present  if  it
                       has a tray)

                     • io-status  (BlockDeviceIoStatus,  optional)  -- BlockDeviceIoStatus.  Only present if the
                       device supports it and the VM is configured to stop on errors (supported  device  models:
                       virtio-blk, IDE, SCSI except scsi-generic)

                     • inserted (BlockDeviceInfo, optional) -- BlockDeviceInfo describing the device if media is
                       present

       Object BlockMeasureInfo (Since: 2.10)
              Image  file  size  calculation  information.   This  structure describes the size requirements for
              creating a new image file.

              The size requirements depend on the new image file format.  File size always equals  virtual  disk
              size for the 'raw' format, even for sparse POSIX files.  Compact formats such as 'qcow2' represent
              unallocated and zero regions efficiently so file size may be smaller than virtual disk size.

              The  values  are  upper  bounds  that  are  guaranteed  to  fit  the  new  image file.  Subsequent
              modification, such as internal snapshot or further bitmap creation, may require  additional  space
              and is not covered here.

              Membersrequired  (int)  --  Size  required  for  a  new  image file, in bytes, when copying just
                       allocated guest-visible contents.

                     • fully-allocated (int) -- Image file size, in bytes, once data has  been  written  to  all
                       sectors, when copying just guest-visible contents.

                     • bitmaps  (int, optional) -- Additional size required if all the top-level bitmap metadata
                       in the source image were to be copied to the destination, present only  when  source  and
                       destination both support persistent bitmaps.  (since 5.1)

       Command query-block (Since: 0.14)
              Get a list of BlockInfo for all virtual block devices.

              Return [BlockInfo] -- a list of BlockInfo describing each virtual block device.  Filter nodes that
                     were created implicitly are skipped over.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-block" }
                     <- {
                           "return":[
                              {
                                 "io-status": "ok",
                                 "device":"ide0-hd0",
                                 "locked":false,
                                 "removable":false,
                                 "inserted":{
                                    "ro":false,
                                    "drv":"qcow2",
                                    "encrypted":false,
                                    "file":"disks/test.qcow2",
                                    "backing_file_depth":1,
                                    "bps":1000000,
                                    "bps_rd":0,
                                    "bps_wr":0,
                                    "iops":1000000,
                                    "iops_rd":0,
                                    "iops_wr":0,
                                    "bps_max": 8000000,
                                    "bps_rd_max": 0,
                                    "bps_wr_max": 0,
                                    "iops_max": 0,
                                    "iops_rd_max": 0,
                                    "iops_wr_max": 0,
                                    "iops_size": 0,
                                    "detect_zeroes": "on",
                                    "write_threshold": 0,
                                    "image":{
                                       "filename":"disks/test.qcow2",
                                       "format":"qcow2",
                                       "virtual-size":2048000,
                                       "backing_file":"base.qcow2",
                                       "full-backing-filename":"disks/base.qcow2",
                                       "backing-filename-format":"qcow2",
                                       "snapshots":[
                                          {
                                             "id": "1",
                                             "name": "snapshot1",
                                             "vm-state-size": 0,
                                             "date-sec": 10000200,
                                             "date-nsec": 12,
                                             "vm-clock-sec": 206,
                                             "vm-clock-nsec": 30
                                          }
                                       ],
                                       "backing-image":{
                                           "filename":"disks/base.qcow2",
                                           "format":"qcow2",
                                           "virtual-size":2048000
                                       }
                                    }
                                 },
                                 "qdev": "ide_disk",
                                 "type":"unknown"
                              },
                              {
                                 "io-status": "ok",
                                 "device":"ide1-cd0",
                                 "locked":false,
                                 "removable":true,
                                 "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[23]",
                                 "tray_open": false,
                                 "type":"unknown"
                              },
                              {
                                 "device":"floppy0",
                                 "locked":false,
                                 "removable":true,
                                 "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[20]",
                                 "type":"unknown"
                              },
                              {
                                 "device":"sd0",
                                 "locked":false,
                                 "removable":true,
                                 "type":"unknown"
                              }
                           ]
                        }

       Object BlockDeviceTimedStats (Since: 2.5)
              Statistics of a block device during a given interval of time.

              Membersinterval_length (int) -- Interval used for calculating the statistics, in seconds.

                     • min_rd_latency_ns (int) -- Minimum latency of read operations in the defined interval, in
                       nanoseconds.

                     • min_wr_latency_ns  (int)  -- Minimum latency of write operations in the defined interval,
                       in nanoseconds.

                     • min_zone_append_latency_ns (int) -- Minimum latency of  zone  append  operations  in  the
                       defined interval, in nanoseconds (since 8.1)

                     • min_flush_latency_ns  (int)  --  Minimum  latency  of  flush  operations  in  the defined
                       interval, in nanoseconds.

                     • max_rd_latency_ns (int) -- Maximum latency of read operations in the defined interval, in
                       nanoseconds.

                     • max_wr_latency_ns (int) -- Maximum latency of write operations in the  defined  interval,
                       in nanoseconds.

                     • max_zone_append_latency_ns  (int)  --  Maximum  latency  of zone append operations in the
                       defined interval, in nanoseconds (since 8.1)

                     • max_flush_latency_ns (int)  --  Maximum  latency  of  flush  operations  in  the  defined
                       interval, in nanoseconds.

                     • avg_rd_latency_ns (int) -- Average latency of read operations in the defined interval, in
                       nanoseconds.

                     • avg_wr_latency_ns  (int)  -- Average latency of write operations in the defined interval,
                       in nanoseconds.

                     • avg_zone_append_latency_ns (int) -- Average latency of  zone  append  operations  in  the
                       defined interval, in nanoseconds (since 8.1)

                     • avg_flush_latency_ns  (int)  --  Average  latency  of  flush  operations  in  the defined
                       interval, in nanoseconds.

                     • avg_rd_queue_depth (number) -- Average number of pending read operations in  the  defined
                       interval.

                     • avg_wr_queue_depth  (number) -- Average number of pending write operations in the defined
                       interval.

                     • avg_zone_append_queue_depth (number) -- Average number of pending zone append  operations
                       in the defined interval (since 8.1).

       Object BlockDeviceStats (Since: 0.14)
              Statistics of a virtual block device or a block backing device.

              Membersrd_bytes (int) -- The number of bytes read by the device.

                     • wr_bytes (int) -- The number of bytes written by the device.

                     • zone_append_bytes (int) -- The number of bytes appended by the zoned devices (since 8.1)

                     • unmap_bytes (int) -- The number of bytes unmapped by the device (Since 4.2)

                     • rd_operations (int) -- The number of read operations performed by the device.

                     • wr_operations (int) -- The number of write operations performed by the device.

                     • zone_append_operations  (int)  --  The  number of zone append operations performed by the
                       zoned devices (since 8.1)

                     • flush_operations (int) -- The number of cache flush operations performed  by  the  device
                       (since 0.15)

                     • unmap_operations  (int)  -- The number of unmap operations performed by the device (Since
                       4.2)

                     • rd_total_time_ns (int) -- Total time spent on reads in nanoseconds (since 0.15).

                     • wr_total_time_ns (int) -- Total time spent on writes in nanoseconds (since 0.15).

                     • zone_append_total_time_ns (int) -- Total time spent on zone append writes in  nanoseconds
                       (since 8.1)

                     • flush_total_time_ns  (int)  --  Total  time  spent on cache flushes in nanoseconds (since
                       0.15).

                     • unmap_total_time_ns (int) -- Total time spent on unmap operations in  nanoseconds  (Since
                       4.2)

                     • wr_highest_offset (int) -- The offset after the greatest byte written to the device.  The
                       intended  use of this information is for growable sparse files (like qcow2) that are used
                       on top of a physical device.

                     • rd_merged (int) -- Number of read requests that have been  merged  into  another  request
                       (Since 2.3).

                     • wr_merged  (int)  --  Number of write requests that have been merged into another request
                       (Since 2.3).

                     • zone_append_merged (int) -- Number of zone append requests that  have  been  merged  into
                       another request (since 8.1)

                     • unmap_merged (int) -- Number of unmap requests that have been merged into another request
                       (Since 4.2)

                     • idle_time_ns  (int,  optional)  -- Time since the last I/O operation, in nanoseconds.  If
                       the field is absent it means that there haven't been any operations yet (Since 2.5).

                     • failed_rd_operations (int) -- The number of  failed  read  operations  performed  by  the
                       device (Since 2.5)

                     • failed_wr_operations  (int)  --  The  number  of failed write operations performed by the
                       device (Since 2.5)

                     • failed_zone_append_operations (int) -- The number of failed zone append write  operations
                       performed by the zoned devices (since 8.1)

                     • failed_flush_operations  (int)  -- The number of failed flush operations performed by the
                       device (Since 2.5)

                     • failed_unmap_operations (int) -- The number of failed unmap operations performed  by  the
                       device (Since 4.2)

                     • invalid_rd_operations  (int)  --  The  number of invalid read operations performed by the
                       device (Since 2.5)

                     • invalid_wr_operations (int) -- The number of invalid write operations  performed  by  the
                       device (Since 2.5)

                     • invalid_zone_append_operations  (int)  --  The  number  of invalid zone append operations
                       performed by the zoned device (since 8.1)

                     • invalid_flush_operations (int) -- The number of invalid flush operations performed by the
                       device (Since 2.5)

                     • invalid_unmap_operations (int) -- The number of invalid unmap operations performed by the
                       device (Since 4.2)

                     • account_invalid (boolean) -- Whether invalid operations are included in the  last  access
                       statistics (Since 2.5)

                     • account_failed  (boolean)  --  Whether  failed operations are included in the latency and
                       last access statistics (Since 2.5)

                     • timed_stats ([BlockDeviceTimedStats]) -- Statistics specific to  the  set  of  previously
                       defined intervals of time (Since 2.5)

                     • rd_latency_histogram  (BlockLatencyHistogramInfo, optional) -- BlockLatencyHistogramInfo.
                       (Since 4.0)

                     • wr_latency_histogram (BlockLatencyHistogramInfo, optional) --  BlockLatencyHistogramInfo.
                       (Since 4.0)

                     • zone_append_latency_histogram        (BlockLatencyHistogramInfo,       optional)       --
                       BlockLatencyHistogramInfo.  (since 8.1)

                     • flush_latency_histogram         (BlockLatencyHistogramInfo,         optional)          --
                       BlockLatencyHistogramInfo.  (Since 4.0)

       Object BlockStatsSpecificFile (Since: 4.2)
              File driver statistics

              Membersdiscard-nb-ok  (int)  --  The  number  of  successful discard operations performed by the
                       driver.

                     • discard-nb-failed (int) -- The number of  failed  discard  operations  performed  by  the
                       driver.

                     • discard-bytes-ok (int) -- The number of bytes discarded by the driver.

       Object BlockStatsSpecificNvme (Since: 5.2)
              NVMe driver statistics

              Memberscompletion-errors (int) -- The number of completion errors.

                     • aligned-accesses (int) -- The number of aligned accesses performed by the driver.

                     • unaligned-accesses (int) -- The number of unaligned accesses performed by the driver.

       Object BlockStatsSpecific (Since: 4.2)
              Block driver specific statistics

              Membersdriver (BlockdevDriver) -- block driver name

                     • When driver is file: The members of BlockStatsSpecificFile.

                     • When driver is host_device: The members of BlockStatsSpecificFile.

                     • When driver is nvme: The members of BlockStatsSpecificNvme.

       Object BlockStats (Since: 0.14)
              Statistics of a virtual block device or a block backing device.

              Membersdevice  (string,  optional)  --  If  the  stats  are for a virtual block device, the name
                       corresponding to the virtual block device.

                     • node-name (string, optional) -- The node name of the device.  (Since 2.3)

                     • qdev (string, optional) -- The qdev ID, or if no ID is assigned,  the  QOM  path  of  the
                       block device.  (since 3.0)

                     • stats (BlockDeviceStats) -- A BlockDeviceStats for the device.

                     • driver-specific (BlockStatsSpecific, optional) -- Optional driver-specific stats.  (Since
                       4.2)

                     • parent  (BlockStats,  optional)  --  This  describes the file block device if it has one.
                       Contains recursively the statistics of the underlying protocol (e.g. the host file for  a
                       qcow2 image).  If there is no underlying protocol, this field is omitted

                     • backing  (BlockStats, optional) -- This describes the backing block device if it has one.
                       (Since 2.0)

       Command query-blockstats (Since: 0.14)
              Query the BlockStats for all virtual block devices.

              Argumentsquery-nodes (boolean, optional) -- If true, the command will query all  the  block  nodes
                       that  have  a  node  name,  in  a  list  which will include "parent" information, but not
                       "backing".  If false or omitted, the behavior  is  as  before  -  query  all  the  device
                       backends,  recursively  including  their  "parent" and "backing".  Filter nodes that were
                       created implicitly are skipped over in this mode.  (Since 2.3)

              Return [BlockStats] -- A list of BlockStats for each virtual block devices.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-blockstats" }
                     <- {
                           "return":[
                              {
                                 "device":"ide0-hd0",
                                 "parent":{
                                    "stats":{
                                       "wr_highest_offset":3686448128,
                                       "wr_bytes":9786368,
                                       "wr_operations":751,
                                       "rd_bytes":122567168,
                                       "rd_operations":36772
                                       "wr_total_times_ns":313253456
                                       "rd_total_times_ns":3465673657
                                       "flush_total_times_ns":49653
                                       "flush_operations":61,
                                       "rd_merged":0,
                                       "wr_merged":0,
                                       "idle_time_ns":2953431879,
                                       "account_invalid":true,
                                       "account_failed":false
                                    }
                                 },
                                 "stats":{
                                    "wr_highest_offset":2821110784,
                                    "wr_bytes":9786368,
                                    "wr_operations":692,
                                    "rd_bytes":122739200,
                                    "rd_operations":36604
                                    "flush_operations":51,
                                    "wr_total_times_ns":313253456
                                    "rd_total_times_ns":3465673657
                                    "flush_total_times_ns":49653,
                                    "rd_merged":0,
                                    "wr_merged":0,
                                    "idle_time_ns":2953431879,
                                    "account_invalid":true,
                                    "account_failed":false
                                 },
                                 "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[23]"
                              },
                              {
                                 "device":"ide1-cd0",
                                 "stats":{
                                    "wr_highest_offset":0,
                                    "wr_bytes":0,
                                    "wr_operations":0,
                                    "rd_bytes":0,
                                    "rd_operations":0
                                    "flush_operations":0,
                                    "wr_total_times_ns":0
                                    "rd_total_times_ns":0
                                    "flush_total_times_ns":0,
                                    "rd_merged":0,
                                    "wr_merged":0,
                                    "account_invalid":false,
                                    "account_failed":false
                                 },
                                 "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[24]"
                              },
                              {
                                 "device":"floppy0",
                                 "stats":{
                                    "wr_highest_offset":0,
                                    "wr_bytes":0,
                                    "wr_operations":0,
                                    "rd_bytes":0,
                                    "rd_operations":0
                                    "flush_operations":0,
                                    "wr_total_times_ns":0
                                    "rd_total_times_ns":0
                                    "flush_total_times_ns":0,
                                    "rd_merged":0,
                                    "wr_merged":0,
                                    "account_invalid":false,
                                    "account_failed":false
                                 },
                                 "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[16]"
                              },
                              {
                                 "device":"sd0",
                                 "stats":{
                                    "wr_highest_offset":0,
                                    "wr_bytes":0,
                                    "wr_operations":0,
                                    "rd_bytes":0,
                                    "rd_operations":0
                                    "flush_operations":0,
                                    "wr_total_times_ns":0
                                    "rd_total_times_ns":0
                                    "flush_total_times_ns":0,
                                    "rd_merged":0,
                                    "wr_merged":0,
                                    "account_invalid":false,
                                    "account_failed":false
                                 }
                              }
                           ]
                        }

       Enum BlockdevOnError (Since: 1.3)
              An enumeration of possible behaviors for errors on I/O operations.  The exact meaning  depends  on
              whether the I/O was initiated by a guest or by a block job

              Valuesreport -- for guest operations, report the error to the guest; for jobs, cancel the job

                     • ignore  -- ignore the error, only report a QMP event (BLOCK_IO_ERROR or BLOCK_JOB_ERROR).
                       The backup, mirror and commit block jobs retry the failing request later  and  may  still
                       complete  successfully.   The stream block job continues to stream and will complete with
                       an error.

                     • enospc -- same as stop on ENOSPC, same as report otherwise.

                     • stop -- for guest operations, stop the virtual machine; for jobs, pause the job

                     • auto -- inherit the error handling policy of the backend (since: 2.7)

       Enum MirrorSyncMode (Since: 1.3)
              An enumeration of possible behaviors for the initial synchronization phase of storage mirroring.

              Valuestop -- copies data in the topmost image to the destination

                     • full -- copies data from all images to the destination

                     • none -- only copy data written from now on

                     • incremental -- only copy data described by the dirty bitmap.  (since: 2.4)

                     • bitmap -- only copy data described  by  the  dirty  bitmap.   (since:  4.2)  Behavior  on
                       completion is determined by the BitmapSyncMode.

       Enum BitmapSyncMode (Since: 4.2)
              An  enumeration  of possible behaviors for the synchronization of a bitmap when used for data copy
              operations.

              Valueson-success -- The bitmap is only synced when the operation is successful.   This  is  the
                       behavior always used for 'INCREMENTAL' backups.

                     • never  -- The bitmap is never synchronized with the operation, and is treated solely as a
                       read-only manifest of blocks to copy.

                     • always -- The bitmap is always synchronized with the operation, regardless of whether  or
                       not the operation was successful.

       Enum MirrorCopyMode (Since: 3.0)
              An enumeration whose values tell the mirror block job when to trigger writes to the target.

              Valuesbackground -- copy data in background only.

                     • write-blocking  --  when  data  is written to the source, write it (synchronously) to the
                       target as well.  In addition, data is copied in background just like in background mode.

       Object BlockJobInfoMirror (Since: 8.2)
              Information specific to mirror block jobs.

              Membersactively-synced (boolean) -- Whether the source is actively synced to  the  target,  i.e.
                       same data and new writes are done synchronously to both.

       Object BlockJobInfo (Since: 1.1)
              Information about a long-running block device operation.

              Memberstype (JobType) -- the job type ('stream' for image streaming)

                     • device  (string)  -- The job identifier.  Originally the device name but other values are
                       allowed since QEMU 2.7

                     • len (int) -- Estimated offset value at  the  completion  of  the  job.   This  value  can
                       arbitrarily change while the job is running, in both directions.

                     • offset  (int)  --  Progress made until now.  The unit is arbitrary and the value can only
                       meaningfully be used for the  ratio  of  offset  to  len.   The  value  is  monotonically
                       increasing.

                     • busy  (boolean)  -- false if the job is known to be in a quiescent state, with no pending
                       I/O.  (Since 1.3)

                     • paused (boolean) -- whether the job is paused or, if busy is true, will pause  itself  as
                       soon as possible.  (Since 1.3)

                     • speed (int) -- the rate limit, bytes per second

                     • io-status (BlockDeviceIoStatus) -- the status of the job (since 1.3)

                     • ready (boolean) -- true if the job may be completed (since 2.2)

                     • status (JobStatus) -- Current job state/status (since 2.12)

                     • auto-finalize (boolean) -- Job will finalize itself when PENDING, moving to the CONCLUDED
                       state.  (since 2.12)

                     • auto-dismiss  (boolean)  --  Job  will  dismiss itself when CONCLUDED, moving to the NULL
                       state and disappearing from the query list.  (since 2.12)

                     • error (string, optional) -- Error information if the job did not  complete  successfully.
                       Not set if the job completed successfully.  (since 2.12.1)

                     • When type is mirror: The members of BlockJobInfoMirror.

       Command query-block-jobs (Since: 1.1)
              Return information about long-running block device operations.

              Return [BlockJobInfo] -- a list of BlockJobInfo for each active block job

       Command block_resize (Since: 0.14)
              Resize a block image while a guest is running.

              Either device or node-name must be set but not both.

              Argumentsdevice (string, optional) -- the name of the device to get the image resized

                     • node-name (string, optional) -- graph node name to get the image resized (Since 2.0)

                     • size (int) -- new image size in bytes

              Errors

                     • If device is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "block_resize",
                          "arguments": { "device": "scratch", "size": 1073741824 } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Enum NewImageMode (Since: 1.1)
              An enumeration that tells QEMU how to set the backing file path in a new image file.

              Valuesexisting -- QEMU should look for an existing image file.

                     • absolute-paths  --  QEMU  should  create  a new image with absolute paths for the backing
                       file.  If there is no backing file available, the new image will not be backed either.

       Object BlockdevSnapshotSync
              Either device or node-name must be set but not both.

              Membersdevice (string, optional) -- the name of the device to take a snapshot of.

                     • node-name (string, optional) -- graph node name to generate the snapshot from (Since 2.0)

                     • snapshot-file (string) -- the target of the new overlay image.  If the file exists, or if
                       it is a device, the overlay will be created in the existing  file/device.   Otherwise,  a
                       new file will be created.

                     • snapshot-node-name (string, optional) -- the graph node name of the new image (Since 2.0)

                     • format (string, optional) -- the format of the overlay image, default is 'qcow2'.

                     • mode  (NewImageMode, optional) -- whether and how QEMU should create a new image, default
                       is 'absolute-paths'.

       Object BlockdevSnapshot (Since: 2.5)

              Membersnode (string) -- device or node name that will have a snapshot taken.

                     • overlay (string) -- reference to the existing block device that will become  the  overlay
                       of  node,  as part of taking the snapshot.  It must not have a current backing file (this
                       can be achieved by passing "backing": null to blockdev-add).

       Object BackupPerf (Since: 6.0)
              Optional  parameters  for  backup.   These  parameters  don't  affect   functionality,   but   may
              significantly affect performance.

              Membersuse-copy-range (boolean, optional) -- Use copy offloading.  Default false.

                     • max-workers  (int,  optional)  --  Maximum  number of parallel requests for the sustained
                       background copying process.  Doesn't influence copy-before-write operations.  Default 64.

                     • max-chunk (int, optional) -- Maximum request length for the sustained background  copying
                       process.   Doesn't  influence  copy-before-write  operations.   0  means  unlimited.   If
                       max-chunk is non-zero then it  should  not  be  less  than  job  cluster  size  which  is
                       calculated as maximum of target image cluster size and 64k.  Default 0.

                     • min-cluster-size  (int, optional) -- Minimum size of blocks used by copy-before-write and
                       background copy operations.  Has to be a power of 2.   No  effect  if  smaller  than  the
                       maximum of the target's cluster size and 64 KiB.  Default 0.  (Since 9.2)

       Object BackupCommon (Since: 4.2)

              Membersjob-id (string, optional) -- identifier for the newly-created block job.  If omitted, the
                       device name will be used.  (Since 2.7)

                     • device (string) -- the device name or node-name of a root node which should be copied.

                     • sync (MirrorSyncMode) -- what parts of the disk image should be copied to the destination
                       (all  the  disk, only the sectors allocated in the topmost image, from a dirty bitmap, or
                       only new I/O).

                     • speed (int, optional) -- the maximum speed, in bytes per second.  The default is  0,  for
                       unlimited.

                     • bitmap  (string, optional) -- The name of a dirty bitmap to use.  Must be present if sync
                       is "bitmap" or "incremental".  Can be present if sync is "full" or "top".   Must  not  be
                       present otherwise.  (Since 2.4 (drive-backup), 3.1 (blockdev-backup))

                     • bitmap-mode  (BitmapSyncMode,  optional)  -- Specifies the type of data the bitmap should
                       contain after the operation concludes.  Must be present if a bitmap  was  provided,  Must
                       NOT be present otherwise.  (Since 4.2)

                     • compress  (boolean, optional) -- true to compress data, if the target format supports it.
                       (default: false) (since 2.8)

                     • on-source-error (BlockdevOnError, optional) -- the action to take  on  an  error  on  the
                       source,  default  'report'.   'stop'  and  'enospc'  can only be used if the block device
                       supports io-status (see BlockInfo).

                     • on-target-error (BlockdevOnError, optional) -- the action to take  on  an  error  on  the
                       target,  default 'report' (no limitations, since this applies to a different block device
                       than device).

                     • auto-finalize (boolean, optional) -- When false, this job will wait in  a  PENDING  state
                       after  it  has  finished its work, waiting for block-job-finalize before making any block
                       graph changes.  When true, this job  will  automatically  perform  its  abort  or  commit
                       actions.  Defaults to true.  (Since 2.12)

                     • auto-dismiss  (boolean,  optional) -- When false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state
                       after it has completely ceased all work, and awaits block-job-dismiss.  When  true,  this
                       job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention.  Defaults
                       to true.  (Since 2.12)

                     • filter-node-name  (string,  optional)  --  the  node  name that should be assigned to the
                       filter driver that the backup job inserts into the graph above node specified  by  drive.
                       If this option is not given, a node name is autogenerated.  (Since: 4.2)

                     • discard-source  (boolean,  optional)  -- Discard blocks on source which have already been
                       copied to the target.  (Since 9.1)

                     • x-perf (BackupPerf, optional) -- Performance options.  (Since 6.0)

              Featuresunstable -- Member x-perf is experimental.

              NOTE:
                 on-source-error and on-target-error only affect background I/O.  If an error  occurs  during  a
                 guest write request, the device's rerror/werror actions will be used.

       Object DriveBackup (Since: 1.6)

              Memberstarget  (string)  --  the  target  of  the  new image.  If the file exists, or if it is a
                       device, the existing file/device will be used as the new destination.   If  it  does  not
                       exist, a new file will be created.

                     • format  (string,  optional)  -- the format of the new destination, default is to probe if
                       mode is 'existing', else the format of the source

                     • mode (NewImageMode, optional) -- whether and how QEMU should create a new image,  default
                       is 'absolute-paths'.

                     • The members of BackupCommon.

       Object BlockdevBackup (Since: 2.3)

              Memberstarget (string) -- the device name or node-name of the backup target node.

                     • The members of BackupCommon.

       Command blockdev-snapshot-sync (Since: 0.14)
              Takes a synchronous snapshot of a block device.

              Arguments

                     • The members of BlockdevSnapshotSync.

              Errors

                     • If device is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "blockdev-snapshot-sync",
                          "arguments": { "device": "ide-hd0",
                                         "snapshot-file":
                                         "/some/place/my-image",
                                         "format": "qcow2" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command blockdev-snapshot (Since: 2.5)
              Takes a snapshot of a block device.

              Take  a snapshot, by installing 'node' as the backing image of 'overlay'.  Additionally, if 'node'
              is associated with a block device, the block device changes to using 'overlay' as its  new  active
              image.

              Arguments

                     • The members of BlockdevSnapshot.

              Featuresallow-write-only-overlay  --  If  present,  the  check whether this operation is safe was
                       relaxed so  that  it  can  be  used  to  change  backing  file  of  a  destination  of  a
                       blockdev-mirror.  (since 5.0)

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "blockdev-add",
                          "arguments": { "driver": "qcow2",
                                         "node-name": "node1534",
                                         "file": { "driver": "file",
                                                   "filename": "hd1.qcow2" },
                                         "backing": null } }

                     <- { "return": {} }

                     -> { "execute": "blockdev-snapshot",
                          "arguments": { "node": "ide-hd0",
                                         "overlay": "node1534" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command change-backing-file (Since: 2.1)
              Change  the backing file in the image file metadata.  This does not cause QEMU to reopen the image
              file to reparse the backing filename (it may, however, perform a reopen to change permissions from
              r/o -> r/w -> r/o, if needed).  The new backing  file  string  is  written  into  the  image  file
              metadata, and the QEMU internal strings are updated.

              Argumentsimage-node-name  (string)  --  The  name  of  the block driver state node of the image to
                       modify.  The "device" argument is used  to  verify  "image-node-name"  is  in  the  chain
                       described by "device".

                     • device   (string)   --  The  device  name  or  node-name  of  the  root  node  that  owns
                       image-node-name.

                     • backing-file (string) -- The string to write as the backing file.   This  string  is  not
                       validated,  so care should be taken when specifying the string or the image chain may not
                       be able to be reopened again.

              Errors

                     • If "device" does not exist or cannot be determined, DeviceNotFound

       Command block-commit (Since: 1.3)
              Live commit of data from overlay image nodes into backing nodes - i.e., writes data between  'top'
              and 'base' into 'base'.

              If  top  ==  base, that is an error.  If top has no overlays on top of it, or if it is in use by a
              writer, the job will not be completed by itself.  The user needs to  complete  the  job  with  the
              block-job-complete command after getting the ready event.  (Since 2.0)

              If  the base image is smaller than top, then the base image will be resized to be the same size as
              top.  If top is smaller than the base image, the base will not be truncated.  If you want the base
              image size to match the size of the smaller top, you can safely  truncate  it  yourself  once  the
              commit operation successfully completes.

              Argumentsjob-id (string, optional) -- identifier for the newly-created block job.  If omitted, the
                       device name will be used.  (Since 2.7)

                     • device (string) -- the device name or node-name of a root node

                     • base-node  (string,  optional)  -- The node name of the backing image to write data into.
                       If not specified, this is the deepest backing image.  (since: 3.1)

                     • base (string, optional) -- Same as base-node, except that it is a file name rather than a
                       node name.  This must be the exact filename string that was used to open the node;  other
                       strings, even if addressing the same file, are not accepted

                     • top-node  (string, optional) -- The node name of the backing image within the image chain
                       which contains the topmost data to be committed down.  If  not  specified,  this  is  the
                       active layer.  (since: 3.1)

                     • top  (string,  optional) -- Same as top-node, except that it is a file name rather than a
                       node name.  This must be the exact filename string that was used to open the node;  other
                       strings, even if addressing the same file, are not accepted

                     • backing-file (string, optional) --

                       The backing file string to write into the overlay image of 'top'.  If 'top' does not have
                       an  overlay image, or if 'top' is in use by a writer, specifying a backing file string is
                       an error.

                       This filename is not validated.  If a pathname string is such that it cannot be  resolved
                       by QEMU, that means that subsequent QMP or HMP commands must use node-names for the image
                       in question, as filename lookup methods will fail.

                       If  not  specified,  QEMU will automatically determine the backing file string to use, or
                       error out if there is no obvious choice.   Care  should  be  taken  when  specifying  the
                       string, to specify a valid filename or protocol.  (Since 2.1)

                     • backing-mask-protocol  (boolean,  optional) -- If true, replace any protocol mentioned in
                       the 'backing file format' with 'raw', rather  than  storing  the  protocol  name  as  the
                       backing  format.   Can  be used even when no image header will be updated (default false;
                       since 9.0).

                     • speed (int, optional) -- the maximum speed, in bytes per second

                     • on-error (BlockdevOnError, optional) -- the action to take on an error.   'ignore'  means
                       that the request should be retried.  (default: report; Since: 5.0)

                     • filter-node-name  (string,  optional)  --  the  node  name that should be assigned to the
                       filter driver that the commit job inserts into the graph above top.  If  this  option  is
                       not given, a node name is autogenerated.  (Since: 2.9)

                     • auto-finalize  (boolean,  optional)  -- When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state
                       after it has finished its work, waiting for block-job-finalize before  making  any  block
                       graph  changes.   When  true,  this  job  will  automatically perform its abort or commit
                       actions.  Defaults to true.  (Since 3.1)

                     • auto-dismiss (boolean, optional) -- When false, this job will wait in a  CONCLUDED  state
                       after  it  has completely ceased all work, and awaits block-job-dismiss.  When true, this
                       job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention.  Defaults
                       to true.  (Since 3.1)

              Featuresdeprecated -- Members base and top are deprecated.  Use base-node and top-node instead.

              Errors

                     • If device does not exist, DeviceNotFound

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "block-commit",
                          "arguments": { "device": "virtio0",
                                         "top": "/tmp/snap1.qcow2" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command drive-backup (Since: 1.6)
              This command is deprecated.

              Start a point-in-time copy of a block  device  to  a  new  destination.   The  status  of  ongoing
              drive-backup operations can be checked with query-block-jobs where the BlockJobInfo.type field has
              the   value   'backup'.   The  operation  can  be  stopped  before  it  has  completed  using  the
              block-job-cancel command.

              Arguments

                     • The members of DriveBackup.

              Featuresdeprecated -- This command is deprecated.  Use blockdev-backup instead.

              Errors

                     • If device is not a valid block device, GenericError

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "drive-backup",
                          "arguments": { "device": "drive0",
                                         "sync": "full",
                                         "target": "backup.img" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command blockdev-backup (Since: 2.3)
              Start a point-in-time copy of a block  device  to  a  new  destination.   The  status  of  ongoing
              blockdev-backup  operations can be checked with query-block-jobs where the BlockJobInfo.type field
              has the value 'backup'.   The  operation  can  be  stopped  before  it  has  completed  using  the
              block-job-cancel command.

              Arguments

                     • The members of BlockdevBackup.

              Errors

                     • If device is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "blockdev-backup",
                          "arguments": { "device": "src-id",
                                         "sync": "full",
                                         "target": "tgt-id" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command query-named-block-nodes (Since: 2.0)
              Get the named block driver list

              Argumentsflat  (boolean,  optional)  --  Omit the nested data about backing image ("backing-image"
                       key) if true.  Default is false (Since 5.0)

              Return [BlockDeviceInfo] -- the list of BlockDeviceInfo

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-named-block-nodes" }
                     <- { "return": [ { "ro":false,
                                        "drv":"qcow2",
                                        "encrypted":false,
                                        "file":"disks/test.qcow2",
                                        "node-name": "my-node",
                                        "backing_file_depth":1,
                                        "detect_zeroes":"off",
                                        "bps":1000000,
                                        "bps_rd":0,
                                        "bps_wr":0,
                                        "iops":1000000,
                                        "iops_rd":0,
                                        "iops_wr":0,
                                        "bps_max": 8000000,
                                        "bps_rd_max": 0,
                                        "bps_wr_max": 0,
                                        "iops_max": 0,
                                        "iops_rd_max": 0,
                                        "iops_wr_max": 0,
                                        "iops_size": 0,
                                        "write_threshold": 0,
                                        "image":{
                                           "filename":"disks/test.qcow2",
                                           "format":"qcow2",
                                           "virtual-size":2048000,
                                           "backing_file":"base.qcow2",
                                           "full-backing-filename":"disks/base.qcow2",
                                           "backing-filename-format":"qcow2",
                                           "snapshots":[
                                              {
                                                 "id": "1",
                                                 "name": "snapshot1",
                                                 "vm-state-size": 0,
                                                 "date-sec": 10000200,
                                                 "date-nsec": 12,
                                                 "vm-clock-sec": 206,
                                                 "vm-clock-nsec": 30
                                              }
                                           ],
                                           "backing-image":{
                                               "filename":"disks/base.qcow2",
                                               "format":"qcow2",
                                               "virtual-size":2048000
                                           }
                                        } } ] }

       Enum XDbgBlockGraphNodeType (Since: 4.0)

              Valuesblock-backend -- corresponds to BlockBackend

                     • block-job -- corresponds to BlockJob

                     • block-driver -- corresponds to BlockDriverState

       Object XDbgBlockGraphNode (Since: 4.0)

              Membersid  (int)  --  Block  graph  node  identifier.    This   id   is   generated   only   for
                       x-debug-query-block-graph and does not relate to any other identifiers in Qemu.

                     • type  (XDbgBlockGraphNodeType)  --  Type  of  graph  node.   Can be one of block-backend,
                       block-job or block-driver-state.

                     • name (string) --  Human  readable  name  of  the  node.   Corresponds  to  node-name  for
                       block-driver-state  nodes;  is  not  guaranteed  to  be  unique  in the whole graph (with
                       block-jobs and block-backends).

       Enum BlockPermission (Since: 4.0)
              Enum of base block permissions.

              Valuesconsistent-read -- A user that has the "permission" of  consistent  reads  is  guaranteed
                       that  their  view  of  the  contents of the block device is complete and self-consistent,
                       representing the contents of a  disk  at  a  specific  point.   For  most  block  devices
                       (including  their backing files) this is true, but the property cannot be maintained in a
                       few situations like for intermediate nodes of a commit block job.

                     • write -- This permission is required to change the visible disk contents.

                     • write-unchanged -- This permission (which is weaker than BLK_PERM_WRITE) is  both  enough
                       and  required for writes to the block node when the caller promises that the visible disk
                       content doesn't change.  As the BLK_PERM_WRITE permission is strictly stronger, either is
                       sufficient to perform an unchanging write.

                     • resize -- This permission is required to change the size of a block node.

       Object XDbgBlockGraphEdge (Since: 4.0)
              Block Graph edge description for x-debug-query-block-graph.

              Membersparent (int) -- parent id

                     • child (int) -- child id

                     • name (string) -- name of the relation (examples are 'file' and 'backing')

                     • perm ([BlockPermission]) -- granted permissions for the parent operating on the child

                     • shared-perm ([BlockPermission]) -- permissions that can still be granted to  other  users
                       of the child while it is still attached to this parent

       Object XDbgBlockGraph (Since: 4.0)
              Block Graph - list of nodes and list of edges.

              Membersnodes ([XDbgBlockGraphNode]) -- Not documented

                     • edges ([XDbgBlockGraphEdge]) -- Not documented

       Command x-debug-query-block-graph (Since: 4.0)
              This command is unstable/experimental.

              Get the block graph.

              Featuresunstable -- This command is meant for debugging.

       Command drive-mirror (Since: 1.3)
              Start  mirroring a block device's writes to a new destination.  target specifies the target of the
              new image.  If the file exists, or if it is a device, it will be used as the new  destination  for
              writes.   If  it  does  not exist, a new file will be created.  format specifies the format of the
              mirror image, default is to probe if mode='existing', else the format of the source.

              Arguments

                     • The members of DriveMirror.

              Errors

                     • If device is not a valid block device, GenericError

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "drive-mirror",
                          "arguments": { "device": "ide-hd0",
                                         "target": "/some/place/my-image",
                                         "sync": "full",
                                         "format": "qcow2" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Object DriveMirror (Since: 1.3)
              A set of parameters describing drive mirror setup.

              Membersjob-id (string, optional) -- identifier for the newly-created block job.  If omitted, the
                       device name will be used.  (Since 2.7)

                     • device (string) -- the device name or node-name of a root node  whose  writes  should  be
                       mirrored.

                     • target  (string)  --  the  target  of  the  new image.  If the file exists, or if it is a
                       device, the existing file/device will be used as the new destination.   If  it  does  not
                       exist, a new file will be created.

                     • format  (string,  optional)  -- the format of the new destination, default is to probe if
                       mode is 'existing', else the format of the source

                     • node-name (string, optional) -- the new block driver state node name in the graph  (Since
                       2.1)

                     • replaces  (string,  optional) -- with sync=full graph node name to be replaced by the new
                       image when a whole image copy is done.  This can be used to repair broken  Quorum  files.
                       By  default,  device  is  replaced,  although  implicitly created filters on it are kept.
                       (Since 2.1)

                     • mode (NewImageMode, optional) -- whether and how QEMU should create a new image,  default
                       is 'absolute-paths'.

                     • speed (int, optional) -- the maximum speed, in bytes per second

                     • sync (MirrorSyncMode) -- what parts of the disk image should be copied to the destination
                       (all the disk, only the sectors allocated in the topmost image, or only new I/O).

                     • granularity  (int,  optional)  --  granularity of the dirty bitmap, default is 64K if the
                       image format doesn't have clusters, 4K if the clusters are smaller than  that,  else  the
                       cluster size.  Must be a power of 2 between 512 and 64M (since 1.4).

                     • buf-size (int, optional) -- maximum amount of data in flight from source to target (since
                       1.4).

                     • on-source-error  (BlockdevOnError,  optional)  --  the  action to take on an error on the
                       source, default 'report'.  'stop' and 'enospc' can only  be  used  if  the  block  device
                       supports io-status (see BlockInfo).

                     • on-target-error  (BlockdevOnError,  optional)  --  the  action to take on an error on the
                       target, default 'report' (no limitations, since this applies to a different block  device
                       than device).

                     • unmap (boolean, optional) -- Whether to try to unmap target sectors where source has only
                       zero.   If  true,  and target unallocated sectors will read as zero, target image sectors
                       will be unmapped; otherwise, zeroes will be  written.   Both  will  result  in  identical
                       contents.  Default is true.  (Since 2.4)

                     • copy-mode (MirrorCopyMode, optional) -- when to copy data to the destination; defaults to
                       'background' (Since: 3.0)

                     • auto-finalize  (boolean,  optional)  -- When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state
                       after it has finished its work, waiting for block-job-finalize before  making  any  block
                       graph  changes.   When  true,  this  job  will  automatically perform its abort or commit
                       actions.  Defaults to true.  (Since 3.1)

                     • auto-dismiss (boolean, optional) -- When false, this job will wait in a  CONCLUDED  state
                       after  it  has completely ceased all work, and awaits block-job-dismiss.  When true, this
                       job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention.  Defaults
                       to true.  (Since 3.1)

       Object BlockDirtyBitmap (Since: 2.4)

              Membersnode (string) -- name of device/node which the bitmap is tracking

                     • name (string) -- name of the dirty bitmap

       Object BlockDirtyBitmapAdd (Since: 2.4)

              Membersnode (string) -- name of device/node which the bitmap is tracking

                     • name (string) -- name of the dirty bitmap (must be less than 1024 bytes)

                     • granularity  (int,  optional)  --  the   bitmap   granularity,   default   is   64k   for
                       block-dirty-bitmap-add

                     • persistent  (boolean, optional) -- the bitmap is persistent, i.e. it will be saved to the
                       corresponding block device image file on its close.  For now  only  Qcow2  disks  support
                       persistent bitmaps.  Default is false for block-dirty-bitmap-add.  (Since: 2.10)

                     • disabled  (boolean, optional) -- the bitmap is created in the disabled state, which means
                       that  it  will  not  track   drive   changes.    The   bitmap   may   be   enabled   with
                       block-dirty-bitmap-enable.  Default is false.  (Since: 4.0)

       Alternate BlockDirtyBitmapOrStr (Since: 4.1)

              Alternativeslocal (string) -- name of the bitmap, attached to the same node as target bitmap.

                     • external (BlockDirtyBitmap) -- bitmap with specified node

       Object BlockDirtyBitmapMerge (Since: 4.0)

              Membersnode (string) -- name of device/node which the target bitmap is tracking

                     • target (string) -- name of the destination dirty bitmap

                     • bitmaps ([BlockDirtyBitmapOrStr]) -- name(s) of the source dirty bitmap(s) at node and/or
                       fully specified BlockDirtyBitmap elements.  The latter are supported since 4.1.

       Command block-dirty-bitmap-add (Since: 2.4)
              Create a dirty bitmap with a name on the node, and start tracking the writes.

              Arguments

                     • The members of BlockDirtyBitmapAdd.

              Errors

                     • If node is not a valid block device or node, DeviceNotFound

                     • If name is already taken, GenericError

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-add",
                          "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command block-dirty-bitmap-remove (Since: 2.4)
              Stop  write tracking and remove the dirty bitmap that was created with block-dirty-bitmap-add.  If
              the bitmap is persistent, remove it from its storage too.

              Arguments

                     • The members of BlockDirtyBitmap.

              Errors

                     • If node is not a valid block device or node, DeviceNotFound

                     • If name is not found, GenericError

                     • if name is frozen by an operation, GenericError

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-remove",
                          "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command block-dirty-bitmap-clear (Since: 2.4)
              Clear (reset) a dirty bitmap on the device, so that an incremental backup from this point in  time
              forward will only backup clusters modified after this clear operation.

              Arguments

                     • The members of BlockDirtyBitmap.

              Errors

                     • If node is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound

                     • If name is not found, GenericError

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-clear",
                          "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command block-dirty-bitmap-enable (Since: 4.0)
              Enables a dirty bitmap so that it will begin tracking disk changes.

              Arguments

                     • The members of BlockDirtyBitmap.

              Errors

                     • If node is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound

                     • If name is not found, GenericError

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-enable",
                          "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command block-dirty-bitmap-disable (Since: 4.0)
              Disables a dirty bitmap so that it will stop tracking disk changes.

              Arguments

                     • The members of BlockDirtyBitmap.

              Errors

                     • If node is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound

                     • If name is not found, GenericError

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-disable",
                          "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command block-dirty-bitmap-merge (Since: 4.0)
              Merge  dirty  bitmaps listed in bitmaps to the target dirty bitmap.  Dirty bitmaps in bitmaps will
              be unchanged, except if it also appears as the target bitmap.  Any bits already set in target will
              still be set after the merge, i.e., this operation does not clear the target.  On error, target is
              unchanged.

              The resulting bitmap will count as dirty any clusters  that  were  dirty  in  any  of  the  source
              bitmaps.  This can be used to achieve backup checkpoints, or in simpler usages, to copy bitmaps.

              Arguments

                     • The members of BlockDirtyBitmapMerge.

              Errors

                     • If node is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound

                     • If any bitmap in bitmaps or target is not found, GenericError

                     • If any of the bitmaps have different sizes or granularities, GenericError

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-merge",
                          "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "target": "bitmap0",
                                         "bitmaps": ["bitmap1"] } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Object BlockDirtyBitmapSha256 (Since: 2.10)
              SHA256 hash of dirty bitmap data

              Memberssha256 (string) -- ASCII representation of SHA256 bitmap hash

       Command x-debug-block-dirty-bitmap-sha256 (Since: 2.10)
              This command is unstable/experimental.

              Get bitmap SHA256.

              Arguments

                     • The members of BlockDirtyBitmap.

              Featuresunstable -- This command is meant for debugging.

              Return BlockDirtyBitmapSha256 -- BlockDirtyBitmapSha256

              Errors

                     • If node is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound

                     • If name is not found or if hashing has failed, GenericError

       Command blockdev-mirror (Since: 2.6)
              Start mirroring a block device's writes to a new destination.

              Argumentsjob-id (string, optional) -- identifier for the newly-created block job.  If omitted, the
                       device name will be used.  (Since 2.7)

                     • device  (string)  --  The  device name or node-name of a root node whose writes should be
                       mirrored.

                     • target (string) -- the id or node-name of the block device to mirror to.  This mustn't be
                       attached to guest.

                     • replaces (string, optional) -- with sync=full graph node name to be replaced by  the  new
                       image  when  a whole image copy is done.  This can be used to repair broken Quorum files.
                       By default, device is replaced, although implicitly created filters on it are kept.

                     • speed (int, optional) -- the maximum speed, in bytes per second

                     • sync (MirrorSyncMode) -- what parts of the disk image should be copied to the destination
                       (all the disk, only the sectors allocated in the topmost image, or only new I/O).

                     • granularity (int, optional) -- granularity of the dirty bitmap, default  is  64K  if  the
                       image  format  doesn't  have clusters, 4K if the clusters are smaller than that, else the
                       cluster size.  Must be a power of 2 between 512 and 64M

                     • buf-size (int, optional) -- maximum amount of data in flight from source to target

                     • on-source-error (BlockdevOnError, optional) -- the action to take  on  an  error  on  the
                       source,  default  'report'.   'stop'  and  'enospc'  can only be used if the block device
                       supports io-status (see BlockInfo).

                     • on-target-error (BlockdevOnError, optional) -- the action to take  on  an  error  on  the
                       target,  default 'report' (no limitations, since this applies to a different block device
                       than device).

                     • filter-node-name (string, optional) -- the node name  that  should  be  assigned  to  the
                       filter driver that the mirror job inserts into the graph above device.  If this option is
                       not given, a node name is autogenerated.  (Since: 2.9)

                     • copy-mode (MirrorCopyMode, optional) -- when to copy data to the destination; defaults to
                       'background' (Since: 3.0)

                     • auto-finalize  (boolean,  optional)  -- When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state
                       after it has finished its work, waiting for block-job-finalize before  making  any  block
                       graph  changes.   When  true,  this  job  will  automatically perform its abort or commit
                       actions.  Defaults to true.  (Since 3.1)

                     • auto-dismiss (boolean, optional) -- When false, this job will wait in a  CONCLUDED  state
                       after  it  has completely ceased all work, and awaits block-job-dismiss.  When true, this
                       job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention.  Defaults
                       to true.  (Since 3.1)

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "blockdev-mirror",
                          "arguments": { "device": "ide-hd0",
                                         "target": "target0",
                                         "sync": "full" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Object BlockIOThrottle (Since: 1.1)
              A set of parameters describing block throttling.

              Membersdevice (string, optional) -- Block device name

                     • id (string, optional) -- The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8)

                     • bps (int) -- total throughput limit in bytes per second

                     • bps_rd (int) -- read throughput limit in bytes per second

                     • bps_wr (int) -- write throughput limit in bytes per second

                     • iops (int) -- total I/O operations per second

                     • iops_rd (int) -- read I/O operations per second

                     • iops_wr (int) -- write I/O operations per second

                     • bps_max (int, optional) -- total throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)

                     • bps_rd_max (int, optional) -- read throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)

                     • bps_wr_max (int, optional) -- write throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)

                     • iops_max (int, optional) -- total I/O operations  per  second  during  bursts,  in  bytes
                       (Since 1.7)

                     • iops_rd_max  (int,  optional)  --  read I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes
                       (Since 1.7)

                     • iops_wr_max (int, optional) -- write I/O operations per second during  bursts,  in  bytes
                       (Since 1.7)

                     • bps_max_length (int, optional) -- maximum length of the bps_max burst period, in seconds.
                       It must only be set if bps_max is set as well.  Defaults to 1.  (Since 2.6)

                     • bps_rd_max_length  (int,  optional)  -- maximum length of the bps_rd_max burst period, in
                       seconds.  It must only be set if bps_rd_max is set as well.  Defaults to 1.  (Since 2.6)

                     • bps_wr_max_length (int, optional) -- maximum length of the bps_wr_max  burst  period,  in
                       seconds.  It must only be set if bps_wr_max is set as well.  Defaults to 1.  (Since 2.6)

                     • iops_max_length  (int,  optional) -- maximum length of the iops burst period, in seconds.
                       It must only be set if iops_max is set as well.  Defaults to 1.  (Since 2.6)

                     • iops_rd_max_length (int, optional) -- maximum length of the iops_rd_max burst period,  in
                       seconds.  It must only be set if iops_rd_max is set as well.  Defaults to 1.  (Since 2.6)

                     • iops_wr_max_length  (int, optional) -- maximum length of the iops_wr_max burst period, in
                       seconds.  It must only be set if iops_wr_max is set as well.  Defaults to 1.  (Since 2.6)

                     • iops_size (int, optional) -- an I/O size in bytes (Since 1.7)

                     • group (string, optional) -- throttle group name (Since 2.4)

              Featuresdeprecated -- Member device is deprecated.  Use id instead.

       Object ThrottleLimits (Since: 2.11)
              Limit parameters for throttling.  Since some limit combinations are illegal, limits should  always
              be  set  in one transaction.  All fields are optional.  When setting limits, if a field is missing
              the current value is not changed.

              Membersiops-total (int, optional) -- limit total I/O operations per second

                     • iops-total-max (int, optional) -- I/O operations burst

                     • iops-total-max-length (int, optional) -- length of the iops-total-max  burst  period,  in
                       seconds It must only be set if iops-total-max is set as well.

                     • iops-read (int, optional) -- limit read operations per second

                     • iops-read-max (int, optional) -- I/O operations read burst

                     • iops-read-max-length  (int,  optional)  --  length  of the iops-read-max burst period, in
                       seconds It must only be set if iops-read-max is set as well.

                     • iops-write (int, optional) -- limit write operations per second

                     • iops-write-max (int, optional) -- I/O operations write burst

                     • iops-write-max-length (int, optional) -- length of the iops-write-max  burst  period,  in
                       seconds It must only be set if iops-write-max is set as well.

                     • bps-total (int, optional) -- limit total bytes per second

                     • bps-total-max (int, optional) -- total bytes burst

                     • bps-total-max-length  (int,  optional)  --  length  of the bps-total-max burst period, in
                       seconds.  It must only be set if bps-total-max is set as well.

                     • bps-read (int, optional) -- limit read bytes per second

                     • bps-read-max (int, optional) -- total bytes read burst

                     • bps-read-max-length (int, optional) --  length  of  the  bps-read-max  burst  period,  in
                       seconds It must only be set if bps-read-max is set as well.

                     • bps-write (int, optional) -- limit write bytes per second

                     • bps-write-max (int, optional) -- total bytes write burst

                     • bps-write-max-length  (int,  optional)  --  length  of the bps-write-max burst period, in
                       seconds It must only be set if bps-write-max is set as well.

                     • iops-size (int, optional) -- when limiting by iops max size of an I/O in bytes

       Object ThrottleGroupProperties (Since: 2.11)
              Properties for throttle-group objects.

              Memberslimits (ThrottleLimits, optional) -- limits to apply for this throttle group

                     • x-iops-total (int, optional) -- Not documented

                     • x-iops-total-max (int, optional) -- Not documented

                     • x-iops-total-max-length (int, optional) -- Not documented

                     • x-iops-read (int, optional) -- Not documented

                     • x-iops-read-max (int, optional) -- Not documented

                     • x-iops-read-max-length (int, optional) -- Not documented

                     • x-iops-write (int, optional) -- Not documented

                     • x-iops-write-max (int, optional) -- Not documented

                     • x-iops-write-max-length (int, optional) -- Not documented

                     • x-bps-total (int, optional) -- Not documented

                     • x-bps-total-max (int, optional) -- Not documented

                     • x-bps-total-max-length (int, optional) -- Not documented

                     • x-bps-read (int, optional) -- Not documented

                     • x-bps-read-max (int, optional) -- Not documented

                     • x-bps-read-max-length (int, optional) -- Not documented

                     • x-bps-write (int, optional) -- Not documented

                     • x-bps-write-max (int, optional) -- Not documented

                     • x-bps-write-max-length (int, optional) -- Not documented

                     • x-iops-size (int, optional) -- Not documented

              Featuresunstable -- All members starting with x- are aliases for the same key without x-  in  the
                       limits object.  This is not a stable interface and may be removed or changed incompatibly
                       in the future.  Use limits for a supported stable interface.

       Command block-stream (Since: 1.1)
              Copy data from a backing file into a block device.

              The  block  streaming  operation  is performed in the background until the entire backing file has
              been copied.  This command returns immediately once streaming has started.  The status of  ongoing
              block  streaming  operations  can  be checked with query-block-jobs.  The operation can be stopped
              before it has completed using the block-job-cancel command.

              The node that receives the data is called the top image, can be located in any part of  the  chain
              (but  always  above the base image; see below) and can be specified using its device or node name.
              Earlier qemu versions only  allowed  'device'  to  name  the  top  level  node;  presence  of  the
              'base-node'  parameter  during introspection can be used as a witness of the enhanced semantics of
              'device'.

              If a base file is specified then sectors are not copied from that base file and its backing chain.
              This can be used to stream a subset of the backing file chain instead  of  flattening  the  entire
              image.   When  streaming  completes  the  image  file will have the base file as its backing file,
              unless that node was changed while the job was running.  In that case, base's parent's backing (or
              filtered, whichever exists) child (i.e., base at the beginning of the job) will be the new backing
              file.

              On  successful  completion  the  image  file  is  updated  to  drop  the  backing  file  and   the
              BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED event is emitted.

              In  case device is a filter node, block-stream modifies the first non-filter overlay node below it
              to point to the new backing node instead of modifying device itself.

              Argumentsjob-id (string, optional) -- identifier for the newly-created block job.  If omitted, the
                       device name will be used.  (Since 2.7)

                     • device (string) -- the device or node name of the top image

                     • base (string, optional) -- the common backing file name.  It cannot be set  if  base-node
                       or bottom is also set.

                     • base-node  (string,  optional) -- the node name of the backing file.  It cannot be set if
                       base or bottom is also set.  (Since 2.8)

                     • bottom (string, optional) -- the last node in the chain that should be streamed into top.
                       It cannot be set if base or base-node is also set.  It cannot  be  filter  node.   (Since
                       6.0)

                     • backing-file (string, optional) --

                       The backing file string to write into the top image.  This filename is not validated.

                       If  a  pathname  string  is  such  that  it  cannot  be resolved by QEMU, that means that
                       subsequent QMP or HMP commands must use node-names for the image in question, as filename
                       lookup methods will fail.

                       If not specified, QEMU will automatically determine the backing file string  to  use,  or
                       error  out  if  there  is  no  obvious  choice.  Care should be taken when specifying the
                       string, to specify a valid filename or protocol.  (Since 2.1)

                     • backing-mask-protocol (boolean, optional) -- If true, replace any protocol  mentioned  in
                       the  'backing  file  format'  with  'raw',  rather  than storing the protocol name as the
                       backing format.  Can be used even when no image header will be  updated  (default  false;
                       since 9.0).

                     • speed (int, optional) -- the maximum speed, in bytes per second

                     • on-error  (BlockdevOnError, optional) -- the action to take on an error (default report).
                       'stop' and 'enospc' can only  be  used  if  the  block  device  supports  io-status  (see
                       BlockInfo).  (Since 1.3)

                     • filter-node-name  (string,  optional)  --  the  node  name that should be assigned to the
                       filter driver that the stream job inserts into the graph above device.  If this option is
                       not given, a node name is autogenerated.  (Since: 6.0)

                     • auto-finalize (boolean, optional) -- When false, this job will wait in  a  PENDING  state
                       after  it  has  finished its work, waiting for block-job-finalize before making any block
                       graph changes.  When true, this job  will  automatically  perform  its  abort  or  commit
                       actions.  Defaults to true.  (Since 3.1)

                     • auto-dismiss  (boolean,  optional) -- When false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state
                       after it has completely ceased all work, and awaits block-job-dismiss.  When  true,  this
                       job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention.  Defaults
                       to true.  (Since 3.1)

              Errors

                     • If device does not exist, DeviceNotFound.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "block-stream",
                          "arguments": { "device": "virtio0",
                                         "base": "/tmp/master.qcow2" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command block-job-set-speed (Since: 1.1)
              Set maximum speed for a background block operation.

              This command can only be issued when there is an active block job.

              Throttling can be disabled by setting the speed to 0.

              Argumentsdevice  (string) -- The job identifier.  This used to be a device name (hence the name of
                       the parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values.

                     • speed (int) -- the maximum speed, in bytes per second, or 0 for unlimited.   Defaults  to
                       0.

              Errors

                     • If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive

       Command block-job-cancel (Since: 1.1)
              Stop an active background block operation.

              This  command  returns  immediately  after  marking  the  active  background  block  operation for
              cancellation.  It is an error to call this command if no operation is in progress.

              The operation will cancel as soon as possible and then emit the BLOCK_JOB_CANCELLED event.  Before
              that happens the job is still visible when enumerated using query-block-jobs.

              Note that if you issue 'block-job-cancel'  after  'drive-mirror'  has  indicated  (via  the  event
              BLOCK_JOB_READY)  that  the  source  and destination are synchronized, then the event triggered by
              this command changes to BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED, to indicate that the  mirroring  has  ended  and  the
              destination now has a point-in-time copy tied to the time of the cancellation.

              For  streaming,  the image file retains its backing file unless the streaming operation happens to
              complete just as it is being cancelled.  A new streaming operation can be started at a later  time
              to finish copying all data from the backing file.

              Argumentsdevice  (string) -- The job identifier.  This used to be a device name (hence the name of
                       the parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values.

                     • force (boolean, optional) --  If  true,  and  the  job  has  already  emitted  the  event
                       BLOCK_JOB_READY,  abandon  the  job immediately (even if it is paused) instead of waiting
                       for the destination to complete its final synchronization (since 1.3)

              Errors

                     • If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive

       Command block-job-pause (Since: 1.3)
              Pause an active background block operation.

              This command returns immediately after marking the active background block operation for  pausing.
              It  is  an  error  to  call  this  command if no operation is in progress or if the job is already
              paused.

              The operation will pause as soon as possible.  No event is emitted when the operation is  actually
              paused.  Cancelling a paused job automatically resumes it.

              Argumentsdevice  (string) -- The job identifier.  This used to be a device name (hence the name of
                       the parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values.

              Errors

                     • If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive

       Command block-job-resume (Since: 1.3)
              Resume an active background block operation.

              This command returns immediately after resuming a paused background block  operation.   It  is  an
              error to call this command if no operation is in progress or if the job is not paused.

              This command also clears the error status of the job.

              Argumentsdevice  (string) -- The job identifier.  This used to be a device name (hence the name of
                       the parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values.

              Errors

                     • If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive

       Command block-job-complete (Since: 1.3)
              Manually trigger completion of an active background block operation.  This is supported for  drive
              mirroring,  where  it  also  switches the device to write to the target path only.  The ability to
              complete is signaled with a BLOCK_JOB_READY event.

              This command completes an active background block operation synchronously.  The ordering  of  this
              command's  return  with  the  BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED event is not defined.  Note that if an I/O error
              occurs during the processing of this command: 1) the command itself will fail; 2) the  error  will
              be  processed  according  to  the  rerror/werror  arguments  that were specified when starting the
              operation.

              A cancelled or paused job cannot be completed.

              Argumentsdevice (string) -- The job identifier.  This used to be a device name (hence the name  of
                       the parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values.

              Errors

                     • If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive

       Command block-job-dismiss (Since: 2.12)
              For  jobs  that  have  already concluded, remove them from the block-job-query list.  This command
              only needs to be run for  jobs  which  were  started  with  QEMU  2.12+  job  lifetime  management
              semantics.

              This  command  will  refuse  to  operate  on  any job that has not yet reached its terminal state,
              JOB_STATUS_CONCLUDED.  For jobs that make use of the BLOCK_JOB_READY  event,  block-job-cancel  or
              block-job-complete will still need to be used as appropriate.

              Argumentsid (string) -- The job identifier.

       Command block-job-finalize (Since: 2.12)
              Once  a  job  that has manual=true reaches the pending state, it can be instructed to finalize any
              graph changes and do any  necessary  cleanup  via  this  command.   For  jobs  in  a  transaction,
              instructing  one job to finalize will force ALL jobs in the transaction to finalize, so it is only
              necessary to instruct a single member job to finalize.

              Argumentsid (string) -- The job identifier.

       Object BlockJobChangeOptionsMirror (Since: 8.2)

              Memberscopy-mode (MirrorCopyMode) -- Switch to this copy mode.  Currently, only the switch  from
                       'background' to 'write-blocking' is implemented.

       Object BlockJobChangeOptions (Since: 8.2)
              Block job options that can be changed after job creation.

              Membersid (string) -- The job identifier

                     • type (JobType) -- The job type

                     • When type is mirror: The members of BlockJobChangeOptionsMirror.

       Command block-job-change (Since: 8.2)
              Change the block job's options.

              Arguments

                     • The members of BlockJobChangeOptions.

       Enum BlockdevDiscardOptions (Since: 2.9)
              Determines how to handle discard requests.

              Valuesignore -- Ignore the request

                     • unmap -- Forward as an unmap request

       Enum BlockdevDetectZeroesOptions (Since: 2.1)
              Describes the operation mode for the automatic conversion of plain zero writes by the OS to driver
              specific optimized zero write commands.

              Valuesoff -- Disabled (default)

                     • on -- Enabled

                     • unmap  --  Enabled  and  even  try  to unmap blocks if possible.  This requires also that
                       BlockdevDiscardOptions is set to unmap for this device.

       Enum BlockdevAioOptions (Since: 2.9)
              Selects the AIO backend to handle I/O requests

              Valuesthreads -- Use qemu's thread pool

                     • native -- Use native AIO backend (only Linux and Windows)

                     • io_uring -- Use linux io_uring (since 5.0)

       Object BlockdevCacheOptions (Since: 2.9)
              Includes cache-related options for block devices

              Membersdirect (boolean, optional) -- enables use  of  O_DIRECT  (bypass  the  host  page  cache;
                       default: false)

                     • no-flush (boolean, optional) -- ignore any flush requests for the device (default: false)

       Enum BlockdevDriver (Since: 2.9)
              Drivers that are supported in block device operations.

              Valuesthrottle -- Since 2.11

                     • nvme -- Since 2.12

                     • copy-on-read -- Since 3.0

                     • blklogwrites -- Since 3.0

                     • blkreplay -- Since 4.2

                     • compress -- Since 5.0

                     • copy-before-write -- Since 6.2

                     • snapshot-access -- Since 7.0

                     • blkdebug -- Not documented

                     • blkverify -- Not documented

                     • bochs -- Not documented

                     • cloop -- Not documented

                     • dmg -- Not documented

                     • file -- Not documented

                     • ftp -- Not documented

                     • ftps -- Not documented

                     • gluster -- Not documented

                     • host_cdrom -- Not documented

                     • host_device -- Not documented

                     • http -- Not documented

                     • https -- Not documented

                     • io_uring -- Not documented

                     • iscsi -- Not documented

                     • luks -- Not documented

                     • nbd -- Not documented

                     • nfs -- Not documented

                     • null-aio -- Not documented

                     • null-co -- Not documented

                     • nvme-io_uring -- Not documented

                     • parallels -- Not documented

                     • preallocate -- Not documented

                     • qcow -- Not documented

                     • qcow2 -- Not documented

                     • qed -- Not documented

                     • quorum -- Not documented

                     • raw -- Not documented

                     • rbd -- Not documented

                     • replication -- Not documented

                     • ssh -- Not documented

                     • vdi -- Not documented

                     • vhdx -- Not documented

                     • virtio-blk-vfio-pci -- Not documented

                     • virtio-blk-vhost-user -- Not documented

                     • virtio-blk-vhost-vdpa -- Not documented

                     • vmdk -- Not documented

                     • vpc -- Not documented

                     • vvfat -- Not documented

              Featuresdeprecated -- Member gluster is deprecated because GlusterFS development ceased.

       Object BlockdevOptionsFile (Since: 2.9)
              Driver specific block device options for the file backend.

              Membersfilename (string) -- path to the image file

                     • pr-manager  (string,  optional)  --  the  id  for  the object that will handle persistent
                       reservations for this device (default: none, forward the commands via SG_IO; since 2.11)

                     • aio (BlockdevAioOptions, optional) -- AIO backend (default: threads) (since: 2.8)

                     • aio-max-batch (int, optional) -- maximum number of requests  to  batch  together  into  a
                       single  submission  in  the  AIO  backend.   The  smallest  value  between  this  and the
                       aio-max-batch value of the IOThread object is chosen.  0 means that the AIO backend  will
                       handle it automatically.  (default: 0, since 6.2)

                     • locking  (OnOffAuto, optional) -- whether to enable file locking.  If set to 'auto', only
                       enable when Open File Descriptor (OFD) locking API is  available  (default:  auto,  since
                       2.10)

                     • drop-cache  (boolean,  optional)  --  invalidate  page cache during live migration.  This
                       prevents stale data on the migration destination with cache.direct=off.   Currently  only
                       supported on Linux hosts.  (default: on, since: 4.0)

                     • x-check-cache-dropped (boolean, optional) -- whether to check that page cache was dropped
                       on live migration.  May cause noticeable delays if the image file is large, do not use in
                       production.  (default: off) (since: 3.0)

              Featuresdynamic-auto-read-only  --  If present, enabled auto-read-only means that the driver will
                       open the image read-only at first, dynamically reopen the image file read-write when  the
                       first  writer  is  attached  to  the  node  and  reopen read-only when the last writer is
                       detached.  This allows giving QEMU write permissions only on  demand  when  an  operation
                       actually needs write access.

                     • unstable -- Member x-check-cache-dropped is meant for debugging.

       Object BlockdevOptionsNull (Since: 2.9)
              Driver specific block device options for the null backend.

              Memberssize (int, optional) -- size of the device in bytes.

                     • latency-ns  (int,  optional) -- emulated latency (in nanoseconds) in processing requests.
                       Default to zero which completes requests immediately.  (Since 2.4)

                     • read-zeroes (boolean, optional) -- if true, reads from  the  device  produce  zeroes;  if
                       false, the buffer is left unchanged.  (default: false; since: 4.1)

       Object BlockdevOptionsNVMe (Since: 2.12)
              Driver specific block device options for the NVMe backend.

              Membersdevice  (string)  --  PCI  controller  address  of the NVMe device in format hhhh:bb:ss.f
                       (host:bus:slot.function)

                     • namespace (int) -- namespace number of the device, starting from 1.

              Note that the PCI device must have been unbound from any host  kernel  driver  before  instructing
              QEMU to add the blockdev.

       Object BlockdevOptionsVVFAT (Since: 2.9)
              Driver specific block device options for the vvfat protocol.

              Membersdir (string) -- directory to be exported as FAT image

                     • fat-type (int, optional) -- FAT type: 12, 16 or 32

                     • floppy (boolean, optional) -- whether to export a floppy image (true) or partitioned hard
                       disk (false; default)

                     • label  (string,  optional) -- set the volume label, limited to 11 bytes.  FAT16 and FAT32
                       traditionally have some restrictions on labels,  which  are  ignored  by  most  operating
                       systems.  Defaults to "QEMU VVFAT".  (since 2.4)

                     • rw (boolean, optional) -- whether to allow write operations (default: false)

       Object BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat (Since: 2.9)
              Driver  specific  block  device  options  for  image format that have no option besides their data
              source.

              Membersfile (BlockdevRef) -- reference to or definition of the data source block device

       Object BlockdevOptionsLUKS (Since: 2.9)
              Driver specific block device options for LUKS.

              Memberskey-secret (string,  optional)  --  the  ID  of  a  QCryptoSecret  object  providing  the
                       decryption  key  (since  2.6).   Mandatory except when doing a metadata-only probe of the
                       image.

                     • header (BlockdevRef, optional) -- block device holding a detached  LUKS  header.   (since
                       9.0)

                     • The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat.

       Object BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat (Since: 2.9)
              Driver  specific  block  device  options  for  image format that have no option besides their data
              source and an optional backing file.

              Membersbacking (BlockdevRefOrNull, optional) -- reference to or definition of the  backing  file
                       block  device,  null  disables  the  backing file entirely.  Defaults to the backing file
                       stored the image file.

                     • The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat.

       Enum Qcow2OverlapCheckMode (Since: 2.9)
              General overlap check modes.

              Valuesnone -- Do not perform any checks

                     • constant -- Perform only checks which can be done in constant time  and  without  reading
                       anything from disk

                     • cached -- Perform only checks which can be done without reading anything from disk

                     • all -- Perform all available overlap checks

       Object Qcow2OverlapCheckFlags (Since: 2.9)
              Structure  of  flags for each metadata structure.  Setting a field to 'true' makes QEMU guard that
              Qcow2 format structure  against  unintended  overwriting.   See  Qcow2  format  specification  for
              detailed  information  on these structures.  The default value is chosen according to the template
              given.

              Memberstemplate (Qcow2OverlapCheckMode, optional) -- Specifies a  template  mode  which  can  be
                       adjusted using the other flags, defaults to 'cached'

                     • main-header (boolean, optional) -- Qcow2 format header

                     • active-l1 (boolean, optional) -- Qcow2 active L1 table

                     • active-l2 (boolean, optional) -- Qcow2 active L2 table

                     • refcount-table (boolean, optional) -- Qcow2 refcount table

                     • refcount-block (boolean, optional) -- Qcow2 refcount blocks

                     • snapshot-table (boolean, optional) -- Qcow2 snapshot table

                     • inactive-l1 (boolean, optional) -- Qcow2 inactive L1 tables

                     • inactive-l2 (boolean, optional) -- Qcow2 inactive L2 tables

                     • bitmap-directory (boolean, optional) -- Qcow2 bitmap directory (since 3.0)

       Alternate Qcow2OverlapChecks (Since: 2.9)
              Specifies which metadata structures should be guarded against unintended overwriting.

              Alternativesflags  (Qcow2OverlapCheckFlags)  --  set  of  flags  for  separate  specification of each
                       metadata structure type

                     • mode (Qcow2OverlapCheckMode) -- named mode which chooses a specific set of flags

       Enum BlockdevQcowEncryptionFormat (Since: 2.10)

              Valuesaes -- AES-CBC with plain64 initialization vectors

       Object BlockdevQcowEncryption (Since: 2.10)

              Membersformat (BlockdevQcowEncryptionFormat) -- encryption format

                     • When format is aes: The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow.

       Object BlockdevOptionsQcow (Since: 2.10)
              Driver specific block device options for qcow.

              Membersencrypt (BlockdevQcowEncryption, optional) -- Image decryption  options.   Mandatory  for
                       encrypted images, except when doing a metadata-only probe of the image.

                     • The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat.

       Enum BlockdevQcow2EncryptionFormat (Since: 2.10)

              Valuesaes -- AES-CBC with plain64 initialization vectors

                     • luks -- Not documented

       Object BlockdevQcow2Encryption (Since: 2.10)

              Membersformat (BlockdevQcow2EncryptionFormat) -- encryption format

                     • When format is aes: The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow.

                     • When format is luks: The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS.

       Object BlockdevOptionsPreallocate (Since: 6.0)
              Filter  driver  intended  to  be inserted between format and protocol node and do preallocation in
              protocol node on write.

              Membersprealloc-align (int, optional) -- on preallocation, align file  length  to  this  number,
                       default 1048576 (1M)

                     • prealloc-size (int, optional) -- how much to preallocate, default 134217728 (128M)

                     • The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat.

       Object BlockdevOptionsQcow2 (Since: 2.9)
              Driver specific block device options for qcow2.

              Memberslazy-refcounts  (boolean,  optional)  --  whether  to  enable  the lazy refcounts feature
                       (default is taken from the image file)

                     • pass-discard-request (boolean, optional) -- whether discard requests to the qcow2  device
                       should be forwarded to the data source

                     • pass-discard-snapshot (boolean, optional) -- whether discard requests for the data source
                       should  be  issued when a snapshot operation (e.g. deleting a snapshot) frees clusters in
                       the qcow2 file

                     • pass-discard-other (boolean, optional) -- whether discard requests for  the  data  source
                       should be issued on other occasions where a cluster gets freed

                     • discard-no-unref   (boolean,  optional)  --  when  enabled,  data  clusters  will  remain
                       preallocated when they are no longer used, e.g. because they are discarded  or  converted
                       to  zero  clusters.   As usual, whether the old data is discarded or kept on the protocol
                       level (i.e. in the image file) depends on the setting of the pass-discard-request option.
                       Keeping the clusters preallocated prevents qcow2 fragmentation that  would  otherwise  be
                       caused   by   freeing  and  re-allocating  them  later.   Besides  potential  performance
                       degradation, such fragmentation can lead to increased allocation of clusters past the end
                       of the image file, resulting in image files whose file length can grow much  larger  than
                       their  guest  disk  size  would  suggest.   If image file length is of concern (e.g. when
                       storing qcow2 images directly on  block  devices),  you  should  consider  enabling  this
                       option.  (since 8.1)

                     • overlap-check  (Qcow2OverlapChecks,  optional)  --  which  overlap  checks to perform for
                       writes to the image, defaults to 'cached' (since 2.2)

                     • cache-size (int, optional) -- the maximum total size of the L2 table and  refcount  block
                       caches in bytes (since 2.2)

                     • l2-cache-size  (int,  optional) -- the maximum size of the L2 table cache in bytes (since
                       2.2)

                     • l2-cache-entry-size (int, optional) -- the size of each entry in the L2 cache  in  bytes.
                       It  must  be  a  power of two between 512 and the cluster size.  The default value is the
                       cluster size (since 2.12)

                     • refcount-cache-size (int, optional) -- the maximum size of the refcount  block  cache  in
                       bytes (since 2.2)

                     • cache-clean-interval  (int,  optional)  --  clean  unused  entries in the L2 and refcount
                       caches.  The interval is in seconds.  The default value is 600 on  supporting  platforms,
                       and 0 on other platforms.  0 disables this feature.  (since 2.5)

                     • encrypt  (BlockdevQcow2Encryption,  optional) -- Image decryption options.  Mandatory for
                       encrypted images, except when doing a metadata-only probe of the image.  (since 2.10)

                     • data-file (BlockdevRef, optional) -- reference to or  definition  of  the  external  data
                       file.   This  may only be specified for images that require an external data file.  If it
                       is not specified for such an image, the data file name is loaded  from  the  image  file.
                       (since 4.0)

                     • The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat.

       Enum SshHostKeyCheckMode (Since: 2.12)

              Valuesnone -- Don't check the host key at all

                     • hash -- Compare the host key with a given hash

                     • known_hosts -- Check the host key against the known_hosts file

       Enum SshHostKeyCheckHashType (Since: 2.12)

              Valuesmd5 -- The given hash is an md5 hash

                     • sha1 -- The given hash is an sha1 hash

                     • sha256 -- The given hash is an sha256 hash

       Object SshHostKeyHash (Since: 2.12)

              Memberstype (SshHostKeyCheckHashType) -- The hash algorithm used for the hash

                     • hash (string) -- The expected hash value

       Object SshHostKeyCheck (Since: 2.12)

              Membersmode (SshHostKeyCheckMode) -- How to check the host key

                     • When mode is hash: The members of SshHostKeyHash.

       Object BlockdevOptionsSsh (Since: 2.9)

              Membersserver (InetSocketAddress) -- host address

                     • path (string) -- path to the image on the host

                     • user (string, optional) -- user as which to connect, defaults to current local user name

                     • host-key-check  (SshHostKeyCheck, optional) -- Defines how and what to check the host key
                       against (default: known_hosts)

       Enum BlkdebugEvent (Since: 2.9)
              Trigger events supported by blkdebug.

              Valuesl1_shrink_write_table -- write zeros to the l1 table to shrink image.  (since 2.11)

                     • l1_shrink_free_l2_clusters -- discard the l2 tables.  (since 2.11)

                     • cor_write -- a write due to copy-on-read (since 2.11)

                     • cluster_alloc_space -- an allocation of file space for a cluster (since 4.1)

                     • none -- triggers once at creation of the blkdebug node (since 4.1)

                     • l1_update -- Not documented

                     • l1_grow_alloc_table -- Not documented

                     • l1_grow_write_table -- Not documented

                     • l1_grow_activate_table -- Not documented

                     • l2_load -- Not documented

                     • l2_update -- Not documented

                     • l2_update_compressed -- Not documented

                     • l2_alloc_cow_read -- Not documented

                     • l2_alloc_write -- Not documented

                     • read_aio -- Not documented

                     • read_backing_aio -- Not documented

                     • read_compressed -- Not documented

                     • write_aio -- Not documented

                     • write_compressed -- Not documented

                     • vmstate_load -- Not documented

                     • vmstate_save -- Not documented

                     • cow_read -- Not documented

                     • cow_write -- Not documented

                     • reftable_load -- Not documented

                     • reftable_grow -- Not documented

                     • reftable_update -- Not documented

                     • refblock_load -- Not documented

                     • refblock_update -- Not documented

                     • refblock_update_part -- Not documented

                     • refblock_alloc -- Not documented

                     • refblock_alloc_hookup -- Not documented

                     • refblock_alloc_write -- Not documented

                     • refblock_alloc_write_blocks -- Not documented

                     • refblock_alloc_write_table -- Not documented

                     • refblock_alloc_switch_table -- Not documented

                     • cluster_alloc -- Not documented

                     • cluster_alloc_bytes -- Not documented

                     • cluster_free -- Not documented

                     • flush_to_os -- Not documented

                     • flush_to_disk -- Not documented

                     • pwritev_rmw_head -- Not documented

                     • pwritev_rmw_after_head -- Not documented

                     • pwritev_rmw_tail -- Not documented

                     • pwritev_rmw_after_tail -- Not documented

                     • pwritev -- Not documented

                     • pwritev_zero -- Not documented

                     • pwritev_done -- Not documented

                     • empty_image_prepare -- Not documented

       Enum BlkdebugIOType (Since: 4.1)
              Kinds of I/O that blkdebug can inject errors in.

              Valuesread -- .bdrv_co_preadv()

                     • write -- .bdrv_co_pwritev()

                     • write-zeroes -- .bdrv_co_pwrite_zeroes()

                     • discard -- .bdrv_co_pdiscard()

                     • flush -- .bdrv_co_flush_to_disk()

                     • block-status -- .bdrv_co_block_status()

       Object BlkdebugInjectErrorOptions (Since: 2.9)
              Describes a single error injection for blkdebug.

              Membersevent (BlkdebugEvent) -- trigger event

                     • state (int, optional) -- the state identifier blkdebug needs to be in to actually trigger
                       the event; defaults to "any"

                     • iotype (BlkdebugIOType, optional) -- the type of  I/O  operations  on  which  this  error
                       should  be  injected;  defaults  to  "all  read,  write, write-zeroes, discard, and flush
                       operations" (since: 4.1)

                     • errno (int, optional) -- error identifier (errno) to be returned; defaults to EIO

                     • sector (int, optional) -- specifies the sector index which has to be affected in order to
                       actually trigger the event; defaults to "any sector"

                     • once (boolean, optional) -- disables further events after this one  has  been  triggered;
                       defaults to false

                     • immediately (boolean, optional) -- fail immediately; defaults to false

       Object BlkdebugSetStateOptions (Since: 2.9)
              Describes a single state-change event for blkdebug.

              Membersevent (BlkdebugEvent) -- trigger event

                     • state  (int,  optional) -- the current state identifier blkdebug needs to be in; defaults
                       to "any"

                     • new_state (int) -- the state identifier blkdebug is supposed to assume if this  event  is
                       triggered

       Object BlockdevOptionsBlkdebug (Since: 2.9)
              Driver specific block device options for blkdebug.

              Membersimage (BlockdevRef) -- underlying raw block device (or image file)

                     • config (string, optional) -- filename of the configuration file

                     • align (int, optional) -- required alignment for requests in bytes, must be positive power
                       of 2, or 0 for default

                     • max-transfer (int, optional) -- maximum size for I/O transfers in bytes, must be positive
                       multiple of align and of the underlying file's request alignment (but need not be a power
                       of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10)

                     • opt-write-zero  (int,  optional) -- preferred alignment for write zero requests in bytes,
                       must be positive multiple of align and of the underlying file's  request  alignment  (but
                       need not be a power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10)

                     • max-write-zero  (int, optional) -- maximum size for write zero requests in bytes, must be
                       positive multiple of align, of opt-write-zero,  and  of  the  underlying  file's  request
                       alignment (but need not be a power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10)

                     • opt-discard (int, optional) -- preferred alignment for discard requests in bytes, must be
                       positive  multiple  of align and of the underlying file's request alignment (but need not
                       be a power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10)

                     • max-discard (int, optional) -- maximum size  for  discard  requests  in  bytes,  must  be
                       positive  multiple  of  align,  of  opt-discard,  and  of  the  underlying file's request
                       alignment (but need not be a power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10)

                     • inject-error  ([BlkdebugInjectErrorOptions],  optional)  --  array  of  error   injection
                       descriptions

                     • set-state ([BlkdebugSetStateOptions], optional) -- array of state-change descriptions

                     • take-child-perms  ([BlockPermission],  optional)  --  Permissions  to  take  on  image in
                       addition to what is necessary anyway (which depends on how the blkdebug  node  is  used).
                       Defaults to none.  (since 5.0)

                     • unshare-child-perms ([BlockPermission], optional) -- Permissions not to share on image in
                       addition  to  what  cannot  be  shared  anyway (which depends on how the blkdebug node is
                       used).  Defaults to none.  (since 5.0)

       Object BlockdevOptionsBlklogwrites (Since: 3.0)
              Driver specific block device options for blklogwrites.

              Membersfile (BlockdevRef) -- block device

                     • log (BlockdevRef) -- block device used to log writes to filelog-sector-size (int, optional) -- sector size used in logging writes to file, determines
                       granularity of offsets and sizes of writes (default: 512)

                     • log-append (boolean, optional) -- append to an existing log (default: false)

                     • log-super-update-interval (int, optional) -- interval of write requests after  which  the
                       log super block is updated to disk (default: 4096)

       Object BlockdevOptionsBlkverify (Since: 2.9)
              Driver specific block device options for blkverify.

              Memberstest (BlockdevRef) -- block device to be tested

                     • raw (BlockdevRef) -- raw image used for verification

       Object BlockdevOptionsBlkreplay (Since: 4.2)
              Driver specific block device options for blkreplay.

              Membersimage (BlockdevRef) -- disk image which should be controlled with blkreplay

       Enum QuorumReadPattern (Since: 2.9)
              An enumeration of quorum read patterns.

              Valuesquorum -- read all the children and do a quorum vote on reads

                     • fifo -- read only from the first child that has not failed

       Object BlockdevOptionsQuorum (Since: 2.9)
              Driver specific block device options for Quorum

              Membersblkverify  (boolean,  optional)  -- true if the driver must print content mismatch set to
                       false by default

                     • children ([BlockdevRef]) -- the children block devices to use

                     • vote-threshold (int) -- the vote limit under which a read will fail

                     • rewrite-corrupted (boolean, optional) -- rewrite corrupted data when  quorum  is  reached
                       (Since 2.1)

                     • read-pattern  (QuorumReadPattern,  optional)  -- choose read pattern and set to quorum by
                       default (Since 2.2)

       Object BlockdevOptionsGluster (Since: 2.9)
              Driver specific block device options for Gluster

              Membersvolume (string) -- name of gluster volume where VM image resides

                     • path (string) -- absolute path to image file in gluster volume

                     • server ([SocketAddress]) -- gluster servers description

                     • debug (int, optional) -- libgfapi log level (default '4' which is Error) (Since 2.8)

                     • logfile (string, optional) -- libgfapi log file (default /dev/stderr) (Since 2.8)

       Object BlockdevOptionsIoUring (Since: 7.2)
              Availability: CONFIG_BLKIO

              Driver specific block device options for the io_uring backend.

              Membersfilename (string) -- path to the image file

       Object BlockdevOptionsNvmeIoUring (Since: 7.2)
              Availability: CONFIG_BLKIO

              Driver specific block device options for the nvme-io_uring backend.

              Memberspath (string) -- path to the NVMe namespace's character device (e.g.  /dev/ng0n1).

       Object BlockdevOptionsVirtioBlkVfioPci (Since: 7.2)
              Availability: CONFIG_BLKIO

              Driver specific block device options for the virtio-blk-vfio-pci backend.

              Memberspath   (string)   --   path   to    the    PCI    device's    sysfs    directory    (e.g.
                       /sys/bus/pci/devices/0000:00:01.0).

       Object BlockdevOptionsVirtioBlkVhostUser (Since: 7.2)
              Availability: CONFIG_BLKIO

              Driver specific block device options for the virtio-blk-vhost-user backend.

              Memberspath (string) -- path to the vhost-user UNIX domain socket.

       Object BlockdevOptionsVirtioBlkVhostVdpa (Since: 7.2)
              Availability: CONFIG_BLKIO

              Driver specific block device options for the virtio-blk-vhost-vdpa backend.

              Memberspath (string) -- path to the vhost-vdpa character device.

              Featuresfdset -- Member path supports the special "/dev/fdset/N" path (since 8.1)

       Enum IscsiTransport (Since: 2.9)
              An enumeration of libiscsi transport types

              Valuestcp -- Not documented

                     • iser -- Not documented

       Enum IscsiHeaderDigest (Since: 2.9)
              An enumeration of header digests supported by libiscsi

              Valuescrc32c -- Not documented

                     • none -- Not documented

                     • crc32c-none -- Not documented

                     • none-crc32c -- Not documented

       Object BlockdevOptionsIscsi (Since: 2.9)
              Driver specific block device options for iscsi

              Memberstransport (IscsiTransport) -- The iscsi transport type

                     • portal (string) -- The address of the iscsi portal

                     • target (string) -- The target iqn name

                     • lun (int, optional) -- LUN to connect to.  Defaults to 0.

                     • user  (string, optional) -- User name to log in with.  If omitted, no CHAP authentication
                       is performed.

                     • password-secret (string, optional) -- The ID of  a  QCryptoSecret  object  providing  the
                       password for the login.  This option is required if user is specified.

                     • initiator-name  (string,  optional) -- The iqn name we want to identify to the target as.
                       If this option is not specified, an initiator name is generated automatically.

                     • header-digest (IscsiHeaderDigest, optional) -- The desired header  digest.   Defaults  to
                       none-crc32c.

                     • timeout  (int,  optional)  --  Timeout  in seconds after which a request will timeout.  0
                       means no timeout and is the default.

       Enum RbdAuthMode (Since: 3.0)

              Valuescephx -- Not documented

                     • none -- Not documented

       Enum RbdImageEncryptionFormat (Since: 6.1)

              Valuesluks-any -- Used for opening either luks or luks2 (Since 8.0)

                     • luks -- Not documented

                     • luks2 -- Not documented

       Object RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKSBase (Since: 6.1)

              Memberskey-secret (string) -- ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing a passphrase for  unlocking
                       the encryption

       Object RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKSBase (Since: 6.1)

              Memberscipher-alg (QCryptoCipherAlgo, optional) -- The encryption algorithm

                     • The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKSBase.

       Object RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKS (Since: 6.1)

              Members

                     • The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKSBase.

       Object RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKS2 (Since: 6.1)

              Members

                     • The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKSBase.

       Object RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKSAny (Since: 8.0)

              Members

                     • The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKSBase.

       Object RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKS (Since: 6.1)

              Members

                     • The members of RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKSBase.

       Object RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKS2 (Since: 6.1)

              Members

                     • The members of RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKSBase.

       Object RbdEncryptionOptions (Since: 6.1)

              Membersformat (RbdImageEncryptionFormat) -- Encryption format.

                     • parent  (RbdEncryptionOptions,  optional)  -- Parent image encryption options (for cloned
                       images).  Can be left unspecified if this cloned image is encrypted using the same format
                       and secret as its parent image (i.e. not explicitly formatted) or if its parent image  is
                       not encrypted.  (Since 8.0)

                     • When format is luks: The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKS.

                     • When format is luks2: The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKS2.

                     • When format is luks-any: The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKSAny.

       Object RbdEncryptionCreateOptions (Since: 6.1)

              Membersformat (RbdImageEncryptionFormat) -- Encryption format.

                     • When format is luks: The members of RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKS.

                     • When format is luks2: The members of RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKS2.

       Object BlockdevOptionsRbd (Since: 2.9)

              Memberspool (string) -- Ceph pool name.

                     • namespace (string, optional) -- Rados namespace name in the Ceph pool.  (Since 5.0)

                     • image (string) -- Image name in the Ceph pool.

                     • conf  (string, optional) -- path to Ceph configuration file.  Values in the configuration
                       file will be overridden by options specified via QAPI.

                     • snapshot (string, optional) -- Ceph snapshot name.

                     • encrypt (RbdEncryptionOptions, optional) -- Image encryption options.  (Since 6.1)

                     • user (string, optional) -- Ceph id name.

                     • auth-client-required ([RbdAuthMode], optional) -- Acceptable authentication modes.   This
                       maps to Ceph configuration option "auth_client_required".  (Since 3.0)

                     • key-secret  (string,  optional) -- ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing a key for cephx
                       authentication.  This maps to Ceph configuration option "key".  (Since 3.0)

                     • server ([InetSocketAddressBase], optional) -- Monitor host address and port.   This  maps
                       to the "mon_host" Ceph option.

       Enum ReplicationMode (Since: 2.9)
              Availability: CONFIG_REPLICATION

              An enumeration of replication modes.

              Valuesprimary -- Primary mode, the vm's state will be sent to secondary QEMU.

                     • secondary -- Secondary mode, receive the vm's state from primary QEMU.

       Object BlockdevOptionsReplication (Since: 2.9)
              Availability: CONFIG_REPLICATION

              Driver specific block device options for replication

              Membersmode (ReplicationMode) -- the replication mode

                     • top-id  (string,  optional) -- In secondary mode, node name or device ID of the root node
                       who owns the replication node chain.  Must not be given in primary mode.

                     • The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat.

       Enum NFSTransport (Since: 2.9)
              An enumeration of NFS transport types

              Valuesinet -- TCP transport

       Object NFSServer (Since: 2.9)
              Captures the address of the socket

              Memberstype (NFSTransport) -- transport type used for NFS (only TCP supported)

                     • host (string) -- host address for NFS server

       Object BlockdevOptionsNfs (Since: 2.9)
              Driver specific block device option for NFS

              Membersserver (NFSServer) -- host address

                     • path (string) -- path of the image on the host

                     • user (int, optional) -- UID value to use when talking to the server (defaults to 65534 on
                       Windows and getuid() on unix)

                     • group (int, optional) -- GID value to use when talking to the server (defaults  to  65534
                       on Windows and getgid() in unix)

                     • tcp-syn-count  (int,  optional)  --  number  of  SYNs  during  the  session establishment
                       (defaults to libnfs default)

                     • readahead-size (int, optional) -- set the readahead size in  bytes  (defaults  to  libnfs
                       default)

                     • page-cache-size  (int,  optional)  -- set the pagecache size in bytes (defaults to libnfs
                       default)

                     • debug (int, optional) -- set the NFS debug level (max 2) (defaults to libnfs default)

       Object BlockdevOptionsCurlBase (Since: 2.9)
              Driver specific block device options shared by all protocols supported by the curl backend.

              Membersurl (string) -- URL of the image file

                     • readahead (int, optional) -- Size of the read-ahead cache; must  be  a  multiple  of  512
                       (defaults to 256 kB)

                     • timeout (int, optional) -- Timeout for connections, in seconds (defaults to 5)

                     • username (string, optional) -- Username for authentication (defaults to none)

                     • password-secret  (string,  optional) -- ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing a password
                       for authentication (defaults to no password)

                     • proxy-username (string, optional) -- Username for proxy authentication (defaults to none)

                     • proxy-password-secret (string, optional) -- ID of  a  QCryptoSecret  object  providing  a
                       password for proxy authentication (defaults to no password)

       Object BlockdevOptionsCurlHttp (Since: 2.9)
              Driver  specific block device options for HTTP connections over the curl backend.  URLs must start
              with "http://".

              Memberscookie (string,  optional)  --  List  of  cookies  to  set;  format  is  "name1=content1;
                       name2=content2;" as explained by CURLOPT_COOKIE(3).  Defaults to no cookies.

                     • cookie-secret  (string,  optional)  --  ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the cookie
                       data in a secure way.  See cookie for the format.  (since 2.10)

                     • The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlBase.

       Object BlockdevOptionsCurlHttps (Since: 2.9)
              Driver specific block device options for HTTPS connections over the curl backend.  URLs must start
              with "https://".

              Memberscookie (string,  optional)  --  List  of  cookies  to  set;  format  is  "name1=content1;
                       name2=content2;" as explained by CURLOPT_COOKIE(3).  Defaults to no cookies.

                     • sslverify  (boolean,  optional)  --  Whether  to  verify  the  SSL certificate's validity
                       (defaults to true)

                     • cookie-secret (string, optional) -- ID of a QCryptoSecret  object  providing  the  cookie
                       data in a secure way.  See cookie for the format.  (since 2.10)

                     • The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlBase.

       Object BlockdevOptionsCurlFtp (Since: 2.9)
              Driver  specific  block device options for FTP connections over the curl backend.  URLs must start
              with "ftp://".

              Members

                     • The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlBase.

       Object BlockdevOptionsCurlFtps (Since: 2.9)
              Driver specific block device options for FTPS connections over the curl backend.  URLs must  start
              with "ftps://".

              Memberssslverify  (boolean,  optional)  --  Whether  to  verify  the  SSL certificate's validity
                       (defaults to true)

                     • The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlBase.

       Object BlockdevOptionsNbd (Since: 2.9)
              Driver specific block device options for NBD.

              Membersserver (SocketAddress) -- NBD server address

                     • export (string, optional) -- export name

                     • tls-creds (string, optional) -- TLS credentials ID

                     • tls-hostname (string, optional) --  TLS  hostname  override  for  certificate  validation
                       (Since 7.0)

                     • x-dirty-bitmap    (string,    optional)    --   A   metadata   context   name   such   as
                       "qemu:dirty-bitmap:NAME" or "qemu:allocation-depth" to query in place of the  traditional
                       "base:allocation"  block  status  (see NBD_OPT_LIST_META_CONTEXT in the NBD protocol; and
                       yes, naming this option x-context would have made more sense) (since 3.0)

                     • reconnect-delay (int, optional) -- On an unexpected disconnect, the nbd client  tries  to
                       connect  again  until  succeeding  or  encountering  a  serious  error.  During the first
                       reconnect-delay seconds, all requests are paused  and  will  be  rerun  on  a  successful
                       reconnect.   After  that  time,  any  delayed  requests  and all future requests before a
                       successful reconnect will immediately fail.  Default 0 (Since 4.2)

                     • open-timeout (int, optional) -- In seconds.  If zero, the nbd driver tries the connection
                       only once, and fails to open if the connection fails.  If non-zero, the nbd  driver  will
                       repeat  connection  attempts until successful or until open-timeout seconds have elapsed.
                       Default 0 (Since 7.0)

              Featuresunstable -- Member x-dirty-bitmap is experimental.

       Object BlockdevOptionsRaw (Since: 2.9)
              Driver specific block device options for the raw driver.

              Membersoffset (int, optional) -- position where the block device starts

                     • size (int, optional) -- the assumed size of the device

                     • The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat.

       Object BlockdevOptionsThrottle (Since: 2.11)
              Driver specific block device options for the throttle driver

              Membersthrottle-group (string) -- the name of the throttle-group object to use.  It must already
                       exist.

                     • file (BlockdevRef) -- reference to or definition of the data source block device

       Object BlockdevOptionsCor (Since: 6.0)
              Driver specific block device options for the copy-on-read driver.

              Membersbottom (string, optional) -- The name of a  non-filter  node  (allocation-bearing  layer)
                       that  limits  the  COR operations in the backing chain (inclusive), so that no data below
                       this node will be copied by this filter.  If option is absent, the limit is not  applied,
                       so that data from all backing layers may be copied.

                     • The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat.

       Enum OnCbwError (Since: 7.1)
              An enumeration of possible behaviors for copy-before-write operation failures.

              Valuesbreak-guest-write -- report the error to the guest.  This way, the guest will not be able
                       to overwrite areas that cannot be backed up, so the backup process remains valid.

                     • break-snapshot  --  continue guest write.  Doing so will make the provided snapshot state
                       invalid and any backup or export process based on it will finally fail.

       Object BlockdevOptionsCbw (Since: 6.2)
              Driver specific block device options for  the  copy-before-write  driver,  which  does  so  called
              copy-before-write  operations:  when  data  is  written  to  the  filter,  the  filter first reads
              corresponding blocks from its file child and copies them  to  target  child.   After  successfully
              copying,  the  write  request  is  propagated to file child.  If copying fails, the original write
              request is failed too and no data is written to file child.

              Memberstarget (BlockdevRef) -- The target for copy-before-write operations.

                     • bitmap (BlockDirtyBitmap, optional) -- If specified,  copy-before-write  filter  will  do
                       copy-before-write  operations  only for dirty regions of the bitmap.  Bitmap size must be
                       equal to length of file and target child of the filter.  Note also, that bitmap  is  used
                       only to initialize internal bitmap of the process, so further modifications (or removing)
                       of specified bitmap doesn't influence the filter.  (Since 7.0)

                     • on-cbw-error   (OnCbwError,   optional)  --  Behavior  on  failure  of  copy-before-write
                       operation.  Default is break-guest-write.  (Since 7.1)

                     • cbw-timeout (int, optional) -- Zero means no limit.  Non-zero sets the timeout in seconds
                       for copy-before-write operation.  When a timeout occurs, the respective copy-before-write
                       operation will fail, and the on-cbw-error parameter  will  decide  how  this  failure  is
                       handled.  Default 0.  (Since 7.1)

                     • min-cluster-size  (int,  optional)  --  Minimum  size of blocks used by copy-before-write
                       operations.  Has to be a power of 2.  No effect  if  smaller  than  the  maximum  of  the
                       target's cluster size and 64 KiB.  Default 0.  (Since 9.2)

                     • The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat.

       Object BlockdevOptions (Since: 2.9)
              Options  for  creating  a  block  device.   Many  options  are  available  for  all block devices,
              independent of the block driver:

              Membersdriver (BlockdevDriver) -- block driver name

                     • node-name (string, optional) -- the node name of the new node (Since 2.0).   This  option
                       is  required on the top level of blockdev-add.  Valid node names start with an alphabetic
                       character and may contain only alphanumeric characters, '-', '.' and '_'.  Their  maximum
                       length is 31 characters.

                     • discard (BlockdevDiscardOptions, optional) -- discard-related options (default: ignore)

                     • cache (BlockdevCacheOptions, optional) -- cache-related options

                     • active (boolean, optional) -- whether the block node should be activated (default: true).
                       Having  inactive  block nodes is useful primarily for migration because it allows opening
                       an image on the destination while the source is still holding locks for it. (Since 10.0)

                     • read-only (boolean, optional) -- whether the block device should be  read-only  (default:
                       false).   Note that some block drivers support only read-only access, either generally or
                       in certain configurations.  In this case, the default value does not work and the  option
                       must be specified explicitly.

                     • auto-read-only  (boolean,  optional)  --  if  true  and  read-only  is  false,  QEMU  may
                       automatically decide not to open the image read-write as  requested,  but  fall  back  to
                       read-only  instead  (and  switch  between the modes later), e.g. depending on whether the
                       image file is writable or whether a writing user is attached to the node (default: false,
                       since 3.1)

                     • detect-zeroes (BlockdevDetectZeroesOptions, optional) -- detect and optimize zero  writes
                       (Since 2.1) (default: off)

                     • force-share  (boolean,  optional) -- force share all permission on added nodes.  Requires
                       read-only=true.  (Since 2.10)

                     • When driver is blkdebug: The members of BlockdevOptionsBlkdebug.

                     • When driver is blklogwrites: The members of BlockdevOptionsBlklogwrites.

                     • When driver is blkverify: The members of BlockdevOptionsBlkverify.

                     • When driver is blkreplay: The members of BlockdevOptionsBlkreplay.

                     • When driver is bochs: The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat.

                     • When driver is cloop: The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat.

                     • When driver is compress: The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat.

                     • When driver is copy-before-write: The members of BlockdevOptionsCbw.

                     • When driver is copy-on-read: The members of BlockdevOptionsCor.

                     • When driver is dmg: The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat.

                     • When driver is file: The members of BlockdevOptionsFile.

                     • When driver is ftp: The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlFtp.

                     • When driver is ftps: The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlFtps.

                     • When driver is gluster: The members of BlockdevOptionsGluster.

                     • When driver is host_cdrom: The members of BlockdevOptionsFile.

                     • When driver is host_device: The members of BlockdevOptionsFile.

                     • When driver is http: The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlHttp.

                     • When driver is https: The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlHttps.

                     • When driver is io_uring: The members of BlockdevOptionsIoUring.

                     • When driver is iscsi: The members of BlockdevOptionsIscsi.

                     • When driver is luks: The members of BlockdevOptionsLUKS.

                     • When driver is nbd: The members of BlockdevOptionsNbd.

                     • When driver is nfs: The members of BlockdevOptionsNfs.

                     • When driver is null-aio: The members of BlockdevOptionsNull.

                     • When driver is null-co: The members of BlockdevOptionsNull.

                     • When driver is nvme: The members of BlockdevOptionsNVMe.

                     • When driver is nvme-io_uring: The members of BlockdevOptionsNvmeIoUring.

                     • When driver is parallels: The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat.

                     • When driver is preallocate: The members of BlockdevOptionsPreallocate.

                     • When driver is qcow2: The members of BlockdevOptionsQcow2.

                     • When driver is qcow: The members of BlockdevOptionsQcow.

                     • When driver is qed: The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat.

                     • When driver is quorum: The members of BlockdevOptionsQuorum.

                     • When driver is raw: The members of BlockdevOptionsRaw.

                     • When driver is rbd: The members of BlockdevOptionsRbd.

                     • When driver is replication: The members of BlockdevOptionsReplication.

                     • When driver is snapshot-access: The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat.

                     • When driver is ssh: The members of BlockdevOptionsSsh.

                     • When driver is throttle: The members of BlockdevOptionsThrottle.

                     • When driver is vdi: The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat.

                     • When driver is vhdx: The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat.

                     • When driver is virtio-blk-vfio-pci: The members of BlockdevOptionsVirtioBlkVfioPci.

                     • When driver is virtio-blk-vhost-user: The members of BlockdevOptionsVirtioBlkVhostUser.

                     • When driver is virtio-blk-vhost-vdpa: The members of BlockdevOptionsVirtioBlkVhostVdpa.

                     • When driver is vmdk: The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat.

                     • When driver is vpc: The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat.

                     • When driver is vvfat: The members of BlockdevOptionsVVFAT.

       Alternate BlockdevRef (Since: 2.9)
              Reference to a block device.

              Alternativesdefinition (BlockdevOptions) -- defines a new block device inline

                     • reference (string) -- references the ID of an existing block device

       Alternate BlockdevRefOrNull (Since: 2.9)
              Reference to a block device.

              Alternativesdefinition (BlockdevOptions) -- defines a new block device inline

                     • reference (string) -- references the ID of an existing block  device.   An  empty  string
                       means that no block device should be referenced.  Deprecated; use null instead.

                     • null (null) -- No block device should be referenced (since 2.10)

       Command blockdev-add (Since: 2.9)
              Creates a new block device.

              Arguments

                     • The members of BlockdevOptions.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "blockdev-add",
                          "arguments": {
                               "driver": "qcow2",
                               "node-name": "test1",
                               "file": {
                                   "driver": "file",
                                   "filename": "test.qcow2"
                                }
                           }
                         }
                     <- { "return": {} }

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "blockdev-add",
                          "arguments": {
                               "driver": "qcow2",
                               "node-name": "node0",
                               "discard": "unmap",
                               "cache": {
                                  "direct": true
                                },
                                "file": {
                                  "driver": "file",
                                  "filename": "/tmp/test.qcow2"
                                },
                                "backing": {
                                   "driver": "raw",
                                   "file": {
                                      "driver": "file",
                                      "filename": "/dev/fdset/4"
                                    }
                                }
                            }
                          }

                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command blockdev-reopen (Since: 6.1)
              Reopens  one  or more block devices using the given set of options.  Any option not specified will
              be reset to its default value regardless of its previous status.  If an option cannot  be  changed
              or  a  particular  driver  does  not support reopening then the command will return an error.  All
              devices in the list are reopened in one transaction, so if  one  of  them  fails  then  the  whole
              transaction is cancelled.

              The  command  receives  a  list  of  block devices to reopen.  For each one of them, the top-level
              node-name option (from BlockdevOptions) must be specified and is used to select the  block  device
              to  be reopened.  Other node-name options must be either omitted or set to the current name of the
              appropriate node.  This command won't change any node name and any attempt to do it will result in
              an error.

              In the case of options that refer to child nodes, the behavior of  this  command  depends  on  the
              value:

                 1. A set of options (BlockdevOptions): the child is reopened with the specified set of options.

                 2. A reference to the current child: the child is reopened using its existing set of options.

                 3. A reference to a different node: the current child is replaced with the specified one.

                 4. NULL: the current child (if any) is detached.

              Options (1) and (2) are supported in all cases.  Option (3) is supported for file and backing, and
              option (4) for backing only.

              Unlike with blockdev-add, the backing option must always be present unless the node being reopened
              does  not  have  a backing file and its image does not have a default backing file name as part of
              its metadata.

              Argumentsoptions ([BlockdevOptions]) -- Not documented

       Command blockdev-del (Since: 2.9)
              Deletes a block device that has been added using blockdev-add.  The command will fail if the  node
              is attached to a device or is otherwise being used.

              Argumentsnode-name (string) -- Name of the graph node to delete.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "blockdev-add",
                          "arguments": {
                               "driver": "qcow2",
                               "node-name": "node0",
                               "file": {
                                   "driver": "file",
                                   "filename": "test.qcow2"
                               }
                          }
                        }
                     <- { "return": {} }

                     -> { "execute": "blockdev-del",
                          "arguments": { "node-name": "node0" }
                        }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command blockdev-set-active (Since: 10.0)
              Activate  or  inactivate  a  block  device.  Use  this  to manage the handover of block devices on
              migration with qemu-storage-daemon.

              Activating a node automatically activates all of its  child  nodes  first.   Inactivating  a  node
              automatically inactivates any of its child nodes that are not in use by a still active node.

              Argumentsnode-name  (string,  optional)  --  Name  of the graph node to activate or inactivate. By
                       default, all nodes are affected by the operation.

                     • active (boolean) -- true if the nodes should be active when the command returns  success,
                       false if they should be inactive.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "blockdev-set-active",
                          "arguments": {
                               "node-name": "node0",
                               "active": false
                          }
                        }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Object BlockdevCreateOptionsFile (Since: 2.12)
              Driver specific image creation options for file.

              Membersfilename (string) -- Filename for the new image file

                     • size (int) -- Size of the virtual disk in bytes

                     • preallocation  (PreallocMode, optional) -- Preallocation mode for the new image (default:
                       off; allowed values: off, falloc (if CONFIG_POSIX_FALLOCATE), full (if CONFIG_POSIX))

                     • nocow (boolean, optional) -- Turn off copy-on-write (valid only on btrfs; default: off)

                     • extent-size-hint (int, optional) -- Extent size hint to add to the image file; 0 for  not
                       adding an extent size hint (default: 1 MB, since 5.1)

       Object BlockdevCreateOptionsGluster (Since: 2.12)
              Driver specific image creation options for gluster.

              Memberslocation (BlockdevOptionsGluster) -- Where to store the new image file

                     • size (int) -- Size of the virtual disk in bytes

                     • preallocation  (PreallocMode, optional) -- Preallocation mode for the new image (default:
                       off;  allowed   values:   off,   falloc   (if   CONFIG_GLUSTERFS_FALLOCATE),   full   (if
                       CONFIG_GLUSTERFS_ZEROFILL))

       Object BlockdevCreateOptionsLUKS (Since: 2.12)
              Driver specific image creation options for LUKS.

              Membersfile (BlockdevRef, optional) -- Node to create the image format on, mandatory except when
                       'preallocation' is not requested

                     • header  (BlockdevRef,  optional)  -- Block device holding a detached LUKS header.  (since
                       9.0)

                     • size (int) -- Size of the virtual disk in bytes

                     • preallocation (PreallocMode, optional) -- Preallocation mode for the  new  image  (since:
                       4.2) (default: off; allowed values: off, metadata, falloc, full)

                     • The members of QCryptoBlockCreateOptionsLUKS.

       Object BlockdevCreateOptionsNfs (Since: 2.12)
              Driver specific image creation options for NFS.

              Memberslocation (BlockdevOptionsNfs) -- Where to store the new image file

                     • size (int) -- Size of the virtual disk in bytes

       Object BlockdevCreateOptionsParallels (Since: 2.12)
              Driver specific image creation options for parallels.

              Membersfile (BlockdevRef) -- Node to create the image format on

                     • size (int) -- Size of the virtual disk in bytes

                     • cluster-size (int, optional) -- Cluster size in bytes (default: 1 MB)

       Object BlockdevCreateOptionsQcow (Since: 2.12)
              Driver specific image creation options for qcow.

              Membersfile (BlockdevRef) -- Node to create the image format on

                     • size (int) -- Size of the virtual disk in bytes

                     • backing-file (string, optional) -- File name of the backing file if a backing file should
                       be used

                     • encrypt  (QCryptoBlockCreateOptions,  optional) -- Encryption options if the image should
                       be encrypted

       Enum BlockdevQcow2Version (Since: 2.12)

              Valuesv2 -- The original QCOW2 format as introduced in qemu 0.10 (version 2)

                     • v3 -- The extended QCOW2 format as introduced in qemu 1.1 (version 3)

       Enum Qcow2CompressionType (Since: 5.1)
              Compression type used in qcow2 image file

              Valueszlib -- zlib compression, see <http://zlib.net/>

                     • zstd -- zstd compression, see <http://github.com/facebook/zstd>

       Object BlockdevCreateOptionsQcow2 (Since: 2.12)
              Driver specific image creation options for qcow2.

              Membersfile (BlockdevRef) -- Node to create the image format on

                     • data-file (BlockdevRef, optional) -- Node to use as an external data file  in  which  all
                       guest data is stored so that only metadata remains in the qcow2 file (since: 4.0)

                     • data-file-raw  (boolean, optional) -- True if the external data file must stay valid as a
                       standalone (read-only) raw image without  looking  at  qcow2  metadata  (default:  false;
                       since: 4.0)

                     • extended-l2  (boolean,  optional)  --  True  to  make  the image have extended L2 entries
                       (default: false; since 5.2)

                     • size (int) -- Size of the virtual disk in bytes

                     • version (BlockdevQcow2Version, optional) -- Compatibility level (default: v3)

                     • backing-file (string, optional) -- File name of the backing file if a backing file should
                       be used

                     • backing-fmt (BlockdevDriver, optional) -- Name of the block driver to use for the backing
                       file

                     • encrypt (QCryptoBlockCreateOptions, optional) -- Encryption options if the  image  should
                       be encrypted

                     • cluster-size (int, optional) -- qcow2 cluster size in bytes (default: 65536)

                     • preallocation  (PreallocMode, optional) -- Preallocation mode for the new image (default:
                       off; allowed values: off, falloc, full, metadata)

                     • lazy-refcounts (boolean, optional) -- True if refcounts may be updated  lazily  (default:
                       off)

                     • refcount-bits (int, optional) -- Width of reference counts in bits (default: 16)

                     • compression-type (Qcow2CompressionType, optional) -- The image cluster compression method
                       (default: zlib, since 5.1)

       Object BlockdevCreateOptionsQed (Since: 2.12)
              Driver specific image creation options for qed.

              Membersfile (BlockdevRef) -- Node to create the image format on

                     • size (int) -- Size of the virtual disk in bytes

                     • backing-file (string, optional) -- File name of the backing file if a backing file should
                       be used

                     • backing-fmt (BlockdevDriver, optional) -- Name of the block driver to use for the backing
                       file

                     • cluster-size (int, optional) -- Cluster size in bytes (default: 65536)

                     • table-size (int, optional) -- L1/L2 table size (in clusters)

       Object BlockdevCreateOptionsRbd (Since: 2.12)
              Driver specific image creation options for rbd/Ceph.

              Memberslocation (BlockdevOptionsRbd) -- Where to store the new image file.  This location cannot
                       point to a snapshot.

                     • size (int) -- Size of the virtual disk in bytes

                     • cluster-size (int, optional) -- RBD object size

                     • encrypt (RbdEncryptionCreateOptions, optional) -- Image encryption options.  (Since 6.1)

       Enum BlockdevVmdkSubformat (Since: 4.0)
              Subformat options for VMDK images

              ValuesmonolithicSparse -- Single file image with sparse cluster allocation

                     • monolithicFlat -- Single flat data image and a descriptor file

                     • twoGbMaxExtentSparse  -- Data is split into 2GB (per virtual LBA) sparse extent files, in
                       addition to a descriptor file

                     • twoGbMaxExtentFlat -- Data is split into 2GB (per virtual  LBA)  flat  extent  files,  in
                       addition to a descriptor file

                     • streamOptimized  --  Single file image sparse cluster allocation, optimized for streaming
                       over network.

       Enum BlockdevVmdkAdapterType (Since: 4.0)
              Adapter type info for VMDK images

              Valueside -- Not documented

                     • buslogic -- Not documented

                     • lsilogic -- Not documented

                     • legacyESX -- Not documented

       Object BlockdevCreateOptionsVmdk (Since: 4.0)
              Driver specific image creation options for VMDK.

              Membersfile (BlockdevRef) -- Where to store the new image file.  This refers to the  image  file
                       for monolithcSparse and streamOptimized format, or the descriptor file for other formats.

                     • size (int) -- Size of the virtual disk in bytes

                     • extents  ([BlockdevRef],  optional)  --  Where  to  store the data extents.  Required for
                       monolithcFlat, twoGbMaxExtentSparse and twoGbMaxExtentFlat formats.  For  monolithicFlat,
                       only  one  entry is required; for twoGbMaxExtent* formats, the number of entries required
                       is calculated as extent_number = virtual_size / 2GB.  Providing more extents than will be
                       used is an error.

                     • subformat (BlockdevVmdkSubformat, optional) -- The subformat of the VMDK image.  Default:
                       "monolithicSparse".

                     • backing-file (string, optional) -- The path of backing file.  Default: no backing file is
                       used.

                     • adapter-type (BlockdevVmdkAdapterType, optional) -- The adapter type used to fill in  the
                       descriptor.  Default: ide.

                     • hwversion (string, optional) -- Hardware version.  The meaningful options are "4" or "6".
                       Default: "4".

                     • toolsversion  (string,  optional)  --  VMware guest tools version.  Default: "2147483647"
                       (Since 6.2)

                     • zeroed-grain (boolean, optional) -- Whether to enable  zeroed-grain  feature  for  sparse
                       subformats.  Default: false.

       Object BlockdevCreateOptionsSsh (Since: 2.12)
              Driver specific image creation options for SSH.

              Memberslocation (BlockdevOptionsSsh) -- Where to store the new image file

                     • size (int) -- Size of the virtual disk in bytes

       Object BlockdevCreateOptionsVdi (Since: 2.12)
              Driver specific image creation options for VDI.

              Membersfile (BlockdevRef) -- Node to create the image format on

                     • size (int) -- Size of the virtual disk in bytes

                     • preallocation  (PreallocMode, optional) -- Preallocation mode for the new image (default:
                       off; allowed values: off, metadata)

       Enum BlockdevVhdxSubformat (Since: 2.12)

              Valuesdynamic -- Growing image file

                     • fixed -- Preallocated fixed-size image file

       Object BlockdevCreateOptionsVhdx (Since: 2.12)
              Driver specific image creation options for vhdx.

              Membersfile (BlockdevRef) -- Node to create the image format on

                     • size (int) -- Size of the virtual disk in bytes

                     • log-size (int, optional) -- Log size in bytes, must be a multiple of 1 MB (default: 1 MB)

                     • block-size (int, optional) -- Block size in bytes, must be a multiple of  1  MB  and  not
                       larger  than  256  MB  (default: automatically choose a block size depending on the image
                       size)

                     • subformat (BlockdevVhdxSubformat, optional) -- vhdx subformat (default: dynamic)

                     • block-state-zero (boolean, optional) -- Force use  of  payload  blocks  of  type  'ZERO'.
                       Non-standard,  but  default.   Do  not  set  to  'off' when using 'qemu-img convert' with
                       subformat=dynamic.

       Enum BlockdevVpcSubformat (Since: 2.12)

              Valuesdynamic -- Growing image file

                     • fixed -- Preallocated fixed-size image file

       Object BlockdevCreateOptionsVpc (Since: 2.12)
              Driver specific image creation options for vpc (VHD).

              Membersfile (BlockdevRef) -- Node to create the image format on

                     • size (int) -- Size of the virtual disk in bytes

                     • subformat (BlockdevVpcSubformat, optional) -- vhdx subformat (default: dynamic)

                     • force-size (boolean, optional) -- Force use of the exact byte size instead of rounding to
                       the next size that can be represented in CHS geometry (default: false)

       Object BlockdevCreateOptions (Since: 2.12)
              Options for creating an image format on a given node.

              Membersdriver (BlockdevDriver) -- block driver to create the image format

                     • When driver is file: The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsFile.

                     • When driver is gluster: The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsGluster.

                     • When driver is luks: The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsLUKS.

                     • When driver is nfs: The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsNfs.

                     • When driver is parallels: The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsParallels.

                     • When driver is qcow: The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsQcow.

                     • When driver is qcow2: The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsQcow2.

                     • When driver is qed: The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsQed.

                     • When driver is rbd: The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsRbd.

                     • When driver is ssh: The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsSsh.

                     • When driver is vdi: The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsVdi.

                     • When driver is vhdx: The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsVhdx.

                     • When driver is vmdk: The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsVmdk.

                     • When driver is vpc: The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsVpc.

       Command blockdev-create (Since: 3.0)
              Starts a job to create an image format on a given node.  The job is automatically finalized, but a
              manual job-dismiss is required.

              Argumentsjob-id (string) -- Identifier for the newly created job.

                     • options (BlockdevCreateOptions) -- Options for the image creation.

       Object BlockdevAmendOptionsLUKS (Since: 5.1)
              Driver specific image amend options for LUKS.

              Members

                     • The members of QCryptoBlockAmendOptionsLUKS.

       Object BlockdevAmendOptionsQcow2 (Since: 5.1)
              Driver specific image amend options for qcow2.  For now, only encryption options can be amended

              Membersencrypt (QCryptoBlockAmendOptions, optional) -- Encryption options to be amended

       Object BlockdevAmendOptions (Since: 5.1)
              Options for amending an image format

              Membersdriver (BlockdevDriver) -- Block driver of the node to amend.

                     • When driver is luks: The members of BlockdevAmendOptionsLUKS.

                     • When driver is qcow2: The members of BlockdevAmendOptionsQcow2.

       Command x-blockdev-amend (Since: 5.1)
              This command is unstable/experimental.

              Starts a job to amend format specific options  of  an  existing  open  block  device  The  job  is
              automatically finalized, but a manual job-dismiss is required.

              Argumentsjob-id (string) -- Identifier for the newly created job.

                     • node-name (string) -- Name of the block node to work on

                     • options (BlockdevAmendOptions) -- Options (driver specific)

                     • force  (boolean,  optional)  --  Allow  unsafe  operations, format specific For luks that
                       allows erase of the last active keyslot (permanent loss of data), and replacement  of  an
                       active keyslot (possible loss of data if IO error happens)

              Featuresunstable -- This command is experimental.

       Enum BlockErrorAction (Since: 2.1)
              An enumeration of action that has been taken when a DISK I/O occurs

              Valuesignore -- error has been ignored

                     • report -- error has been reported to the device

                     • stop -- error caused VM to be stopped

       Event BLOCK_IMAGE_CORRUPTED (Since: 1.7)
              Emitted  when  a disk image is being marked corrupt.  The image can be identified by its device or
              node name.  The 'device' field is always present for compatibility reasons, but it  can  be  empty
              ("") if the image does not have a device name associated.

              Membersdevice (string) -- device name.  This is always present for compatibility reasons, but it
                       can be empty ("") if the image does not have a device name associated.

                     • node-name (string, optional) -- node name (Since: 2.4)

                     • msg (string) -- informative message for human consumption, such as the kind of corruption
                       being detected.  It should not be parsed by machine as it is not guaranteed to be stable

                     • offset  (int,  optional)  -- if the corruption resulted from an image access, this is the
                       host's access offset into the image

                     • size (int, optional) -- if the corruption resulted from an  image  access,  this  is  the
                       access size

                     • fatal  (boolean) -- if set, the image is marked corrupt and therefore unusable after this
                       event and must be repaired (Since 2.2;  before,  every  BLOCK_IMAGE_CORRUPTED  event  was
                       fatal)

              NOTE:
                 If action is "stop", a STOP event will eventually follow the BLOCK_IO_ERROR event.

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "BLOCK_IMAGE_CORRUPTED",
                          "data": { "device": "", "node-name": "drive", "fatal": false,
                                    "msg": "L2 table offset 0x2a2a2a00 unaligned (L1 index: 0)" },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1648243240, "microseconds": 906060 } }

       Event BLOCK_IO_ERROR (Since: 0.13)
              Emitted when a disk I/O error occurs

              Membersqom-path (string) -- path to the device object in the QOM tree (since 9.2)

                     • device (string) -- device name.  This is always present for compatibility reasons, but it
                       can be empty ("") if the image does not have a device name associated.

                     • node-name (string, optional) -- node name.  Note that errors may be reported for the root
                       node that is directly attached to a guest device rather than for the node where the error
                       occurred.  The node name is not present if the drive is empty.  (Since: 2.8)

                     • operation (IoOperationType) -- I/O operation

                     • action (BlockErrorAction) -- action that has been taken

                     • nospace  (boolean, optional) -- true if I/O error was caused due to a no-space condition.
                       This key is only present if query-block's io-status is present,  please  see  query-block
                       documentation for more information (since: 2.2)

                     • reason  (string)  --  human readable string describing the error cause.  (This field is a
                       debugging aid for humans, it should not be parsed by applications) (since: 2.2)

              NOTE:
                 If action is "stop", a STOP event will eventually follow the BLOCK_IO_ERROR event.

              NOTE:
                 This event is rate-limited.

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "BLOCK_IO_ERROR",
                          "data": { "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]",
                                    "device": "ide0-hd1",
                                    "node-name": "#block212",
                                    "operation": "write",
                                    "action": "stop",
                                    "reason": "No space left on device" },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }

       Event BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED (Since: 1.1)
              Emitted when a block job has completed

              Memberstype (JobType) -- job type

                     • device (string) -- The job identifier.  Originally the device name but other  values  are
                       allowed since QEMU 2.7

                     • len (int) -- maximum progress value

                     • offset  (int)  --  current  progress value.  On success this is equal to len.  On failure
                       this is less than len

                     • speed (int) -- rate limit, bytes per second

                     • error (string, optional) -- error message.  Only present on failure.  This field contains
                       a human-readable error message.  There are no semantics other  than  that  streaming  has
                       failed and clients should not try to interpret the error string

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED",
                          "data": { "type": "stream", "device": "virtio-disk0",
                                    "len": 10737418240, "offset": 10737418240,
                                    "speed": 0 },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267061043, "microseconds": 959568 } }

       Event BLOCK_JOB_CANCELLED (Since: 1.1)
              Emitted when a block job has been cancelled

              Memberstype (JobType) -- job type

                     • device  (string)  -- The job identifier.  Originally the device name but other values are
                       allowed since QEMU 2.7

                     • len (int) -- maximum progress value

                     • offset (int) -- current progress value.  On success this is equal  to  len.   On  failure
                       this is less than len

                     • speed (int) -- rate limit, bytes per second

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_CANCELLED",
                          "data": { "type": "stream", "device": "virtio-disk0",
                                    "len": 10737418240, "offset": 134217728,
                                    "speed": 0 },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267061043, "microseconds": 959568 } }

       Event BLOCK_JOB_ERROR (Since: 1.3)
              Emitted when a block job encounters an error

              Membersdevice  (string)  -- The job identifier.  Originally the device name but other values are
                       allowed since QEMU 2.7

                     • operation (IoOperationType) -- I/O operation

                     • action (BlockErrorAction) -- action that has been taken

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_ERROR",
                          "data": { "device": "ide0-hd1",
                                    "operation": "write",
                                    "action": "stop" },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }

       Event BLOCK_JOB_READY (Since: 1.3)
              Emitted when a block job is ready to complete

              Memberstype (JobType) -- job type

                     • device (string) -- The job identifier.  Originally the device name but other  values  are
                       allowed since QEMU 2.7

                     • len (int) -- maximum progress value

                     • offset  (int)  --  current  progress value.  On success this is equal to len.  On failure
                       this is less than len

                     • speed (int) -- rate limit, bytes per second

              NOTE:
                 The "ready to complete" status is always reset by a BLOCK_JOB_ERROR event.

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_READY",
                          "data": { "device": "drive0", "type": "mirror", "speed": 0,
                                    "len": 2097152, "offset": 2097152 },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }

       Event BLOCK_JOB_PENDING (Since: 2.12)
              Emitted when a block job  is  awaiting  explicit  authorization  to  finalize  graph  changes  via
              block-job-finalize.   If  this job is part of a transaction, it will not emit this event until the
              transaction has converged first.

              Memberstype (JobType) -- job type

                     • id (string) -- The job identifier.

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_PENDING",
                          "data": { "type": "mirror", "id": "backup_1" },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }

       Enum PreallocMode (Since: 2.2)
              Preallocation mode of QEMU image file

              Valuesoff -- no preallocation

                     • metadata -- preallocate only for metadata

                     • falloc -- like full preallocation but allocate disk  space  by  posix_fallocate()  rather
                       than writing data.

                     • full  --  preallocate all data by writing it to the device to ensure disk space is really
                       available.  This data may or may not be zero, depending on the image format and  storage.
                       full preallocation also sets up metadata correctly.

       Event BLOCK_WRITE_THRESHOLD (Since: 2.3)
              Emitted  when  writes  on  block  device  reaches  or exceeds the configured write threshold.  For
              thin-provisioned devices, this means the device should be  extended  to  avoid  pausing  for  disk
              exhaustion.   The  event  is  one shot.  Once triggered, it needs to be re-registered with another
              block-set-write-threshold command.

              Membersnode-name (string) -- graph node name on which the threshold was exceeded.

                     • amount-exceeded (int) -- amount of data which exceeded the threshold, in bytes.

                     • write-threshold (int) -- last configured threshold, in bytes.

       Command block-set-write-threshold (Since: 2.3)
              Change the write threshold for a block drive.  An event will be delivered if a write to this block
              drive crosses the configured threshold.  The threshold is an offset, thus  must  be  non-negative.
              Default is no write threshold.  Setting the threshold to zero disables it.

              This is useful to transparently resize thin-provisioned drives without the guest OS noticing.

              Argumentsnode-name (string) -- graph node name on which the threshold must be set.

                     • write-threshold  (int)  --  configured  threshold  for the block device, bytes.  Use 0 to
                       disable the threshold.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "block-set-write-threshold",
                          "arguments": { "node-name": "mydev",
                                         "write-threshold": 17179869184 } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command x-blockdev-change (Since: 2.7)
              This command is unstable/experimental.

              Dynamically reconfigure the block driver state graph.

              Currently only supports adding and deleting quorum children.  A child will be added at the end  of
              the  list  of  children.   Its  contents  must  be  consistent with the other childrens' contents.
              Deleting a child that is not last in the list of children is problematic, because  it  "renumbers"
              the children following it.

              Argumentsparent (string) -- the id or name of the parent node.

                     • child  (string,  optional) -- the name of a child to be deleted.  Mutually exclusive with
                       node.

                     • node (string, optional) -- the name of the node to be  added.   Mutually  exclusive  with
                       child.

              Featuresunstable -- This command is experimental.

                 Example: Add a new node to a quorum

                      -> { "execute": "blockdev-add",
                           "arguments": {
                               "driver": "raw",
                               "node-name": "new_node",
                               "file": { "driver": "file",
                                         "filename": "test.raw" } } }
                      <- { "return": {} }
                      -> { "execute": "x-blockdev-change",
                           "arguments": { "parent": "disk1",
                                          "node": "new_node" } }
                      <- { "return": {} }

                 Example: Delete a quorum's node

                      -> { "execute": "x-blockdev-change",
                           "arguments": { "parent": "disk1",
                                          "child": "children.1" } }
                      <- { "return": {} }

       Command x-blockdev-set-iothread (Since: 2.12)
              This command is unstable/experimental.

              Move node and its children into the iothread.  If iothread is null then move node and its children
              into the main loop.

              The node must not be attached to a BlockBackend.

              Argumentsnode-name (string) -- the name of the block driver node

                     • iothread (StrOrNull) -- the name of the IOThread object or null for the main loop

                     • force  (boolean,  optional)  --  true if the node and its children should be moved when a
                       BlockBackend is already attached

              Featuresunstable -- This command is experimental and intended for test cases  that  need  control
                       over IOThreads only.

                 Example: Move a node into an IOThread

                      -> { "execute": "x-blockdev-set-iothread",
                           "arguments": { "node-name": "disk1",
                                          "iothread": "iothread0" } }
                      <- { "return": {} }

                 Example: Move a node into the main loop

                      -> { "execute": "x-blockdev-set-iothread",
                           "arguments": { "node-name": "disk1",
                                          "iothread": null } }
                      <- { "return": {} }

       Enum QuorumOpType (Since: 2.6)
              An enumeration of the quorum operation types

              Valuesread -- read operation

                     • write -- write operation

                     • flush -- flush operation

       Event QUORUM_FAILURE (Since: 2.0)
              Emitted by the Quorum block driver if it fails to establish a quorum

              Membersreference (string) -- device name if defined else node name

                     • sector-num (int) -- number of the first sector of the failed read operation

                     • sectors-count (int) -- failed read operation sector count

              NOTE:
                 This event is rate-limited.

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "QUORUM_FAILURE",
                          "data": { "reference": "usr1", "sector-num": 345435, "sectors-count": 5 },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344522075, "microseconds": 745528 } }

       Event QUORUM_REPORT_BAD (Since: 2.0)
              Emitted to report a corruption of a Quorum file

              Memberstype (QuorumOpType) -- quorum operation type (Since 2.6)

                     • error (string, optional) -- error message.  Only present on failure.  This field contains
                       a  human-readable  error message.  There are no semantics other than that the block layer
                       reported an error and clients should not try to interpret the error string.

                     • node-name (string) -- the graph node name of the block driver state

                     • sector-num (int) -- number of the first sector of the failed read operation

                     • sectors-count (int) -- failed read operation sector count

              NOTE:
                 This event is rate-limited.

                 Example: Read operation

                      <- { "event": "QUORUM_REPORT_BAD",
                           "data": { "node-name": "node0", "sector-num": 345435, "sectors-count": 5,
                                     "type": "read" },
                           "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344522075, "microseconds": 745528 } }

                 Example: Flush operation

                      <- { "event": "QUORUM_REPORT_BAD",
                           "data": { "node-name": "node0", "sector-num": 0, "sectors-count": 2097120,
                                     "type": "flush", "error": "Broken pipe" },
                           "timestamp": { "seconds": 1456406829, "microseconds": 291763 } }

       Object BlockdevSnapshotInternal (Since: 1.7)

              Membersdevice (string) -- the device name or node-name of a root node to generate  the  snapshot
                       from

                     • name (string) -- the name of the internal snapshot to be created

       Command blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync (Since: 1.7)
              Synchronously  take  an  internal  snapshot  of  a block device, when the format of the image used
              supports it.  If the name is an empty  string,  or  a  snapshot  with  name  already  exists,  the
              operation will fail.

              Arguments

                     • The members of BlockdevSnapshotInternal.

              Errors

                     • If device is not a valid block device, GenericError

                     • If any snapshot matching name exists, or name is empty, GenericError

                     • If the format of the image used does not support it, GenericError

              NOTE:
                 Only some image formats such as qcow2 and rbd support internal snapshots.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync",
                          "arguments": { "device": "ide-hd0",
                                         "name": "snapshot0" }
                        }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command blockdev-snapshot-delete-internal-sync (Since: 1.7)
              Synchronously  delete  an  internal  snapshot of a block device, when the format of the image used
              support it.  The snapshot is identified by name or id or both.  One of the name or id is required.
              Return SnapshotInfo for the successfully deleted snapshot.

              Argumentsdevice (string) -- the device name or node-name of a root node  to  delete  the  snapshot
                       from

                     • id (string, optional) -- optional the snapshot's ID to be deleted

                     • name (string, optional) -- optional the snapshot's name to be deleted

              Return SnapshotInfo -- SnapshotInfo

              Errors

                     • If device is not a valid block device, GenericError

                     • If snapshot not found, GenericError

                     • If the format of the image used does not support it, GenericError

                     • If id and name are both not specified, GenericError

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "blockdev-snapshot-delete-internal-sync",
                          "arguments": { "device": "ide-hd0",
                                         "name": "snapshot0" }
                        }
                     <- { "return": {
                                        "id": "1",
                                        "name": "snapshot0",
                                        "vm-state-size": 0,
                                        "date-sec": 1000012,
                                        "date-nsec": 10,
                                        "vm-clock-sec": 100,
                                        "vm-clock-nsec": 20,
                                        "icount": 220414
                          }
                        }

       Object DummyBlockCoreForceArrays (Since: 8.0)
              Not used by QMP; hack to let us use BlockGraphInfoList internally

              Membersunused-block-graph-info ([BlockGraphInfo]) -- Not documented

   Additional block stuff (VM related)
       Enum BiosAtaTranslation (Since: 2.0)
              Policy that BIOS should use to interpret cylinder/head/sector addresses.  Note that Bochs BIOS and
              SeaBIOS  will not actually translate logical CHS to physical; instead, they will use logical block
              addressing.

              Valuesauto -- If cylinder/heads/sizes are passed, choose between none and LBA depending on  the
                       size  of  the  disk.  If they are not passed, choose none if QEMU can guess that the disk
                       had 16 or fewer heads, large if QEMU can guess that the disk had 131072 or  fewer  tracks
                       across all heads (i.e. cylinders*heads<131072), otherwise LBA.

                     • none -- The physical disk geometry is equal to the logical geometry.

                     • lba -- Assume 63 sectors per track and one of 16, 32, 64, 128 or 255 heads (if fewer than
                       255  are  enough  to  cover  the  whole  disk  with  1024 cylinders/head).  The number of
                       cylinders/head is then computed based on the number of sectors and heads.

                     • large -- The number of cylinders per head is  scaled  down  to  1024  by  correspondingly
                       scaling up the number of heads.

                     • rechs   --  Same  as  large,  but  first  convert  a  16-head  geometry  to  15-head,  by
                       proportionally scaling up the number of cylinders/head.

       Enum FloppyDriveType (Since: 2.6)
              Type of Floppy drive to be emulated by the Floppy Disk Controller.

              Values144 -- 1.44MB 3.5" drive

                     • 288 -- 2.88MB 3.5" drive

                     • 120 -- 1.2MB 5.25" drive

                     • none -- No drive connected

                     • auto -- Automatically determined by inserted media at boot

       Object PRManagerInfo (Since: 3.0)
              Information about a persistent reservation manager

              Membersid (string) -- the identifier of the persistent reservation manager

                     • connected (boolean) -- true if the persistent reservation manager  is  connected  to  the
                       underlying storage or helper

       Command query-pr-managers (Since: 3.0)
              Returns a list of information about each persistent reservation manager.

              Return [PRManagerInfo] -- a list of PRManagerInfo for each persistent reservation manager

       Command eject (Since: 0.14)
              Ejects the medium from a removable drive.

              Argumentsdevice (string, optional) -- Block device name

                     • id (string, optional) -- The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8)

                     • force  (boolean,  optional)  -- If true, eject regardless of whether the drive is locked.
                       If not specified, the default value is false.

              Featuresdeprecated -- Member device is deprecated.  Use id instead.

              Errors

                     • If device is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound

              NOTE:
                 Ejecting a device with no media results in success.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "eject", "arguments": { "id": "ide1-0-1" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command blockdev-open-tray (Since: 2.5)
              Opens a block device's tray.  If there is a block driver state tree inserted as a medium, it  will
              become  inaccessible  to  the guest (but it will remain associated to the block device, so closing
              the tray will make it accessible again).

              If the tray was already open before, this will be a no-op.

              Once the tray opens, a DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED event is emitted.  There are cases in which no such event
              will be generated, these include:

              • if the guest has locked the tray, force is false and the guest does not  respond  to  the  eject
                request

              • if the BlockBackend denoted by device does not have a guest device attached to it

              • if the guest device does not have an actual tray

              Argumentsdevice (string, optional) -- Block device name

                     • id (string, optional) -- The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8)

                     • force (boolean, optional) -- if false (the default), an eject request will be sent to the
                       guest  if  it has locked the tray (and the tray will not be opened immediately); if true,
                       the tray will be opened regardless of whether it is locked

              Featuresdeprecated -- Member device is deprecated.  Use id instead.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "blockdev-open-tray",
                          "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0" } }

                     <- { "timestamp": { "seconds": 1418751016,
                                         "microseconds": 716996 },
                          "event": "DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED",
                          "data": { "device": "ide1-cd0",
                                    "id": "ide0-1-0",
                                    "tray-open": true } }

                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command blockdev-close-tray (Since: 2.5)
              Closes a block device's tray.  If there is a block driver state tree  associated  with  the  block
              device (which is currently ejected), that tree will be loaded as the medium.

              If the tray was already closed before, this will be a no-op.

              Argumentsdevice (string, optional) -- Block device name

                     • id (string, optional) -- The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8)

              Featuresdeprecated -- Member device is deprecated.  Use id instead.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "blockdev-close-tray",
                          "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0" } }

                     <- { "timestamp": { "seconds": 1418751345,
                                         "microseconds": 272147 },
                          "event": "DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED",
                          "data": { "device": "ide1-cd0",
                                    "id": "ide0-1-0",
                                    "tray-open": false } }

                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command blockdev-remove-medium (Since: 2.12)
              Removes  a  medium (a block driver state tree) from a block device.  That block device's tray must
              currently be open (unless there is no attached guest device).

              If the tray is open and there is no medium inserted, this will be a no-op.

              Argumentsid (string) -- The name or QOM path of the guest device

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "blockdev-remove-medium",
                          "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0" } }

                     <- { "error": { "class": "GenericError",
                                     "desc": "Tray of device 'ide0-1-0' is not open" } }

                     -> { "execute": "blockdev-open-tray",
                          "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0" } }

                     <- { "timestamp": { "seconds": 1418751627,
                                         "microseconds": 549958 },
                          "event": "DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED",
                          "data": { "device": "ide1-cd0",
                                    "id": "ide0-1-0",
                                    "tray-open": true } }

                     <- { "return": {} }

                     -> { "execute": "blockdev-remove-medium",
                          "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0" } }

                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command blockdev-insert-medium (Since: 2.12)
              Inserts a medium (a block driver state tree) into a block device.  That block device's  tray  must
              currently  be open (unless there is no attached guest device) and there must be no medium inserted
              already.

              Argumentsid (string) -- The name or QOM path of the guest device

                     • node-name (string) -- name of a node in the block driver state graph

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "blockdev-add",
                          "arguments": {
                              "node-name": "node0",
                              "driver": "raw",
                              "file": { "driver": "file",
                                        "filename": "fedora.iso" } } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

                     -> { "execute": "blockdev-insert-medium",
                          "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0",
                                         "node-name": "node0" } }

                     <- { "return": {} }

       Enum BlockdevChangeReadOnlyMode (Since: 2.3)
              Specifies the new read-only mode of a block device subject to the blockdev-change-medium command.

              Valuesretain -- Retains the current read-only mode

                     • read-only -- Makes the device read-only

                     • read-write -- Makes the device writable

       Command blockdev-change-medium (Since: 2.5)
              Changes the medium inserted into a block device by ejecting the current medium and loading  a  new
              image  file  which  is  inserted  as  the  new  medium  (this command combines blockdev-open-tray,
              blockdev-remove-medium, blockdev-insert-medium and blockdev-close-tray).

              Argumentsdevice (string, optional) -- Block device name

                     • id (string, optional) -- The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8)

                     • filename (string) -- filename of the new image to be loaded

                     • format (string, optional) -- format to open the new image with (defaults  to  the  probed
                       format)

                     • read-only-mode (BlockdevChangeReadOnlyMode, optional) -- change the read-only mode of the
                       device; defaults to 'retain'

                     • force   (boolean,  optional)  --  if  false  (the  default),  an  eject  request  through
                       blockdev-open-tray will be sent to the guest if it has locked the tray (and the tray will
                       not be opened immediately); if true, the tray will be opened regardless of whether it  is
                       locked.  (since 7.1)

              Featuresdeprecated -- Member device is deprecated.  Use id instead.

                 Example: Change a removable medium

                      -> { "execute": "blockdev-change-medium",
                           "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0",
                                          "filename": "/srv/images/Fedora-12-x86_64-DVD.iso",
                                          "format": "raw" } }
                      <- { "return": {} }

                 Example: Load a read-only medium into a writable drive

                      -> { "execute": "blockdev-change-medium",
                           "arguments": { "id": "floppyA",
                                          "filename": "/srv/images/ro.img",
                                          "format": "raw",
                                          "read-only-mode": "retain" } }

                      <- { "error":
                           { "class": "GenericError",
                             "desc": "Could not open '/srv/images/ro.img': Permission denied" } }

                      -> { "execute": "blockdev-change-medium",
                           "arguments": { "id": "floppyA",
                                          "filename": "/srv/images/ro.img",
                                          "format": "raw",
                                          "read-only-mode": "read-only" } }

                      <- { "return": {} }

       Event DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED (Since: 1.1)
              Emitted whenever the tray of a removable device is moved by the guest or by HMP/QMP commands

              Membersdevice  (string) -- Block device name.  This is always present for compatibility reasons,
                       but it can be empty ("") if the image does not have a device name associated.

                     • id (string) -- The name or QOM path of the guest device (since 2.8)

                     • tray-open (boolean) -- true if the tray has been opened or false if it has been closed

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED",
                          "data": { "device": "ide1-cd0",
                                    "id": "/machine/unattached/device[22]",
                                    "tray-open": true
                          },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }

       Event PR_MANAGER_STATUS_CHANGED (Since: 3.0)
              Emitted whenever the connected status of a persistent reservation manager changes.

              Membersid (string) -- The id of the PR manager object

                     • connected (boolean) -- true if the PR manager is connected to a backend

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "PR_MANAGER_STATUS_CHANGED",
                          "data": { "id": "pr-helper0",
                                    "connected": true
                          },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1519840375, "microseconds": 450486 } }

       Command block_set_io_throttle (Since: 1.1)
              Change I/O throttle limits for a block drive.

              Since QEMU 2.4, each device with I/O limits is member of a throttle group.

              If two or more devices are members of the same group, the limits will apply to the combined I/O of
              the whole group in a round-robin fashion.  Therefore, setting new I/O  limits  to  a  device  will
              affect the whole group.

              The name of the group can be specified using the 'group' parameter.  If the parameter is unset, it
              is  assumed to be the current group of that device.  If it's not in any group yet, the name of the
              device will be used as the name for its group.

              The 'group' parameter can also be used to move a device to a different group.  In  this  case  the
              limits specified in the parameters will be applied to the new group only.

              I/O  limits  can be disabled by setting all of them to 0.  In this case the device will be removed
              from its group and the rest of its members  will  not  be  affected.   The  'group'  parameter  is
              ignored.

              Arguments

                     • The members of BlockIOThrottle.

              Errors

                     • If device is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "block_set_io_throttle",
                          "arguments": { "id": "virtio-blk-pci0/virtio-backend",
                                         "bps": 0,
                                         "bps_rd": 0,
                                         "bps_wr": 0,
                                         "iops": 512,
                                         "iops_rd": 0,
                                         "iops_wr": 0,
                                         "bps_max": 0,
                                         "bps_rd_max": 0,
                                         "bps_wr_max": 0,
                                         "iops_max": 0,
                                         "iops_rd_max": 0,
                                         "iops_wr_max": 0,
                                         "bps_max_length": 0,
                                         "iops_size": 0 } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "block_set_io_throttle",
                          "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0",
                                         "bps": 1000000,
                                         "bps_rd": 0,
                                         "bps_wr": 0,
                                         "iops": 0,
                                         "iops_rd": 0,
                                         "iops_wr": 0,
                                         "bps_max": 8000000,
                                         "bps_rd_max": 0,
                                         "bps_wr_max": 0,
                                         "iops_max": 0,
                                         "iops_rd_max": 0,
                                         "iops_wr_max": 0,
                                         "bps_max_length": 60,
                                         "iops_size": 0 } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command block-latency-histogram-set (Since: 4.0)
              Manage read, write and flush latency histograms for the device.

              If  only  id  parameter  is  specified,  remove  all  present  latency  histograms for the device.
              Otherwise, add/reset some of (or all) latency histograms.

              Argumentsid (string) -- The name or QOM path of the guest device.

                     • boundaries ([int], optional) -- list of interval  boundary  values  (see  description  in
                       BlockLatencyHistogramInfo definition).  If specified, all latency histograms are removed,
                       and  empty  ones  created  for  all  io  types with intervals corresponding to boundaries
                       (except for io types, for  which  specific  boundaries  are  set  through  the  following
                       parameters).

                     • boundaries-read  ([int],  optional)  -- list of interval boundary values for read latency
                       histogram.  If specified, old read latency histogram is removed, and  empty  one  created
                       with  intervals corresponding to boundaries-read.  The parameter has higher priority then
                       boundaries.

                     • boundaries-write ([int], optional) -- list of interval boundary values for write  latency
                       histogram.

                     • boundaries-zap  ([int],  optional)  --  list  of interval boundary values for zone append
                       write latency histogram.

                     • boundaries-flush ([int], optional) -- list of interval boundary values for flush  latency
                       histogram.

              Errors

                     • if device is not found or any boundary arrays are invalid.

                 Example:

                        Set  new  histograms for all io types with intervals [0, 10), [10, 50), [50, 100), [100,
                        +inf):

                     -> { "execute": "block-latency-histogram-set",
                          "arguments": { "id": "drive0",
                                         "boundaries": [10, 50, 100] } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

                 Example:

                        Set new histogram only for write, other histograms  will  remain  not  changed  (or  not
                        created):

                     -> { "execute": "block-latency-histogram-set",
                          "arguments": { "id": "drive0",
                                         "boundaries-write": [10, 50, 100] } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

                 Example:

                        Set new histograms with the following intervals:

                 • read, flush: [0, 10), [10, 50), [50, 100), [100, +inf)

                 • write: [0, 1000), [1000, 5000), [5000, +inf)

                     -> { "execute": "block-latency-histogram-set",
                          "arguments": { "id": "drive0",
                                         "boundaries": [10, 50, 100],
                                         "boundaries-write": [1000, 5000] } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

                 Example:

                        Remove all latency histograms:

                     -> { "execute": "block-latency-histogram-set",
                          "arguments": { "id": "drive0" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

   Block device exports
       Object NbdServerOptionsBase

              Membershandshake-max-seconds  (int,  optional) -- Time limit, in seconds, at which a client that
                       has not completed the negotiation handshake will be  disconnected,  or  0  for  no  limit
                       (since 10.0; default: 10).

                     • tls-creds (string, optional) -- ID of the TLS credentials object (since 2.6).

                     • tls-authz  (string,  optional)  -- ID of the QAuthZ authorization object used to validate
                       the client's x509 distinguished name.  This object is is only resolved at time of use, so
                       can be deleted and recreated on the fly while the NBD server is active.  If  missing,  it
                       will default to denying access (since 4.0).

                     • max-connections (int, optional) -- The maximum number of connections to allow at the same
                       time, 0 for unlimited.  Setting this to 1 also stops the server from advertising multiple
                       client support (since 5.2; default: 100).

       Object NbdServerOptions
              Keep  this  type consistent with the NbdServerOptionsLegacy type.  The only intended difference is
              using SocketAddress instead of SocketAddressLegacy.

              Membersaddr (SocketAddress) -- Address on which to listen (since 4.2).

                     • The members of NbdServerOptionsBase.

       Object NbdServerOptionsLegacy
              Keep this type consistent with the NbdServerOptions type.  The only intended difference  is  using
              SocketAddressLegacy instead of SocketAddress.

              Membersaddr (SocketAddressLegacy) -- Address on which to listen (since 1.3).

                     • The members of NbdServerOptionsBase.

       Command nbd-server-start (Since: 1.3)
              Start  an  NBD  server  listening  on the given host and port.  Block devices can then be exported
              using nbd-server-add.  The NBD server will present them as named  exports;  for  example,  another
              QEMU instance could refer to them as "nbd:HOST:PORT:exportname=NAME".

              Arguments

                     • The members of NbdServerOptionsLegacy.

              Errors

                     • if the server is already running

       Object BlockExportOptionsNbdBase (Since: 5.0)
              An  NBD  block  export  (common  options  shared  between  nbd-server-add  and  the  NBD branch of
              block-export-add).

              Membersname (string, optional) -- Export name.  If unspecified, the device parameter is used  as
                       the export name.  (Since 2.12)

                     • description  (string, optional) -- Free-form description of the export, up to 4096 bytes.
                       (Since 5.0)

       Object BlockExportOptionsNbd (Since: 5.2)
              An NBD block export (distinct options used in the NBD branch of block-export-add).

              Membersbitmaps ([BlockDirtyBitmapOrStr], optional) --  Also  export  each  of  the  named  dirty
                       bitmaps  reachable  from  device, so the NBD client can use NBD_OPT_SET_META_CONTEXT with
                       the metadata context name "qemu:dirty-bitmap:BITMAP" to inspect each bitmap.   Since  7.1
                       bitmap may be specified by node/name pair.

                     • allocation-depth  (boolean, optional) -- Also export the allocation depth map for device,
                       so the NBD client  can  use  NBD_OPT_SET_META_CONTEXT  with  the  metadata  context  name
                       "qemu:allocation-depth" to inspect allocation details.  (since 5.2)

                     • The members of BlockExportOptionsNbdBase.

       Object BlockExportOptionsVhostUserBlk (Since: 5.2)
              A vhost-user-blk block export.

              Membersaddr  (SocketAddress)  -- The vhost-user socket on which to listen.  Both 'unix' and 'fd'
                       SocketAddress types are supported.  Passed fds must be UNIX domain sockets.

                     • logical-block-size (int, optional) -- Logical block  size  in  bytes.   Defaults  to  512
                       bytes.

                     • num-queues  (int,  optional)  --  Number  of request virtqueues.  Must be greater than 0.
                       Defaults to 1.

       Enum FuseExportAllowOther (Since: 6.1)
              Possible allow_other modes for FUSE exports.

              Valuesoff -- Do not pass allow_other as a mount option.

                     • on -- Pass allow_other as a mount option.

                     • auto  --  Try  mounting  with  allow_other  first,  and  if  that  fails,  retry  without
                       allow_other.

       Object BlockExportOptionsFuse (Since: 6.0)
              Availability: CONFIG_FUSE

              Options for exporting a block graph node on some (file) mountpoint as a raw image.

              Membersmountpoint  (string)  --  Path  on  which to export the block device via FUSE.  This must
                       point to an existing regular file.

                     • growable (boolean, optional) -- Whether writes beyond the EOF should grow the block  node
                       accordingly.  (default: false)

                     • allow-other  (FuseExportAllowOther,  optional)  --  If  this  is off, only qemu's user is
                       allowed access to this export.   That  cannot  be  changed  even  with  chmod  or  chown.
                       Enabling  this  option  will  allow  other users access to the export with the FUSE mount
                       option  "allow_other".   Note  that  using  allow_other  as  a  non-root  user   requires
                       user_allow_other  to be enabled in the global fuse.conf configuration file.  In auto mode
                       (the default), the FUSE export driver  will  first  attempt  to  mount  the  export  with
                       allow_other, and if that fails, try again without.  (since 6.1; default: auto)

       Object BlockExportOptionsVduseBlk (Since: 7.1)
              A vduse-blk block export.

              Membersname (string) -- the name of VDUSE device (must be unique across the host).

                     • num-queues (int, optional) -- the number of virtqueues.  Defaults to 1.

                     • queue-size (int, optional) -- the size of virtqueue.  Defaults to 256.

                     • logical-block-size  (int,  optional)  --  Logical  block  size  in  bytes.   Range  [512,
                       PAGE_SIZE] and must be power of 2.  Defaults to 512 bytes.

                     • serial (string, optional) -- the serial number of virtio block device.  Defaults to empty
                       string.

       Object NbdServerAddOptions (Since: 5.0)
              An NBD block export, per legacy nbd-server-add command.

              Membersdevice (string) -- The device name or node name of the node to be exported

                     • writable (boolean, optional) -- Whether clients should be able to write to the device via
                       the NBD connection (default false).

                     • bitmap (string, optional) -- Also export a single dirty bitmap reachable from device,  so
                       the   NBD  client  can  use  NBD_OPT_SET_META_CONTEXT  with  the  metadata  context  name
                       "qemu:dirty-bitmap:BITMAP" to inspect the bitmap (since 4.0).

                     • The members of BlockExportOptionsNbdBase.

       Command nbd-server-add (Since: 1.3)
              This command is deprecated.

              Export a block node to QEMU's embedded NBD server.

              The export name will be used as the id for the resulting block export.

              Arguments

                     • The members of NbdServerAddOptions.

              Featuresdeprecated -- This command is deprecated.  Use block-export-add instead.

              Errors

                     • if the server is not running

                     • if an export with the same name already exists

       Enum BlockExportRemoveMode (Since: 2.12)
              Mode for removing a block export.

              Valuessafe -- Remove export if there are no existing connections, fail otherwise.

                     • hard -- Drop all connections immediately and remove export.

       Command nbd-server-remove (Since: 2.12)
              This command is deprecated.

              Remove NBD export by name.

              Argumentsname (string) -- Block export id.

                     • mode   (BlockExportRemoveMode,   optional)   --   Mode   of   command   operation.    See
                       BlockExportRemoveMode description.  Default is 'safe'.

              Featuresdeprecated -- This command is deprecated.  Use block-export-del instead.

              Errors

                     • if the server is not running

                     • if export is not found

                     • if mode is 'safe' and there are existing connections

       Command nbd-server-stop (Since: 1.3)
              Stop QEMU's embedded NBD server, and unregister all devices previously added via nbd-server-add.

       Enum BlockExportType (Since: 4.2)
              An enumeration of block export types

              Valuesnbd -- NBD export

                     • vhost-user-blk -- vhost-user-blk export (since 5.2)

                     • fuse -- FUSE export (since: 6.0)

                     • vduse-blk -- vduse-blk export (since 7.1)

       Object BlockExportOptions (Since: 4.2)
              Describes a block export, i.e. how single node should be exported on an external interface.

              Memberstype (BlockExportType) -- Block export type

                     • id (string) -- A unique identifier for the block export (across all export types)

                     • node-name (string) -- The node name of the block node to be exported (since: 5.2)

                     • writable  (boolean,  optional)  --  True if clients should be able to write to the export
                       (default false)

                     • writethrough (boolean, optional) -- If true, caches are flushed after every write request
                       to the export before completion is signalled.  (since: 5.2; default: false)

                     • iothread (string, optional) -- The name of the iothread object where the export will run.
                       The default is to use the thread currently associated with the block node.  (since: 5.2)

                     • fixed-iothread (boolean, optional) -- True prevents the block node from  being  moved  to
                       another  thread  while  the  export  is  active.   If  true and iothread is given, export
                       creation fails if the block node cannot be moved to the iothread.  The default is  false.
                       (since: 5.2)

                     • allow-inactive  (boolean, optional) -- If true, the export allows the exported node to be
                       inactive.  If it is created for an inactive block node, the node remains inactive. If the
                       export type doesn't support running on an inactive node, an error is returned. If  false,
                       inactive block nodes are automatically activated before creating the export and trying to
                       inactivate them later fails.  (since: 10.0; default: false)

                     • When type is nbd: The members of BlockExportOptionsNbd.

                     • When type is vhost-user-blk: The members of BlockExportOptionsVhostUserBlk.

                     • When type is fuse: The members of BlockExportOptionsFuse.

                     • When type is vduse-blk: The members of BlockExportOptionsVduseBlk.

       Command block-export-add (Since: 5.2)
              Creates a new block export.

              Arguments

                     • The members of BlockExportOptions.

       Command block-export-del (Since: 5.2)
              Request  to  remove a block export.  This drops the user's reference to the export, but the export
              may still stay around after this command returns until the shutdown of the export has completed.

              Argumentsid (string) -- Block export id.

                     • mode   (BlockExportRemoveMode,   optional)   --   Mode   of   command   operation.    See
                       BlockExportRemoveMode description.  Default is 'safe'.

              Errors

                     • if the export is not found

                     • if mode is 'safe' and the export is still in use (e.g. by existing client connections)

       Event BLOCK_EXPORT_DELETED (Since: 5.2)
              Emitted when a block export is removed and its id can be reused.

              Membersid (string) -- Block export id.

       Object BlockExportInfo (Since: 5.2)
              Information about a single block export.

              Membersid (string) -- The unique identifier for the block export

                     • type (BlockExportType) -- The block export type

                     • node-name (string) -- The node name of the block node that is exported

                     • shutting-down   (boolean)  --  True  if  the  export  is  shutting  down  (e.g.  after  a
                       block-export-del command, but before the shutdown has completed)

       Command query-block-exports (Since: 5.2)

              Return [BlockExportInfo] -- A list of BlockExportInfo describing all block exports

CHARACTER DEVICES

       Object ChardevInfo (Since: 0.14)
              Information about a character device.

              Memberslabel (string) -- the label of the character device

                     • filename (string) -- the filename of the character device

                     • frontend-open (boolean) -- shows whether the frontend device  attached  to  this  backend
                       (e.g. with the chardev=... option) is in open or closed state (since 2.1)

              NOTE:
                 filename  is  encoded  using the QEMU command line character device encoding.  See the QEMU man
                 page for details.

       Command query-chardev (Since: 0.14)
              Returns information about current character devices.

              Return [ChardevInfo] -- a list of ChardevInfo

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-chardev" }
                     <- {
                           "return": [
                              {
                                 "label": "charchannel0",
                                 "filename": "unix:/var/lib/libvirt/qemu/seabios.rhel6.agent,server=on",
                                 "frontend-open": false
                              },
                              {
                                 "label": "charmonitor",
                                 "filename": "unix:/var/lib/libvirt/qemu/seabios.rhel6.monitor,server=on",
                                 "frontend-open": true
                              },
                              {
                                 "label": "charserial0",
                                 "filename": "pty:/dev/pts/2",
                                 "frontend-open": true
                              }
                           ]
                        }

       Object ChardevBackendInfo (Since: 2.0)
              Information about a character device backend

              Membersname (string) -- The backend name

       Command query-chardev-backends (Since: 2.0)
              Returns information about character device backends.

              Return [ChardevBackendInfo] -- a list of ChardevBackendInfo

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-chardev-backends" }
                     <- {
                           "return":[
                              {
                                 "name":"udp"
                              },
                              {
                                 "name":"tcp"
                              },
                              {
                                 "name":"unix"
                              },
                              {
                                 "name":"spiceport"
                              }
                           ]
                        }

       Enum DataFormat (Since: 1.4)
              An enumeration of data format.

              Valuesutf8 -- Data is a UTF-8 string (RFC 3629)

                     • base64 -- Data is Base64 encoded binary (RFC 3548)

       Command ringbuf-write (Since: 1.4)
              Write to a ring buffer character device.

              Argumentsdevice (string) -- the ring buffer character device name

                     • data (string) -- data to write

                     • format (DataFormat, optional) --

                       data encoding (default 'utf8').

                       • base64: data must be base64 encoded text.  Its binary decoding gets written.

                       • utf8: data's UTF-8 encoding is written

                       • data itself is always Unicode regardless of format, like any other string.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "ringbuf-write",
                          "arguments": { "device": "foo",
                                         "data": "abcdefgh",
                                         "format": "utf8" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command ringbuf-read (Since: 1.4)
              Read from a ring buffer character device.

              Argumentsdevice (string) -- the ring buffer character device name

                     • size (int) -- how many bytes to read at most

                     • format (DataFormat, optional) --

                       data encoding (default 'utf8').

                       • base64: the data read is returned in base64 encoding.

                       • utf8: the data read is interpreted as  UTF-8.   Bug:  can  screw  up  when  the  buffer
                         contains  invalid UTF-8 sequences, NUL characters, after the ring buffer lost data, and
                         when reading stops because the size limit is reached.

                       • The return value is always Unicode regardless of format, like any other string.

              Return string -- data read from the device

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "ringbuf-read",
                          "arguments": { "device": "foo",
                                         "size": 1000,
                                         "format": "utf8" } }
                     <- { "return": "abcdefgh" }

       Object ChardevCommon (Since: 2.6)
              Configuration shared across all chardev backends

              Memberslogfile (string, optional) -- The name of a logfile to save output

                     • logappend (boolean, optional) -- true to append instead of truncate (default to false  to
                       truncate)

       Object ChardevFile (Since: 1.4)
              Configuration info for file chardevs.

              Membersin (string, optional) -- The name of the input file

                     • out (string) -- The name of the output file

                     • append  (boolean,  optional)  -- Open the file in append mode (default false to truncate)
                       (Since 2.6)

                     • The members of ChardevCommon.

       Object ChardevHostdev (Since: 1.4)
              Configuration info for device and pipe chardevs.

              Membersdevice (string) -- The name of the special file for the device, i.e.  /dev/ttyS0 on  Unix
                       or COM1: on Windows

                     • The members of ChardevCommon.

       Object ChardevSocket (Since: 1.4)
              Configuration info for (stream) socket chardevs.

              Membersaddr  (SocketAddressLegacy)  --  socket  address to listen on (server=true) or connect to
                       (server=false)

                     • tls-creds (string, optional) -- the ID of the TLS credentials object (since 2.6)

                     • tls-authz (string, optional) -- the ID of the QAuthZ authorization object  against  which
                       the  client's x509 distinguished name will be validated.  This object is only resolved at
                       time of use, so can be deleted and recreated on the  fly  while  the  chardev  server  is
                       active.  If missing, it will default to denying access (since 4.0)

                     • server (boolean, optional) -- create server socket (default: true)

                     • wait  (boolean,  optional)  --  wait  for incoming connection on server sockets (default:
                       false).  Silently ignored with server: false.  This use is deprecated.

                     • nodelay (boolean, optional) -- set TCP_NODELAY socket option (default: false)

                     • telnet (boolean, optional) -- enable telnet protocol on server sockets (default: false)

                     • tn3270 (boolean, optional) -- enable tn3270 protocol on server sockets  (default:  false)
                       (Since: 2.10)

                     • websocket  (boolean,  optional)  -- enable websocket protocol on server sockets (default:
                       false) (Since: 3.1)

                     • reconnect (int, optional) -- For a client socket,  if  a  socket  is  disconnected,  then
                       attempt  a  reconnect  after  the given number of seconds.  Setting this to zero disables
                       this function.  The use of this member is deprecated, use reconnect-ms instead. (default:
                       0) (Since: 2.2)

                     • reconnect-ms (int, optional) -- For a client socket, if a socket  is  disconnected,  then
                       attempt  a  reconnect  after  the  given  number  of  milliseconds.  Setting this to zero
                       disables this function.  This member is mutually exclusive with reconnect.  (default:  0)
                       (Since: 9.2)

                     • The members of ChardevCommon.

              Featuresdeprecated -- Member reconnect is deprecated.  Use reconnect-ms instead.

       Object ChardevUdp (Since: 1.5)
              Configuration info for datagram socket chardevs.

              Membersremote (SocketAddressLegacy) -- remote address

                     • local (SocketAddressLegacy, optional) -- local address

                     • The members of ChardevCommon.

       Object ChardevMux (Since: 1.5)
              Configuration info for mux chardevs.

              Memberschardev (string) -- name of the base chardev.

                     • The members of ChardevCommon.

       Object ChardevHub (Since: 10.0)
              Configuration info for hub chardevs.

              Memberschardevs ([string]) -- IDs to be added to this hub (maximum 4 devices).

                     • The members of ChardevCommon.

       Object ChardevStdio (Since: 1.5)
              Configuration info for stdio chardevs.

              Memberssignal (boolean, optional) -- Allow signals (such as SIGINT triggered by ^C) be delivered
                       to qemu.  Default: true.

                     • The members of ChardevCommon.

       Object ChardevSpiceChannel (Since: 1.5)
              Availability: CONFIG_SPICE

              Configuration info for spice vm channel chardevs.

              Memberstype (string) -- kind of channel (for example vdagent).

                     • The members of ChardevCommon.

       Object ChardevSpicePort (Since: 1.5)
              Availability: CONFIG_SPICE

              Configuration info for spice port chardevs.

              Membersfqdn (string) -- name of the channel (see docs/spice-port-fqdn.txt)

                     • The members of ChardevCommon.

       Object ChardevDBus (Since: 7.0)
              Availability: CONFIG_DBUS_DISPLAY

              Configuration info for DBus chardevs.

              Membersname (string) -- name of the channel (following docs/spice-port-fqdn.txt)

                     • The members of ChardevCommon.

       Object ChardevVC (Since: 1.5)
              Configuration info for virtual console chardevs.

              Memberswidth (int, optional) -- console width, in pixels

                     • height (int, optional) -- console height, in pixels

                     • cols (int, optional) -- console width, in chars

                     • rows (int, optional) -- console height, in chars

                     • The members of ChardevCommon.

              NOTE:
                 The  options  are only effective when the VNC or SDL graphical display backend is active.  They
                 are ignored with the GTK, Spice, VNC and D-Bus display backends.

       Object ChardevRingbuf (Since: 1.5)
              Configuration info for ring buffer chardevs.

              Memberssize (int, optional) -- ring buffer size, must be power of two, default is 65536

                     • The members of ChardevCommon.

       Object ChardevQemuVDAgent (Since: 6.1)
              Availability: CONFIG_SPICE_PROTOCOL

              Configuration info for qemu vdagent implementation.

              Membersmouse (boolean, optional) -- enable/disable mouse, default is enabled.

                     • clipboard (boolean, optional) -- enable/disable clipboard, default is disabled.

                     • The members of ChardevCommon.

       Object ChardevPty (Since: 9.2)
              Configuration info for pty implementation.

              Memberspath (string, optional) -- optional path to create a symbolic link  that  points  to  the
                       allocated PTY

                     • The members of ChardevCommon.

       Enum ChardevBackendKind (Since: 1.4)

              Valuesfile -- regular files

                     • serial -- serial host device

                     • parallel -- parallel host device

                     • pipe -- pipes (since 1.5)

                     • socket -- stream socket

                     • udp -- datagram socket (since 1.5)

                     • pty -- pseudo-terminal

                     • null -- provides no input, throws away output

                     • mux -- (since 1.5)

                     • hub -- (since 10.0)

                     • msmouse -- emulated Microsoft serial mouse (since 1.5)

                     • wctablet -- emulated Wacom Penpartner serial tablet (since 2.9)

                     • braille -- Baum Braille device (since 1.5)

                     • testdev -- device for test-suite control (since 2.2)

                     • stdio -- standard I/O (since 1.5)

                     • console -- Windows console (since 1.5)

                     • spicevmc -- spice vm channel (since 1.5)

                     • spiceport -- Spice port channel (since 1.5)

                     • qemu-vdagent -- Spice vdagent (since 6.1)

                     • dbus -- D-Bus channel (since 7.0)

                     • vc -- virtual console (since 1.5)

                     • ringbuf -- memory ring buffer (since 1.6)

                     • memory -- synonym for ringbuf (since 1.5)

              Featuresdeprecated -- Member memory is deprecated.  Use ringbuf instead.

       Object ChardevFileWrapper (Since: 1.4)

              Membersdata (ChardevFile) -- Configuration info for file chardevs

       Object ChardevHostdevWrapper (Since: 1.4)

              Membersdata (ChardevHostdev) -- Configuration info for device and pipe chardevs

       Object ChardevSocketWrapper (Since: 1.4)

              Membersdata (ChardevSocket) -- Configuration info for (stream) socket chardevs

       Object ChardevUdpWrapper (Since: 1.5)

              Membersdata (ChardevUdp) -- Configuration info for datagram socket chardevs

       Object ChardevCommonWrapper (Since: 2.6)

              Membersdata (ChardevCommon) -- Configuration shared across all chardev backends

       Object ChardevMuxWrapper (Since: 1.5)

              Membersdata (ChardevMux) -- Configuration info for mux chardevs

       Object ChardevHubWrapper (Since: 10.0)

              Membersdata (ChardevHub) -- Configuration info for hub chardevs

       Object ChardevStdioWrapper (Since: 1.5)

              Membersdata (ChardevStdio) -- Configuration info for stdio chardevs

       Object ChardevSpiceChannelWrapper (Since: 1.5)
              Availability: CONFIG_SPICE.INDENT 7.0

       Membersdata (ChardevSpiceChannel) -- Configuration info for spice vm channel chardevs

       Object ChardevSpicePortWrapper (Since: 1.5)
              Availability: CONFIG_SPICE.INDENT 7.0

       Membersdata (ChardevSpicePort) -- Configuration info for spice port chardevs

       Object ChardevQemuVDAgentWrapper (Since: 6.1)
              Availability: CONFIG_SPICE_PROTOCOL.INDENT 7.0

       Membersdata (ChardevQemuVDAgent) -- Configuration info for qemu vdagent implementation

       Object ChardevDBusWrapper (Since: 7.0)
              Availability: CONFIG_DBUS_DISPLAY.INDENT 7.0

       Membersdata (ChardevDBus) -- Configuration info for DBus chardevs

       Object ChardevVCWrapper (Since: 1.5)

              Membersdata (ChardevVC) -- Configuration info for virtual console chardevs

       Object ChardevRingbufWrapper (Since: 1.5)

              Membersdata (ChardevRingbuf) -- Configuration info for ring buffer chardevs

       Object ChardevPtyWrapper (Since: 9.2)

              Membersdata (ChardevPty) -- Configuration info for pty chardevs

       Object ChardevBackend (Since: 1.4)
              Configuration info for the new chardev backend.

              Memberstype (ChardevBackendKind) -- backend type

                     • When type is file: The members of ChardevFileWrapper.

                     • When type is serial: The members of ChardevHostdevWrapper.

                     • When type is parallel: The members of ChardevHostdevWrapper.

                     • When type is pipe: The members of ChardevHostdevWrapper.

                     • When type is socket: The members of ChardevSocketWrapper.

                     • When type is udp: The members of ChardevUdpWrapper.

                     • When type is pty: The members of ChardevPtyWrapper.

                     • When type is null: The members of ChardevCommonWrapper.

                     • When type is mux: The members of ChardevMuxWrapper.

                     • When type is hub: The members of ChardevHubWrapper.

                     • When type is msmouse: The members of ChardevCommonWrapper.

                     • When type is wctablet: The members of ChardevCommonWrapper.

                     • When type is braille: The members of ChardevCommonWrapper.

                     • When type is testdev: The members of ChardevCommonWrapper.

                     • When type is stdio: The members of ChardevStdioWrapper.

                     • When type is console: The members of ChardevCommonWrapper.

                     • When type is spicevmc: The members of ChardevSpiceChannelWrapper.

                     • When type is spiceport: The members of ChardevSpicePortWrapper.

                     • When type is qemu-vdagent: The members of ChardevQemuVDAgentWrapper.

                     • When type is dbus: The members of ChardevDBusWrapper.

                     • When type is vc: The members of ChardevVCWrapper.

                     • When type is ringbuf: The members of ChardevRingbufWrapper.

                     • When type is memory: The members of ChardevRingbufWrapper.

       Object ChardevReturn (Since: 1.4)
              Return info about the chardev backend just created.

              Memberspty (string, optional) -- name of the slave pseudoterminal device, present if and only if
                       a chardev of type 'pty' was created

       Command chardev-add (Since: 1.4)
              Add a character device backend

              Argumentsid (string) -- the chardev's ID, must be unique

                     • backend (ChardevBackend) -- backend type and parameters

              Return ChardevReturn -- ChardevReturn.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute" : "chardev-add",
                          "arguments" : { "id" : "foo",
                                          "backend" : { "type" : "null", "data" : {} } } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute" : "chardev-add",
                          "arguments" : { "id" : "bar",
                                          "backend" : { "type" : "file",
                                                        "data" : { "out" : "/tmp/bar.log" } } } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute" : "chardev-add",
                          "arguments" : { "id" : "baz",
                                          "backend" : { "type" : "pty", "data" : {} } } }
                     <- { "return": { "pty" : "/dev/pty/42" } }

       Command chardev-change (Since: 2.10)
              Change a character device backend

              Argumentsid (string) -- the chardev's ID, must exist

                     • backend (ChardevBackend) -- new backend type and parameters

              Return ChardevReturn -- ChardevReturn.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute" : "chardev-change",
                          "arguments" : { "id" : "baz",
                                          "backend" : { "type" : "pty", "data" : {} } } }
                     <- { "return": { "pty" : "/dev/pty/42" } }

                 Example:

                     -> {"execute" : "chardev-change",
                         "arguments" : {
                             "id" : "charchannel2",
                             "backend" : {
                                 "type" : "socket",
                                 "data" : {
                                     "addr" : {
                                         "type" : "unix" ,
                                         "data" : {
                                             "path" : "/tmp/charchannel2.socket"
                                         }
                                      },
                                      "server" : true,
                                      "wait" : false }}}}
                     <- {"return": {}}

       Command chardev-remove (Since: 1.4)
              Remove a character device backend

              Argumentsid (string) -- the chardev's ID, must exist and not be in use

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "chardev-remove", "arguments": { "id" : "foo" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command chardev-send-break (Since: 2.10)
              Send a break to a character device

              Argumentsid (string) -- the chardev's ID, must exist

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "chardev-send-break", "arguments": { "id" : "foo" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Event VSERPORT_CHANGE (Since: 2.1)
              Emitted when the guest opens or closes a virtio-serial port.

              Membersid (string) -- device identifier of the virtio-serial port

                     • open (boolean) -- true if the guest has opened the virtio-serial port

              NOTE:
                 This event is rate-limited.

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "VSERPORT_CHANGE",
                          "data": { "id": "channel0", "open": true },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1401385907, "microseconds": 422329 } }

DUMP GUEST MEMORY

       Enum DumpGuestMemoryFormat (Since: 2.0)
              An enumeration of guest-memory-dump's format.

              Valueself -- elf format

                     • kdump-zlib -- makedumpfile flattened, kdump-compressed format with zlib compression

                     • kdump-lzo -- makedumpfile flattened, kdump-compressed format with lzo compression

                     • kdump-snappy -- makedumpfile flattened, kdump-compressed format with snappy compression

                     • kdump-raw-zlib -- raw assembled kdump-compressed format with zlib compression (since 8.2)

                     • kdump-raw-lzo -- raw assembled kdump-compressed format with lzo compression (since 8.2)

                     • kdump-raw-snappy  -- raw assembled kdump-compressed format with snappy compression (since
                       8.2)

                     • win-dmp -- Windows full crashdump format, can be used instead of  ELF  converting  (since
                       2.13)

       Command dump-guest-memory (Since: 1.2)
              Dump guest's memory to vmcore.  It is a synchronous operation that can take very long depending on
              the amount of guest memory.

              Argumentspaging (boolean) --

                       if  true,  do paging to get guest's memory mapping.  This allows using gdb to process the
                       core file.

                       IMPORTANT: this option can make QEMU allocate several gigabytes of RAM.  This can  happen
                       for a large guest, or a malicious guest pretending to be large.

                       Also, paging=true has the following limitations:

                       1. The guest may be in a catastrophic state or can have corrupted memory, which cannot be
                          trusted

                       2. The  guest can be in real-mode even if paging is enabled.  For example, the guest uses
                          ACPI to sleep, and ACPI sleep state goes in real-mode

                       3. Currently only supported on i386 and x86_64.

                     • protocol (string) --

                       the filename or file descriptor of the vmcore.  The supported protocols are:

                       1. file: the protocol starts with "file:", and the following string is the file's path.

                       2. fd: the protocol starts with "fd:", and the following string is the fd's name.

                     • detach (boolean, optional) -- if true, QMP will return immediately  rather  than  waiting
                       for the dump to finish.  The user can track progress using "query-dump".  (since 2.6).

                     • begin (int, optional) -- if specified, the starting physical address.

                     • length  (int, optional) -- if specified, the memory size, in bytes.  If you don't want to
                       dump all guest's memory, please specify the start begin and lengthformat (DumpGuestMemoryFormat, optional) -- if specified,  the  format  of  guest  memory
                       dump.   But  non-elf  format  is  conflict with paging and filter, ie.  paging, begin and
                       length is not allowed to be specified with non-elf format at the same time (since 2.0)

              NOTE:
                 All boolean arguments default to false.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "dump-guest-memory",
                          "arguments": { "paging": false, "protocol": "fd:dump" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Enum DumpStatus (Since: 2.6)
              Describe the status of a long-running background guest memory dump.

              Valuesnone -- no dump-guest-memory has started yet.

                     • active -- there is one dump running in background.

                     • completed -- the last dump has finished successfully.

                     • failed -- the last dump has failed.

       Object DumpQueryResult (Since: 2.6)
              The result format for 'query-dump'.

              Membersstatus (DumpStatus) -- enum of DumpStatus, which shows current dump status

                     • completed (int) -- bytes written in latest dump (uncompressed)

                     • total (int) -- total bytes to be written in latest dump (uncompressed)

       Command query-dump (Since: 2.6)
              Query latest dump status.

              Return DumpQueryResult -- A DumpStatus object showing the dump status.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-dump" }
                     <- { "return": { "status": "active", "completed": 1024000,
                                      "total": 2048000 } }

       Event DUMP_COMPLETED (Since: 2.6)
              Emitted when background dump has completed

              Membersresult (DumpQueryResult) -- final dump status

                     • error (string, optional) -- human-readable error string that provides hint  on  why  dump
                       failed.   Only  presents  on  failure.   The  user  should not try to interpret the error
                       string.

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "DUMP_COMPLETED",
                          "data": { "result": { "total": 1090650112, "status": "completed",
                                                "completed": 1090650112 } },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1648244171, "microseconds": 950316 } }

       Object DumpGuestMemoryCapability (Since: 2.0)

              Membersformats ([DumpGuestMemoryFormat]) -- the available formats for dump-guest-memory

       Command query-dump-guest-memory-capability (Since: 2.0)
              Returns the available formats for dump-guest-memory

              Return DumpGuestMemoryCapability -- A DumpGuestMemoryCapability object listing  available  formats
                     for dump-guest-memory

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-dump-guest-memory-capability" }
                     <- { "return": { "formats":
                                      ["elf", "kdump-zlib", "kdump-lzo", "kdump-snappy"] } }

NET DEVICES

       Command set_link (Since: 0.14)
              Sets the link status of a virtual network adapter.

              Argumentsname (string) -- the device name of the virtual network adapter

                     • up (boolean) -- true to set the link status to be up

              Errors

                     • If name is not a valid network device, DeviceNotFound

              NOTE:
                 Not  all  network  adapters support setting link status.  This command will succeed even if the
                 network adapter does not support link status notification.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "set_link",
                          "arguments": { "name": "e1000.0", "up": false } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command netdev_add (Since: 0.14)
              Add a network backend.

              Additional arguments depend on the type.

              Arguments

                     • The members of Netdev.

              Errors

                     • If type is not a valid network backend, DeviceNotFound

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "netdev_add",
                          "arguments": { "type": "user", "id": "netdev1",
                                         "dnssearch": [ { "str": "example.org" } ] } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command netdev_del (Since: 0.14)
              Remove a network backend.

              Argumentsid (string) -- the name of the network backend to remove

              Errors

                     • If id is not a valid network backend, DeviceNotFound

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "netdev_del", "arguments": { "id": "netdev1" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Object NetLegacyNicOptions (Since: 1.2)
              Create a new Network Interface Card.

              Membersnetdev (string, optional) -- id of -netdev to connect to

                     • macaddr (string, optional) -- MAC address

                     • model (string, optional) -- device model (e1000, rtl8139, virtio etc.)

                     • addr (string, optional) -- PCI device address

                     • vectors (int, optional) -- number of MSI-x vectors, 0 to disable MSI-X

       Object String (Since: 1.2)
              A fat type wrapping 'str', to be embedded in lists.

              Membersstr (string) -- Not documented

       Object NetdevUserOptions (Since: 1.2)
              Use the user mode network stack which requires no administrator privilege to run.

              Membershostname (string, optional) -- client hostname reported by the builtin DHCP server

                     • restrict (boolean, optional) -- isolate the guest from the host

                     • ipv4 (boolean, optional) -- whether to support IPv4, default true for enabled (since 2.6)

                     • ipv6 (boolean, optional) -- whether to support IPv6, default true for enabled (since 2.6)

                     • ip (string, optional) -- legacy parameter, use net= instead

                     • net (string, optional) -- IP network address  that  the  guest  will  see,  in  the  form
                       addr[/netmask]  The  netmask  is  optional, and can be either in the form a.b.c.d or as a
                       number of valid top-most bits.  Default is 10.0.2.0/24.

                     • host (string, optional) -- guest-visible address of the host

                     • tftp (string, optional) -- root directory of the built-in TFTP server

                     • bootfile (string, optional) -- BOOTP filename, for use with tftp=

                     • dhcpstart (string, optional) -- the first of the 16 IPs  the  built-in  DHCP  server  can
                       assign

                     • dns (string, optional) -- guest-visible address of the virtual nameserver

                     • dnssearch  ([String],  optional) -- list of DNS suffixes to search, passed as DHCP option
                       to the guest

                     • domainname (string, optional) -- guest-visible domain  name  of  the  virtual  nameserver
                       (since 3.0)

                     • ipv6-prefix  (string,  optional)  -- IPv6 network prefix (default is fec0::) (since 2.6).
                       The network prefix is given in the usual hexadecimal IPv6 address notation.

                     • ipv6-prefixlen (int, optional) -- IPv6 network prefix length (default is 64) (since 2.6)

                     • ipv6-host (string, optional) -- guest-visible IPv6 address of the host (since 2.6)

                     • ipv6-dns (string, optional) -- guest-visible  IPv6  address  of  the  virtual  nameserver
                       (since 2.6)

                     • smb (string, optional) -- root directory of the built-in SMB server

                     • smbserver (string, optional) -- IP address of the built-in SMB server

                     • hostfwd  ([String],  optional)  -- redirect incoming TCP or UDP host connections to guest
                       endpoints

                     • guestfwd ([String], optional) -- forward guest TCP connections

                     • tftp-server-name (string, optional) -- RFC2132 "TFTP server name" string (Since 3.1)

       Object NetdevTapOptions (Since: 1.2)
              Used to configure a host TAP network interface backend.

              Membersifname (string, optional) -- interface name

                     • fd (string, optional) -- file descriptor of an already opened tap

                     • fds (string, optional) -- multiple file descriptors of already opened multiqueue  capable
                       tap

                     • script (string, optional) -- script to initialize the interface

                     • downscript (string, optional) -- script to shut down the interface

                     • br (string, optional) -- bridge name (since 2.8)

                     • helper (string, optional) -- command to execute to configure bridge

                     • sndbuf (int, optional) -- send buffer limit.  Understands [TGMKkb] suffixes.

                     • vnet_hdr (boolean, optional) -- enable the IFF_VNET_HDR flag on the tap interface

                     • vhost (boolean, optional) -- enable vhost-net network accelerator

                     • vhostfd (string, optional) -- file descriptor of an already opened vhost net device

                     • vhostfds  (string,  optional)  --  file  descriptors of multiple already opened vhost net
                       devices

                     • vhostforce (boolean, optional) -- vhost on for non-MSIX virtio guests

                     • queues (int, optional) -- number of queues to be created for multiqueue capable tap

                     • poll-us (int, optional) -- maximum number of microseconds that could  be  spent  on  busy
                       polling for tap (since 2.7)

       Object NetdevSocketOptions (Since: 1.2)
              Socket  netdevs  are  used to establish a network connection to another QEMU virtual machine via a
              TCP socket.

              Membersfd (string, optional) -- file descriptor of an already opened socket

                     • listen (string, optional) -- port number, and optional hostname, to listen on

                     • connect (string, optional) -- port number, and optional hostname, to connect to

                     • mcast (string, optional) -- UDP multicast address and port number

                     • localaddr (string, optional) -- source address and port for multicast and udp packets

                     • udp (string, optional) -- UDP unicast address and port number

       Object NetdevL2TPv3Options (Since: 2.1)
              Configure an Ethernet over L2TPv3 tunnel.

              Memberssrc (string) -- source address

                     • dst (string) -- destination address

                     • srcport (string, optional) -- source port - mandatory for udp, optional for ip

                     • dstport (string, optional) -- destination port - mandatory for udp, optional for ip

                     • ipv6 (boolean, optional) -- force the use of ipv6

                     • udp (boolean, optional) -- use the udp version of l2tpv3 encapsulation

                     • cookie64 (boolean, optional) -- use 64 bit cookies

                     • counter (boolean, optional) -- have sequence counter

                     • pincounter (boolean, optional) -- pin sequence counter to zero  -  workaround  for  buggy
                       implementations or networks with packet reorder

                     • txcookie (int, optional) -- 32 or 64 bit transmit cookie

                     • rxcookie (int, optional) -- 32 or 64 bit receive cookie

                     • txsession (int) -- 32 bit transmit session

                     • rxsession  (int,  optional)  -- 32 bit receive session - if not specified set to the same
                       value as transmit

                     • offset (int, optional)  --  additional  offset  -  allows  the  insertion  of  additional
                       application-specific data before the packet payload

       Object NetdevVdeOptions (Since: 1.2)
              Connect to a vde switch running on the host.

              Memberssock (string, optional) -- socket path

                     • port (int, optional) -- port number

                     • group (string, optional) -- group owner of socket

                     • mode (int, optional) -- permissions for socket

       Object NetdevBridgeOptions (Since: 1.2)
              Connect a host TAP network interface to a host bridge device.

              Membersbr (string, optional) -- bridge name

                     • helper (string, optional) -- command to execute to configure bridge

       Object NetdevHubPortOptions (Since: 1.2)
              Connect two or more net clients through a software hub.

              Membershubid (int) -- hub identifier number

                     • netdev  (string,  optional) -- used to connect hub to a netdev instead of a device (since
                       2.12)

       Object NetdevNetmapOptions (Since: 2.0)
              Connect a client to a netmap-enabled NIC or to a VALE switch port

              Membersifname (string) -- Either the name of an existing network interface supported by  netmap,
                       or  the  name  of  a  VALE  port  (created  on the fly).  A VALE port name is in the form
                       'valeXXX:YYY', where XXX and YYY are non-negative integers.  XXX identifies a switch  and
                       YYY  identifies  a  port  of  the  switch.   VALE ports having the same XXX are therefore
                       connected to the same switch.

                     • devname (string, optional) -- path of the netmap device (default: '/dev/netmap').

       Enum AFXDPMode (Since: 8.2)
              Availability: CONFIG_AF_XDP

              Attach mode for a default XDP program

              Valuesskb -- generic mode, no driver support necessary

                     • native -- DRV mode, program is attached to a driver, packets are  passed  to  the  socket
                       without allocation of skb.

       Object NetdevAFXDPOptions (Since: 8.2)
              Availability: CONFIG_AF_XDP

              AF_XDP network backend

              Membersifname (string) -- The name of an existing network interface.

                     • mode  (AFXDPMode,  optional) -- Attach mode for a default XDP program.  If not specified,
                       then 'native' will be tried first, then 'skb'.

                     • force-copy (boolean, optional) -- Force XDP copy mode even if device supports  zero-copy.
                       (default: false)

                     • queues (int, optional) -- number of queues to be used for multiqueue interfaces (default:
                       1).

                     • start-queue (int, optional) -- Use queues starting from this queue number (default: 0).

                     • inhibit  (boolean,  optional) -- Don't load a default XDP program, use one already loaded
                       to the interface (default: false).  Requires sock-fds.

                     • sock-fds (string, optional) -- A colon (:) separated list of file descriptors for already
                       open but not bound AF_XDP  sockets  in  the  queue  order.   One  fd  per  queue.   These
                       descriptors  should  already  be  added  into  XDP  socket  map for corresponding queues.
                       Requires inhibit.

       Object NetdevVhostUserOptions (Since: 2.1)
              Vhost-user network backend

              Memberschardev (string) -- name of a unix socket chardev

                     • vhostforce (boolean, optional) -- vhost on for non-MSIX virtio guests (default: false).

                     • queues (int, optional) -- number of  queues  to  be  created  for  multiqueue  vhost-user
                       (default: 1) (Since 2.5)

       Object NetdevVhostVDPAOptions (Since: 5.1)
              Vhost-vdpa network backend

              vDPA  device is a device that uses a datapath which complies with the virtio specifications with a
              vendor specific control path.

              Membersvhostdev (string, optional) -- path of vhost-vdpa device (default:'/dev/vhost-vdpa-0')

                     • vhostfd (string, optional) -- file descriptor of an already opened vhost vdpa device

                     • queues (int, optional) -- number of  queues  to  be  created  for  multiqueue  vhost-vdpa
                       (default: 1)

                     • x-svq  (boolean,  optional) -- Start device with (experimental) shadow virtqueue.  (Since
                       7.1) (default: false)

              Featuresunstable -- Member x-svq is experimental.

       Object NetdevVmnetHostOptions (Since: 7.1)
              Availability: CONFIG_VMNET

              vmnet (host mode) network backend.

              Allows the vmnet interface to communicate with other vmnet interfaces that are in  host  mode  and
              also with the host.

              Membersstart-address  (string,  optional) -- The starting IPv4 address to use for the interface.
                       Must be in the private IP range (RFC 1918).  Must be specified along with end-address and
                       subnet-mask.  This address is used as the gateway address.  The subsequent address up  to
                       and including end-address are placed in the DHCP pool.

                     • end-address  (string,  optional)  --  The  DHCP  IPv4  range  end  address to use for the
                       interface.  Must be in the private IP range (RFC 1918).  Must  be  specified  along  with
                       start-address and subnet-mask.

                     • subnet-mask  (string, optional) -- The IPv4 subnet mask to use on the interface.  Must be
                       specified along with start-address and subnet-mask.

                     • isolated (boolean, optional) -- Enable isolation for this interface.  Interface isolation
                       ensures that vmnet interface is not able to communicate with any other vmnet  interfaces.
                       Only communication with host is allowed.  Requires at least macOS Big Sur 11.0.

                     • net-uuid  (string,  optional)  -- The identifier (UUID) to uniquely identify the isolated
                       network vmnet interface should be added to.  If set, no DHCP service is provided for this
                       interface and network communication is allowed only with other interfaces added  to  this
                       network identified by the UUID.  Requires at least macOS Big Sur 11.0.

       Object NetdevVmnetSharedOptions (Since: 7.1)
              Availability: CONFIG_VMNET

              vmnet (shared mode) network backend.

              Allows  traffic  originating  from  the  vmnet  interface  to reach the Internet through a network
              address translator (NAT).  The vmnet interface can communicate with the host and with other shared
              mode interfaces on the same subnet.  If no DHCP settings, subnet mask and IPv6  prefix  specified,
              the interface can communicate with any of other interfaces in shared mode.

              Membersstart-address  (string,  optional) -- The starting IPv4 address to use for the interface.
                       Must be in the private IP range (RFC 1918).  Must be specified along with end-address and
                       subnet-mask.  This address is used as the gateway address.  The subsequent address up  to
                       and including end-address are placed in the DHCP pool.

                     • end-address  (string,  optional)  --  The  DHCP  IPv4  range  end  address to use for the
                       interface.  Must be in the private IP range (RFC 1918).  Must  be  specified  along  with
                       start-address and subnet-mask.

                     • subnet-mask  (string, optional) -- The IPv4 subnet mask to use on the interface.  Must be
                       specified along with start-address and subnet-mask.

                     • isolated (boolean, optional) -- Enable isolation for this interface.  Interface isolation
                       ensures that vmnet interface is not able to communicate with any other vmnet  interfaces.
                       Only communication with host is allowed.  Requires at least macOS Big Sur 11.0.

                     • nat66-prefix  (string, optional) -- The IPv6 prefix to use into guest network.  Must be a
                       unique local address i.e. start with fd00::/8 and have length of 64.

       Object NetdevVmnetBridgedOptions (Since: 7.1)
              Availability: CONFIG_VMNET

              vmnet (bridged mode) network backend.

              Bridges the vmnet interface with a physical network interface.

              Membersifname (string) -- The name of the physical interface to be bridged.

                     • isolated (boolean, optional) -- Enable isolation for this interface.  Interface isolation
                       ensures that vmnet interface is not able to communicate with any other vmnet  interfaces.
                       Only communication with host is allowed.  Requires at least macOS Big Sur 11.0.

       Object NetdevStreamOptions (Since: 7.2)
              Configuration info for stream socket netdev

              Membersaddr  (SocketAddress)  --  socket  address  to  listen  on  (server=true)  or  connect to
                       (server=false)

                     • server (boolean, optional) -- create server socket (default: false)

                     • reconnect (int, optional) -- For a client socket,  if  a  socket  is  disconnected,  then
                       attempt  a  reconnect  after  the given number of seconds.  Setting this to zero disables
                       this function.  (default: 0) (since 8.0)

                     • reconnect-ms (int, optional) -- For a client socket, if a socket  is  disconnected,  then
                       attempt  a  reconnect  after  the  given  number  of  milliseconds.  Setting this to zero
                       disables this function.  This member is mutually exclusive with reconnect.  (default:  0)
                       (Since: 9.2)

              Only SocketAddress types 'unix', 'inet' and 'fd' are supported.

              Featuresdeprecated -- Member reconnect is deprecated.  Use reconnect-ms instead.

       Object NetdevDgramOptions (Since: 7.2)
              Configuration info for datagram socket netdev.

              Membersremote (SocketAddress, optional) -- remote address

                     • local (SocketAddress, optional) -- local address

              Only SocketAddress types 'unix', 'inet' and 'fd' are supported.

              If  remote  address is present and it's a multicast address, local address is optional.  Otherwise
              local address is required and remote address is optional.

VALID PARAMETERS COMBINATION TABLE

                                         ┌───────────────┬─────────┬───────┐
                                         │ remote        │ local   │ okay? │
                                         ├───────────────┼─────────┼───────┤
                                         │ absent        │ absent  │ no    │
                                         ├───────────────┼─────────┼───────┤
                                         │ absent        │ not fd  │ no    │
                                         ├───────────────┼─────────┼───────┤
                                         │ absent        │ fd      │ yes   │
                                         ├───────────────┼─────────┼───────┤
                                         │ multicast     │ absent  │ yes   │
                                         ├───────────────┼─────────┼───────┤
                                         │ multicast     │ present │ yes   │
                                         ├───────────────┼─────────┼───────┤
                                         │ not multicast │ absent  │ no    │
                                         ├───────────────┼─────────┼───────┤
                                         │ not multicast │ present │ yes   │
                                         └───────────────┴─────────┴───────┘

       Enum NetClientDriver (Since: 2.7)
              Available netdev drivers.

              Valuesl2tpv3 -- since 2.1

                     • vhost-vdpa -- since 5.1

                     • vmnet-host -- since 7.1

                     • vmnet-shared -- since 7.1

                     • vmnet-bridged -- since 7.1

                     • stream -- since 7.2

                     • dgram -- since 7.2

                     • af-xdp -- since 8.2

                     • none -- Not documented

                     • nic -- Not documented

                     • user -- Not documented

                     • tap -- Not documented

                     • socket -- Not documented

                     • vde -- Not documented

                     • bridge -- Not documented

                     • hubport -- Not documented

                     • netmap -- Not documented

                     • vhost-user -- Not documented

       Object Netdev (Since: 1.2)
              Captures the configuration of a network device.

              Membersid (string) -- identifier for monitor commands.

                     • type (NetClientDriver) -- Specify the driver used for interpreting remaining arguments.

                     • When type is nic: The members of NetLegacyNicOptions.

                     • When type is user: The members of NetdevUserOptions.

                     • When type is tap: The members of NetdevTapOptions.

                     • When type is l2tpv3: The members of NetdevL2TPv3Options.

                     • When type is socket: The members of NetdevSocketOptions.

                     • When type is stream: The members of NetdevStreamOptions.

                     • When type is dgram: The members of NetdevDgramOptions.

                     • When type is vde: The members of NetdevVdeOptions.

                     • When type is bridge: The members of NetdevBridgeOptions.

                     • When type is hubport: The members of NetdevHubPortOptions.

                     • When type is netmap: The members of NetdevNetmapOptions.

                     • When type is af-xdp: The members of NetdevAFXDPOptions.

                     • When type is vhost-user: The members of NetdevVhostUserOptions.

                     • When type is vhost-vdpa: The members of NetdevVhostVDPAOptions.

                     • When type is vmnet-host: The members of NetdevVmnetHostOptions.

                     • When type is vmnet-shared: The members of NetdevVmnetSharedOptions.

                     • When type is vmnet-bridged: The members of NetdevVmnetBridgedOptions.

       Enum RxState (Since: 1.6)
              Packets receiving state

              Valuesnormal -- filter assigned packets according to the mac-table

                     • none -- don't receive any assigned packet

                     • all -- receive all assigned packets

       Object RxFilterInfo (Since: 1.6)
              Rx-filter information for a NIC.

              Membersname (string) -- net client name

                     • promiscuous (boolean) -- whether promiscuous mode is enabled

                     • multicast (RxState) -- multicast receive state

                     • unicast (RxState) -- unicast receive state

                     • vlan (RxState) -- vlan receive state (Since 2.0)

                     • broadcast-allowed (boolean) -- whether to receive broadcast

                     • multicast-overflow (boolean) -- multicast table is overflowed or not

                     • unicast-overflow (boolean) -- unicast table is overflowed or not

                     • main-mac (string) -- the main macaddr string

                     • vlan-table ([int]) -- a list of active vlan id

                     • unicast-table ([string]) -- a list of unicast macaddr string

                     • multicast-table ([string]) -- a list of multicast macaddr string

       Command query-rx-filter (Since: 1.6)
              Return rx-filter information for all NICs (or for the given NIC).

              Argumentsname (string, optional) -- net client name

              Return [RxFilterInfo] -- list of RxFilterInfo for all NICs (or for the given NIC).

              Errors

                     • if the given name doesn't exist

                     • if the given NIC doesn't support rx-filter querying

                     • if the given net client isn't a NIC

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-rx-filter", "arguments": { "name": "vnet0" } }
                     <- { "return": [
                             {
                                 "promiscuous": true,
                                 "name": "vnet0",
                                 "main-mac": "52:54:00:12:34:56",
                                 "unicast": "normal",
                                 "vlan": "normal",
                                 "vlan-table": [
                                     4,
                                     0
                                 ],
                                 "unicast-table": [
                                 ],
                                 "multicast": "normal",
                                 "multicast-overflow": false,
                                 "unicast-overflow": false,
                                 "multicast-table": [
                                     "01:00:5e:00:00:01",
                                     "33:33:00:00:00:01",
                                     "33:33:ff:12:34:56"
                                 ],
                                 "broadcast-allowed": false
                             }
                           ]
                        }

       Event NIC_RX_FILTER_CHANGED (Since: 1.6)
              Emitted once until the 'query-rx-filter' command is executed,  the  first  event  will  always  be
              emitted

              Membersname (string, optional) -- net client name

                     • path (string) -- device path

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "NIC_RX_FILTER_CHANGED",
                          "data": { "name": "vnet0",
                                    "path": "/machine/peripheral/vnet0/virtio-backend" },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1368697518, "microseconds": 326866 } }

       Object AnnounceParameters (Since: 4.0)
              Parameters for self-announce timers

              Membersinitial (int) -- Initial delay (in ms) before sending the first GARP/RARP announcement

                     • max (int) -- Maximum delay (in ms) between GARP/RARP announcement packets

                     • rounds (int) -- Number of self-announcement attempts

                     • step (int) -- Delay increase (in ms) after each self-announcement attempt

                     • interfaces  ([string],  optional) -- An optional list of interface names, which restricts
                       the announcement to the listed interfaces.  (Since 4.1)

                     • id (string, optional) -- A name to be used to identify an instance of announce-timers and
                       to allow it to modified later.  Not for use as part of the migration parameters.   (Since
                       4.1)

       Command announce-self (Since: 4.0)
              Trigger  generation  of broadcast RARP frames to update network switches.  This can be useful when
              network bonds fail-over the active slave.

              Arguments

                     • The members of AnnounceParameters.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "announce-self",
                          "arguments": {
                              "initial": 50, "max": 550, "rounds": 10, "step": 50,
                              "interfaces": ["vn2", "vn3"], "id": "bob" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Event FAILOVER_NEGOTIATED (Since: 4.2)
              Emitted when VIRTIO_NET_F_STANDBY  was  enabled  during  feature  negotiation.   Failover  primary
              devices  which  were  hidden  (not hotplugged when requested) before will now be hotplugged by the
              virtio-net standby device.

              Membersdevice-id (string) -- QEMU device id of the unplugged device

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "FAILOVER_NEGOTIATED",
                          "data": { "device-id": "net1" },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1368697518, "microseconds": 326866 } }

       Event NETDEV_STREAM_CONNECTED (Since: 7.2)
              Emitted when the netdev stream backend is connected

              Membersnetdev-id (string) -- QEMU netdev id that is connected

                     • addr (SocketAddress) -- The destination address

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "NETDEV_STREAM_CONNECTED",
                          "data": { "netdev-id": "netdev0",
                                    "addr": { "port": "47666", "ipv6": true,
                                              "host": "::1", "type": "inet" } },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1666269863, "microseconds": 311222 } }

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "NETDEV_STREAM_CONNECTED",
                          "data": { "netdev-id": "netdev0",
                                    "addr": { "path": "/tmp/qemu0", "type": "unix" } },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1666269706, "microseconds": 413651 } }

       Event NETDEV_STREAM_DISCONNECTED (Since: 7.2)
              Emitted when the netdev stream backend is disconnected

              Membersnetdev-id (string) -- QEMU netdev id that is disconnected

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "NETDEV_STREAM_DISCONNECTED",
                          "data": {"netdev-id": "netdev0"},
                          "timestamp": {"seconds": 1663330937, "microseconds": 526695} }

       Event NETDEV_VHOST_USER_CONNECTED (Since: 10.0)
              Emitted when the vhost-user chardev is connected

              Membersnetdev-id (string) -- QEMU netdev id that is connected

                     • chardev-id (string) -- The character device id used by the QEMU netdev

                 Example:

                     <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1739538638, "microseconds": 354181 },
                          "event": "NETDEV_VHOST_USER_CONNECTED",
                          "data": { "netdev-id": "netdev0", "chardev-id": "chr0" } }

       Event NETDEV_VHOST_USER_DISCONNECTED (Since: 10.0)
              Emitted when the vhost-user chardev is disconnected

              Membersnetdev-id (string) -- QEMU netdev id that is disconnected

                 Example:

                     <- { "timestamp": { "seconds": 1739538634, "microseconds": 920450 },
                          "event": "NETDEV_VHOST_USER_DISCONNECTED",
                          "data": { "netdev-id": "netdev0" } }

EBPF OBJECTS

       eBPF object is an ELF binary that contains the eBPF program and eBPF map description(BTF).  Overall, eBPF
       object should contain the program and enough metadata to create/load  eBPF  with  libbpf.   As  the  eBPF
       maps/program should correspond to QEMU, the eBPF can't be used from different QEMU build.

       Currently, there is a possible eBPF for receive-side scaling (RSS).

       Object EbpfObject (Since: 9.0)
              Availability: CONFIG_EBPF

              An eBPF ELF object.

              Membersobject (string) -- the eBPF object encoded in base64

       Enum EbpfProgramID (Since: 9.0)
              Availability: CONFIG_EBPF

              The eBPF programs that can be gotten with request-ebpf.

              Valuesrss  --  Receive  side scaling, technology that allows steering traffic between queues by
                       calculation  hash.   Users  may  set  up  indirection   table   and   hash/packet   types
                       configurations.  Used with virtio-net.

       Command request-ebpf (Since: 9.0)
              Availability: CONFIG_EBPF

              Retrieve  an  eBPF  object that can be loaded with libbpf.  Management applications (e.g. libvirt)
              may load it and pass file  descriptors  to  QEMU,  so  they  can  run  running  QEMU  without  BPF
              capabilities.

              Argumentsid (EbpfProgramID) -- The ID of the program to return.

              Return EbpfObject -- eBPF object encoded in base64.

ROCKER SWITCH DEVICE

       Object RockerSwitch (Since: 2.4)
              Rocker switch information.

              Membersname (string) -- switch name

                     • id (int) -- switch ID

                     • ports (int) -- number of front-panel ports

       Command query-rocker (Since: 2.4)
              Return rocker switch information.

              Argumentsname (string) -- switch name

              Return RockerSwitch -- Rocker information

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-rocker", "arguments": { "name": "sw1" } }
                     <- { "return": {"name": "sw1", "ports": 2, "id": 1327446905938}}

       Enum RockerPortDuplex (Since: 2.4)
              An enumeration of port duplex states.

              Valueshalf -- half duplex

                     • full -- full duplex

       Enum RockerPortAutoneg (Since: 2.4)
              An enumeration of port autoneg states.

              Valuesoff -- autoneg is off

                     • on -- autoneg is on

       Object RockerPort (Since: 2.4)
              Rocker switch port information.

              Membersname (string) -- port name

                     • enabled (boolean) -- port is enabled for I/O

                     • link-up (boolean) -- physical link is UP on port

                     • speed (int) -- port link speed in Mbps

                     • duplex (RockerPortDuplex) -- port link duplex

                     • autoneg (RockerPortAutoneg) -- port link autoneg

       Command query-rocker-ports (Since: 2.4)
              Return rocker switch port information.

              Argumentsname (string) -- port name

              Return [RockerPort] -- a list of RockerPort information

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-rocker-ports", "arguments": { "name": "sw1" } }
                     <- { "return": [ {"duplex": "full", "enabled": true, "name": "sw1.1",
                                       "autoneg": "off", "link-up": true, "speed": 10000},
                                      {"duplex": "full", "enabled": true, "name": "sw1.2",
                                       "autoneg": "off", "link-up": true, "speed": 10000}
                        ]}

       Object RockerOfDpaFlowKey (Since: 2.4)
              Rocker switch OF-DPA flow key

              Memberspriority (int) -- key priority, 0 being lowest priority

                     • tbl-id (int) -- flow table ID

                     • in-pport (int, optional) -- physical input port

                     • tunnel-id (int, optional) -- tunnel ID

                     • vlan-id (int, optional) -- VLAN ID

                     • eth-type (int, optional) -- Ethernet header type

                     • eth-src (string, optional) -- Ethernet header source MAC address

                     • eth-dst (string, optional) -- Ethernet header destination MAC address

                     • ip-proto (int, optional) -- IP Header protocol field

                     • ip-tos (int, optional) -- IP header TOS field

                     • ip-dst (string, optional) -- IP header destination address

              NOTE:
                 Optional  members  may  or  may not appear in the flow key depending if they're relevant to the
                 flow key.

       Object RockerOfDpaFlowMask (Since: 2.4)
              Rocker switch OF-DPA flow mask

              Membersin-pport (int, optional) -- physical input port

                     • tunnel-id (int, optional) -- tunnel ID

                     • vlan-id (int, optional) -- VLAN ID

                     • eth-src (string, optional) -- Ethernet header source MAC address

                     • eth-dst (string, optional) -- Ethernet header destination MAC address

                     • ip-proto (int, optional) -- IP Header protocol field

                     • ip-tos (int, optional) -- IP header TOS field

              NOTE:
                 Optional members may or may not appear in the flow mask depending if they're  relevant  to  the
                 flow mask.

       Object RockerOfDpaFlowAction (Since: 2.4)
              Rocker switch OF-DPA flow action

              Membersgoto-tbl (int, optional) -- next table ID

                     • group-id (int, optional) -- group ID

                     • tunnel-lport (int, optional) -- tunnel logical port ID

                     • vlan-id (int, optional) -- VLAN ID

                     • new-vlan-id (int, optional) -- new VLAN ID

                     • out-pport (int, optional) -- physical output port

              NOTE:
                 Optional  members may or may not appear in the flow action depending if they're relevant to the
                 flow action.

       Object RockerOfDpaFlow (Since: 2.4)
              Rocker switch OF-DPA flow

              Memberscookie (int) -- flow unique cookie ID

                     • hits (int) -- count of matches (hits) on flow

                     • key (RockerOfDpaFlowKey) -- flow key

                     • mask (RockerOfDpaFlowMask) -- flow mask

                     • action (RockerOfDpaFlowAction) -- flow action

       Command query-rocker-of-dpa-flows (Since: 2.4)
              Return rocker OF-DPA flow information.

              Argumentsname (string) -- switch name

                     • tbl-id (int, optional) -- flow table ID.   If  tbl-id  is  not  specified,  returns  flow
                       information for all tables.

              Return [RockerOfDpaFlow] -- rocker OF-DPA flow information

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-rocker-of-dpa-flows",
                          "arguments": { "name": "sw1" } }
                     <- { "return": [ {"key": {"in-pport": 0, "priority": 1, "tbl-id": 0},
                                       "hits": 138,
                                       "cookie": 0,
                                       "action": {"goto-tbl": 10},
                                       "mask": {"in-pport": 4294901760}
                                      },
                                      ...
                        ]}

       Object RockerOfDpaGroup (Since: 2.4)
              Rocker switch OF-DPA group

              Membersid (int) -- group unique ID

                     • type (int) -- group type

                     • vlan-id (int, optional) -- VLAN ID

                     • pport (int, optional) -- physical port number

                     • index (int, optional) -- group index, unique with group type

                     • out-pport (int, optional) -- output physical port number

                     • group-id (int, optional) -- next group ID

                     • set-vlan-id (int, optional) -- VLAN ID to set

                     • pop-vlan (int, optional) -- pop VLAN headr from packet

                     • group-ids ([int], optional) -- list of next group IDs

                     • set-eth-src (string, optional) -- set source MAC address in Ethernet header

                     • set-eth-dst (string, optional) -- set destination MAC address in Ethernet header

                     • ttl-check (int, optional) -- perform TTL check

              NOTE:
                 Optional  members may or may not appear in the group depending if they're relevant to the group
                 type.

       Command query-rocker-of-dpa-groups (Since: 2.4)
              Return rocker OF-DPA group information.

              Argumentsname (string) -- switch name

                     • type (int, optional) -- group type.  If type is not specified, returns group  information
                       for all group types.

              Return [RockerOfDpaGroup] -- rocker OF-DPA group information

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-rocker-of-dpa-groups",
                          "arguments": { "name": "sw1" } }
                     <- { "return": [ {"type": 0, "out-pport": 2,
                                       "pport": 2, "vlan-id": 3841,
                                       "pop-vlan": 1, "id": 251723778},
                                      {"type": 0, "out-pport": 0,
                                       "pport": 0, "vlan-id": 3841,
                                       "pop-vlan": 1, "id": 251723776},
                                      {"type": 0, "out-pport": 1,
                                       "pport": 1, "vlan-id": 3840,
                                       "pop-vlan": 1, "id": 251658241},
                                      {"type": 0, "out-pport": 0,
                                       "pport": 0, "vlan-id": 3840,
                                       "pop-vlan": 1, "id": 251658240}
                        ]}

TPM (TRUSTED PLATFORM MODULE) DEVICES

       Enum TpmModel (Since: 1.5)
              Availability: CONFIG_TPM

              An enumeration of TPM models

              Valuestpm-tis -- TPM TIS model

                     • tpm-crb -- TPM CRB model (since 2.12)

                     • tpm-spapr -- TPM SPAPR model (since 5.0)

       Command query-tpm-models (Since: 1.5)
              Availability: CONFIG_TPM

              Return a list of supported TPM models

              Return [TpmModel] -- a list of TpmModel

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-tpm-models" }
                     <- { "return": [ "tpm-tis", "tpm-crb", "tpm-spapr" ] }

       Enum TpmType (Since: 1.5)
              Availability: CONFIG_TPM

              An enumeration of TPM types

              Valuespassthrough -- TPM passthrough type

                     • emulator -- Software Emulator TPM type (since 2.11)

       Command query-tpm-types (Since: 1.5)
              Availability: CONFIG_TPM

              Return a list of supported TPM types

              Return [TpmType] -- a list of TpmType

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-tpm-types" }
                     <- { "return": [ "passthrough", "emulator" ] }

       Object TPMPassthroughOptions (Since: 1.5)
              Availability: CONFIG_TPM

              Information about the TPM passthrough type

              Memberspath (string, optional) -- string describing the path used for accessing the TPM device

                     • cancel-path  (string,  optional)  --  string  showing  the  TPM's  sysfs  cancel file for
                       cancellation of TPM commands while they are executing

       Object TPMEmulatorOptions (Since: 2.11)
              Availability: CONFIG_TPM

              Information about the TPM emulator type

              Memberschardev (string) -- Name of a unix socket chardev

       Object TPMPassthroughOptionsWrapper (Since: 1.5)
              Availability: CONFIG_TPM.INDENT 7.0

       Membersdata (TPMPassthroughOptions) -- Information about the TPM passthrough type

       Object TPMEmulatorOptionsWrapper (Since: 2.11)
              Availability: CONFIG_TPM.INDENT 7.0

       Membersdata (TPMEmulatorOptions) -- Information about the TPM emulator type

       Object TpmTypeOptions (Since: 1.5)
              Availability: CONFIG_TPM

              A union referencing different TPM backend types' configuration options

              Memberstype (TpmType) -- .INDENT 2.0

                     • 'passthrough' The configuration options for the TPM passthrough type

                     • 'emulator' The configuration options for TPM emulator backend type

              • When type is passthrough: The members of TPMPassthroughOptionsWrapper.

              • When type is emulator: The members of TPMEmulatorOptionsWrapper.

       Object TPMInfo (Since: 1.5)
              Availability: CONFIG_TPM

              Information about the TPM

              Membersid (string) -- The Id of the TPM

                     • model (TpmModel) -- The TPM frontend model

                     • options (TpmTypeOptions) -- The TPM (backend) type configuration options

       Command query-tpm (Since: 1.5)
              Availability: CONFIG_TPM

              Return information about the TPM device

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-tpm" }
                     <- { "return":
                          [
                            { "model": "tpm-tis",
                              "options":
                                { "type": "passthrough",
                                  "data":
                                    { "cancel-path": "/sys/class/misc/tpm0/device/cancel",
                                      "path": "/dev/tpm0"
                                    }
                                },
                              "id": "tpm0"
                            }
                          ]
                        }

REMOTE DESKTOP

       Enum DisplayProtocol (Since: 7.0)
              Display protocols which support changing password options.

              Valuesvnc -- Not documented

                     • spice -- Not documented

       Enum SetPasswordAction (Since: 7.0)
              An action to take on changing a password on a connection with active clients.

              Valueskeep -- maintain existing clients

                     • fail -- fail the command if clients are connected

                     • disconnect -- disconnect existing clients

       Object SetPasswordOptions (Since: 7.0)
              Options for set_password.

              Membersprotocol (DisplayProtocol) -- .INDENT 2.0

                     • 'vnc' to modify the VNC server password

                     • 'spice' to modify the Spice server password

              • password (string) -- the new password

              • connected (SetPasswordAction, optional) -- How to handle  existing  clients  when  changing  the
                password.   If  nothing  is  specified,  defaults  to 'keep'.  For VNC, only 'keep' is currently
                implemented.

              • When protocol is vnc: The members of SetPasswordOptionsVnc.

       Object SetPasswordOptionsVnc (Since: 7.0)
              Options for set_password specific to the VNC protocol.

              Membersdisplay (string, optional) -- The id of the display where the password should be changed.
                       Defaults to the first.

       Command set_password (Since: 0.14)
              Set the password of a remote display server.

              Arguments

                     • The members of SetPasswordOptions.

              Errors

                     • If Spice is not enabled, DeviceNotFound

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "set_password", "arguments": { "protocol": "vnc",
                                                                    "password": "secret" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Object ExpirePasswordOptions (Since: 7.0)
              General options for expire_password.

              Membersprotocol (DisplayProtocol) -- .INDENT 2.0

                     • 'vnc' to modify the VNC server expiration

                     • 'spice' to modify the Spice server expiration

              • time (string) --

                when to expire the password.

                • 'now' to expire the password immediately

                • 'never' to cancel password expiration

                • '+INT' where INT is the number of seconds from now (integer)

                • 'INT' where INT is the absolute time in seconds

              • When protocol is vnc: The members of ExpirePasswordOptionsVnc.

       NOTE:
                 Time is relative to the server and currently there is no way to  coordinate  server  time  with
                 client  time.   It  is  not  recommended to use the absolute time version of the time parameter
                 unless you're sure you are on the same machine as the QEMU instance.

       Object ExpirePasswordOptionsVnc (Since: 7.0)
              Options for expire_password specific to the VNC protocol.

              Membersdisplay (string, optional) -- The id of  the  display  where  the  expiration  should  be
                       changed.  Defaults to the first.

       Command expire_password (Since: 0.14)
              Expire the password of a remote display server.

              Arguments

                     • The members of ExpirePasswordOptions.

              Errors

                     • If protocol is 'spice' and Spice is not active, DeviceNotFound

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "expire_password", "arguments": { "protocol": "vnc",
                                                                       "time": "+60" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Enum ImageFormat (Since: 7.1)
              Supported image format types.

              Valuespng -- PNG format

                     • ppm -- PPM format

       Command screendump (Since: 0.14)
              Availability: CONFIG_PIXMAN

              Capture the contents of a screen and write it to a file.

              Argumentsfilename (string) -- the path of a new file to store the image

                     • device  (string,  optional)  --  ID of the display device that should be dumped.  If this
                       parameter is missing, the primary display will be used.  (Since 2.12)

                     • head (int, optional) -- head to use in case the device supports multiple heads.  If  this
                       parameter  is  missing,  head  #0  will  be  used.   Also  note that the head can only be
                       specified in conjunction with the device ID.  (Since 2.12)

                     • format (ImageFormat, optional) -- image format for  screendump.   (default:  ppm)  (Since
                       7.1)

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "screendump",
                          "arguments": { "filename": "/tmp/image" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

   Spice
       Object SpiceBasicInfo (Since: 2.1)
              Availability: CONFIG_SPICE

              The basic information for SPICE network connection

              Membershost (string) -- IP address

                     • port (string) -- port number

                     • family (NetworkAddressFamily) -- address family

       Object SpiceServerInfo (Since: 2.1)
              Availability: CONFIG_SPICE

              Information about a SPICE server

              Membersauth (string, optional) -- authentication method

                     • The members of SpiceBasicInfo.

       Object SpiceChannel (Since: 0.14)
              Availability: CONFIG_SPICE

              Information about a SPICE client channel.

              Membersconnection-id  (int) -- SPICE connection id number.  All channels with the same id belong
                       to the same SPICE session.

                     • channel-type (int) -- SPICE channel type number.  "1" is the main control channel, filter
                       for this one if you want to track spice sessions only

                     • channel-id (int) -- SPICE channel ID  number.   Usually  "0",  might  be  different  when
                       multiple  channels  of  the  same  type  exist,  such  as  multiple display channels in a
                       multihead setup

                     • tls (boolean) -- true if the channel is encrypted, false otherwise.

                     • The members of SpiceBasicInfo.

       Enum SpiceQueryMouseMode (Since: 1.1)
              Availability: CONFIG_SPICE

              An enumeration of Spice mouse states.

              Valuesclient -- Mouse cursor position is determined by the client.

                     • server -- Mouse cursor position is determined by the server.

                     • unknown -- No information is available about mouse mode used by the spice server.

       Object SpiceInfo (Since: 0.14)
              Availability: CONFIG_SPICE

              Information about the SPICE session.

              Membersenabled (boolean) -- true if the SPICE server is enabled, false otherwise

                     • migrated (boolean) -- true if the last guest migration completed and spice migration  had
                       completed as well, false otherwise (since 1.4)

                     • host  (string,  optional)  -- The hostname the SPICE server is bound to.  This depends on
                       the name resolution on the host and may be an IP address.

                     • port (int, optional) -- The SPICE server's port number.

                     • compiled-version (string, optional) -- SPICE server version.

                     • tls-port (int, optional) -- The SPICE server's TLS port number.

                     • auth (string, optional) --

                       the current authentication type used by the server

                       • 'none' if no authentication is being used

                       • 'spice' uses SASL or direct TLS authentication, depending on command line options

                     • mouse-mode (SpiceQueryMouseMode) -- The mode in  which  the  mouse  cursor  is  displayed
                       currently.   Can  be  determined  by the client or the server, or unknown if spice server
                       doesn't provide this information.  (since: 1.1)

                     • channels ([SpiceChannel], optional) -- a list  of  SpiceChannel  for  each  active  spice
                       channel

       Command query-spice (Since: 0.14)
              Availability: CONFIG_SPICE

              Returns information about the current SPICE server

              Return SpiceInfo -- SpiceInfo

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-spice" }
                     <- { "return": {
                              "enabled": true,
                              "auth": "spice",
                              "port": 5920,
                              "migrated":false,
                              "tls-port": 5921,
                              "host": "0.0.0.0",
                              "mouse-mode":"client",
                              "channels": [
                                 {
                                    "port": "54924",
                                    "family": "ipv4",
                                    "channel-type": 1,
                                    "connection-id": 1804289383,
                                    "host": "127.0.0.1",
                                    "channel-id": 0,
                                    "tls": true
                                 },
                                 {
                                    "port": "36710",
                                    "family": "ipv4",
                                    "channel-type": 4,
                                    "connection-id": 1804289383,
                                    "host": "127.0.0.1",
                                    "channel-id": 0,
                                    "tls": false
                                 },
                                 ...
                              ]
                           }
                        }

       Event SPICE_CONNECTED (Since: 0.14)
              Availability: CONFIG_SPICE

              Emitted when a SPICE client establishes a connection

              Membersserver (SpiceBasicInfo) -- server information

                     • client (SpiceBasicInfo) -- client information

                 Example:

                     <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1290688046, "microseconds": 388707},
                          "event": "SPICE_CONNECTED",
                          "data": {
                            "server": { "port": "5920", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"},
                            "client": {"port": "52873", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"}
                        }}

       Event SPICE_INITIALIZED (Since: 0.14)
              Availability: CONFIG_SPICE

              Emitted  after  initial handshake and authentication takes place (if any) and the SPICE channel is
              up and running

              Membersserver (SpiceServerInfo) -- server information

                     • client (SpiceChannel) -- client information

                 Example:

                     <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1290688046, "microseconds": 417172},
                          "event": "SPICE_INITIALIZED",
                          "data": {"server": {"auth": "spice", "port": "5921",
                                              "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"},
                                   "client": {"port": "49004", "family": "ipv4", "channel-type": 3,
                                              "connection-id": 1804289383, "host": "127.0.0.1",
                                              "channel-id": 0, "tls": true}
                        }}

       Event SPICE_DISCONNECTED (Since: 0.14)
              Availability: CONFIG_SPICE

              Emitted when the SPICE connection is closed

              Membersserver (SpiceBasicInfo) -- server information

                     • client (SpiceBasicInfo) -- client information

                 Example:

                     <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1290688046, "microseconds": 388707},
                          "event": "SPICE_DISCONNECTED",
                          "data": {
                            "server": { "port": "5920", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"},
                            "client": {"port": "52873", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"}
                        }}

       Event SPICE_MIGRATE_COMPLETED (Since: 1.3)
              Availability: CONFIG_SPICE

              Emitted when SPICE migration has completed

                 Example:

                     <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1290688046, "microseconds": 417172},
                          "event": "SPICE_MIGRATE_COMPLETED" }

   VNC
       Object VncBasicInfo (Since: 2.1)
              Availability: CONFIG_VNC

              The basic information for vnc network connection

              Membershost (string) -- IP address

                     • service (string) -- The service name of the vnc  port.   This  may  depend  on  the  host
                       system's service database so symbolic names should not be relied on.

                     • family (NetworkAddressFamily) -- address family

                     • websocket (boolean) -- true in case the socket is a websocket (since 2.3).

       Object VncServerInfo (Since: 2.1)
              Availability: CONFIG_VNC

              The network connection information for server

              Membersauth  (string,  optional) -- authentication method used for the plain (non-websocket) VNC
                       server

                     • The members of VncBasicInfo.

       Object VncClientInfo (Since: 0.14)
              Availability: CONFIG_VNC

              Information about a connected VNC client.

              Membersx509_dname (string, optional) -- If x509 authentication is in use, the Distinguished Name
                       of the client.

                     • sasl_username (string, optional) -- If SASL authentication is in use, the  SASL  username
                       used for authentication.

                     • The members of VncBasicInfo.

       Object VncInfo (Since: 0.14)
              Availability: CONFIG_VNC

              Information about the VNC session.

              Membersenabled (boolean) -- true if the VNC server is enabled, false otherwise

                     • host  (string, optional) -- The hostname the VNC server is bound to.  This depends on the
                       name resolution on the host and may be an IP address.

                     • family (NetworkAddressFamily, optional) -- .INDENT 2.0

                     • 'ipv6' if the host is listening for IPv6 connections

                     • 'ipv4' if the host is listening for IPv4 connections

                     • 'unix' if the host is listening on a unix domain socket

                     • 'unknown' otherwise

              • service (string, optional) -- The service name of the server's port.  This may  depends  on  the
                host system's service database so symbolic names should not be relied on.

              • auth (string, optional) --

                the current authentication type used by the server

                • 'none' if no authentication is being used

                • 'vnc' if VNC authentication is being used

                • 'vencrypt+plain' if VEncrypt is used with plain text authentication

                • 'vencrypt+tls+none' if VEncrypt is used with TLS and no authentication

                • 'vencrypt+tls+vnc' if VEncrypt is used with TLS and VNC authentication

                • 'vencrypt+tls+plain' if VEncrypt is used with TLS and plain text auth

                • 'vencrypt+x509+none' if VEncrypt is used with x509 and no auth

                • 'vencrypt+x509+vnc' if VEncrypt is used with x509 and VNC auth

                • 'vencrypt+x509+plain' if VEncrypt is used with x509 and plain text auth

                • 'vencrypt+tls+sasl' if VEncrypt is used with TLS and SASL auth

                • 'vencrypt+x509+sasl' if VEncrypt is used with x509 and SASL auth

              • clients  ([VncClientInfo],  optional)  --  a  list  of  VncClientInfo of all currently connected
                clients

       Enum VncPrimaryAuth (Since: 2.3)
              Availability: CONFIG_VNC

              vnc primary authentication method.

              Valuesnone -- Not documented

                     • vnc -- Not documented

                     • ra2 -- Not documented

                     • ra2ne -- Not documented

                     • tight -- Not documented

                     • ultra -- Not documented

                     • tls -- Not documented

                     • vencrypt -- Not documented

                     • sasl -- Not documented

       Enum VncVencryptSubAuth (Since: 2.3)
              Availability: CONFIG_VNC

              vnc sub authentication method with vencrypt.

              Valuesplain -- Not documented

                     • tls-none -- Not documented

                     • x509-none -- Not documented

                     • tls-vnc -- Not documented

                     • x509-vnc -- Not documented

                     • tls-plain -- Not documented

                     • x509-plain -- Not documented

                     • tls-sasl -- Not documented

                     • x509-sasl -- Not documented

       Object VncServerInfo2 (Since: 2.9)
              Availability: CONFIG_VNC

              The network connection information for server

              Membersauth (VncPrimaryAuth) -- The current authentication type used by the servers

                     • vencrypt (VncVencryptSubAuth, optional) -- The vencrypt sub authentication type  used  by
                       the servers, only specified in case auth == vencrypt.

                     • The members of VncBasicInfo.

       Object VncInfo2 (Since: 2.3)
              Availability: CONFIG_VNC

              Information about a vnc server

              Membersid (string) -- vnc server name.

                     • server  ([VncServerInfo2])  --  A list of VncBasincInfo describing all listening sockets.
                       The list can be empty (in case the vnc server is disabled).  It also  may  have  multiple
                       entries: normal + websocket, possibly also ipv4 + ipv6 in the future.

                     • clients  ([VncClientInfo]) -- A list of VncClientInfo of all currently connected clients.
                       The list can be empty, for obvious reasons.

                     • auth (VncPrimaryAuth) -- The current  authentication  type  used  by  the  non-websockets
                       servers

                     • vencrypt  (VncVencryptSubAuth,  optional) -- The vencrypt authentication type used by the
                       servers, only specified in case auth == vencrypt.

                     • display (string, optional) -- The display device the vnc server is linked to.

       Command query-vnc (Since: 0.14)
              Availability: CONFIG_VNC

              Returns information about the current VNC server

              Return VncInfo -- VncInfo

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-vnc" }
                     <- { "return": {
                              "enabled":true,
                              "host":"0.0.0.0",
                              "service":"50402",
                              "auth":"vnc",
                              "family":"ipv4",
                              "clients":[
                                 {
                                    "host":"127.0.0.1",
                                    "service":"50401",
                                    "family":"ipv4",
                                    "websocket":false
                                 }
                              ]
                           }
                        }

       Command query-vnc-servers (Since: 2.3)
              Availability: CONFIG_VNC

              Returns a list of vnc servers.  The list can be empty.

              Return [VncInfo2] -- a list of VncInfo2

       Command change-vnc-password (Since: 1.1)
              Availability: CONFIG_VNC

              Change the VNC server password.

              Argumentspassword (string) -- the new password to use with VNC authentication

              NOTE:
                 An empty password in this command will set the password to the empty string.  Existing  clients
                 are unaffected by executing this command.

       Event VNC_CONNECTED (Since: 0.13)
              Availability: CONFIG_VNC

              Emitted when a VNC client establishes a connection

              Membersserver (VncServerInfo) -- server information

                     • client (VncBasicInfo) -- client information

              NOTE:
                 This  event is emitted before any authentication takes place, thus the authentication ID is not
                 provided.

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "VNC_CONNECTED",
                          "data": {
                                "server": { "auth": "sasl", "family": "ipv4", "websocket": false,
                                            "service": "5901", "host": "0.0.0.0" },
                                "client": { "family": "ipv4", "service": "58425",
                                            "host": "127.0.0.1", "websocket": false } },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1262976601, "microseconds": 975795 } }

       Event VNC_INITIALIZED (Since: 0.13)
              Availability: CONFIG_VNC

              Emitted after authentication takes place (if any) and the VNC session is made active

              Membersserver (VncServerInfo) -- server information

                     • client (VncClientInfo) -- client information

                 Example:

                     <-  { "event": "VNC_INITIALIZED",
                           "data": {
                                "server": { "auth": "sasl", "family": "ipv4", "websocket": false,
                                            "service": "5901", "host": "0.0.0.0"},
                                "client": { "family": "ipv4", "service": "46089", "websocket": false,
                                            "host": "127.0.0.1", "sasl_username": "luiz" } },
                           "timestamp": { "seconds": 1263475302, "microseconds": 150772 } }

       Event VNC_DISCONNECTED (Since: 0.13)
              Availability: CONFIG_VNC

              Emitted when the connection is closed

              Membersserver (VncServerInfo) -- server information

                     • client (VncClientInfo) -- client information

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "VNC_DISCONNECTED",
                          "data": {
                                "server": { "auth": "sasl", "family": "ipv4", "websocket": false,
                                            "service": "5901", "host": "0.0.0.0" },
                                "client": { "family": "ipv4", "service": "58425", "websocket": false,
                                            "host": "127.0.0.1", "sasl_username": "luiz" } },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1262976601, "microseconds": 975795 } }

INPUT

       Object MouseInfo (Since: 0.14)
              Information about a mouse device.

              Membersname (string) -- the name of the mouse device

                     • index (int) -- the index of the mouse device

                     • current (boolean) -- true if this device is currently receiving mouse events

                     • absolute (boolean) -- true if this device supports absolute coordinates as input

       Command query-mice (Since: 0.14)
              Returns information about each active mouse device

              Return [MouseInfo] -- a list of MouseInfo for each device

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-mice" }
                     <- { "return": [
                              {
                                 "name":"QEMU Microsoft Mouse",
                                 "index":0,
                                 "current":false,
                                 "absolute":false
                              },
                              {
                                 "name":"QEMU PS/2 Mouse",
                                 "index":1,
                                 "current":true,
                                 "absolute":true
                              }
                           ]
                        }

       Enum QKeyCode (Since: 1.3)
              An enumeration of key name.

              This is used by the send-key command.

              Valuesunmapped -- since 2.0

                     • pause -- since 2.0

                     • ro -- since 2.4

                     • kp_comma -- since 2.4

                     • kp_equals -- since 2.6

                     • power -- since 2.6

                     • hiragana -- since 2.9

                     • henkan -- since 2.9

                     • yen -- since 2.9

                     • sleep -- since 2.10

                     • wake -- since 2.10

                     • audionext -- since 2.10

                     • audioprev -- since 2.10

                     • audiostop -- since 2.10

                     • audioplay -- since 2.10

                     • audiomute -- since 2.10

                     • volumeup -- since 2.10

                     • volumedown -- since 2.10

                     • mediaselect -- since 2.10

                     • mail -- since 2.10

                     • calculator -- since 2.10

                     • computer -- since 2.10

                     • ac_home -- since 2.10

                     • ac_back -- since 2.10

                     • ac_forward -- since 2.10

                     • ac_refresh -- since 2.10

                     • ac_bookmarks -- since 2.10

                     • muhenkan -- since 2.12

                     • katakanahiragana -- since 2.12

                     • lang1 -- since 6.1

                     • lang2 -- since 6.1

                     • f13 -- since 8.0

                     • f14 -- since 8.0

                     • f15 -- since 8.0

                     • f16 -- since 8.0

                     • f17 -- since 8.0

                     • f18 -- since 8.0

                     • f19 -- since 8.0

                     • f20 -- since 8.0

                     • f21 -- since 8.0

                     • f22 -- since 8.0

                     • f23 -- since 8.0

                     • f24 -- since 8.0

                     • shift -- Not documented

                     • shift_r -- Not documented

                     • alt -- Not documented

                     • alt_r -- Not documented

                     • ctrl -- Not documented

                     • ctrl_r -- Not documented

                     • menu -- Not documented

                     • esc -- Not documented

                     • 1 -- Not documented

                     • 2 -- Not documented

                     • 3 -- Not documented

                     • 4 -- Not documented

                     • 5 -- Not documented

                     • 6 -- Not documented

                     • 7 -- Not documented

                     • 8 -- Not documented

                     • 9 -- Not documented

                     • 0 -- Not documented

                     • minus -- Not documented

                     • equal -- Not documented

                     • backspace -- Not documented

                     • tab -- Not documented

                     • q -- Not documented

                     • w -- Not documented

                     • e -- Not documented

                     • r -- Not documented

                     • t -- Not documented

                     • y -- Not documented

                     • u -- Not documented

                     • i -- Not documented

                     • o -- Not documented

                     • p -- Not documented

                     • bracket_left -- Not documented

                     • bracket_right -- Not documented

                     • ret -- Not documented

                     • a -- Not documented

                     • s -- Not documented

                     • d -- Not documented

                     • f -- Not documented

                     • g -- Not documented

                     • h -- Not documented

                     • j -- Not documented

                     • k -- Not documented

                     • l -- Not documented

                     • semicolon -- Not documented

                     • apostrophe -- Not documented

                     • grave_accent -- Not documented

                     • backslash -- Not documented

                     • z -- Not documented

                     • x -- Not documented

                     • c -- Not documented

                     • v -- Not documented

                     • b -- Not documented

                     • n -- Not documented

                     • m -- Not documented

                     • comma -- Not documented

                     • dot -- Not documented

                     • slash -- Not documented

                     • asterisk -- Not documented

                     • spc -- Not documented

                     • caps_lock -- Not documented

                     • f1 -- Not documented

                     • f2 -- Not documented

                     • f3 -- Not documented

                     • f4 -- Not documented

                     • f5 -- Not documented

                     • f6 -- Not documented

                     • f7 -- Not documented

                     • f8 -- Not documented

                     • f9 -- Not documented

                     • f10 -- Not documented

                     • num_lock -- Not documented

                     • scroll_lock -- Not documented

                     • kp_divide -- Not documented

                     • kp_multiply -- Not documented

                     • kp_subtract -- Not documented

                     • kp_add -- Not documented

                     • kp_enter -- Not documented

                     • kp_decimal -- Not documented

                     • sysrq -- Not documented

                     • kp_0 -- Not documented

                     • kp_1 -- Not documented

                     • kp_2 -- Not documented

                     • kp_3 -- Not documented

                     • kp_4 -- Not documented

                     • kp_5 -- Not documented

                     • kp_6 -- Not documented

                     • kp_7 -- Not documented

                     • kp_8 -- Not documented

                     • kp_9 -- Not documented

                     • less -- Not documented

                     • f11 -- Not documented

                     • f12 -- Not documented

                     • print -- Not documented

                     • home -- Not documented

                     • pgup -- Not documented

                     • pgdn -- Not documented

                     • end -- Not documented

                     • left -- Not documented

                     • up -- Not documented

                     • down -- Not documented

                     • right -- Not documented

                     • insert -- Not documented

                     • delete -- Not documented

                     • stop -- Not documented

                     • again -- Not documented

                     • props -- Not documented

                     • undo -- Not documented

                     • front -- Not documented

                     • copy -- Not documented

                     • open -- Not documented

                     • paste -- Not documented

                     • find -- Not documented

                     • cut -- Not documented

                     • lf -- Not documented

                     • help -- Not documented

                     • meta_l -- Not documented

                     • meta_r -- Not documented

                     • compose -- Not documented

              'sysrq' was mistakenly added to hack around the fact  that  the  ps2  driver  was  not  generating
              correct  scancodes sequences when 'alt+print' was pressed.  This flaw is now fixed and the 'sysrq'
              key serves no further purpose.  Any further use  of  'sysrq'  will  be  transparently  changed  to
              'print', so they are effectively synonyms.

       Enum KeyValueKind (Since: 1.3)

              Valuesnumber -- Not documented

                     • qcode -- Not documented

       Object IntWrapper (Since: 1.3)

              Membersdata (int) -- a numeric key code

       Object QKeyCodeWrapper (Since: 1.3)

              Membersdata (QKeyCode) -- An enumeration of key name

       Object KeyValue (Since: 1.3)
              Represents a keyboard key.

              Memberstype (KeyValueKind) -- key encoding

                     • When type is number: The members of IntWrapper.

                     • When type is qcode: The members of QKeyCodeWrapper.

       Command send-key (Since: 1.3)
              Send keys to guest.

              Argumentskeys  ([KeyValue])  --  An  array  of KeyValue elements.  All KeyValues in this array are
                       simultaneously sent to the guest.  A KeyValue.number value is sent directly to the guest,
                       while KeyValue.qcode must be a valid QKeyCode value

                     • hold-time (int, optional) -- time to delay key up events, milliseconds.  Defaults to 100

              Errors

                     • If key is unknown or redundant, GenericError

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "send-key",
                          "arguments": { "keys": [ { "type": "qcode", "data": "ctrl" },
                                                   { "type": "qcode", "data": "alt" },
                                                   { "type": "qcode", "data": "delete" } ] } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Enum InputButton (Since: 2.0)
              Button of a pointer input device (mouse, tablet).

              Valuesside -- front side button of a 5-button mouse (since 2.9)

                     • extra -- rear side button of a 5-button mouse (since 2.9)

                     • touch -- screen contact on a multi-touch device (since 8.1)

                     • left -- Not documented

                     • middle -- Not documented

                     • right -- Not documented

                     • wheel-up -- Not documented

                     • wheel-down -- Not documented

                     • wheel-left -- Not documented

                     • wheel-right -- Not documented

       Enum InputAxis (Since: 2.0)
              Position axis of a pointer input device (mouse, tablet).

              Valuesx -- Not documented

                     • y -- Not documented

       Enum InputMultiTouchType (Since: 8.1)
              Type of a multi-touch event.

              Valuesbegin -- A new touch event sequence has just started.

                     • update -- A touch event sequence has been updated.

                     • end -- A touch event sequence has finished.

                     • cancel -- A touch event sequence has been canceled.

                     • data -- Absolute position data.

       Object InputKeyEvent (Since: 2.0)
              Keyboard input event.

              Memberskey (KeyValue) -- Which key this event is for.

                     • down (boolean) -- True for key-down and false for key-up events.

       Object InputBtnEvent (Since: 2.0)
              Pointer button input event.

              Membersbutton (InputButton) -- Which button this event is for.

                     • down (boolean) -- True for key-down and false for key-up events.

       Object InputMoveEvent (Since: 2.0)
              Pointer motion input event.

              Membersaxis (InputAxis) -- Which axis is referenced by value.

                     • value (int) -- Pointer position.  For absolute  coordinates  the  valid  range  is  0  to
                       0x7fff.

       Object InputMultiTouchEvent (Since: 8.1)
              MultiTouch input event.

              Memberstype (InputMultiTouchType) -- The type of multi-touch event.

                     • slot (int) -- Which slot has generated the event.

                     • tracking-id (int) -- ID to correlate this event with previously generated events.

                     • axis (InputAxis) -- Which axis is referenced by value.

                     • value (int) -- Contact position.

       Enum InputEventKind (Since: 2.0)

              Valueskey -- a keyboard input event

                     • btn -- a pointer button input event

                     • rel -- a relative pointer motion input event

                     • abs -- an absolute pointer motion input event

                     • mtt -- a multi-touch input event

       Object InputKeyEventWrapper (Since: 2.0)

              Membersdata (InputKeyEvent) -- Keyboard input event

       Object InputBtnEventWrapper (Since: 2.0)

              Membersdata (InputBtnEvent) -- Pointer button input event

       Object InputMoveEventWrapper (Since: 2.0)

              Membersdata (InputMoveEvent) -- Pointer motion input event

       Object InputMultiTouchEventWrapper (Since: 8.1)

              Membersdata (InputMultiTouchEvent) -- MultiTouch input event

       Object InputEvent (Since: 2.0)
              Input event union.

              Memberstype (InputEventKind) -- the type of input event

                     • When type is key: The members of InputKeyEventWrapper.

                     • When type is btn: The members of InputBtnEventWrapper.

                     • When type is rel: The members of InputMoveEventWrapper.

                     • When type is abs: The members of InputMoveEventWrapper.

                     • When type is mtt: The members of InputMultiTouchEventWrapper.

       Command input-send-event (Since: 2.6)
              Send input event(s) to guest.

              The  device  and  head parameters can be used to send the input event to specific input devices in
              case (a) multiple input devices of the same kind are added to the virtual machine and (b) you have
              configured input routing (see docs/multiseat.txt) for those input devices.   The  parameters  work
              exactly  like the device and head properties of input devices.  If device is missing, only devices
              that have no input routing config are admissible.  If device is specified, both input devices with
              and without input routing config are admissible,  but  devices  with  input  routing  config  take
              precedence.

              Argumentsdevice (string, optional) -- display device to send event(s) to.

                     • head  (int,  optional)  --  head to send event(s) to, in case the display device supports
                       multiple scanouts.

                     • events ([InputEvent]) -- List of InputEvent union.

              NOTE:
                 The consoles are visible in the qom tree, under /backend/console[$index].  They have  a  device
                 link  and  head  property,  so  it is possible to map which console belongs to which device and
                 display.

                 Example: Press left mouse button

                      -> { "execute": "input-send-event",
                          "arguments": { "device": "video0",
                                         "events": [ { "type": "btn",
                                         "data" : { "down": true, "button": "left" } } ] } }
                      <- { "return": {} }

                      -> { "execute": "input-send-event",
                          "arguments": { "device": "video0",
                                         "events": [ { "type": "btn",
                                         "data" : { "down": false, "button": "left" } } ] } }
                      <- { "return": {} }

                 Example: Press ctrl-alt-del

                      -> { "execute": "input-send-event",
                           "arguments": { "events": [
                              { "type": "key", "data" : { "down": true,
                                "key": {"type": "qcode", "data": "ctrl" } } },
                              { "type": "key", "data" : { "down": true,
                                "key": {"type": "qcode", "data": "alt" } } },
                              { "type": "key", "data" : { "down": true,
                                "key": {"type": "qcode", "data": "delete" } } } ] } }
                      <- { "return": {} }

                 Example: Move mouse pointer to absolute coordinates

                      -> { "execute": "input-send-event" ,
                        "arguments": { "events": [
                                     { "type": "abs", "data" : { "axis": "x", "value" : 20000 } },
                                     { "type": "abs", "data" : { "axis": "y", "value" : 400 } } ] } }
                      <- { "return": {} }

       Object DisplayGTK (Since: 2.12)
              GTK display options.

              Membersgrab-on-hover (boolean, optional) -- Grab keyboard input on mouse hover.

                     • zoom-to-fit (boolean, optional) -- Zoom guest display to fit into the host window.   When
                       turned  off  the  host  window  will  be resized instead.  In case the display device can
                       notify the guest on window resizes (virtio-gpu) this will default to "on",  assuming  the
                       guest  will  resize  the display to match the window size then.  Otherwise it defaults to
                       "off".  (Since 3.1)

                     • show-tabs (boolean, optional) -- Display the tab bar for switching  between  the  various
                       graphical interfaces (e.g. VGA and virtual console character devices) by default.  (Since
                       7.1)

                     • show-menubar  (boolean,  optional) -- Display the main window menubar.  Defaults to "on".
                       (Since 8.0)

       Object DisplayEGLHeadless (Since: 3.1)
              EGL headless display options.

              Membersrendernode (string, optional) -- Which DRM render node should be used.   Default  is  the
                       first available node on the host.

       Object DisplayDBus (Since: 7.0)
              DBus display options.

              Membersaddr (string, optional) -- The D-Bus bus address (default to the session bus).

                     • rendernode  (string,  optional)  -- Which DRM render node should be used.  Default is the
                       first available node on the host.

                     • p2p (boolean, optional) -- Whether to  use  peer-to-peer  connections  (accepted  through
                       add_client).

                     • audiodev (string, optional) -- Use the specified DBus audiodev to export audio.

       Enum DisplayGLMode (Since: 3.0)
              Display OpenGL mode.

              Valuesoff -- Disable OpenGL (default).

                     • on  --  Use OpenGL, pick context type automatically.  Would better be named 'auto' but is
                       called 'on' for backward compatibility with bool type.

                     • core -- Use OpenGL with Core (desktop) Context.

                     • es -- Use OpenGL with ES (embedded systems) Context.

       Object DisplayCurses (Since: 4.0)
              Curses display options.

              Memberscharset (string, optional) -- Font charset used by guest (default: CP437).

       Object DisplayCocoa (Since: 7.0)
              Cocoa display options.

              Membersleft-command-key (boolean, optional) -- Enable/disable forwarding of left command key  to
                       guest.   Allows  command-tab window switching on the host without sending this key to the
                       guest when "off".  Defaults to "on"

                     • full-grab (boolean, optional) -- Capture all key presses, including system combos.   This
                       requires  accessibility  permissions,  since  it  performs  a  global grab on key events.
                       (default: off)  See https://support.apple.com/en-in/guide/mac-help/mh32356/macswap-opt-cmd (boolean, optional) -- Swap the Option and Command keys so  that  their  key
                       codes  match their position on non-Mac keyboards and you can use Meta/Super and Alt where
                       you expect them.  (default: off)

                     • zoom-to-fit (boolean, optional) -- Zoom guest display to fit into the host window.   When
                       turned off the host window will be resized instead.  Defaults to "off".  (Since 8.2)

                     • zoom-interpolation  (boolean,  optional)  --  Apply  interpolation  to smooth output when
                       zoom-to-fit is enabled.  Defaults to "off".  (Since 9.0)

       Enum HotKeyMod (Since: 7.1)
              Set of modifier keys that need to be held for shortcut key actions.

              Valueslctrl-lalt -- Not documented

                     • lshift-lctrl-lalt -- Not documented

                     • rctrl -- Not documented

       Object DisplaySDL (Since: 7.1)
              SDL2 display options.

              Membersgrab-mod (HotKeyMod, optional) -- Modifier keys that should be pressed together with  the
                       "G" key to release the mouse grab.

       Enum DisplayType (Since: 2.12)
              Display (user interface) type.

              Valuesdefault  --  The  default user interface, selecting from the first available of gtk, sdl,
                       cocoa, and vnc.

                     • none -- No user interface or video output display.  The guest will still see an  emulated
                       graphics card, but its output will not be displayed to the QEMU user.

                     • gtk -- The GTK user interface.

                     • sdl -- The SDL user interface.

                     • egl-headless  --  No  user  interface,  offload  GL  operations  to  a  local DRI device.
                       Graphical display need to be paired with VNC or Spice.  (Since 3.1)

                     • curses -- Display video output via curses.  For graphics device models  which  support  a
                       text  mode,  QEMU  can  display this output using a curses/ncurses interface.  Nothing is
                       displayed when the graphics device is in graphical mode or if the  graphics  device  does
                       not support a text mode.  Generally only the VGA device models support text mode.

                     • cocoa -- The Cocoa user interface.

                     • spice-app  -- Set up a Spice server and run the default associated application to connect
                       to it.  The server will redirect the serial console and QEMU monitors.  (Since 4.0)

                     • dbus -- Start a D-Bus service for the display.  (Since 7.0)

       Object DisplayOptions (Since: 2.12)
              Display (user interface) options.

              Memberstype (DisplayType) -- Which DisplayType qemu should use.

                     • full-screen (boolean, optional) -- Start user  interface  in  fullscreen  mode  (default:
                       off).

                     • window-close (boolean, optional) -- Allow to quit qemu with window close button (default:
                       on).

                     • show-cursor  (boolean,  optional)  --  Force  showing  the  mouse  cursor (default: off).
                       (since: 5.0)

                     • gl (DisplayGLMode, optional) -- Enable OpenGL support (default: off).

                     • When type is gtk: The members of DisplayGTK.

                     • When type is cocoa: The members of DisplayCocoa.

                     • When type is curses: The members of DisplayCurses.

                     • When type is egl-headless: The members of DisplayEGLHeadless.

                     • When type is dbus: The members of DisplayDBus.

                     • When type is sdl: The members of DisplaySDL.

       Command query-display-options (Since: 3.1)
              Returns information about display configuration

              Return DisplayOptions -- DisplayOptions

       Enum DisplayReloadType (Since: 6.0)
              Available DisplayReload types.

              Valuesvnc -- VNC display

       Object DisplayReloadOptionsVNC (Since: 6.0)
              Specify the VNC reload options.

              Memberstls-certs (boolean, optional) -- reload tls certs or not.

       Object DisplayReloadOptions (Since: 6.0)
              Options of the display configuration reload.

              Memberstype (DisplayReloadType) -- Specify the display type.

                     • When type is vnc: The members of DisplayReloadOptionsVNC.

       Command display-reload (Since: 6.0)
              Reload display configuration.

              Arguments

                     • The members of DisplayReloadOptions.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "display-reload",
                          "arguments": { "type": "vnc", "tls-certs": true  } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Enum DisplayUpdateType (Since: 7.1)
              Available DisplayUpdate types.

              Valuesvnc -- VNC display

       Object DisplayUpdateOptionsVNC (Since: 7.1)
              Specify the VNC reload options.

              Membersaddresses ([SocketAddress], optional) -- If specified, change set of addresses to  listen
                       for connections.  Addresses configured for websockets are not touched.

       Object DisplayUpdateOptions (Since: 7.1)
              Options of the display configuration reload.

              Memberstype (DisplayUpdateType) -- Specify the display type.

                     • When type is vnc: The members of DisplayUpdateOptionsVNC.

       Command display-update (Since: 7.1)
              Update display configuration.

              Arguments

                     • The members of DisplayUpdateOptions.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "display-update",
                          "arguments": { "type": "vnc", "addresses":
                                         [ { "type": "inet", "host": "0.0.0.0",
                                             "port": "5901" } ] } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command client_migrate_info (Since: 0.14)
              Set  migration  information  for  remote  display.   This  makes  the  server  ask  the  client to
              automatically reconnect using the new  parameters  once  migration  finished  successfully.   Only
              implemented for SPICE.

              Argumentsprotocol (string) -- must be "spice"

                     • hostname (string) -- migration target hostname

                     • port (int, optional) -- spice tcp port for plaintext channels

                     • tls-port (int, optional) -- spice tcp port for tls-secured channels

                     • cert-subject (string, optional) -- server certificate subject

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "client_migrate_info",
                          "arguments": { "protocol": "spice",
                                         "hostname": "virt42.lab.kraxel.org",
                                         "port": 1234 } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

USER AUTHORIZATION

       Enum QAuthZListPolicy (Since: 4.0)
              The authorization policy result

              Valuesdeny -- deny access

                     • allow -- allow access

       Enum QAuthZListFormat (Since: 4.0)
              The authorization policy match format

              Valuesexact -- an exact string match

                     • glob -- string with ? and * shell wildcard support

       Object QAuthZListRule (Since: 4.0)
              A single authorization rule.

              Membersmatch (string) -- a string or glob to match against a user identity

                     • policy (QAuthZListPolicy) -- the result to return if match evaluates to true

                     • format (QAuthZListFormat, optional) -- the format of the match rule (default 'exact')

       Object AuthZListProperties (Since: 4.0)
              Properties for authz-list objects.

              Memberspolicy  (QAuthZListPolicy,  optional)  --  Default  policy  to apply when no rule matches
                       (default: deny)

                     • rules ([QAuthZListRule], optional) -- Authorization rules based on matching user

       Object AuthZListFileProperties (Since: 4.0)
              Properties for authz-listfile objects.

              Membersfilename (string) -- File name to load the configuration from.   The  file  must  contain
                       valid JSON for AuthZListProperties.

                     • refresh   (boolean,  optional)  --  If  true,  inotify  is  used  to  monitor  the  file,
                       automatically reloading changes.  If an error occurs during reloading, all authorizations
                       will fail until the file is next successfully loaded.  (default: true if the  binary  was
                       built with CONFIG_INOTIFY1, false otherwise)

       Object AuthZPAMProperties (Since: 4.0)
              Properties for authz-pam objects.

              Membersservice (string) -- PAM service name to use for authorization

       Object AuthZSimpleProperties (Since: 4.0)
              Properties for authz-simple objects.

              Membersidentity  (string)  --  Identifies  the  allowed user.  Its format depends on the network
                       service that authorization object is associated with.  For authorizing based on TLS  x509
                       certificates, the identity must be the x509 distinguished name.

MIGRATION

       Object MigrationStats (Since: 0.14)
              Detailed migration status.

              Memberstransferred (int) -- amount of bytes already transferred to the target VM

                     • remaining (int) -- amount of bytes remaining to be transferred to the target VM

                     • total (int) -- total amount of bytes involved in the migration process

                     • duplicate (int) -- number of duplicate (zero) pages (since 1.2)

                     • normal (int) -- number of normal pages (since 1.2)

                     • normal-bytes (int) -- number of normal bytes sent (since 1.2)

                     • dirty-pages-rate (int) -- number of pages dirtied by second by the guest (since 1.3)

                     • mbps (number) -- throughput in megabits/sec.  (since 1.6)

                     • dirty-sync-count (int) -- number of times that dirty ram was synchronized (since 2.1)

                     • postcopy-requests  (int)  --  The  number  of page requests received from the destination
                       (since 2.7)

                     • page-size (int) -- The number of bytes per page for  the  various  page-based  statistics
                       (since 2.10)

                     • multifd-bytes (int) -- The number of bytes sent through multifd (since 3.0)

                     • pages-per-second (int) -- the number of memory pages transferred per second (Since 4.0)

                     • precopy-bytes (int) -- The number of bytes sent in the pre-copy phase (since 7.0).

                     • downtime-bytes (int) -- The number of bytes sent while the guest is paused (since 7.0).

                     • postcopy-bytes (int) -- The number of bytes sent during the post-copy phase (since 7.0).

                     • dirty-sync-missed-zero-copy  (int) -- Number of times dirty RAM synchronization could not
                       avoid copying dirty pages.  This is between 0 and  dirty-sync-count  *  multifd-channels.
                       (since 7.1)

       Object XBZRLECacheStats (Since: 1.2)
              Detailed XBZRLE migration cache statistics

              Memberscache-size (int) -- XBZRLE cache size

                     • bytes (int) -- amount of bytes already transferred to the target VM

                     • pages (int) -- amount of pages transferred to the target VM

                     • cache-miss (int) -- number of cache miss

                     • cache-miss-rate (number) -- rate of cache miss (since 2.1)

                     • encoding-rate (number) -- rate of encoded bytes (since 5.1)

                     • overflow (int) -- number of overflows

       Object CompressionStats (Since: 3.1)
              Detailed migration compression statistics

              Memberspages (int) -- amount of pages compressed and transferred to the target VM

                     • busy (int) -- count of times that no free thread was available to compress data

                     • busy-rate (number) -- rate of thread busy

                     • compressed-size (int) -- amount of bytes after compression

                     • compression-rate (number) -- rate of compressed size

       Enum MigrationStatus (Since: 2.3)
              An enumeration of migration status.

              Valuesnone -- no migration has ever happened.

                     • setup -- migration process has been initiated.

                     • cancelling -- in the process of cancelling migration.

                     • cancelled -- cancelling migration is finished.

                     • active -- in the process of doing migration.

                     • postcopy-active -- like active, but now in postcopy mode.  (since 2.5)

                     • postcopy-paused -- during postcopy but paused.  (since 3.0)

                     • postcopy-recover-setup  --  setup  phase for a postcopy recovery process, preparing for a
                       recovery phase to start.  (since 9.1)

                     • postcopy-recover -- trying to recover from a paused postcopy.  (since 3.0)

                     • completed -- migration is finished.

                     • failed -- some error occurred during migration process.

                     • colo -- VM is in the process of fault tolerance, VM can not get into  this  state  unless
                       colo capability is enabled for migration.  (since 2.8)

                     • pre-switchover -- Paused before device serialisation.  (since 2.11)

                     • device -- During device serialisation (also known as switchover phase).  Before 9.2, this
                       is  only  used  when  (1)  in precopy, and (2) when pre-switchover capability is enabled.
                       After 10.0, this state will always be  present  for  every  migration  procedure  as  the
                       switchover phase.  (since 2.11)

                     • wait-unplug -- wait for device unplug request by guest OS to be completed.  (since 4.2)

       Object VfioStats (Since: 5.2)
              Detailed VFIO devices migration statistics

              Memberstransferred (int) -- amount of bytes transferred to the target VM by VFIO devices

       Object MigrationInfo (Since: 0.14)
              Information about current migration process.

              Membersstatus  (MigrationStatus,  optional)  -- MigrationStatus describing the current migration
                       status.  If this field is not returned, no migration process has been initiated

                     • ram (MigrationStats, optional) -- MigrationStats containing  detailed  migration  status,
                       only returned if status is 'active' or 'completed'(since 1.2)

                     • xbzrle-cache  (XBZRLECacheStats, optional) -- XBZRLECacheStats containing detailed XBZRLE
                       migration statistics, only returned if XBZRLE feature is on and  status  is  'active'  or
                       'completed' (since 1.2)

                     • total-time  (int,  optional) -- total amount of milliseconds since migration started.  If
                       migration has ended, it returns the total migration time.  (since 1.2)

                     • downtime (int, optional) -- only present when migration finishes correctly total downtime
                       in milliseconds for the guest.  (since 1.3)

                     • expected-downtime (int, optional) -- only present  while  migration  is  active  expected
                       downtime in milliseconds for the guest in last walk of the dirty bitmap.  (since 1.3)

                     • setup-time  (int, optional) -- amount of setup time in milliseconds before the iterations
                       begin but after the QMP command is issued.  This is designed to provide an accounting  of
                       any  activities  (such as RDMA pinning) which may be expensive, but do not actually occur
                       during the iterative migration rounds themselves.  (since 1.6)

                     • cpu-throttle-percentage (int, optional) --  percentage  of  time  guest  cpus  are  being
                       throttled  during  auto-converge.   This  is  only present when auto-converge has started
                       throttling guest cpus.  (Since 2.7)

                     • error-desc (string, optional) -- the human readable error  description  string.   Clients
                       should not attempt to parse the error strings.  (Since 2.7)

                     • postcopy-blocktime  (int,  optional)  --  total  time  when  all vCPU were blocked during
                       postcopy live migration.  This is only  present  when  the  postcopy-blocktime  migration
                       capability is enabled.  (Since 3.0)

                     • postcopy-vcpu-blocktime  ([int],  optional)  --  list of the postcopy blocktime per vCPU.
                       This is only present when the postcopy-blocktime migration capability is enabled.  (Since
                       3.0)

                     • socket-address ([SocketAddress], optional) -- Only used for tcp, to know  what  the  real
                       port is (Since 4.0)

                     • vfio  (VfioStats,  optional)  --  VfioStats  containing  detailed  VFIO devices migration
                       statistics, only returned if VFIO device is present, migration is supported by  all  VFIO
                       devices and status is 'active' or 'completed' (since 5.2)

                     • blocked-reasons  ([string],  optional)  --  A  list  of  reasons an outgoing migration is
                       blocked.  Present and non-empty when migration is blocked.  (since 6.0)

                     • dirty-limit-throttle-time-per-round  (int,  optional)  --  Maximum  throttle   time   (in
                       microseconds)   of   virtual   CPUs   each   dirty  ring  full  round,  which  shows  how
                       MigrationCapability dirty-limit affects the guest during live migration.  (Since 8.1)

                     • dirty-limit-ring-full-time (int, optional) -- Estimated average dirty ring full time  (in
                       microseconds)  for  each  dirty  ring full round.  The value equals the dirty ring memory
                       size divided by the average dirty page rate of the virtual CPU,  which  can  be  used  to
                       observe  the  average  memory  load  of the virtual CPU indirectly.  Note that zero means
                       guest doesn't dirty memory.  (Since 8.1)

       Command query-migrate (Since: 0.14)
              Returns information about current migration process.  If migration is active there will be another
              json-object with RAM migration status.

              Return MigrationInfo -- MigrationInfo

                 Example: Before the first migration

                      -> { "execute": "query-migrate" }
                      <- { "return": {} }

                 Example: Migration is done and has succeeded

                      -> { "execute": "query-migrate" }
                      <- { "return": {
                              "status": "completed",
                              "total-time":12345,
                              "setup-time":12345,
                              "downtime":12345,
                              "ram":{
                                "transferred":123,
                                "remaining":123,
                                "total":246,
                                "duplicate":123,
                                "normal":123,
                                "normal-bytes":123456,
                                "dirty-sync-count":15
                              }
                           }
                         }

                 Example: Migration is done and has failed

                      -> { "execute": "query-migrate" }
                      <- { "return": { "status": "failed" } }

                 Example: Migration is being performed

                      -> { "execute": "query-migrate" }
                      <- {
                            "return":{
                               "status":"active",
                               "total-time":12345,
                               "setup-time":12345,
                               "expected-downtime":12345,
                               "ram":{
                                  "transferred":123,
                                  "remaining":123,
                                  "total":246,
                                  "duplicate":123,
                                  "normal":123,
                                  "normal-bytes":123456,
                                  "dirty-sync-count":15
                               }
                            }
                         }

                 Example: Migration is being performed and XBZRLE is active

                      -> { "execute": "query-migrate" }
                      <- {
                            "return":{
                               "status":"active",
                               "total-time":12345,
                               "setup-time":12345,
                               "expected-downtime":12345,
                               "ram":{
                                  "total":1057024,
                                  "remaining":1053304,
                                  "transferred":3720,
                                  "duplicate":10,
                                  "normal":3333,
                                  "normal-bytes":3412992,
                                  "dirty-sync-count":15
                               },
                               "xbzrle-cache":{
                                  "cache-size":67108864,
                                  "bytes":20971520,
                                  "pages":2444343,
                                  "cache-miss":2244,
                                  "cache-miss-rate":0.123,
                                  "encoding-rate":80.1,
                                  "overflow":34434
                               }
                            }
                         }

       Enum MigrationCapability (Since: 1.2)
              Migration capabilities enumeration

              Valuesxbzrle -- Migration supports xbzrle (Xor Based Zero Run Length Encoding).   This  feature
                       allows  us  to  minimize  migration traffic for certain work loads, by sending compressed
                       difference of the pages

                     • rdma-pin-all -- Controls whether or not the entire VM memory footprint  is  mlock()'d  on
                       demand  or  all at once.  Refer to docs/rdma.txt for usage.  Disabled by default.  (since
                       2.0)

                     • zero-blocks -- During storage  migration  encode  blocks  of  zeroes  efficiently.   This
                       essentially  saves  1MB  of  zeroes  per block on the wire.  Enabling requires source and
                       target VM to support this feature.  To enable it is sufficient to enable  the  capability
                       on the source VM.  The feature is disabled by default.  (since 1.6)

                     • events -- generate events for each migration state change (since 2.4)

                     • auto-converge  -- If enabled, QEMU will automatically throttle down the guest to speed up
                       convergence of RAM migration.  (since 1.6)

                     • postcopy-ram -- Start executing on the migration  target  before  all  of  RAM  has  been
                       migrated,  pulling  the remaining pages along as needed.  The capacity must have the same
                       setting on both source and target or  migration  will  not  even  start.   NOTE:  If  the
                       migration fails during postcopy the VM will fail.  (since 2.6)

                     • x-colo  --  If  enabled, migration will never end, and the state of the VM on the primary
                       side will be migrated continuously to the VM on secondary side, this  process  is  called
                       COarse-Grain LOck Stepping (COLO) for Non-stop Service.  (since 2.8)

                     • release-ram  --  if  enabled,  qemu will free the migrated ram pages on the source during
                       postcopy-ram migration.  (since 2.9)

                     • return-path -- If enabled, migration will use the return path even for  precopy.   (since
                       2.10)

                     • pause-before-switchover  --  Pause outgoing migration before serialising device state and
                       before disabling block IO (since 2.11)

                     • multifd -- Use more than one fd for migration (since 4.0)

                     • dirty-bitmaps -- If enabled, QEMU will migrate named dirty bitmaps.  (since 2.12)

                     • postcopy-blocktime -- Calculate downtime for postcopy live migration (since 3.0)

                     • late-block-activate -- If enabled, the destination will not activate block  devices  (and
                       thus take locks) immediately at the end of migration.  (since 3.0)

                     • x-ignore-shared  -- If enabled, QEMU will not migrate shared memory that is accessible on
                       the destination machine.  (since 4.0)

                     • validate-uuid -- Send the UUID of the source to allow the destination to ensure it is the
                       same.  (since 4.2)

                     • background-snapshot -- If enabled, the migration stream will be  a  snapshot  of  the  VM
                       exactly  at  the  point  when  the  migration procedure starts.  The VM RAM is saved with
                       running VM.  (since 6.0)

                     • zero-copy-send -- Controls behavior on sending memory pages  on  migration.   When  true,
                       enables  a  zero-copy  mechanism for sending memory pages, if host supports it.  Requires
                       that QEMU be permitted to use locked memory for guest RAM pages.  (since 7.1)

                     • postcopy-preempt -- If enabled, the migration process will  allow  postcopy  requests  to
                       preempt  precopy  stream,  so  postcopy  requests  will  be  handled  faster.   This is a
                       performance feature and should not affect the correctness of postcopy migration.   (since
                       7.1)

                     • switchover-ack  --  If  enabled,  migration  will not stop the source VM and complete the
                       migration until an ACK is received from the destination that it's OK to do  so.   Exactly
                       when  this  ACK  is  sent  depends  on  the  migrated devices that use this feature.  For
                       example, a device can use it to make sure some of its data is  sent  and  loaded  in  the
                       destination  before  doing  switchover.  This can reduce downtime if devices that support
                       this capability are present.  'return-path' capability must be enabled to use it.  (since
                       8.1)

                     • dirty-limit -- If enabled, migration will throttle vCPUs as needed to  keep  their  dirty
                       page  rate  within  vcpu-dirty-limit.   This  can  improve responsiveness of large guests
                       during live migration, and can result in more stable read performance.  Requires KVM with
                       accelerator property "dirty-ring-size" set.  (Since 8.1)

                     • mapped-ram -- Migrate using fixed offsets in  the  migration  file  for  each  RAM  page.
                       Requires a migration URI that supports seeking, such as a file.  (since 9.0)

              Featuresunstable -- Members x-colo and x-ignore-shared are experimental.

                     • deprecated -- Member zero-blocks is deprecated as being part of block migration which was
                       already removed.

       Object MigrationCapabilityStatus (Since: 1.2)
              Migration capability information

              Memberscapability (MigrationCapability) -- capability enum

                     • state (boolean) -- capability state bool

       Command migrate-set-capabilities (Since: 1.2)
              Enable/Disable the following migration capabilities (like xbzrle)

              Argumentscapabilities  ([MigrationCapabilityStatus])  -- json array of capability modifications to
                       make

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "migrate-set-capabilities" , "arguments":
                          { "capabilities": [ { "capability": "xbzrle", "state": true } ] } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command query-migrate-capabilities (Since: 1.2)
              Returns information about the current migration capabilities status

              Return [MigrationCapabilityStatus] -- MigrationCapabilityStatus

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-migrate-capabilities" }
                     <- { "return": [
                           {"state": false, "capability": "xbzrle"},
                           {"state": false, "capability": "rdma-pin-all"},
                           {"state": false, "capability": "auto-converge"},
                           {"state": false, "capability": "zero-blocks"},
                           {"state": true, "capability": "events"},
                           {"state": false, "capability": "postcopy-ram"},
                           {"state": false, "capability": "x-colo"}
                        ]}

       Enum MultiFDCompression (Since: 5.0)
              An enumeration of multifd compression methods.

              Valuesnone -- no compression.

                     • zlib -- use zlib compression method.

                     • zstd -- use zstd compression method.

                     • qatzip -- use qatzip compression method.  (Since 9.2)

                     • qpl -- use qpl compression method.  Query Processing Library(qpl) is based on the deflate
                       compression algorithm and use the Intel In-Memory Analytics Accelerator(IAA)  accelerated
                       compression and decompression.  (Since 9.1)

                     • uadk -- use UADK library compression method.  (Since 9.1)

       Enum MigMode

              Valuesnormal -- the original form of migration.  (since 8.2)

                     • cpr-reboot --

                       The  migrate  command  stops the VM and saves state to the URI.  After quitting QEMU, the
                       user resumes by running QEMU -incoming.

                       This mode allows the user to quit QEMU, optionally update and reboot the OS, and  restart
                       QEMU.   If  the  user reboots, the URI must persist across the reboot, such as by using a
                       file.

                       Unlike normal mode, the  use  of  certain  local  storage  options  does  not  block  the
                       migration,  but  the user must not modify the contents of guest block devices between the
                       quit and restart.

                       This mode supports VFIO devices provided the user first puts the guest in  the  suspended
                       runstate, such as by issuing guest-suspend-ram to the QEMU guest agent.

                       Best  performance  is  achieved when the memory backend is shared and the x-ignore-shared
                       migration capability is set, but this is not required.   Further,  if  the  user  reboots
                       before restarting such a configuration, the shared memory must persist across the reboot,
                       such as by backing it with a dax device.

                       cpr-reboot may not be used with postcopy, background-snapshot, or COLO.

                       (since 8.2)

                     • cpr-transfer --

                       This  mode  allows  the  user to transfer a guest to a new QEMU instance on the same host
                       with minimal guest pause time by preserving guest RAM in place.  Devices and their pinned
                       pages will also be preserved in a future QEMU release.

                       The user starts new QEMU on the same host as old QEMU,  with  command-line  arguments  to
                       create  the  same machine, plus the -incoming option for the main migration channel, like
                       normal live migration.  In addition, the user adds a second -incoming option with channel
                       type "cpr".  This CPR channel must support file descriptor transfer with SCM_RIGHTS, i.e.
                       it must be a UNIX domain socket.

                       To initiate CPR, the user issues a migrate command to old QEMU, adding a second migration
                       channel of type "cpr" in the channels argument.  Old QEMU stops the VM,  saves  state  to
                       the migration channels, and enters the postmigrate state.  Execution resumes in new QEMU.

                       New  QEMU reads the CPR channel before opening a monitor, hence the CPR channel cannot be
                       specified in the list of channels  for  a  migrate-incoming  command.   It  may  only  be
                       specified on the command line.

                       The  main  channel address cannot be a file type, and for an inet socket, the port cannot
                       be 0 (meaning dynamically choose a port).

                       Memory-backend objects must have the share=on attribute, but  memory-backend-epc  is  not
                       supported.  The VM must be started with the '-machine aux-ram-share=on' option.

                       When using -incoming defer, you must issue the migrate command to old QEMU before issuing
                       any monitor commands to new QEMU.  However, new QEMU does not open and read the migration
                       stream until you issue the migrate incoming command.

                       (since 10.0)

       Enum ZeroPageDetection (Since: 9.0)

              Valuesnone -- Do not perform zero page checking.

                     • legacy -- Perform zero page checking in main migration thread.

                     • multifd  --  Perform  zero page checking in multifd sender thread if multifd migration is
                       enabled, else in the main migration thread as for legacy.

       Object BitmapMigrationBitmapAliasTransform (Since: 6.0)

              Memberspersistent (boolean, optional) -- If present, the  bitmap  will  be  made  persistent  or
                       transient depending on this parameter.

       Object BitmapMigrationBitmapAlias (Since: 5.2)

              Membersname (string) -- The name of the bitmap.

                     • alias  (string)  --  An  alias  name  for  migration  (for example the bitmap name on the
                       opposite site).

                     • transform (BitmapMigrationBitmapAliasTransform, optional) -- Allows the  modification  of
                       the migrated bitmap.  (since 6.0)

       Object BitmapMigrationNodeAlias (Since: 5.2)
              Maps a block node name and the bitmaps it has to aliases for dirty bitmap migration.

              Membersnode-name (string) -- A block node name.

                     • alias  (string)  --  An alias block node name for migration (for example the node name on
                       the opposite site).

                     • bitmaps ([BitmapMigrationBitmapAlias]) -- Mappings for the bitmaps on this node.

       Enum MigrationParameter (Since: 2.4)
              Migration parameters enumeration

              Valuesannounce-initial -- Initial delay (in milliseconds) before  sending  the  first  announce
                       (Since 4.0)

                     • announce-max  --  Maximum  delay  (in  milliseconds)  between packets in the announcement
                       (Since 4.0)

                     • announce-rounds -- Number of self-announce packets sent after migration (Since 4.0)

                     • announce-step -- Increase in delay (in milliseconds) between subsequent  packets  in  the
                       announcement (Since 4.0)

                     • throttle-trigger-threshold  --  The  ratio of bytes_dirty_period and bytes_xfer_period to
                       trigger throttling.  It is expressed as percentage.  The default  value  is  50.   (Since
                       5.0)

                     • cpu-throttle-initial  --  Initial  percentage  of  time  guest  cpus  are  throttled when
                       migration auto-converge is activated.  The default value is 20.  (Since 2.7)

                     • cpu-throttle-increment -- throttle percentage increase each  time  auto-converge  detects
                       that migration is not making progress.  The default value is 10.  (Since 2.7)

                     • cpu-throttle-tailslow  --  Make  CPU throttling slower at tail stage At the tail stage of
                       throttling, the Guest  is  very  sensitive  to  CPU  percentage  while  the  cpu-throttle
                       -increment  is  excessive  usually  at  tail  stage.   If this parameter is true, we will
                       compute the ideal CPU percentage used by the Guest, which may exactly make the dirty rate
                       match the dirty rate threshold.  Then we will choose a smaller throttle increment between
                       the  one  specified  by  cpu-throttle-increment  and  the  one  generated  by  ideal  CPU
                       percentage.   Therefore,  it  is  compatible  to  traditional  throttling,  meanwhile the
                       throttle increment won't be excessive at tail stage.  The default value is false.  (Since
                       5.1)

                     • tls-creds -- ID of the 'tls-creds' object that provides credentials  for  establishing  a
                       TLS  connection  over the migration data channel.  On the outgoing side of the migration,
                       the credentials must be for  a  'client'  endpoint,  while  for  the  incoming  side  the
                       credentials  must be for a 'server' endpoint.  Setting this to a non-empty string enables
                       TLS for all migrations.  An empty string means that QEMU will use  plain  text  mode  for
                       migration, rather than TLS.  (Since 2.7)

                     • tls-hostname --

                       migration  target's  hostname  for validating the server's x509 certificate identity.  If
                       empty, QEMU will use the hostname from the migration URI, if any.  A non-empty  value  is
                       required  when  using x509 based TLS credentials and the migration URI does not include a
                       hostname, such as fd: or exec: based migration.  (Since 2.7)

                       Note: empty value works only since 2.9.

                     • tls-authz -- ID of the 'authz' object subclass that provides access control  checking  of
                       the  TLS  x509  certificate  distinguished name.  This object is only resolved at time of
                       use, so can be deleted and recreated on the fly while the migration server is active.  If
                       missing, it will default to denying access (Since 4.0)

                     • max-bandwidth -- maximum speed for migration, in bytes per second.  (Since 2.8)

                     • avail-switchover-bandwidth -- to set the  available  bandwidth  that  migration  can  use
                       during switchover phase.  NOTE!  This does not limit the bandwidth during switchover, but
                       only  for  calculations  when  making decisions to switchover.  By default, this value is
                       zero, which means QEMU will estimate the bandwidth automatically.  This can be  set  when
                       the  estimated  value is not accurate, while the user is able to guarantee such bandwidth
                       is available when switching over.  When specified correctly, this can make the switchover
                       decision much more accurate.  (Since 8.2)

                     • downtime-limit -- set maximum tolerated downtime  for  migration.   maximum  downtime  in
                       milliseconds (Since 2.8)

                     • x-checkpoint-delay  --  The  delay  time (in ms) between two COLO checkpoints in periodic
                       mode.  (Since 2.8)

                     • multifd-channels -- Number of channels used to migrate data in  parallel.   This  is  the
                       same number that the number of sockets used for migration.  The default value is 2 (since
                       4.0)

                     • xbzrle-cache-size  --  cache  size  to  be  used  by  XBZRLE migration.  It needs to be a
                       multiple of the target page size and a power of 2 (Since 2.11)

                     • max-postcopy-bandwidth -- Background transfer bandwidth during postcopy.  Defaults  to  0
                       (unlimited).  In bytes per second.  (Since 3.0)

                     • max-cpu-throttle -- maximum cpu throttle percentage.  Defaults to 99.  (Since 3.1)

                     • multifd-compression -- Which compression method to use.  Defaults to none.  (Since 5.0)

                     • multifd-zlib-level  --  Set  the  compression  level  to  be  used in live migration, the
                       compression level is an integer between 0 and 9, where 0 means no  compression,  1  means
                       the  best  compression  speed, and 9 means best compression ratio which will consume more
                       CPU.  Defaults to 1.  (Since 5.0)

                     • multifd-qatzip-level -- Set the compression level to be used in live migration. The level
                       is an integer between 1 and 9, where 1 means the best compression speed, and 9 means  the
                       best compression ratio which will consume more CPU. Defaults to 1.  (Since 9.2)

                     • multifd-zstd-level  --  Set  the  compression  level  to  be  used in live migration, the
                       compression level is an integer between 0 and 20, where 0 means no compression,  1  means
                       the  best  compression speed, and 20 means best compression ratio which will consume more
                       CPU.  Defaults to 1.  (Since 5.0)

                     • block-bitmap-mapping -- Maps block nodes and bitmaps on them to aliases for  the  purpose
                       of  dirty  bitmap  migration.  Such aliases may for example be the corresponding names on
                       the opposite site.  The mapping must be one-to-one, but not necessarily complete: On  the
                       source,  unmapped  bitmaps  and  all  bitmaps  on unmapped nodes will be ignored.  On the
                       destination, encountering an unmapped alias in the incoming migration stream will  result
                       in a report, and all further bitmap migration data will then be discarded.  Note that the
                       destination does not know about bitmaps it does not receive, so there is no limitation or
                       requirement  regarding the number of bitmaps received, or how they are named, or on which
                       nodes they are placed.  By default (when this parameter has never been set), bitmap names
                       are mapped to themselves.  Nodes are mapped to their block device name if there  is  one,
                       and to their node name otherwise.  (Since 5.2)

                     • x-vcpu-dirty-limit-period  --  Periodic time (in milliseconds) of dirty limit during live
                       migration.  Should be in the range 1 to 1000ms.  Defaults to 1000ms.  (Since 8.1)

                     • vcpu-dirty-limit -- Dirtyrate limit (MB/s) during live migration.  Defaults to 1.  (Since
                       8.1)

                     • mode -- Migration mode.  See description in MigMode.  Default is 'normal'.  (Since 8.2)

                     • zero-page-detection -- Whether  and  how  to  detect  zero  pages.   See  description  in
                       ZeroPageDetection.  Default is 'multifd'.  (since 9.0)

                     • direct-io  --  Open migration files with O_DIRECT when possible.  This only has effect if
                       the mapped-ram capability is enabled.  (Since 9.1)

              Featuresunstable -- Members x-checkpoint-delay and x-vcpu-dirty-limit-period are experimental.

       Object MigrateSetParameters (Since: 2.4)

              Membersannounce-initial (int, optional) -- Initial delay (in milliseconds)  before  sending  the
                       first announce (Since 4.0)

                     • announce-max  (int,  optional)  -- Maximum delay (in milliseconds) between packets in the
                       announcement (Since 4.0)

                     • announce-rounds (int, optional) -- Number of self-announce packets sent  after  migration
                       (Since 4.0)

                     • announce-step  (int,  optional) -- Increase in delay (in milliseconds) between subsequent
                       packets in the announcement (Since 4.0)

                     • throttle-trigger-threshold  (int,  optional)  --  The  ratio  of  bytes_dirty_period  and
                       bytes_xfer_period  to  trigger  throttling.   It is expressed as percentage.  The default
                       value is 50.  (Since 5.0)

                     • cpu-throttle-initial (int, optional)  --  Initial  percentage  of  time  guest  cpus  are
                       throttled  when  migration  auto-converge is activated.  The default value is 20.  (Since
                       2.7)

                     • cpu-throttle-increment  (int,  optional)  --  throttle  percentage  increase  each   time
                       auto-converge  detects  that  migration is not making progress.  The default value is 10.
                       (Since 2.7)

                     • cpu-throttle-tailslow (boolean, optional) -- Make CPU throttling slower at tail stage  At
                       the  tail  stage  of  throttling, the Guest is very sensitive to CPU percentage while the
                       cpu-throttle -increment is excessive usually at tail stage.  If this parameter  is  true,
                       we  will  compute  the ideal CPU percentage used by the Guest, which may exactly make the
                       dirty rate match the dirty rate threshold.   Then  we  will  choose  a  smaller  throttle
                       increment  between  the  one specified by cpu-throttle-increment and the one generated by
                       ideal CPU percentage.  Therefore, it is compatible to traditional  throttling,  meanwhile
                       the  throttle  increment  won't  be excessive at tail stage.  The default value is false.
                       (Since 5.1)

                     • tls-creds (StrOrNull, optional) -- ID of the 'tls-creds' object that provides credentials
                       for establishing a TLS connection over the migration data channel.  On the outgoing  side
                       of the migration, the credentials must be for a 'client' endpoint, while for the incoming
                       side the credentials must be for a 'server' endpoint.  Setting this to a non-empty string
                       enables TLS for all migrations.  An empty string means that QEMU will use plain text mode
                       for migration, rather than TLS.  This is the default.  (Since 2.7)

                     • tls-hostname (StrOrNull, optional) --

                       migration  target's  hostname  for validating the server's x509 certificate identity.  If
                       empty, QEMU will use the hostname from the migration URI, if any.  A non-empty  value  is
                       required  when  using x509 based TLS credentials and the migration URI does not include a
                       hostname, such as fd: or exec: based migration.  (Since 2.7)

                       Note: empty value works only since 2.9.

                     • tls-authz (StrOrNull, optional) -- ID of the 'authz' object subclass that provides access
                       control checking of the TLS x509 certificate distinguished name.   This  object  is  only
                       resolved  at  time of use, so can be deleted and recreated on the fly while the migration
                       server is active.  If missing, it will default to denying access (Since 4.0)

                     • max-bandwidth (int, optional) -- maximum  speed  for  migration,  in  bytes  per  second.
                       (Since 2.8)

                     • avail-switchover-bandwidth  (int,  optional)  --  to  set  the  available  bandwidth that
                       migration can use during switchover phase.  NOTE!  This  does  not  limit  the  bandwidth
                       during  switchover,  but  only  for calculations when making decisions to switchover.  By
                       default, this value is zero, which means QEMU will estimate the bandwidth  automatically.
                       This  can  be  set  when  the  estimated value is not accurate, while the user is able to
                       guarantee such bandwidth is available when switching  over.   When  specified  correctly,
                       this can make the switchover decision much more accurate.  (Since 8.2)

                     • downtime-limit  (int, optional) -- set maximum tolerated downtime for migration.  maximum
                       downtime in milliseconds (Since 2.8)

                     • x-checkpoint-delay (int, optional) -- The delay time (in ms) between two COLO checkpoints
                       in periodic mode.  (Since 2.8)

                     • multifd-channels (int, optional) -- Number of channels used to migrate data in  parallel.
                       This is the same number that the number of sockets used for migration.  The default value
                       is 2 (since 4.0)

                     • xbzrle-cache-size (int, optional) -- cache size to be used by XBZRLE migration.  It needs
                       to be a multiple of the target page size and a power of 2 (Since 2.11)

                     • max-postcopy-bandwidth  (int, optional) -- Background transfer bandwidth during postcopy.
                       Defaults to 0 (unlimited).  In bytes per second.  (Since 3.0)

                     • max-cpu-throttle (int, optional) -- maximum cpu throttle  percentage.   Defaults  to  99.
                       (Since 3.1)

                     • multifd-compression  (MultiFDCompression,  optional)  -- Which compression method to use.
                       Defaults to none.  (Since 5.0)

                     • multifd-zlib-level (int, optional) -- Set the  compression  level  to  be  used  in  live
                       migration,  the  compression  level  is  an  integer  between  0  and 9, where 0 means no
                       compression, 1 means the best compression speed, and 9 means best compression ratio which
                       will consume more CPU.  Defaults to 1.  (Since 5.0)

                     • multifd-qatzip-level (int, optional) -- Set the compression level  to  be  used  in  live
                       migration.  The  level  is an integer between 1 and 9, where 1 means the best compression
                       speed, and 9 means the best compression ratio which will consume more CPU. Defaults to 1.
                       (Since 9.2)

                     • multifd-zstd-level (int, optional) -- Set the  compression  level  to  be  used  in  live
                       migration,  the  compression  level  is  an  integer  between  0 and 20, where 0 means no
                       compression, 1 means the best compression speed, and  20  means  best  compression  ratio
                       which will consume more CPU.  Defaults to 1.  (Since 5.0)

                     • block-bitmap-mapping  ([BitmapMigrationNodeAlias],  optional)  --  Maps  block  nodes and
                       bitmaps on them to aliases for the purpose of dirty bitmap migration.  Such  aliases  may
                       for  example  be  the  corresponding  names  on  the  opposite site.  The mapping must be
                       one-to-one, but not necessarily complete: On the source, unmapped bitmaps and all bitmaps
                       on unmapped nodes will be ignored.  On the destination, encountering an unmapped alias in
                       the incoming migration stream will result in a report, and all further  bitmap  migration
                       data  will  then  be discarded.  Note that the destination does not know about bitmaps it
                       does not receive, so there is no  limitation  or  requirement  regarding  the  number  of
                       bitmaps  received,  or how they are named, or on which nodes they are placed.  By default
                       (when this parameter has never been set), bitmap names are mapped to  themselves.   Nodes
                       are  mapped to their block device name if there is one, and to their node name otherwise.
                       (Since 5.2)

                     • x-vcpu-dirty-limit-period (int, optional) -- Periodic time  (in  milliseconds)  of  dirty
                       limit  during  live  migration.  Should be in the range 1 to 1000ms.  Defaults to 1000ms.
                       (Since 8.1)

                     • vcpu-dirty-limit (int,  optional)  --  Dirtyrate  limit  (MB/s)  during  live  migration.
                       Defaults to 1.  (Since 8.1)

                     • mode  (MigMode,  optional)  --  Migration  mode.  See description in MigMode.  Default is
                       'normal'.  (Since 8.2)

                     • zero-page-detection (ZeroPageDetection, optional) --  Whether  and  how  to  detect  zero
                       pages.  See description in ZeroPageDetection.  Default is 'multifd'.  (since 9.0)

                     • direct-io  (boolean, optional) -- Open migration files with O_DIRECT when possible.  This
                       only has effect if the mapped-ram capability is enabled.  (Since 9.1)

              Featuresunstable -- Members x-checkpoint-delay and x-vcpu-dirty-limit-period are experimental.

       Command migrate-set-parameters (Since: 2.4)
              Set various migration parameters.

              Arguments

                     • The members of MigrateSetParameters.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "migrate-set-parameters" ,
                          "arguments": { "multifd-channels": 5 } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Object MigrationParameters (Since: 2.4)
              The optional members aren't actually optional.

              Membersannounce-initial (int, optional) -- Initial delay (in milliseconds)  before  sending  the
                       first announce (Since 4.0)

                     • announce-max  (int,  optional)  -- Maximum delay (in milliseconds) between packets in the
                       announcement (Since 4.0)

                     • announce-rounds (int, optional) -- Number of self-announce packets sent  after  migration
                       (Since 4.0)

                     • announce-step  (int,  optional) -- Increase in delay (in milliseconds) between subsequent
                       packets in the announcement (Since 4.0)

                     • throttle-trigger-threshold  (int,  optional)  --  The  ratio  of  bytes_dirty_period  and
                       bytes_xfer_period  to  trigger  throttling.   It is expressed as percentage.  The default
                       value is 50.  (Since 5.0)

                     • cpu-throttle-initial (int, optional)  --  Initial  percentage  of  time  guest  cpus  are
                       throttled when migration auto-converge is activated.  (Since 2.7)

                     • cpu-throttle-increment   (int,  optional)  --  throttle  percentage  increase  each  time
                       auto-converge detects that migration is not making progress.  (Since 2.7)

                     • cpu-throttle-tailslow (boolean, optional) -- Make CPU throttling slower at tail stage  At
                       the  tail  stage  of  throttling, the Guest is very sensitive to CPU percentage while the
                       cpu-throttle -increment is excessive usually at tail stage.  If this parameter  is  true,
                       we  will  compute  the ideal CPU percentage used by the Guest, which may exactly make the
                       dirty rate match the dirty rate threshold.   Then  we  will  choose  a  smaller  throttle
                       increment  between  the  one specified by cpu-throttle-increment and the one generated by
                       ideal CPU percentage.  Therefore, it is compatible to traditional  throttling,  meanwhile
                       the  throttle  increment  won't  be excessive at tail stage.  The default value is false.
                       (Since 5.1)

                     • tls-creds (string, optional) --

                       ID of the 'tls-creds' object that provides credentials for establishing a TLS  connection
                       over  the migration data channel.  On the outgoing side of the migration, the credentials
                       must be for a 'client' endpoint, while for the incoming side the credentials must be  for
                       a  'server'  endpoint.   An  empty  string  means  that QEMU will use plain text mode for
                       migration, rather than TLS.  (Since 2.7)

                       Note: 2.8 omits empty tls-creds instead.

                     • tls-hostname (string, optional) --

                       migration target's hostname for validating the server's x509  certificate  identity.   If
                       empty, QEMU will use the hostname from the migration URI, if any.  (Since 2.7)

                       Note: 2.8 omits empty tls-hostname instead.

                     • tls-authz  (string,  optional)  -- ID of the 'authz' object subclass that provides access
                       control checking of the TLS x509 certificate distinguished name.  (Since 4.0)

                     • max-bandwidth (int, optional) -- maximum  speed  for  migration,  in  bytes  per  second.
                       (Since 2.8)

                     • avail-switchover-bandwidth  (int,  optional)  --  to  set  the  available  bandwidth that
                       migration can use during switchover phase.  NOTE!  This  does  not  limit  the  bandwidth
                       during  switchover,  but  only  for calculations when making decisions to switchover.  By
                       default, this value is zero, which means QEMU will estimate the bandwidth  automatically.
                       This  can  be  set  when  the  estimated value is not accurate, while the user is able to
                       guarantee such bandwidth is available when switching  over.   When  specified  correctly,
                       this can make the switchover decision much more accurate.  (Since 8.2)

                     • downtime-limit  (int, optional) -- set maximum tolerated downtime for migration.  maximum
                       downtime in milliseconds (Since 2.8)

                     • x-checkpoint-delay (int, optional) --  the  delay  time  between  two  COLO  checkpoints.
                       (Since 2.8)

                     • multifd-channels  (int, optional) -- Number of channels used to migrate data in parallel.
                       This is the same number that the number of sockets used for migration.  The default value
                       is 2 (since 4.0)

                     • xbzrle-cache-size (int, optional) -- cache size to be used by XBZRLE migration.  It needs
                       to be a multiple of the target page size and a power of 2 (Since 2.11)

                     • max-postcopy-bandwidth (int, optional) -- Background transfer bandwidth during  postcopy.
                       Defaults to 0 (unlimited).  In bytes per second.  (Since 3.0)

                     • max-cpu-throttle  (int,  optional)  --  maximum cpu throttle percentage.  Defaults to 99.
                       (Since 3.1)

                     • multifd-compression (MultiFDCompression, optional) -- Which compression  method  to  use.
                       Defaults to none.  (Since 5.0)

                     • multifd-zlib-level  (int,  optional)  --  Set  the  compression  level to be used in live
                       migration, the compression level is an  integer  between  0  and  9,  where  0  means  no
                       compression, 1 means the best compression speed, and 9 means best compression ratio which
                       will consume more CPU.  Defaults to 1.  (Since 5.0)

                     • multifd-qatzip-level  (int,  optional)  --  Set  the compression level to be used in live
                       migration. The level is an integer between 1 and 9, where 1 means  the  best  compression
                       speed, and 9 means the best compression ratio which will consume more CPU. Defaults to 1.
                       (Since 9.2)

                     • multifd-zstd-level  (int,  optional)  --  Set  the  compression  level to be used in live
                       migration, the compression level is an integer  between  0  and  20,  where  0  means  no
                       compression,  1  means  the  best  compression speed, and 20 means best compression ratio
                       which will consume more CPU.  Defaults to 1.  (Since 5.0)

                     • block-bitmap-mapping ([BitmapMigrationNodeAlias],  optional)  --  Maps  block  nodes  and
                       bitmaps  on  them to aliases for the purpose of dirty bitmap migration.  Such aliases may
                       for example be the corresponding names  on  the  opposite  site.   The  mapping  must  be
                       one-to-one, but not necessarily complete: On the source, unmapped bitmaps and all bitmaps
                       on unmapped nodes will be ignored.  On the destination, encountering an unmapped alias in
                       the  incoming  migration stream will result in a report, and all further bitmap migration
                       data will then be discarded.  Note that the destination does not know  about  bitmaps  it
                       does  not  receive,  so  there  is  no  limitation or requirement regarding the number of
                       bitmaps received, or how they are named, or on which nodes they are placed.   By  default
                       (when  this  parameter has never been set), bitmap names are mapped to themselves.  Nodes
                       are mapped to their block device name if there is one, and to their node name  otherwise.
                       (Since 5.2)

                     • x-vcpu-dirty-limit-period  (int,  optional)  --  Periodic time (in milliseconds) of dirty
                       limit during live migration.  Should be in the range 1 to 1000ms.   Defaults  to  1000ms.
                       (Since 8.1)

                     • vcpu-dirty-limit  (int,  optional)  --  Dirtyrate  limit  (MB/s)  during  live migration.
                       Defaults to 1.  (Since 8.1)

                     • mode (MigMode, optional) -- Migration mode.  See  description  in  MigMode.   Default  is
                       'normal'.  (Since 8.2)

                     • zero-page-detection  (ZeroPageDetection,  optional)  --  Whether  and  how to detect zero
                       pages.  See description in ZeroPageDetection.  Default is 'multifd'.  (since 9.0)

                     • direct-io (boolean, optional) -- Open migration files with O_DIRECT when possible.   This
                       only has effect if the mapped-ram capability is enabled.  (Since 9.1)

              Featuresunstable -- Members x-checkpoint-delay and x-vcpu-dirty-limit-period are experimental.

       Command query-migrate-parameters (Since: 2.4)
              Returns information about the current migration parameters

              Return MigrationParameters -- MigrationParameters

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-migrate-parameters" }
                     <- { "return": {
                              "multifd-channels": 2,
                              "cpu-throttle-increment": 10,
                              "cpu-throttle-initial": 20,
                              "max-bandwidth": 33554432,
                              "downtime-limit": 300
                           }
                        }

       Command migrate-start-postcopy (Since: 2.5)
              Followup  to  a  migration  command  to  switch  the migration to postcopy mode.  The postcopy-ram
              capability must be set on both source and destination before the original migration command.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "migrate-start-postcopy" }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Event MIGRATION (Since: 2.4)
              Emitted when a migration event happens

              Membersstatus (MigrationStatus) -- MigrationStatus describing the current migration status.

                 Example:

                     <- {"timestamp": {"seconds": 1432121972, "microseconds": 744001},
                         "event": "MIGRATION",
                         "data": {"status": "completed"} }

       Event MIGRATION_PASS (Since: 2.6)
              Emitted from the source side of a migration at the start of each pass (when  it  syncs  the  dirty
              bitmap)

              Memberspass (int) -- An incrementing count (starting at 1 on the first pass)

                 Example:

                     <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1449669631, "microseconds": 239225},
                           "event": "MIGRATION_PASS", "data": {"pass": 2} }

       Enum COLOMessage (Since: 2.8)
              The message transmission between Primary side and Secondary side.

              Valuescheckpoint-ready -- Secondary VM (SVM) is ready for checkpointing

                     • checkpoint-request -- Primary VM (PVM) tells SVM to prepare for checkpointing

                     • checkpoint-reply -- SVM gets PVM's checkpoint request

                     • vmstate-send -- VM's state will be sent by PVM.

                     • vmstate-size -- The total size of VMstate.

                     • vmstate-received -- VM's state has been received by SVM.

                     • vmstate-loaded -- VM's state has been loaded by SVM.

       Enum COLOMode (Since: 2.8)
              The COLO current mode.

              Valuesnone -- COLO is disabled.

                     • primary -- COLO node in primary side.

                     • secondary -- COLO node in slave side.

       Enum FailoverStatus (Since: 2.8)
              An enumeration of COLO failover status

              Valuesnone -- no failover has ever happened

                     • require -- got failover requirement but not handled

                     • active -- in the process of doing failover

                     • completed -- finish the process of failover

                     • relaunch -- restart the failover process, from 'none' -> 'completed' (Since 2.9)

       Event COLO_EXIT (Since: 3.1)
              Emitted when VM finishes COLO mode due to some errors happening or at the request of users.

              Membersmode (COLOMode) -- report COLO mode when COLO exited.

                     • reason (COLOExitReason) -- describes the reason for the COLO exit.

                 Example:

                     <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 2032141960, "microseconds": 417172},
                          "event": "COLO_EXIT", "data": {"mode": "primary", "reason": "request" } }

       Enum COLOExitReason (Since: 3.1)
              The reason for a COLO exit.

              Valuesnone  --  failover has never happened.  This state does not occur in the COLO_EXIT event,
                       and is only visible in the result of query-colo-status.

                     • request -- COLO exit is due to an external request.

                     • error -- COLO exit is due to an internal error.

                     • processing -- COLO is currently handling a failover (since 4.0).

       Command x-colo-lost-heartbeat (Since: 2.8)
              This command is unstable/experimental.Availability: CONFIG_REPLICATION

              Tell qemu that heartbeat is lost, request it to do takeover procedures.  If this command  is  sent
              to  the  PVM,  the Primary side will exit COLO mode.  If sent to the Secondary, the Secondary side
              will run failover work, then takes over server operation to become the service VM.

              Featuresunstable -- This command is experimental.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "x-colo-lost-heartbeat" }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command migrate_cancel (Since: 0.14)
              Cancel the currently executing migration process.  Allows a new  migration  to  be  started  right
              after.   When  postcopy-ram  is  in  use,  cancelling  is not allowed after the postcopy phase has
              started.

              NOTE:
                 This command succeeds even if there is no migration process running.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "migrate_cancel" }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command migrate-continue (Since: 2.11)
              Continue migration when it's in a paused state.

              Argumentsstate (MigrationStatus) -- The state the migration is currently expected to be in

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "migrate-continue" , "arguments":
                          { "state": "pre-switchover" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Enum MigrationAddressType (Since: 8.2)
              The migration stream transport mechanisms.

              Valuessocket -- Migrate via socket.

                     • exec -- Direct the migration stream to another process.

                     • rdma -- Migrate via RDMA.

                     • file -- Direct the migration stream to a file.

       Object FileMigrationArgs (Since: 8.2)

              Membersfilename (string) -- The file to receive the migration stream

                     • offset (int) -- The file offset where the migration stream will start

       Object MigrationExecCommand (Since: 8.2)

              Membersargs ([string]) -- command (list head) and arguments to execute.

       Object MigrationAddress (Since: 8.2)
              Migration endpoint configuration.

              Memberstransport (MigrationAddressType) -- The migration stream transport mechanism

                     • When transport is socket: The members of SocketAddress.

                     • When transport is exec: The members of MigrationExecCommand.

                     • When transport is rdma: The members of InetSocketAddress.

                     • When transport is file: The members of FileMigrationArgs.

       Enum MigrationChannelType (Since: 8.1)
              The migration channel-type request options.

              Valuesmain -- Main outbound migration channel.

                     • cpr -- Checkpoint and restart state channel.

       Object MigrationChannel (Since: 8.1)
              Migration stream channel parameters.

              Memberschannel-type (MigrationChannelType) -- Channel type for transferring packet information.

                     • addr (MigrationAddress) -- Migration endpoint configuration on destination interface.

       Command migrate (Since: 0.14)
              Migrates the current running guest to another Virtual Machine.

              Argumentsuri (string, optional) -- the Uniform Resource Identifier of the destination VM

                     • channels ([MigrationChannel], optional) -- list of migration stream  channels  with  each
                       stream in the list connected to a destination interface endpoint.

                     • detach  (boolean, optional) -- this argument exists only for compatibility reasons and is
                       ignored by QEMU

                     • resume (boolean, optional) -- resume one paused migration, default "off".  (since 3.0)

                 Notes

                 1. The 'query-migrate' command should be used to check migration's progress  and  final  result
                    (this information is provided by the 'status' member).

                 2. All boolean arguments default to false.

                 3. The user Monitor's "detach" argument is invalid in QMP and should not be used.

                 4. The  uri  argument  should  have  the Uniform Resource Identifier of default destination VM.
                    This connection will be bound to default network.

                 5. For now, number of migration  streams  is  restricted  to  one,  i.e.  number  of  items  in
                    'channels' list is just 1.

                 6. The  'uri' and 'channels' arguments are mutually exclusive; exactly one of the two should be
                    present.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "migrate", "arguments": { "uri": "tcp:0:4446" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

                     -> { "execute": "migrate",
                          "arguments": {
                              "channels": [ { "channel-type": "main",
                                              "addr": { "transport": "socket",
                                                        "type": "inet",
                                                        "host": "10.12.34.9",
                                                        "port": "1050" } } ] } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

                     -> { "execute": "migrate",
                          "arguments": {
                              "channels": [ { "channel-type": "main",
                                              "addr": { "transport": "exec",
                                                        "args": [ "/bin/nc", "-p", "6000",
                                                                  "/some/sock" ] } } ] } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

                     -> { "execute": "migrate",
                          "arguments": {
                              "channels": [ { "channel-type": "main",
                                              "addr": { "transport": "rdma",
                                                        "host": "10.12.34.9",
                                                        "port": "1050" } } ] } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

                     -> { "execute": "migrate",
                          "arguments": {
                              "channels": [ { "channel-type": "main",
                                              "addr": { "transport": "file",
                                                        "filename": "/tmp/migfile",
                                                        "offset": "0x1000" } } ] } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command migrate-incoming (Since: 2.3)
              Start an incoming migration, the qemu must have been started with -incoming defer

              Argumentsuri (string, optional) -- The Uniform  Resource  Identifier  identifying  the  source  or
                       address to listen on

                     • channels  ([MigrationChannel],  optional)  -- list of migration stream channels with each
                       stream in the list connected to a destination interface endpoint.

                     • exit-on-error (boolean, optional) -- Exit on incoming migration failure.   Default  true.
                       When  set  to  false,  the failure triggers a MIGRATION event, and error details could be
                       retrieved with query-migrate.  (since 9.1)

                 Notes

                 1. It's a bad idea to use a string for the uri, but it needs to stay compatible with  -incoming
                    and the format of the uri is already exposed above libvirt.

                 2. QEMU must be started with -incoming defer to allow migrate-incoming to be used.

                 3. The uri format is the same as for -incoming

                 4. For  now,  number  of  migration  streams  is  restricted  to  one,  i.e. number of items in
                    'channels' list is just 1.

                 5. The 'uri' and 'channels' arguments are mutually exclusive; exactly one of the two should  be
                    present.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "migrate-incoming",
                          "arguments": { "uri": "tcp:0:4446" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

                     -> { "execute": "migrate-incoming",
                          "arguments": {
                              "channels": [ { "channel-type": "main",
                                              "addr": { "transport": "socket",
                                                        "type": "inet",
                                                        "host": "10.12.34.9",
                                                        "port": "1050" } } ] } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

                     -> { "execute": "migrate-incoming",
                          "arguments": {
                              "channels": [ { "channel-type": "main",
                                              "addr": { "transport": "exec",
                                                        "args": [ "/bin/nc", "-p", "6000",
                                                                  "/some/sock" ] } } ] } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

                     -> { "execute": "migrate-incoming",
                          "arguments": {
                              "channels": [ { "channel-type": "main",
                                              "addr": { "transport": "rdma",
                                                        "host": "10.12.34.9",
                                                        "port": "1050" } } ] } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command xen-save-devices-state (Since: 1.1)
              Save  the  state of all devices to file.  The RAM and the block devices of the VM are not saved by
              this command.

              Argumentsfilename (string) -- the file to save the state of the devices to as  binary  data.   See
                       xen-save-devices-state.txt for a description of the binary format.

                     • live  (boolean,  optional) -- Optional argument to ask QEMU to treat this command as part
                       of a live migration.  Default to true.  (since 2.11)

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "xen-save-devices-state",
                          "arguments": { "filename": "/tmp/save" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command xen-set-global-dirty-log (Since: 1.3)
              Enable or disable the global dirty log mode.

              Argumentsenable (boolean) -- true to enable, false to disable.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "xen-set-global-dirty-log",
                          "arguments": { "enable": true } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command xen-load-devices-state (Since: 2.7)
              Load the state of all devices from file.  The RAM and the block devices of the VM are  not  loaded
              by this command.

              Argumentsfilename  (string) -- the file to load the state of the devices from as binary data.  See
                       xen-save-devices-state.txt for a description of the binary format.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "xen-load-devices-state",
                          "arguments": { "filename": "/tmp/resume" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command xen-set-replication (Since: 2.9)
              Availability: CONFIG_REPLICATION

              Enable or disable replication.

              Argumentsenable (boolean) -- true to enable, false to disable.

                     • primary (boolean) -- true for primary or false for secondary.

                     • failover (boolean, optional) -- true to do failover, false to stop.  Cannot be  specified
                       if 'enable' is true.  Default value is false.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "xen-set-replication",
                          "arguments": {"enable": true, "primary": false} }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Object ReplicationStatus (Since: 2.9)
              Availability: CONFIG_REPLICATION

              The result format for 'query-xen-replication-status'.

              Memberserror (boolean) -- true if an error happened, false if replication is normal.

                     • desc  (string,  optional)  --  the human readable error description string, when error is
                       'true'.

       Command query-xen-replication-status (Since: 2.9)
              Availability: CONFIG_REPLICATION

              Query replication status while the vm is running.

              Return ReplicationStatus -- A ReplicationStatus object showing the status.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-xen-replication-status" }
                     <- { "return": { "error": false } }

       Command xen-colo-do-checkpoint (Since: 2.9)
              Availability: CONFIG_REPLICATION

              Xen uses this command to notify replication to trigger a checkpoint.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "xen-colo-do-checkpoint" }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Object COLOStatus (Since: 3.1)
              Availability: CONFIG_REPLICATION

              The result format for 'query-colo-status'.

              Membersmode (COLOMode) -- COLO running mode.   If  COLO  is  running,  this  field  will  return
                       'primary' or 'secondary'.

                     • last-mode  (COLOMode)  --  COLO  last  running mode.  If COLO is running, this field will
                       return same like mode field, after failover we can use this field to get last colo  mode.
                       (since 4.0)

                     • reason (COLOExitReason) -- describes the reason for the COLO exit.

       Command query-colo-status (Since: 3.1)
              Availability: CONFIG_REPLICATION

              Query COLO status while the vm is running.

              Return COLOStatus -- A COLOStatus object showing the status.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-colo-status" }
                     <- { "return": { "mode": "primary", "last-mode": "none", "reason": "request" } }

       Command migrate-recover (Since: 3.0)
              Provide a recovery migration stream URI.

              Argumentsuri (string) -- the URI to be used for the recovery of migration stream.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "migrate-recover",
                          "arguments": { "uri": "tcp:192.168.1.200:12345" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command migrate-pause (Since: 3.0)
              Pause a migration.  Currently it only supports postcopy.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "migrate-pause" }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Event UNPLUG_PRIMARY (Since: 4.2)
              Emitted from source side of a migration when migration state is WAIT_UNPLUG.  Device was unplugged
              by  guest operating system.  Device resources in QEMU are kept on standby to be able to re-plug it
              in case of migration failure.

              Membersdevice-id (string) -- QEMU device id of the unplugged device

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "UNPLUG_PRIMARY",
                          "data": { "device-id": "hostdev0" },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }

       Object DirtyRateVcpu (Since: 6.2)
              Dirty rate of vcpu.

              Membersid (int) -- vcpu index.

                     • dirty-rate (int) -- dirty rate.

       Enum DirtyRateStatus (Since: 5.2)
              Dirty page rate measurement status.

              Valuesunstarted -- measuring thread has not been started yet

                     • measuring -- measuring thread is running

                     • measured -- dirty page rate is measured and the results are available

       Enum DirtyRateMeasureMode (Since: 6.2)
              Method used to measure dirty page rate.  Differences between available methods  are  explained  in
              calc-dirty-rate.

              Valuespage-sampling -- use page sampling

                     • dirty-ring -- use dirty ring

                     • dirty-bitmap -- use dirty bitmap

       Enum TimeUnit (Since: 8.2)
              Specifies unit in which time-related value is specified.

              Valuessecond -- value is in seconds

                     • millisecond -- value is in milliseconds

       Object DirtyRateInfo (Since: 5.2)
              Information about measured dirty page rate.

              Membersdirty-rate  (int,  optional)  -- an estimate of the dirty page rate of the VM in units of
                       MiB/s.  Value is present only when status is 'measured'.

                     • status (DirtyRateStatus) -- current status of dirty page rate measurements

                     • start-time (int) -- start time in units of second for calculation

                     • calc-time (int) -- time period for which dirty page  rate  was  measured,  expressed  and
                       rounded down to calc-time-unit.

                     • calc-time-unit (TimeUnit) -- time unit of calc-time  (Since 8.2)

                     • sample-pages  (int)  --  number  of sampled pages per GiB of guest memory.  Valid only in
                       page-sampling mode (Since 6.1)

                     • mode (DirtyRateMeasureMode) -- mode that was used to measure dirty page rate (Since 6.2)

                     • vcpu-dirty-rate ([DirtyRateVcpu], optional) -- dirty rate for  each  vCPU  if  dirty-ring
                       mode was specified (Since 6.2)

       Command calc-dirty-rate (Since: 5.2)
              Start  measuring  dirty page rate of the VM.  Results can be retrieved with query-dirty-rate after
              measurements are completed.

              Dirty page rate is the number of pages changed in a given time period  expressed  in  MiB/s.   The
              following methods of calculation are available:

              1. In  page  sampling  mode,  a  random subset of pages are selected and hashed twice: once at the
                 beginning of measurement time period, and once again at the end.  If two hashes for  some  page
                 are  different,  the  page  is  counted  as  changed.  Since this method relies on sampling and
                 hashing, calculated dirty page rate  is  only  an  estimate  of  its  true  value.   Increasing
                 sample-pages improves estimation quality at the cost of higher computational overhead.

              2. Dirty  bitmap  mode captures writes to memory (for example by temporarily revoking write access
                 to all pages) and counting page faults.  Information about modified pages is collected  into  a
                 bitmap,  where each bit corresponds to one guest page.  This mode requires that KVM accelerator
                 property "dirty-ring-size" is not set.

              3. Dirty ring mode is similar to dirty bitmap mode, but the information about  modified  pages  is
                 collected  into  ring buffer.  This mode tracks page modification per each vCPU separately.  It
                 requires that KVM accelerator property "dirty-ring-size" is set.

              Argumentscalc-time (int) -- time period for which dirty page rate is calculated.  By default it is
                       specified in seconds, but the unit can be set explicitly with calc-time-unit.  Note  that
                       larger  calc-time  values  will typically result in smaller dirty page rates because page
                       dirtying is a one-time event.  Once some  page  is  counted  as  dirty  during  calc-time
                       period, further writes to this page will not increase dirty page rate anymore.

                     • calc-time-unit  (TimeUnit,  optional)  --  time unit in which calc-time is specified.  By
                       default it is seconds.  (Since 8.2)

                     • sample-pages (int, optional) -- number of sampled pages per each  GiB  of  guest  memory.
                       Default  value  is 512.  For 4KiB guest pages this corresponds to sampling ratio of 0.2%.
                       This argument is used only in page sampling mode.  (Since 6.1)

                     • mode (DirtyRateMeasureMode, optional) -- mechanism for  tracking  dirty  pages.   Default
                       value is 'page-sampling'.  Others are 'dirty-bitmap' and 'dirty-ring'.  (Since 6.1)

                 Example:

                     -> {"execute": "calc-dirty-rate", "arguments": {"calc-time": 1,
                                                                     "sample-pages": 512} }
                     <- { "return": {} }

                 Example:

                        Measure dirty rate using dirty bitmap for 500 milliseconds:

                     -> {"execute": "calc-dirty-rate", "arguments": {"calc-time": 500,
                         "calc-time-unit": "millisecond", "mode": "dirty-bitmap"} }

                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command query-dirty-rate (Since: 5.2)
              Query results of the most recent invocation of calc-dirty-rate.

              Argumentscalc-time-unit (TimeUnit, optional) -- time unit in which to report calculation time.  By
                       default it is reported in seconds.  (Since 8.2)

                 Example: Measurement is in progress

                      <- {"status": "measuring", "sample-pages": 512,
                          "mode": "page-sampling", "start-time": 1693900454, "calc-time": 10,
                          "calc-time-unit": "second"}

                 Example: Measurement has been completed

                      <- {"status": "measured", "sample-pages": 512, "dirty-rate": 108,
                          "mode": "page-sampling", "start-time": 1693900454, "calc-time": 10,
                          "calc-time-unit": "second"}

       Object DirtyLimitInfo (Since: 7.1)
              Dirty page rate limit information of a virtual CPU.

              Memberscpu-index (int) -- index of a virtual CPU.

                     • limit-rate  (int)  --  upper  limit  of dirty page rate (MB/s) for a virtual CPU, 0 means
                       unlimited.

                     • current-rate (int) -- current dirty page rate (MB/s) for a virtual CPU.

       Command set-vcpu-dirty-limit (Since: 7.1)
              Set the upper limit of dirty page rate for virtual CPUs.

              Requires KVM with accelerator property "dirty-ring-size" set.  A virtual CPU's dirty page rate  is
              a measure of its memory load.  To observe dirty page rates, use calc-dirty-rate.

              Argumentscpu-index (int, optional) -- index of a virtual CPU, default is all.

                     • dirty-rate (int) -- upper limit of dirty page rate (MB/s) for virtual CPUs.

                 Example:

                     -> {"execute": "set-vcpu-dirty-limit"}
                         "arguments": { "dirty-rate": 200,
                                        "cpu-index": 1 } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command cancel-vcpu-dirty-limit (Since: 7.1)
              Cancel the upper limit of dirty page rate for virtual CPUs.

              Cancel  the  dirty  page  limit for the vCPU which has been set with set-vcpu-dirty-limit command.
              Note that this command requires support from dirty ring, same as the "set-vcpu-dirty-limit".

              Argumentscpu-index (int, optional) -- index of a virtual CPU, default is all.

                 Example:

                     -> {"execute": "cancel-vcpu-dirty-limit"},
                         "arguments": { "cpu-index": 1 } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command query-vcpu-dirty-limit (Since: 7.1)
              Returns information about virtual CPU dirty page rate limits, if any.

                 Example:

                     -> {"execute": "query-vcpu-dirty-limit"}
                     <- {"return": [
                            { "limit-rate": 60, "current-rate": 3, "cpu-index": 0},
                            { "limit-rate": 60, "current-rate": 3, "cpu-index": 1}]}

       Object MigrationThreadInfo (Since: 7.2)
              Information about migrationthreads

              Membersname (string) -- the name of migration thread

                     • thread-id (int) -- ID of the underlying host thread

       Command query-migrationthreads (Since: 7.2)
              This command is deprecated.

              Returns information of migration threads

              Featuresdeprecated -- This command is deprecated with no replacement yet.

              Return [MigrationThreadInfo] -- MigrationThreadInfo

       Command snapshot-save (Since: 6.0)
              Save a VM snapshot

              Argumentsjob-id (string) -- identifier for the newly created job

                     • tag (string) -- name of the snapshot to create

                     • vmstate (string) -- block device node name to save vmstate to

                     • devices ([string]) -- list of block device node names to save a snapshot to

              Applications should not assume that the snapshot save is complete when this command returns.   The
              job commands / events must be used to determine completion and to fetch details of any errors that
              arise.

              Note  that  execution  of  the  guest  CPUs  may  be  stopped during the time it takes to save the
              snapshot.  A future version of QEMU may ensure CPUs are executing continuously.

              It is strongly recommended that devices contain all writable block device nodes  if  a  consistent
              snapshot is required.

              If tag already exists, an error will be reported

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "snapshot-save",
                          "arguments": {
                             "job-id": "snapsave0",
                             "tag": "my-snap",
                             "vmstate": "disk0",
                             "devices": ["disk0", "disk1"]
                          }
                        }
                     <- { "return": { } }
                     <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
                         "timestamp": {"seconds": 1432121972, "microseconds": 744001},
                         "data": {"status": "created", "id": "snapsave0"}}
                     <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
                         "timestamp": {"seconds": 1432122172, "microseconds": 744001},
                         "data": {"status": "running", "id": "snapsave0"}}
                     <- {"event": "STOP",
                         "timestamp": {"seconds": 1432122372, "microseconds": 744001} }
                     <- {"event": "RESUME",
                         "timestamp": {"seconds": 1432122572, "microseconds": 744001} }
                     <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
                         "timestamp": {"seconds": 1432122772, "microseconds": 744001},
                         "data": {"status": "waiting", "id": "snapsave0"}}
                     <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
                         "timestamp": {"seconds": 1432122972, "microseconds": 744001},
                         "data": {"status": "pending", "id": "snapsave0"}}
                     <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
                         "timestamp": {"seconds": 1432123172, "microseconds": 744001},
                         "data": {"status": "concluded", "id": "snapsave0"}}
                     -> {"execute": "query-jobs"}
                     <- {"return": [{"current-progress": 1,
                                     "status": "concluded",
                                     "total-progress": 1,
                                     "type": "snapshot-save",
                                     "id": "snapsave0"}]}

       Command snapshot-load (Since: 6.0)
              Load a VM snapshot

              Argumentsjob-id (string) -- identifier for the newly created job

                     • tag (string) -- name of the snapshot to load.

                     • vmstate (string) -- block device node name to load vmstate from

                     • devices ([string]) -- list of block device node names to load a snapshot from

              Applications  should not assume that the snapshot load is complete when this command returns.  The
              job commands / events must be used to determine completion and to fetch details of any errors that
              arise.

              Note that execution of the guest CPUs will be stopped  during  the  time  it  takes  to  load  the
              snapshot.

              It  is  strongly  recommended  that  devices contain all writable block device nodes that can have
              changed since the original snapshot-save command execution.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "snapshot-load",
                          "arguments": {
                             "job-id": "snapload0",
                             "tag": "my-snap",
                             "vmstate": "disk0",
                             "devices": ["disk0", "disk1"]
                          }
                        }
                     <- { "return": { } }
                     <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
                         "timestamp": {"seconds": 1472124172, "microseconds": 744001},
                         "data": {"status": "created", "id": "snapload0"}}
                     <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
                         "timestamp": {"seconds": 1472125172, "microseconds": 744001},
                         "data": {"status": "running", "id": "snapload0"}}
                     <- {"event": "STOP",
                         "timestamp": {"seconds": 1472125472, "microseconds": 744001} }
                     <- {"event": "RESUME",
                         "timestamp": {"seconds": 1472125872, "microseconds": 744001} }
                     <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
                         "timestamp": {"seconds": 1472126172, "microseconds": 744001},
                         "data": {"status": "waiting", "id": "snapload0"}}
                     <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
                         "timestamp": {"seconds": 1472127172, "microseconds": 744001},
                         "data": {"status": "pending", "id": "snapload0"}}
                     <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
                         "timestamp": {"seconds": 1472128172, "microseconds": 744001},
                         "data": {"status": "concluded", "id": "snapload0"}}
                     -> {"execute": "query-jobs"}
                     <- {"return": [{"current-progress": 1,
                                     "status": "concluded",
                                     "total-progress": 1,
                                     "type": "snapshot-load",
                                     "id": "snapload0"}]}

       Command snapshot-delete (Since: 6.0)
              Delete a VM snapshot

              Argumentsjob-id (string) -- identifier for the newly created job

                     • tag (string) -- name of the snapshot to delete.

                     • devices ([string]) -- list of block device node names to delete a snapshot from

              Applications should not assume that the snapshot delete is complete  when  this  command  returns.
              The  job commands / events must be used to determine completion and to fetch details of any errors
              that arise.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "snapshot-delete",
                          "arguments": {
                             "job-id": "snapdelete0",
                             "tag": "my-snap",
                             "devices": ["disk0", "disk1"]
                          }
                        }
                     <- { "return": { } }
                     <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
                         "timestamp": {"seconds": 1442124172, "microseconds": 744001},
                         "data": {"status": "created", "id": "snapdelete0"}}
                     <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
                         "timestamp": {"seconds": 1442125172, "microseconds": 744001},
                         "data": {"status": "running", "id": "snapdelete0"}}
                     <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
                         "timestamp": {"seconds": 1442126172, "microseconds": 744001},
                         "data": {"status": "waiting", "id": "snapdelete0"}}
                     <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
                         "timestamp": {"seconds": 1442127172, "microseconds": 744001},
                         "data": {"status": "pending", "id": "snapdelete0"}}
                     <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE",
                         "timestamp": {"seconds": 1442128172, "microseconds": 744001},
                         "data": {"status": "concluded", "id": "snapdelete0"}}
                     -> {"execute": "query-jobs"}
                     <- {"return": [{"current-progress": 1,
                                     "status": "concluded",
                                     "total-progress": 1,
                                     "type": "snapshot-delete",
                                     "id": "snapdelete0"}]}

TRANSACTIONS

       Object Abort (Since: 1.6)
              This action can be used to test transaction failure.

       Enum ActionCompletionMode (Since: 2.5)
              An enumeration of Transactional completion modes.

              Valuesindividual -- Do not attempt to cancel any other Actions if any Actions  fail  after  the
                       Transaction  request  succeeds.   All  Actions  that can complete successfully will do so
                       without waiting on others.  This is the default.

                     • grouped -- If any Action fails  after  the  Transaction  succeeds,  cancel  all  Actions.
                       Actions  do  not  complete  until  all Actions are ready to complete.  May be rejected by
                       Actions that do not support this completion mode.

       Enum TransactionActionKind (Since: 1.1)

              Valuesabort -- Since 1.6

                     • block-dirty-bitmap-add -- Since 2.5

                     • block-dirty-bitmap-remove -- Since 4.2

                     • block-dirty-bitmap-clear -- Since 2.5

                     • block-dirty-bitmap-enable -- Since 4.0

                     • block-dirty-bitmap-disable -- Since 4.0

                     • block-dirty-bitmap-merge -- Since 4.0

                     • blockdev-backup -- Since 2.3

                     • blockdev-snapshot -- Since 2.5

                     • blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync -- Since 1.7

                     • blockdev-snapshot-sync -- since 1.1

                     • drive-backup -- Since 1.6

              Featuresdeprecated -- Member drive-backup is deprecated.  Use member blockdev-backup instead.

       Object AbortWrapper (Since: 1.6)

              Membersdata (Abort) -- Not documented

       Object BlockDirtyBitmapAddWrapper (Since: 2.5)

              Membersdata (BlockDirtyBitmapAdd) -- Not documented

       Object BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper (Since: 2.5)

              Membersdata (BlockDirtyBitmap) -- Not documented

       Object BlockDirtyBitmapMergeWrapper (Since: 4.0)

              Membersdata (BlockDirtyBitmapMerge) -- Not documented

       Object BlockdevBackupWrapper (Since: 2.3)

              Membersdata (BlockdevBackup) -- Not documented

       Object BlockdevSnapshotWrapper (Since: 2.5)

              Membersdata (BlockdevSnapshot) -- Not documented

       Object BlockdevSnapshotInternalWrapper (Since: 1.7)

              Membersdata (BlockdevSnapshotInternal) -- Not documented

       Object BlockdevSnapshotSyncWrapper (Since: 1.1)

              Membersdata (BlockdevSnapshotSync) -- Not documented

       Object DriveBackupWrapper (Since: 1.6)

              Membersdata (DriveBackup) -- Not documented

       Object TransactionAction (Since: 1.1)
              A discriminated record of operations that can be performed with transaction.

              Memberstype (TransactionActionKind) -- the operation to be performed

                     • When type is abort: The members of AbortWrapper.

                     • When type is block-dirty-bitmap-add: The members of BlockDirtyBitmapAddWrapper.

                     • When type is block-dirty-bitmap-remove: The members of BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper.

                     • When type is block-dirty-bitmap-clear: The members of BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper.

                     • When type is block-dirty-bitmap-enable: The members of BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper.

                     • When type is block-dirty-bitmap-disable: The members of BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper.

                     • When type is block-dirty-bitmap-merge: The members of BlockDirtyBitmapMergeWrapper.

                     • When type is blockdev-backup: The members of BlockdevBackupWrapper.

                     • When type is blockdev-snapshot: The members of BlockdevSnapshotWrapper.

                     • When     type      is      blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync:      The      members      of
                       BlockdevSnapshotInternalWrapper.

                     • When type is blockdev-snapshot-sync: The members of BlockdevSnapshotSyncWrapper.

                     • When type is drive-backup: The members of DriveBackupWrapper.

       Object TransactionProperties (Since: 2.5)
              Optional arguments to modify the behavior of a Transaction.

              Memberscompletion-mode   (ActionCompletionMode,   optional)   --   Controls  how  jobs  launched
                       asynchronously by Actions will complete or fail as a group.  See ActionCompletionMode for
                       details.

       Command transaction (Since: 1.1)
              Executes a number of transactionable QMP commands atomically.  If any operation  fails,  then  the
              entire set of actions will be abandoned and the appropriate error returned.

              For  external snapshots, the dictionary contains the device, the file to use for the new snapshot,
              and the format.  The default format, if not specified, is qcow2.

              Each new snapshot defaults to being created by QEMU (wiping  any  contents  if  the  file  already
              exists),  but  it  is  also possible to reuse an externally-created file.  In the latter case, you
              should ensure that the new image file has the same  contents  as  the  current  one;  QEMU  cannot
              perform  any  meaningful check.  Typically this is achieved by using the current image file as the
              backing file for the new image.

              On failure, the original disks pre-snapshot attempt will be used.

              For internal snapshots, the dictionary contains  the  device  and  the  snapshot's  name.   If  an
              internal  snapshot  matching  name  already exists, the request will be rejected.  Only some image
              formats support it, for example, qcow2, and rbd,

              On failure, qemu will try delete the newly created internal snapshot in the transaction.  When  an
              I/O error occurs during deletion, the user needs to fix it later with qemu-img or other command.

              Argumentsactions  ([TransactionAction])  --  List of TransactionAction; information needed for the
                       respective operations.

                     • properties (TransactionProperties,  optional)  --  structure  of  additional  options  to
                       control  the  execution  of  the  transaction.   See TransactionProperties for additional
                       detail.

              Errors

                     • Any errors from commands in the transaction

              NOTE:
                 The transaction aborts on the first failure.  Therefore, there will be information on only  one
                 failed  operation  returned  in  an  error condition, and subsequent actions will not have been
                 attempted.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "transaction",
                          "arguments": { "actions": [
                              { "type": "blockdev-snapshot-sync", "data" : { "device": "ide-hd0",
                                                          "snapshot-file": "/some/place/my-image",
                                                          "format": "qcow2" } },
                              { "type": "blockdev-snapshot-sync", "data" : { "node-name": "myfile",
                                                          "snapshot-file": "/some/place/my-image2",
                                                          "snapshot-node-name": "node3432",
                                                          "mode": "existing",
                                                          "format": "qcow2" } },
                              { "type": "blockdev-snapshot-sync", "data" : { "device": "ide-hd1",
                                                          "snapshot-file": "/some/place/my-image2",
                                                          "mode": "existing",
                                                          "format": "qcow2" } },
                              { "type": "blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync", "data" : {
                                                          "device": "ide-hd2",
                                                          "name": "snapshot0" } } ] } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

TRACING

       Enum TraceEventState (Since: 2.2)
              State of a tracing event.

              Valuesunavailable -- The event is statically disabled.

                     • disabled -- The event is dynamically disabled.

                     • enabled -- The event is dynamically enabled.

       Object TraceEventInfo (Since: 2.2)
              Information of a tracing event.

              Membersname (string) -- Event name.

                     • state (TraceEventState) -- Tracing state.

       Command trace-event-get-state (Since: 2.2)
              Query the state of events.

              Argumentsname (string) -- Event name pattern (case-sensitive glob).

              Return [TraceEventInfo] -- a list of TraceEventInfo for the matching events

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "trace-event-get-state",
                          "arguments": { "name": "qemu_memalign" } }
                     <- { "return": [ { "name": "qemu_memalign", "state": "disabled", "vcpu": false } ] }

       Command trace-event-set-state (Since: 2.2)
              Set the dynamic tracing state of events.

              Argumentsname (string) -- Event name pattern (case-sensitive glob).

                     • enable (boolean) -- Whether to enable tracing.

                     • ignore-unavailable (boolean, optional) -- Do not match unavailable events with name.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "trace-event-set-state",
                          "arguments": { "name": "qemu_memalign", "enable": true } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

COMPATIBILITY POLICY

       Enum CompatPolicyInput (Since: 6.0)
              Policy for handling "funny" input.

              Valuesaccept -- Accept silently

                     • reject -- Reject with an error

                     • crash -- abort() the process

       Enum CompatPolicyOutput (Since: 6.0)
              Policy for handling "funny" output.

              Valuesaccept -- Pass on unchanged

                     • hide -- Filter out

       Object CompatPolicy (Since: 6.0)
              Policy for handling deprecated management interfaces.

              This is intended for testing users of the management interfaces.

              Limitation: covers only syntactic aspects of QMP, i.e. stuff tagged with feature  'deprecated'  or
              'unstable'.  We may want to extend it to cover semantic aspects and CLI.

              Limitation:  deprecated-output policy hide is not implemented for enumeration values.  They behave
              the same as with policy accept.

              Membersdeprecated-input (CompatPolicyInput, optional) -- how to handle deprecated input (default
                       'accept')

                     • deprecated-output (CompatPolicyOutput, optional)  --  how  to  handle  deprecated  output
                       (default 'accept')

                     • unstable-input  (CompatPolicyInput,  optional)  --  how to handle unstable input (default
                       'accept') (since 6.2)

                     • unstable-output (CompatPolicyOutput, optional) -- how to handle unstable output  (default
                       'accept') (since 6.2)

QMP MONITOR CONTROL

       Command qmp_capabilities (Since: 0.13)
              Enable QMP capabilities.

              Argumentsenable ([QMPCapability], optional) -- An optional list of QMPCapability values to enable.
                       The  client  must  not  enable  any  capability that is not mentioned in the QMP greeting
                       message.  If the field is not provided, it means no QMP  capabilities  will  be  enabled.
                       (since 2.12)

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "qmp_capabilities",
                          "arguments": { "enable": [ "oob" ] } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

              NOTE:
                 This command is valid exactly when first connecting: it must be issued before any other command
                 will  be  accepted,  and  will  fail  once  the monitor is accepting other commands.  (see QEMU
                 Machine Protocol Specification)

              NOTE:
                 The QMP client needs to explicitly enable QMP capabilities, otherwise all the QMP  capabilities
                 will be turned off by default.

       Enum QMPCapability (Since: 2.12)
              Enumeration  of  capabilities to be advertised during initial client connection, used for agreeing
              on particular QMP extension behaviors.

              Valuesoob -- QMP ability to support out-of-band requests.  (Please refer  to  qmp-spec.rst  for
                       more information on OOB)

       Object VersionTriple (Since: 2.4)
              A three-part version number.

              Membersmajor (int) -- The major version number.

                     • minor (int) -- The minor version number.

                     • micro (int) -- The micro version number.

       Object VersionInfo (Since: 0.14)
              A description of QEMU's version.

              Membersqemu  (VersionTriple)  -- The version of QEMU.  By current convention, a micro version of
                       50 signifies a development branch.  A micro version greater than or equal to 90 signifies
                       a release candidate for the next  minor  version.   A  micro  version  of  less  than  50
                       signifies a stable release.

                     • package  (string)  --  QEMU  will  always  set this field to an empty string.  Downstream
                       versions of QEMU should set this to a non-empty string.  The exact format depends on  the
                       downstream however it highly recommended that a unique name is used.

       Command query-version (Since: 0.14)
              Returns the current version of QEMU.

              Return VersionInfo -- A VersionInfo object describing the current version of QEMU.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-version" }
                     <- {
                           "return":{
                              "qemu":{
                                 "major":0,
                                 "minor":11,
                                 "micro":5
                              },
                              "package":""
                           }
                        }

       Object CommandInfo (Since: 0.14)
              Information about a QMP command

              Membersname (string) -- The command name

       Command query-commands (Since: 0.14)
              Return a list of supported QMP commands by this server

              Return [CommandInfo] -- A list of CommandInfo for all supported commands

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-commands" }
                     <- {
                          "return":[
                             {
                                "name":"query-balloon"
                             },
                             {
                                "name":"system_powerdown"
                             },
                             ...
                          ]
                        }

              This example has been shortened as the real response is too long.

       Command quit (Since: 0.14)
              This  command will cause the QEMU process to exit gracefully.  While every attempt is made to send
              the QMP response before terminating, this  is  not  guaranteed.   When  using  this  interface,  a
              premature EOF would not be unexpected.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "quit" }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Enum MonitorMode (Since: 5.0)
              An enumeration of monitor modes.

              Valuesreadline -- HMP monitor (human-oriented command line interface)

                     • control -- QMP monitor (JSON-based machine interface)

       Object MonitorOptions (Since: 5.0)
              Options to be used for adding a new monitor.

              Membersid (string, optional) -- Name of the monitor

                     • mode (MonitorMode, optional) -- Selects the monitor mode (default: readline in the system
                       emulator, control in qemu-storage-daemon)

                     • pretty (boolean, optional) -- Enables pretty printing (QMP only)

                     • chardev (string) -- Name of a character device to expose the monitor on

QMP INTROSPECTION

       Command query-qmp-schema (Since: 2.5)
              Command  query-qmp-schema  exposes  the  QMP  wire  ABI  as an array of SchemaInfo.  This lets QMP
              clients figure out what commands and events are available in this QEMU, and their  parameters  and
              results.

              However,  the  SchemaInfo  can't  reflect  all the rules and restrictions that apply to QMP.  It's
              interface  introspection  (figuring  out  what's  there),  not   interface   specification.    The
              specification is in the QAPI schema.

              Furthermore,  while  we  strive  to  keep  the  QMP  wire  format backwards-compatible across qemu
              versions, the introspection output is not guaranteed to have the same stability.  For example, one
              version of qemu may list an object member as an optional non-variant, while another lists the same
              member only through the object's variants; or the type of a  member  may  change  from  a  generic
              string into a specific enum or from one specific type into an alternate that includes the original
              type alongside something else.

              Return [SchemaInfo] --

                     array  of  SchemaInfo,  where  each element describes an entity in the ABI: command, event,
                     type, ...

                     The order of the various SchemaInfo is unspecified; however, all names are guaranteed to be
                     unique (no name will be duplicated with different meta-types).

              NOTE:
                 The QAPI schema is also used to help define internal interfaces, by defining QAPI types.  These
                 are not part of the QMP wire ABI, and therefore not returned by this command.

       Enum SchemaMetaType (Since: 2.5)
              This is a SchemaInfo's meta type, i.e. the kind of entity it describes.

              Valuesbuiltin -- a predefined type such as 'int' or 'bool'.

                     • enum -- an enumeration type

                     • array -- an array type

                     • object -- an object type (struct or union)

                     • alternate -- an alternate type

                     • command -- a QMP command

                     • event -- a QMP event

       Object SchemaInfo (Since: 2.5)

              Membersname (string) -- the entity's name,  inherited  from  base.   The  SchemaInfo  is  always
                       referenced  by  this name.  Commands and events have the name defined in the QAPI schema.
                       Unlike command and event names, type names are not part of the wire  ABI.   Consequently,
                       type  names  are  meaningless  strings  here,  although  they are still guaranteed unique
                       regardless of meta-type.

                     • meta-type (SchemaMetaType) -- the entity's meta type, inherited from base.

                     • features ([string], optional) -- names of features associated  with  the  entity,  in  no
                       particular order.  (since 4.1 for object types, 4.2 for commands, 5.0 for the rest)

                     • When meta-type is builtin: The members of SchemaInfoBuiltin.

                     • When meta-type is enum: The members of SchemaInfoEnum.

                     • When meta-type is array: The members of SchemaInfoArray.

                     • When meta-type is object: The members of SchemaInfoObject.

                     • When meta-type is alternate: The members of SchemaInfoAlternate.

                     • When meta-type is command: The members of SchemaInfoCommand.

                     • When meta-type is event: The members of SchemaInfoEvent.

       Object SchemaInfoBuiltin (Since: 2.5)
              Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'builtin'.

              Membersjson-type (JSONType) -- the JSON type used for this type on the wire.

       Enum JSONType (Since: 2.5)
              The four primitive and two structured types according to RFC 8259 section 1, plus 'int' (split off
              'number'), plus the obvious top type 'value'.

              Valuesstring -- JSON string

                     • number -- JSON number

                     • int -- JSON number that is an integer

                     • boolean -- literal false or truenull -- literal nullobject -- JSON object

                     • array -- JSON array

                     • value -- any JSON value

       Object SchemaInfoEnum (Since: 2.5)
              Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'enum'.

              Membersmembers  ([SchemaInfoEnumMember])  --  the  enum  type's  members, in no particular order
                       (since 6.2).

                     • values ([string]) -- the  enumeration  type's  member  names,  in  no  particular  order.
                       Redundant with members.  Just for backward compatibility.

              Featuresdeprecated -- Member values is deprecated.  Use members instead.

              Values of this type are JSON string on the wire.

       Object SchemaInfoEnumMember (Since: 6.2)
              An object member.

              Membersname (string) -- the member's name, as defined in the QAPI schema.

                     • features  ([string],  optional)  --  names  of features associated with the member, in no
                       particular order.

       Object SchemaInfoArray (Since: 2.5)
              Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'array'.

              Memberselement-type (string) -- the array type's element type.

              Values of this type are JSON array on the wire.

       Object SchemaInfoObject (Since: 2.5)
              Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'object'.

              Membersmembers ([SchemaInfoObjectMember]) -- the object  type's  (non-variant)  members,  in  no
                       particular order.

                     • tag  (string,  optional)  --  the  name of the member serving as type tag.  An element of
                       members with this name must exist.

                     • variants  ([SchemaInfoObjectVariant],  optional)  --  variant  members,  i.e.  additional
                       members  that  depend on the type tag's value.  Present exactly when tag is present.  The
                       variants are in no particular order, and may even differ from the order of the values  of
                       the enum type of the tag.

              Values of this type are JSON object on the wire.

       Object SchemaInfoObjectMember (Since: 2.5)
              An object member.

              Membersname (string) -- the member's name, as defined in the QAPI schema.

                     • type (string) -- the name of the member's type.

                     • default  (value,  optional)  --  default  when used as command parameter.  If absent, the
                       parameter is mandatory.  If present, the value must be null.  The parameter is  optional,
                       and  behavior  when it's missing is not specified here.  Future extension: if present and
                       non-null, the parameter is optional, and defaults to this value.

                     • features ([string], optional) -- names of features associated  with  the  member,  in  no
                       particular order.  (since 5.0)

       Object SchemaInfoObjectVariant (Since: 2.5)
              The variant members for a value of the type tag.

              Memberscase (string) -- a value of the type tag.

                     • type  (string)  -- the name of the object type that provides the variant members when the
                       type tag has value case.

       Object SchemaInfoAlternate (Since: 2.5)
              Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'alternate'.

              Membersmembers ([SchemaInfoAlternateMember]) -- the alternate type's members, in  no  particular
                       order.   The  members'  wire encoding is distinct, see How to use the QAPI code generator
                       section Alternate types.

              On the wire, this can be any of the members.

       Object SchemaInfoAlternateMember (Since: 2.5)
              An alternate member.

              Memberstype (string) -- the name of the member's type.

       Object SchemaInfoCommand (Since: 2.5)
              Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'command'.

              Membersarg-type (string) -- the name of the object type that provides the command's parameters.

                     • ret-type (string) -- the name of the command's result type.

                     • allow-oob (boolean, optional)  --  whether  the  command  allows  out-of-band  execution,
                       defaults to false (Since: 2.12)

       Object SchemaInfoEvent (Since: 2.5)
              Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'event'.

              Membersarg-type (string) -- the name of the object type that provides the event's parameters.

QEMU OBJECT MODEL (QOM)

       Object ObjectPropertyInfo (Since: 1.2)

              Membersname (string) -- the name of the property

                     • type (string) --

                       the type of the property.  This will typically come in one of four forms:

                       1. A  primitive  type  such  as 'u8', 'u16', 'bool', 'str', or 'double'.  These types are
                          mapped to the appropriate JSON type.

                       2. A child type in the form 'child<subtype>' where subtype is a qdev  device  type  name.
                          Child properties create the composition tree.

                       3. A  link  type  in  the  form 'link<subtype>' where subtype is a qdev device type name.
                          Link properties form the device model graph.

                     • description (string, optional) -- if specified, the description of the property.

                     • default-value (value, optional) -- the default value, if any (since 5.0)

       Command qom-list (Since: 1.2)
              This command will list any properties of a object given a path in the object model.

              Argumentspath (string) -- the path within the object model.  See qom-get for a description of this
                       parameter.

              Return [ObjectPropertyInfo] -- a list of ObjectPropertyInfo that describe the  properties  of  the
                     object.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "qom-list",
                          "arguments": { "path": "/chardevs" } }
                     <- { "return": [ { "name": "type", "type": "string" },
                                      { "name": "parallel0", "type": "child<chardev-vc>" },
                                      { "name": "serial0", "type": "child<chardev-vc>" },
                                      { "name": "mon0", "type": "child<chardev-stdio>" } ] }

       Command qom-get (Since: 1.2)
              This command will get a property from a object model path and return the value.

              Argumentspath (string) --

                       The  path  within the object model.  There are two forms of supported paths--absolute and
                       partial paths.

                       Absolute paths are derived from  the  root  object  and  can  follow  child<>  or  link<>
                       properties.   Since  they  can  follow  link<>  properties, they can be arbitrarily long.
                       Absolute paths look like absolute filenames and are prefixed  with a leading slash.

                       Partial paths look like relative filenames.  They  do  not  begin  with  a  prefix.   The
                       matching rules for partial paths are subtle but designed to make specifying objects easy.
                       At  each  level of the composition tree, the partial path is matched as an absolute path.
                       The first match is not returned.  At least two matches are searched  for.   A  successful
                       result  is  only returned if only one match is found.  If more than one match is found, a
                       flag is return to indicate that the match was ambiguous.

                     • property (string) -- The property name to read

              Return value -- The property value.  The type depends on the property type.   child<>  and  link<>
                     properties  are  returned as #str pathnames.  All integer property types (u8, u16, etc) are
                     returned as #int.

                 Example: Use absolute path

                      -> { "execute": "qom-get",
                           "arguments": { "path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]",
                                          "property": "hotplugged" } }
                      <- { "return": false }

                 Example: Use partial path

                      -> { "execute": "qom-get",
                           "arguments": { "path": "unattached/sysbus",
                                          "property": "type" } }
                      <- { "return": "System" }

       Command qom-set (Since: 1.2)
              This command will set a property from a object model path.

              Argumentspath (string) -- see qom-get for a description of this parameter

                     • property (string) -- the property name to set

                     • value (value) -- a value who's type is appropriate for the property  type.   See  qom-get
                       for a description of type mapping.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "qom-set",
                          "arguments": { "path": "/machine",
                                         "property": "graphics",
                                         "value": false } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Object ObjectTypeInfo (Since: 1.1)
              This structure describes a search result from qom-list-types

              Membersname (string) -- the type name found in the search

                     • abstract  (boolean, optional) -- the type is abstract and can't be directly instantiated.
                       Omitted if false.  (since 2.10)

                     • parent (string, optional) -- Name of parent type, if any (since 2.10)

       Command qom-list-types (Since: 1.1)
              This command will return a list of types given search parameters

              Argumentsimplements (string, optional) -- if specified, only return types that implement this type
                       name

                     • abstract (boolean, optional) -- if true, include abstract types in the results

              Return [ObjectTypeInfo] -- a list of ObjectTypeInfo or an empty list if no results are found

       Command qom-list-properties (Since: 2.12)
              List properties associated with a QOM object.

              Argumentstypename (string) -- the type name of an object

              NOTE:
                 Objects can create properties at runtime, for  example  to  describe  links  between  different
                 devices and/or objects.  These properties are not included in the output of this command.

              Return [ObjectPropertyInfo] -- a list of ObjectPropertyInfo describing object properties

       Object CanHostSocketcanProperties (Since: 2.12)
              Availability: CONFIG_LINUX

              Properties for can-host-socketcan objects.

              Membersif (string) -- interface name of the host system CAN bus to connect to

                     • canbus (string) -- object ID of the can-bus object to connect to the host interface

       Object ColoCompareProperties (Since: 2.8)
              Properties for colo-compare objects.

              Membersprimary_in  (string) -- name of the character device backend to use for the primary input
                       (incoming packets are redirected to outdev)

                     • secondary_in (string) -- name of the character device backend to use for secondary  input
                       (incoming packets are only compared to the input on primary_in and then dropped)

                     • outdev (string) -- name of the character device backend to use for output

                     • iothread (string) -- name of the iothread to run in

                     • notify_dev  (string,  optional)  --  name  of  the character device backend to be used to
                       communicate with the remote colo-frame (only for Xen COLO)

                     • compare_timeout (int, optional) -- the maximum time to hold a packet from primary_in  for
                       comparison with an incoming packet on secondary_in in milliseconds (default: 3000)

                     • expired_scan_cycle  (int,  optional) -- the interval at which colo-compare checks whether
                       packets from primary have timed out, in milliseconds (default: 3000)

                     • max_queue_size (int, optional) -- the maximum number of packets to keep in the queue  for
                       comparing  with  incoming packets from secondary_in.  If the queue is full and additional
                       packets are received, the additional packets are dropped.  (default: 1024)

                     • vnet_hdr_support (boolean, optional) -- if true, vnet header support is enabled (default:
                       false)

       Object CryptodevBackendProperties (Since: 2.8)
              Properties for cryptodev-backend and cryptodev-backend-builtin objects.

              Membersqueues (int, optional) -- the number of queues for the cryptodev  backend.   Ignored  for
                       cryptodev-backend and must be 1 for cryptodev-backend-builtin.  (default: 1)

                     • throttle-bps (int, optional) -- limit total bytes per second (Since 8.0)

                     • throttle-ops (int, optional) -- limit total operations per second (Since 8.0)

       Object CryptodevVhostUserProperties (Since: 2.12)
              Availability: CONFIG_VHOST_CRYPTO

              Properties for cryptodev-vhost-user objects.

              Memberschardev  (string)  --  the name of a Unix domain socket character device that connects to
                       the vhost-user server

                     • The members of CryptodevBackendProperties.

       Object DBusVMStateProperties (Since: 5.0)
              Properties for dbus-vmstate objects.

              Membersaddr (string) -- the name of the DBus bus to connect to

                     • id-list (string, optional) -- a comma separated list of DBus IDs of  helpers  whose  data
                       should be included in the VM state on migration

       Enum NetfilterInsert (Since: 5.0)
              Indicates where to insert a netfilter relative to a given other filter.

              Valuesbefore -- insert before the specified filter

                     • behind -- insert behind the specified filter

       Object NetfilterProperties (Since: 2.5)
              Properties for objects of classes derived from netfilter.

              Membersnetdev (string) -- id of the network device backend to filter

                     • queue (NetFilterDirection, optional) -- indicates which queue(s) to filter (default: all)

                     • status  (string,  optional) -- indicates whether the filter is enabled ("on") or disabled
                       ("off") (default: "on")

                     • position (string, optional) -- specifies where the  filter  should  be  inserted  in  the
                       filter  list.  "head" means the filter is inserted at the head of the filter list, before
                       any existing filters.  "tail" means the filter is inserted at  the  tail  of  the  filter
                       list,  behind  any  existing  filters  (default).  "id=<id>" means the filter is inserted
                       before or behind the  filter  specified  by  <id>,  depending  on  the  insert  property.
                       (default: "tail")

                     • insert  (NetfilterInsert,  optional) -- where to insert the filter relative to the filter
                       given in position.  Ignored if position is "head" or "tail".  (default: behind)

       Object FilterBufferProperties (Since: 2.5)
              Properties for filter-buffer objects.

              Membersinterval (int) -- a non-zero interval in microseconds.  All packets arriving in the given
                       interval are delayed until the end of the interval.

                     • The members of NetfilterProperties.

       Object FilterDumpProperties (Since: 2.5)
              Properties for filter-dump objects.

              Membersfile (string) -- the filename where the dumped packets should be stored

                     • maxlen (int, optional) -- maximum number of bytes in a packet that are  stored  (default:
                       65536)

                     • The members of NetfilterProperties.

       Object FilterMirrorProperties (Since: 2.6)
              Properties for filter-mirror objects.

              Membersoutdev  (string)  -- the name of a character device backend to which all incoming packets
                       are mirrored

                     • vnet_hdr_support (boolean, optional) -- if true, vnet header support is enabled (default:
                       false)

                     • The members of NetfilterProperties.

       Object FilterRedirectorProperties (Since: 2.6)
              Properties for filter-redirector objects.

              At least one of indev or outdev must be present.  If both are present, they must not refer to  the
              same character device backend.

              Membersindev (string, optional) -- the name of a character device backend from which packets are
                       received and redirected to the filtered network device

                     • outdev (string, optional) -- the name of a character device backend to which all incoming
                       packets are redirected

                     • vnet_hdr_support (boolean, optional) -- if true, vnet header support is enabled (default:
                       false)

                     • The members of NetfilterProperties.

       Object FilterRewriterProperties (Since: 2.8)
              Properties for filter-rewriter objects.

              Membersvnet_hdr_support (boolean, optional) -- if true, vnet header support is enabled (default:
                       false)

                     • The members of NetfilterProperties.

       Object InputBarrierProperties (Since: 4.2)
              Properties for input-barrier objects.

              Membersname (string) -- the screen name as declared in the screens section of barrier.conf

                     • server (string, optional) -- hostname of the Barrier server (default: "localhost")

                     • port (string, optional) -- TCP port of the Barrier server (default: "24800")

                     • x-origin  (string,  optional)  --  x coordinate of the leftmost pixel on the guest screen
                       (default: "0")

                     • y-origin (string, optional) -- y coordinate of the topmost  pixel  on  the  guest  screen
                       (default: "0")

                     • width (string, optional) -- the width of secondary screen in pixels (default: "1920")

                     • height (string, optional) -- the height of secondary screen in pixels (default: "1080")

       Object InputLinuxProperties (Since: 2.6)
              Availability: CONFIG_LINUX

              Properties for input-linux objects.

              Membersevdev (string) -- the path of the host evdev device to use

                     • grab_all  (boolean,  optional)  --  if  true,  grab is toggled for all devices (e.g. both
                       keyboard and mouse) instead of just one device (default: false)

                     • repeat (boolean, optional) -- enables auto-repeat events (default: false)

                     • grab-toggle (GrabToggleKeys, optional) -- the key or key combination that toggles  device
                       grab (default: ctrl-ctrl)

       Object EventLoopBaseProperties (Since: 7.1)
              Common properties for event loops

              Membersaio-max-batch  (int,  optional)  --  maximum  number  of  requests in a batch for the AIO
                       engine, 0 means that the engine will use its default.  (default: 0)

                     • thread-pool-min (int, optional) -- minimum number of threads reserved in the thread  pool
                       (default:0)

                     • thread-pool-max  (int, optional) -- maximum number of threads the thread pool can contain
                       (default:64)

       Object IothreadProperties (Since: 2.0)
              Properties for iothread objects.

              Memberspoll-max-ns (int, optional) -- the maximum number of nanoseconds to busy wait for events.
                       0 means polling is disabled (default: 32768 on POSIX hosts, 0 otherwise)

                     • poll-grow (int, optional) -- the multiplier used to increase the polling  time  when  the
                       algorithm  detects  it  is  missing  events  due to not polling long enough.  0 selects a
                       default behaviour (default: 0)

                     • poll-shrink (int, optional) -- the divisor used to decrease the  polling  time  when  the
                       algorithm detects it is spending too long polling without encountering events.  0 selects
                       a default behaviour (default: 0)

                     • The members of EventLoopBaseProperties.

              The aio-max-batch option is available since 6.1.

       Object MainLoopProperties (Since: 7.1)
              Properties for the main-loop object.

              Members

                     • The members of EventLoopBaseProperties.

       Object MemoryBackendProperties (Since: 2.1)
              Properties for objects of classes derived from memory-backend.

              Membersmerge  (boolean,  optional)  -- if true, mark the memory as mergeable (default depends on
                       the machine type)

                     • dump (boolean, optional) -- if true, include the memory in core dumps (default depends on
                       the machine type)

                     • host-nodes ([int], optional) -- the list of NUMA host nodes to bind the memory to

                     • policy (HostMemPolicy, optional) -- the NUMA policy (default: 'default')

                     • prealloc (boolean, optional) -- if true, preallocate memory (default: false)

                     • prealloc-threads (int, optional) -- number of CPU threads to use for  prealloc  (default:
                       1)

                     • prealloc-context   (string,   optional)   --  thread  context  to  use  for  creation  of
                       preallocation threads (default: none) (since 7.2)

                     • share (boolean, optional) -- if false, the memory is private to  QEMU;  if  true,  it  is
                       shared  (default  false for backends memory-backend-file and memory-backend-ram, true for
                       backends memory-backend-epc, memory-backend-memfd, and memory-backend-shm)

                     • reserve (boolean, optional) -- if true, reserve swap space (or huge pages) if  applicable
                       (default: true) (since 6.1)

                     • size (int) -- size of the memory region in bytes

                     • x-use-canonical-path-for-ramblock-id  (boolean,  optional) -- if true, the canonical path
                       is used for ramblock-id.  Disable this for 4.0 machine types or older to allow  migration
                       with newer QEMU versions.  (default: false generally, but true for machine types <= 4.0)

              NOTE:
                 prealloc=true  and  reserve=false  cannot  be  set  at  the  same time.  With reserve=true, the
                 behavior depends on the operating system: for example, Linux will not reserve  swap  space  for
                 shared  file  mappings  --  "not  applicable".   In contrast, reserve=false will bail out if it
                 cannot be configured accordingly.

       Object MemoryBackendFileProperties (Since: 2.1)
              Properties for memory-backend-file objects.

              Membersalign (int, optional) -- the base address alignment when QEMU  mmap(2)s  mem-path.   Some
                       backend  stores specified by mem-path require an alignment different than the default one
                       used by QEMU, e.g. the device DAX /dev/dax0.0 requires 2M alignment rather than  4K.   In
                       such  cases,  users  can  specify  the  required  alignment via this option.  0 selects a
                       default alignment (currently the page size).  (default: 0)

                     • offset (int, optional) -- the offset into the target file that the region starts at.  You
                       can use this option to back multiple regions with a single file.  Must be a  multiple  of
                       the page size.  (default: 0) (since 8.1)

                     • discard-data (boolean, optional) -- if true, the file contents can be destroyed when QEMU
                       exits,  to avoid unnecessarily flushing data to the backing file.  Note that discard-data
                       is only an  optimization,  and  QEMU  might  not  discard  file  contents  if  it  aborts
                       unexpectedly or is terminated using SIGKILL.  (default: false)

                     • mem-path (string) -- the path to either a shared memory or huge page filesystem mount

                     • pmem  (boolean,  optional) -- specifies whether the backing file specified by mem-path is
                       in host persistent memory that can be accessed using the SNIA NVM programming model (e.g.
                       Intel NVDIMM).

                     • readonly (boolean, optional) -- if true, the backing file is opened read-only; if  false,
                       it is opened read-write.  (default: false)

                     • rom  (OnOffAuto,  optional)  --  whether  to create Read Only Memory (ROM) that cannot be
                       modified by the VM.  Any write attempts to such ROM will be denied.  Most use cases  want
                       writable  RAM instead of ROM.  However, selected use cases, like R/O NVDIMMs, can benefit
                       from ROM.  If set to 'on', create ROM; if set to 'off', create writable RAM;  if  set  to
                       'auto',  the  value of the readonly property is used.  This property is primarily helpful
                       when we want to have proper RAM in configurations that  would  traditionally  create  ROM
                       before this property was introduced: VM templating, where we want to open a file readonly
                       (readonly  set  to true) and mark the memory to be private for QEMU (share set to false).
                       For this use case, we need writable RAM instead of ROM, and want to set this property  to
                       'off'.  (default: auto, since 8.2)

                     • The members of MemoryBackendProperties.

       Object MemoryBackendMemfdProperties (Since: 2.12)
              Availability: CONFIG_LINUX

              Properties for memory-backend-memfd objects.

              Membershugetlb  (boolean,  optional) -- if true, the file to be created resides in the hugetlbfs
                       filesystem (default: false)

                     • hugetlbsize (int, optional) -- the hugetlb page size on  systems  that  support  multiple
                       hugetlb  page sizes (it must be a power of 2 value supported by the system).  0 selects a
                       default page size.  This option is ignored if hugetlb is false.  (default: 0)

                     • seal (boolean, optional) -- if true, create  a  sealed-file,  which  will  block  further
                       resizing of the memory (default: true)

                     • The members of MemoryBackendProperties.

       Object MemoryBackendShmProperties (Since: 9.1)
              Availability: CONFIG_POSIX

              Properties for memory-backend-shm objects.

              This memory backend supports only shared memory, which is the default.

              Members

                     • The members of MemoryBackendProperties.

       Object MemoryBackendEpcProperties (Since: 6.2)
              Availability: CONFIG_LINUX

              Properties for memory-backend-epc objects.

              The merge boolean option is false by default with epc

              The dump boolean option is false by default with epc

              Members

                     • The members of MemoryBackendProperties.

       Object PrManagerHelperProperties (Since: 2.11)
              Availability: CONFIG_LINUX

              Properties for pr-manager-helper objects.

              Memberspath (string) -- the path to a Unix domain socket for connecting to the external helper

       Object QtestProperties (Since: 6.0)
              Properties for qtest objects.

              Memberschardev (string) -- the chardev to be used to receive qtest commands on.

                     • log (string, optional) -- the path to a log file

       Object RemoteObjectProperties (Since: 6.0)
              Properties for x-remote-object objects.

              Membersfd (string) -- file descriptor name previously passed via 'getfd' command

                     • devid (string) -- the id of the device to be associated with the file descriptor

       Object VfioUserServerProperties (Since: 7.1)
              Properties for x-vfio-user-server objects.

              Memberssocket (SocketAddress) -- socket to be used by the libvfio-user library

                     • device (string) -- the ID of the device to be emulated at the server

       Object IOMMUFDProperties (Since: 9.0)
              Properties for iommufd objects.

              Membersfd  (string,  optional)  --  file  descriptor name previously passed via 'getfd' command,
                       which represents a pre-opened /dev/iommu.  This allows the iommufd object  to  be  shared
                       across  several  subsystems  (VFIO, VDPA, ...), and the file descriptor to be shared with
                       other process, e.g. DPDK.  (default: QEMU opens /dev/iommu by itself)

       Object AcpiGenericInitiatorProperties (Since: 9.0)
              Properties for acpi-generic-initiator objects.

              Memberspci-dev (string) -- PCI device ID to be associated with the node

                     • node (int) -- NUMA node associated with the PCI device

       Object AcpiGenericPortProperties (Since: 9.2)
              Properties for acpi-generic-port objects.

              Memberspci-bus (string) -- QOM path of the PCI bus of the hostbridge associated with  this  SRAT
                       Generic  Port  Affinity  Structure.   This  is the same as the bus parameter for the root
                       ports attached to this host bridge.  The resulting SRAT Generic Port  Affinity  Structure
                       will refer to the ACPI object in DSDT that represents the host bridge (e.g.  ACPI0016 for
                       CXL host bridges).  See ACPI 6.5 Section 5.2.16.7 for more information.

                     • node  (int) -- Similar to a NUMA node ID, but instead of providing a reference point used
                       for defining NUMA distances and access characteristics to memory  or  from  an  initiator
                       (e.g.  CPU),  this  node defines the boundary point between non-discoverable system buses
                       which must be described by firmware, and a discoverable bus.  NUMA distances  and  access
                       characteristics  are  defined  to  and from that point.  For system software to establish
                       full  initiator  to  target  characteristics  this  information  must  be  combined  with
                       information  retrieved from the discoverable part of the path.  An example would use CDAT
                       (see UEFI.org) information read from  devices  and  switches  in  conjunction  with  link
                       characteristics  read  from  PCIe Configuration space.  To get the full path latency from
                       CPU to CXL attached DRAM CXL device:  Add the latency from CPU to Generic Port (from HMAT
                       indexed via the the node ID in this SRAT structure)  to  that  for  CXL  bus  links,  the
                       latency  across  intermediate  switches  and  from  the  EP  port  to  the actual memory.
                       Bandwidth is more complex as there may be interleaving across multiple devices and shared
                       links in the path.

       Object RngProperties (Since: 1.3)
              Properties for objects of classes derived from rng.

              Membersopened (boolean, optional) -- if true, the device is  opened  immediately  when  applying
                       this  option  and  will  probably  fail when processing the next option.  Don't use; only
                       provided for compatibility.  (default: false)

              Featuresdeprecated -- Member opened is deprecated.  Setting true doesn't make sense, and false is
                       already the default.

       Object RngEgdProperties (Since: 1.3)
              Properties for rng-egd objects.

              Memberschardev (string) -- the name of a character device backend that provides  the  connection
                       to the RNG daemon

                     • The members of RngProperties.

       Object RngRandomProperties (Since: 1.3)
              Availability: CONFIG_POSIX

              Properties for rng-random objects.

              Membersfilename  (string,  optional) -- the filename of the device on the host to obtain entropy
                       from (default: "/dev/urandom")

                     • The members of RngProperties.

       Object SevCommonProperties (Since: 9.1)
              Properties common to objects that are derivatives of sev-common.

              Memberssev-device (string, optional) -- SEV device to use (default: "/dev/sev")

                     • cbitpos (int, optional) -- C-bit location in page table entry (default: 0)

                     • reduced-phys-bits (int) -- number of bits in physical addresses that  become  unavailable
                       when SEV is enabled

                     • kernel-hashes  (boolean,  optional)  -- if true, add hashes of kernel/initrd/cmdline to a
                       designated guest firmware page for measured boot with  -kernel  (default:  false)  (since
                       6.2)

       Object SevGuestProperties (Since: 2.12)
              Properties for sev-guest objects.

              Membersdh-cert-file (string, optional) -- guest owners DH certificate (encoded with base64)

                     • session-file (string, optional) -- guest owners session parameters (encoded with base64)

                     • policy (int, optional) -- SEV policy value (default: 0x1)

                     • handle (int, optional) -- SEV firmware handle (default: 0)

                     • legacy-vm-type  (OnOffAuto,  optional)  --  Use  legacy  KVM_SEV_INIT  KVM  interface for
                       creating the VM.  The newer KVM_SEV_INIT2 interface, from Linux >= 6.10, syncs additional
                       vCPU state when initializing the VMSA structures, which will result in a different  guest
                       measurement.   Set this to 'on' to force compatibility with older QEMU or kernel versions
                       that rely on legacy KVM_SEV_INIT behavior.  'auto' will behave identically to  'on',  but
                       will  automatically  switch  to  using KVM_SEV_INIT2 if the user specifies any additional
                       options  that  require  it.   If  set  to  'off',   QEMU   will   require   KVM_SEV_INIT2
                       unconditionally.  (default: off) (since 9.1)

                     • The members of SevCommonProperties.

       Object SevSnpGuestProperties (Since: 9.1)
              Properties  for  sev-snp-guest  objects.   Most  of  these  are direct arguments for the KVM_SNP_*
              interfaces       documented       in       the       Linux       kernel        source        under
              Documentation/arch/x86/amd-memory-encryption.rst,  which  are  in  turn  closely  coupled with the
              SNP_INIT/SNP_LAUNCH_* firmware commands documented in the SEV-SNP Firmware ABI Specification  (Rev
              0.9).

              More usage information is also available in the QEMU source tree under docs/amd-memory-encryption.

              Memberspolicy  (int,  optional)  --  the  'POLICY' parameter to the SNP_LAUNCH_START command, as
                       defined in the SEV-SNP firmware ABI (default: 0x30000)

                     • guest-visible-workarounds (string, optional) -- 16-byte, base64-encoded  blob  to  report
                       hypervisor-defined   workarounds,   corresponding   to   the  'GOSVW'  parameter  of  the
                       SNP_LAUNCH_START command defined in the SEV-SNP firmware ABI (default: all-zero)

                     • id-block (string, optional) -- 96-byte, base64-encoded blob to  provide  the  'ID  Block'
                       structure for the SNP_LAUNCH_FINISH command defined in the SEV-SNP firmware ABI (default:
                       all-zero)

                     • id-auth  (string,  optional)  --  4096-byte,  base64-encoded  blob  to  provide  the  'ID
                       Authentication Information Structure' for the SNP_LAUNCH_FINISH command  defined  in  the
                       SEV-SNP firmware ABI (default: all-zero)

                     • author-key-enabled   (boolean,   optional)   --  true  if  'id-auth'  blob  contains  the
                       'AUTHOR_KEY' field defined SEV-SNP firmware ABI (default: false)

                     • host-data (string, optional) -- 32-byte, base64-encoded, user-defined blob to provide  to
                       the  guest,  as documented for the 'HOST_DATA' parameter of the SNP_LAUNCH_FINISH command
                       in the SEV-SNP firmware ABI (default: all-zero)

                     • vcek-disabled (boolean, optional) -- Guests are by default allowed to choose between VLEK
                       (Versioned Loaded  Endorsement  Key)  or  VCEK  (Versioned  Chip  Endorsement  Key)  when
                       requesting  attestation  reports  from  firmware.  Set this to true to disable the use of
                       VCEK.  (default: false) (since: 9.1)

                     • The members of SevCommonProperties.

       Object ThreadContextProperties (Since: 7.2)
              Properties for thread context objects.

              Memberscpu-affinity ([int], optional) -- the list of host CPU numbers used as CPU  affinity  for
                       all threads created in the thread context (default: QEMU main thread CPU affinity)

                     • node-affinity ([int], optional) -- the list of host node numbers that will be resolved to
                       a  list  of host CPU numbers used as CPU affinity.  This is a shortcut for specifying the
                       list of host CPU numbers belonging to the host nodes manually  by  setting  cpu-affinity.
                       (default: QEMU main thread affinity)

       Enum ObjectType (Since: 6.0)

              Valuesacpi-generic-initiator -- Not documented

                     • acpi-generic-port -- Not documented

                     • authz-list -- Not documented

                     • authz-listfile -- Not documented

                     • authz-pam -- Not documented

                     • authz-simple -- Not documented

                     • can-bus -- Not documented

                     • can-host-socketcan -- Not documented

                     • colo-compare -- Not documented

                     • cryptodev-backend -- Not documented

                     • cryptodev-backend-builtin -- Not documented

                     • cryptodev-backend-lkcf -- Not documented

                     • cryptodev-vhost-user -- Not documented

                     • dbus-vmstate -- Not documented

                     • filter-buffer -- Not documented

                     • filter-dump -- Not documented

                     • filter-mirror -- Not documented

                     • filter-redirector -- Not documented

                     • filter-replay -- Not documented

                     • filter-rewriter -- Not documented

                     • input-barrier -- Not documented

                     • input-linux -- Not documented

                     • iommufd -- Not documented

                     • iothread -- Not documented

                     • main-loop -- Not documented

                     • memory-backend-epc -- Not documented

                     • memory-backend-file -- Not documented

                     • memory-backend-memfd -- Not documented

                     • memory-backend-ram -- Not documented

                     • memory-backend-shm -- Not documented

                     • pef-guest -- Not documented

                     • pr-manager-helper -- Not documented

                     • qtest -- Not documented

                     • rng-builtin -- Not documented

                     • rng-egd -- Not documented

                     • rng-random -- Not documented

                     • secret -- Not documented

                     • secret_keyring -- Not documented

                     • sev-guest -- Not documented

                     • sev-snp-guest -- Not documented

                     • thread-context -- Not documented

                     • s390-pv-guest -- Not documented

                     • throttle-group -- Not documented

                     • tls-creds-anon -- Not documented

                     • tls-creds-psk -- Not documented

                     • tls-creds-x509 -- Not documented

                     • tls-cipher-suites -- Not documented

                     • x-remote-object -- Not documented

                     • x-vfio-user-server -- Not documented

              Featuresunstable -- Members x-remote-object and x-vfio-user-server are experimental.

       Object ObjectOptions (Since: 6.0)
              Describes the options of a user creatable QOM object.

              Membersqom-type (ObjectType) -- the class name for the object to be created

                     • id (string) -- the name of the new object

                     • When qom-type is acpi-generic-initiator: The members of AcpiGenericInitiatorProperties.

                     • When qom-type is acpi-generic-port: The members of AcpiGenericPortProperties.

                     • When qom-type is authz-list: The members of AuthZListProperties.

                     • When qom-type is authz-listfile: The members of AuthZListFileProperties.

                     • When qom-type is authz-pam: The members of AuthZPAMProperties.

                     • When qom-type is authz-simple: The members of AuthZSimpleProperties.

                     • When qom-type is can-host-socketcan: The members of CanHostSocketcanProperties.

                     • When qom-type is colo-compare: The members of ColoCompareProperties.

                     • When qom-type is cryptodev-backend: The members of CryptodevBackendProperties.

                     • When qom-type is cryptodev-backend-builtin: The members of CryptodevBackendProperties.

                     • When qom-type is cryptodev-backend-lkcf: The members of CryptodevBackendProperties.

                     • When qom-type is cryptodev-vhost-user: The members of CryptodevVhostUserProperties.

                     • When qom-type is dbus-vmstate: The members of DBusVMStateProperties.

                     • When qom-type is filter-buffer: The members of FilterBufferProperties.

                     • When qom-type is filter-dump: The members of FilterDumpProperties.

                     • When qom-type is filter-mirror: The members of FilterMirrorProperties.

                     • When qom-type is filter-redirector: The members of FilterRedirectorProperties.

                     • When qom-type is filter-replay: The members of NetfilterProperties.

                     • When qom-type is filter-rewriter: The members of FilterRewriterProperties.

                     • When qom-type is input-barrier: The members of InputBarrierProperties.

                     • When qom-type is input-linux: The members of InputLinuxProperties.

                     • When qom-type is iommufd: The members of IOMMUFDProperties.

                     • When qom-type is iothread: The members of IothreadProperties.

                     • When qom-type is main-loop: The members of MainLoopProperties.

                     • When qom-type is memory-backend-epc: The members of MemoryBackendEpcProperties.

                     • When qom-type is memory-backend-file: The members of MemoryBackendFileProperties.

                     • When qom-type is memory-backend-memfd: The members of MemoryBackendMemfdProperties.

                     • When qom-type is memory-backend-ram: The members of MemoryBackendProperties.

                     • When qom-type is memory-backend-shm: The members of MemoryBackendShmProperties.

                     • When qom-type is pr-manager-helper: The members of PrManagerHelperProperties.

                     • When qom-type is qtest: The members of QtestProperties.

                     • When qom-type is rng-builtin: The members of RngProperties.

                     • When qom-type is rng-egd: The members of RngEgdProperties.

                     • When qom-type is rng-random: The members of RngRandomProperties.

                     • When qom-type is secret: The members of SecretProperties.

                     • When qom-type is secret_keyring: The members of SecretKeyringProperties.

                     • When qom-type is sev-guest: The members of SevGuestProperties.

                     • When qom-type is sev-snp-guest: The members of SevSnpGuestProperties.

                     • When qom-type is thread-context: The members of ThreadContextProperties.

                     • When qom-type is throttle-group: The members of ThrottleGroupProperties.

                     • When qom-type is tls-creds-anon: The members of TlsCredsAnonProperties.

                     • When qom-type is tls-creds-psk: The members of TlsCredsPskProperties.

                     • When qom-type is tls-creds-x509: The members of TlsCredsX509Properties.

                     • When qom-type is tls-cipher-suites: The members of TlsCredsProperties.

                     • When qom-type is x-remote-object: The members of RemoteObjectProperties.

                     • When qom-type is x-vfio-user-server: The members of VfioUserServerProperties.

       Command object-add (Since: 2.0)
              Create a QOM object.

              Arguments

                     • The members of ObjectOptions.

              Errors

                     • Error if qom-type is not a valid class name

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "object-add",
                          "arguments": { "qom-type": "rng-random", "id": "rng1",
                                         "filename": "/dev/hwrng" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command object-del (Since: 2.0)
              Remove a QOM object.

              Argumentsid (string) -- the name of the QOM object to remove

              Errors

                     • Error if id is not a valid id for a QOM object

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "object-del", "arguments": { "id": "rng1" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

DEVICE INFRASTRUCTURE (QDEV)

       Command device-list-properties (Since: 1.2)
              List properties associated with a device.

              Argumentstypename (string) -- the type name of a device

              Return [ObjectPropertyInfo] -- a list of ObjectPropertyInfo describing a devices properties

              NOTE:
                 Objects  can  create  properties  at  runtime,  for example to describe links between different
                 devices and/or objects.  These properties are not included in the output of this command.

       Command device_add (Since: 0.13)
              Add a device.

              Argumentsdriver (string) -- the name of the new device's driver

                     • bus (string, optional) -- the device's parent bus (device tree path)

                     • id (string, optional) -- the device's ID, must be unique

              Featuresjson-cli -- If present, the "-device" command line option supports  JSON  syntax  with  a
                       structure identical to the arguments of this command.

                     • json-cli-hotplug  --  If  present, the "-device" command line option supports JSON syntax
                       without the reference counting leak that broke hot-unplug

                 Notes

                 1. Additional arguments depend on the type.

                 2. For detailed information about this command, please refer to the  'docs/qdev-device-use.txt'
                    file.

                 3. It's  possible  to  list  device  properties  by  running  QEMU with the -device DEVICE,help
                    command-line argument, where DEVICE is the device's name.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "device_add",
                          "arguments": { "driver": "e1000", "id": "net1",
                                         "bus": "pci.0",
                                         "mac": "52:54:00:12:34:56" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command device_del (Since: 0.14)
              Remove a device from a guest

              Argumentsid (string) -- the device's ID or QOM path

              Errors

                     • If id is not a valid device, DeviceNotFound

              NOTE:
                 When this command completes, the device may not be removed from the guest.  Hot removal  is  an
                 operation  that  requires guest cooperation.  This command merely requests that the guest begin
                 the hot removal process.   Completion  of  the  device  removal  process  is  signaled  with  a
                 DEVICE_DELETED  event.   Guest reset will automatically complete removal for all devices.  If a
                 guest-side error in the hot removal process is detected, the device will not be removed  and  a
                 DEVICE_UNPLUG_GUEST_ERROR event is sent.  Some errors cannot be detected.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "device_del",
                          "arguments": { "id": "net1" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "device_del",
                          "arguments": { "id": "/machine/peripheral-anon/device[0]" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Event DEVICE_DELETED (Since: 1.5)
              Emitted  whenever the device removal completion is acknowledged by the guest.  At this point, it's
              safe to reuse the specified device ID.  Device removal can be initiated by the guest or by HMP/QMP
              commands.

              Membersdevice (string, optional) -- the device's ID if it has one

                     • path (string) -- the device's QOM path

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "DEVICE_DELETED",
                          "data": { "device": "virtio-net-pci-0",
                                    "path": "/machine/peripheral/virtio-net-pci-0" },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }

       Event DEVICE_UNPLUG_GUEST_ERROR (Since: 6.2)
              Emitted when a device hot unplug fails due to a guest reported error.

              Membersdevice (string, optional) -- the device's ID if it has one

                     • path (string) -- the device's QOM path

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "DEVICE_UNPLUG_GUEST_ERROR",
                          "data": { "device": "core1",
                                    "path": "/machine/peripheral/core1" },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1615570772, "microseconds": 202844 } }

       Command device-sync-config (Since: 9.2)
              This command is unstable/experimental.

              Synchronize device configuration from host to guest part.  First, copy the configuration from  the
              host  part  (backend)  to  the  guest  part  (frontend).   Then  notify guest software that device
              configuration changed.

              The command may be used to notify the guest about block device capacity  change.   Currently  only
              vhost-user-blk device supports this.

              Argumentsid (string) -- the device's ID or QOM path

              Featuresunstable -- The command is experimental.

COMMON MACHINE TYPES

       Enum S390CpuEntitlement (Since: 8.2)
              An enumeration of CPU entitlements that can be assumed by a virtual S390 CPU

              Valuesauto -- Not documented

                     • low -- Not documented

                     • medium -- Not documented

                     • high -- Not documented

       Enum CpuTopologyLevel (Since: 9.2)
              An enumeration of CPU topology levels.

              Valuesthread  -- thread level, which would also be called SMT level or logical processor level.
                       The threads option in SMPConfiguration is used to configure the topology of this level.

                     • core -- core level.  The cores option  in  SMPConfiguration  is  used  to  configure  the
                       topology of this level.

                     • module  -- module level.  The modules option in SMPConfiguration is used to configure the
                       topology of this level.

                     • cluster -- cluster level.  The clusters option in SMPConfiguration is used  to  configure
                       the topology of this level.

                     • die  -- die level.  The dies option in SMPConfiguration is used to configure the topology
                       of this level.

                     • socket -- socket level, which would also be called package level.  The sockets option  in
                       SMPConfiguration is used to configure the topology of this level.

                     • book  --  book  level.   The  books  option  in SMPConfiguration is used to configure the
                       topology of this level.

                     • drawer -- drawer level.  The drawers option in SMPConfiguration is used to configure  the
                       topology of this level.

                     • default  -- default level.  Some architectures will have default topology settings (e.g.,
                       cache topology),  and  this  special  level  means  following  the  architecture-specific
                       settings.

       Enum CacheLevelAndType (Since: 9.2)
              Caches  a system may have.  The enumeration value here is the combination of cache level and cache
              type.

              Valuesl1d -- L1 data cache.

                     • l1i -- L1 instruction cache.

                     • l2 -- L2 (unified) cache.

                     • l3 -- L3 (unified) cache

       Object SmpCacheProperties (Since: 9.2)
              Cache information for SMP system.

              Memberscache (CacheLevelAndType) -- Cache name, which is the  combination  of  cache  level  and
                       cache type.

                     • topology  (CpuTopologyLevel)  --  Cache  topology  level.   It  accepts  the CPU topology
                       enumeration as the parameter, i.e., CPUs in the same topology container  share  the  same
                       cache.

       Object SmpCachePropertiesWrapper
              List wrapper of SmpCacheProperties.

              Memberscaches ([SmpCacheProperties]) -- the list of SmpCacheProperties.

              Since 9.2

MACHINES

       Enum SysEmuTarget (Since: 3.0)
              The  comprehensive  enumeration  of  QEMU  system emulation ("softmmu") targets.  Run "./configure
              --help" in the project root directory, and look for the *-softmmu targets near the "--target-list"
              option.  The individual target constants are not documented here, for the time being.

              Valuesrx -- since 5.0

                     • avr -- since 5.1

                     • loongarch64 -- since 7.1

                     • aarch64 -- Not documented

                     • alpha -- Not documented

                     • arm -- Not documented

                     • hppa -- Not documented

                     • i386 -- Not documented

                     • m68k -- Not documented

                     • microblaze -- Not documented

                     • microblazeel -- Not documented

                     • mips -- Not documented

                     • mips64 -- Not documented

                     • mips64el -- Not documented

                     • mipsel -- Not documented

                     • or1k -- Not documented

                     • ppc -- Not documented

                     • ppc64 -- Not documented

                     • riscv32 -- Not documented

                     • riscv64 -- Not documented

                     • s390x -- Not documented

                     • sh4 -- Not documented

                     • sh4eb -- Not documented

                     • sparc -- Not documented

                     • sparc64 -- Not documented

                     • tricore -- Not documented

                     • x86_64 -- Not documented

                     • xtensa -- Not documented

                     • xtensaeb -- Not documented

              NOTE:
                 The resulting QMP strings  can  be  appended  to  the  "qemu-system-"  prefix  to  produce  the
                 corresponding QEMU executable name.  This is true even for "qemu-system-x86_64".

       Enum S390CpuState (Since: 2.12)
              An enumeration of cpu states that can be assumed by a virtual S390 CPU

              Valuesuninitialized -- Not documented

                     • stopped -- Not documented

                     • check-stop -- Not documented

                     • operating -- Not documented

                     • load -- Not documented

       Object CpuInfoS390 (Since: 2.12)
              Additional information about a virtual S390 CPU

              Memberscpu-state (S390CpuState) -- the virtual CPU's state

                     • dedicated (boolean, optional) -- the virtual CPU's dedication (since 8.2)

                     • entitlement (S390CpuEntitlement, optional) -- the virtual CPU's entitlement (since 8.2)

       Object CpuInfoFast (Since: 2.12)
              Information about a virtual CPU

              Memberscpu-index (int) -- index of the virtual CPU

                     • qom-path (string) -- path to the CPU object in the QOM tree

                     • thread-id (int) -- ID of the underlying host thread

                     • props (CpuInstanceProperties, optional) -- properties associated with a virtual CPU, e.g.
                       the socket id

                     • target  (SysEmuTarget)  --  the  QEMU  system  emulation  target,  which determines which
                       additional fields will be listed (since 3.0)

                     • When target is s390x: The members of CpuInfoS390.

       Command query-cpus-fast (Since: 2.12)
              Returns information about all virtual CPUs.

              Return [CpuInfoFast] -- list of CpuInfoFast

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-cpus-fast" }
                     <- { "return": [
                             {
                                 "thread-id": 25627,
                                 "props": {
                                     "core-id": 0,
                                     "thread-id": 0,
                                     "socket-id": 0
                                 },
                                 "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]",
                                 "target":"x86_64",
                                 "cpu-index": 0
                             },
                             {
                                 "thread-id": 25628,
                                 "props": {
                                     "core-id": 0,
                                     "thread-id": 0,
                                     "socket-id": 1
                                 },
                                 "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[2]",
                                 "target":"x86_64",
                                 "cpu-index": 1
                             }
                         ]
                     }

       Object CompatProperty (Since: 9.1)
              Property default values specific to a machine type, for use by scripts/compare-machine-types.

              Membersqom-type (string) -- name of the QOM type to which the default applies

                     • property (string) -- name of its property to which the default applies

                     • value (string) -- the default value (machine-specific default can overwrite the "default"
                       default, to avoid this use -machine none)

       Object MachineInfo (Since: 1.2)
              Information describing a machine.

              Membersname (string) -- the name of the machine

                     • alias (string, optional) -- an alias for the machine name

                     • is-default (boolean, optional) -- whether the machine is default

                     • cpu-max (int) -- maximum number of CPUs supported by the machine type (since 1.5)

                     • hotpluggable-cpus (boolean) -- cpu hotplug via -device is supported (since 2.7)

                     • numa-mem-supported (boolean) -- true if '-numa  node,mem'  option  is  supported  by  the
                       machine type and false otherwise (since 4.1)

                     • deprecated  (boolean)  --  if  true, the machine type is deprecated and may be removed in
                       future versions of QEMU according to the QEMU deprecation policy (since 4.1)

                     • default-cpu-type (string, optional) -- default CPU model typename if  none  is  requested
                       via the -cpu argument.  (since 4.2)

                     • default-ram-id  (string, optional) -- the default ID of initial RAM memory backend (since
                       5.2)

                     • acpi (boolean) -- machine type supports ACPI (since 8.0)

                     • compat-props ([CompatProperty], optional) -- The machine type's compatibility properties.
                       Only present when query-machines argument compat-props is true.  (since 9.1)

              Featuresunstable -- Member compat-props is experimental.

       Command query-machines (Since: 1.2)
              Return a list of supported machines

              Argumentscompat-props (boolean, optional)  --  if  true,  also  return  compatibility  properties.
                       (default: false) (since 9.1)

              Featuresunstable -- Argument compat-props is experimental.

              Return [MachineInfo] -- a list of MachineInfo

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-machines", "arguments": { "compat-props": true } }
                     <- { "return": [
                               {
                                  "hotpluggable-cpus": true,
                                  "name": "pc-q35-6.2",
                                  "compat-props": [
                                       {
                                          "qom-type": "virtio-mem",
                                          "property": "unplugged-inaccessible",
                                          "value": "off"
                                       }
                                   ],
                                   "numa-mem-supported": false,
                                   "default-cpu-type": "qemu64-x86_64-cpu",
                                   "cpu-max": 288,
                                   "deprecated": false,
                                   "default-ram-id": "pc.ram"
                               },
                               ...
                        }

       Object CurrentMachineParams (Since: 4.0)
              Information describing the running machine parameters.

              Memberswakeup-suspend-support (boolean) -- true if the machine supports wake up from suspend

       Command query-current-machine (Since: 4.0)
              Return information on the current virtual machine.

              Return CurrentMachineParams -- CurrentMachineParams

       Object TargetInfo (Since: 1.2)
              Information describing the QEMU target.

              Membersarch (SysEmuTarget) -- the target architecture

       Command query-target (Since: 1.2)
              Return information about the target for this QEMU

              Return TargetInfo -- TargetInfo

       Object UuidInfo (Since: 0.14)
              Guest UUID information (Universally Unique Identifier).

              MembersUUID (string) -- the UUID of the guest

              NOTE:
                 If no UUID was specified for the guest, the nil UUID (all zeroes) is returned.

       Command query-uuid (Since: 0.14)
              Query the guest UUID information.

              Return UuidInfo -- The UuidInfo for the guest

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-uuid" }
                     <- { "return": { "UUID": "550e8400-e29b-41d4-a716-446655440000" } }

       Object GuidInfo (Since: 2.9)
              GUID information.

              Membersguid (string) -- the globally unique identifier

       Command query-vm-generation-id (Since: 2.9)
              Show Virtual Machine Generation ID

       Command system_reset (Since: 0.14)
              Performs a hard reset of a guest.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "system_reset" }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command system_powerdown (Since: 0.14)
              Requests that a guest perform a powerdown operation.

              NOTE:
                 A  guest may or may not respond to this command.  This command returning does not indicate that
                 a guest has accepted the request or that it has shut down.  Many guests will  respond  to  this
                 command by prompting the user in some way.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "system_powerdown" }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command system_wakeup (Since: 1.1)
              Wake   up   guest   from  suspend.   If  the  guest  has  wake-up  from  suspend  support  enabled
              (wakeup-suspend-support flag from query-current-machine), wake-up guest from suspend if the  guest
              is in SUSPENDED state.  Return an error otherwise.

              NOTE:
                 Prior to 4.0, this command does nothing in case the guest isn't suspended.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "system_wakeup" }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Enum LostTickPolicy (Since: 2.0)
              Policy for handling lost ticks in timer devices.  Ticks end up getting lost when, for example, the
              guest is paused.

              Valuesdiscard  -- throw away the missed ticks and continue with future injection normally.  The
                       guest OS will see the timer jump ahead by a potentially quite significant amount  all  at
                       once, as if the intervening chunk of time had simply not existed; needless to say, such a
                       sudden jump can easily confuse a guest OS which is not specifically prepared to deal with
                       it.   Assuming  the guest OS can deal correctly with the time jump, the time in the guest
                       and in the host should now match.

                     • delay -- continue to deliver ticks at the normal rate.  The  guest  OS  will  not  notice
                       anything  is  amiss, as from its point of view time will have continued to flow normally.
                       The time in the guest should now be behind the time in the host by exactly the amount  of
                       time during which ticks have been missed.

                     • slew  --  deliver ticks at a higher rate to catch up with the missed ticks.  The guest OS
                       will not notice anything is amiss, as from its point of view time will have continued  to
                       flow  normally.   Once  the timer has managed to catch up with all the missing ticks, the
                       time in the guest and in the host should match.

       Command inject-nmi (Since: 0.14)
              Injects a Non-Maskable Interrupt into the default CPU (x86/s390) or all CPUs (ppc64).  The command
              fails when the guest doesn't support injecting.

              NOTE:
                 Prior to 2.1, this command was only supported for x86 and s390 VMs.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "inject-nmi" }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Object KvmInfo (Since: 0.14)
              Information about support for KVM acceleration

              Membersenabled (boolean) -- true if KVM acceleration is active

                     • present (boolean) -- true if KVM acceleration is built into this executable

       Command query-kvm (Since: 0.14)
              Returns information about KVM acceleration

              Return KvmInfo -- KvmInfo

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-kvm" }
                     <- { "return": { "enabled": true, "present": true } }

       Enum NumaOptionsType (Since: 2.1)

              Valuesnode -- NUMA nodes configuration

                     • dist -- NUMA distance configuration (since 2.10)

                     • cpu -- property based CPU(s) to node mapping (Since: 2.10)

                     • hmat-lb -- memory latency and bandwidth information (Since: 5.0)

                     • hmat-cache -- memory side cache information (Since: 5.0)

       Object NumaOptions (Since: 2.1)
              A discriminated record of NUMA options.  (for OptsVisitor)

              Memberstype (NumaOptionsType) -- NUMA option type

                     • When type is node: The members of NumaNodeOptions.

                     • When type is dist: The members of NumaDistOptions.

                     • When type is cpu: The members of NumaCpuOptions.

                     • When type is hmat-lb: The members of NumaHmatLBOptions.

                     • When type is hmat-cache: The members of NumaHmatCacheOptions.

       Object NumaNodeOptions (Since: 2.1)
              Create a guest NUMA node.  (for OptsVisitor)

              Membersnodeid (int, optional) -- NUMA node ID (increase by 1 from 0 if omitted)

                     • cpus ([int], optional) -- VCPUs belonging to  this  node  (assign  VCPUS  round-robin  if
                       omitted)

                     • mem (int, optional) -- memory size of this node; mutually exclusive with memdev.  Equally
                       divide total memory among nodes if both mem and memdev are omitted.

                     • memdev  (string,  optional) -- memory backend object.  If specified for one node, it must
                       be specified for all nodes.

                     • initiator (int, optional) -- defined in ACPI 6.3 Chapter 5.2.27.3 Table 5-145, points  to
                       the  nodeid  which  has the memory controller responsible for this NUMA node.  This field
                       provides additional information as to the initiator node that is closest (as in  directly
                       attached) to this node, and therefore has the best performance (since 5.0)

       Object NumaDistOptions (Since: 2.10)
              Set the distance between 2 NUMA nodes.

              Memberssrc (int) -- source NUMA node.

                     • dst (int) -- destination NUMA node.

                     • val  (int)  --  NUMA  distance  from  source  node  to  destination node.  When a node is
                       unreachable from another node, set the distance between them to 255.

       Object CXLFixedMemoryWindowOptions (Since: 7.1)
              Create a CXL Fixed Memory Window

              Memberssize (int) -- Size of the Fixed Memory Window in bytes.  Must be a multiple of 256MiB.

                     • interleave-granularity (int, optional) -- Number of contiguous bytes for  which  accesses
                       will go to a given interleave target.  Accepted values [256, 512, 1k, 2k, 4k, 8k, 16k]

                     • targets  ([string])  --  Target  root  bridge  IDs from -device ...,id=<ID> for each root
                       bridge.

       Object CXLFMWProperties (Since: 7.1)
              List of CXL Fixed Memory Windows.

              Memberscxl-fmw ([CXLFixedMemoryWindowOptions]) -- List of CXLFixedMemoryWindowOptions

       Enum X86CPURegister32 (Since: 1.5)
              A X86 32-bit register

              ValuesEAX -- Not documented

                     • EBX -- Not documented

                     • ECX -- Not documented

                     • EDX -- Not documented

                     • ESP -- Not documented

                     • EBP -- Not documented

                     • ESI -- Not documented

                     • EDI -- Not documented

       Object X86CPUFeatureWordInfo (Since: 1.5)
              Information about a X86 CPU feature word

              Memberscpuid-input-eax (int) -- Input EAX value for CPUID instruction for that feature word

                     • cpuid-input-ecx (int, optional) -- Input ECX value for CPUID instruction for that feature
                       word

                     • cpuid-register (X86CPURegister32) -- Output register containing the feature bits

                     • features (int) -- value of output register, containing the feature bits

       Object DummyForceArrays (Since: 2.5)
              Not used by QMP; hack to let us use X86CPUFeatureWordInfoList internally

              Membersunused ([X86CPUFeatureWordInfo]) -- Not documented

       Object NumaCpuOptions (Since: 2.10)
              Option "-numa cpu" overrides default cpu to  node  mapping.   It  accepts  the  same  set  of  cpu
              properties as returned by query-hotpluggable-cpus[].props, where node-id could be used to override
              default node mapping.

              Members

                     • The members of CpuInstanceProperties.

       Enum HmatLBMemoryHierarchy (Since: 5.0)
              The  memory  hierarchy  in the System Locality Latency and Bandwidth Information Structure of HMAT
              (Heterogeneous Memory Attribute Table)

              For more information about HmatLBMemoryHierarchy, see chapter 5.2.27.4: Table 5-146: Field "Flags"
              of ACPI 6.3 spec.

              Valuesmemory -- the structure represents the memory performance

                     • first-level -- first level of memory side cache

                     • second-level -- second level of memory side cache

                     • third-level -- third level of memory side cache

       Enum HmatLBDataType (Since: 5.0)
              Data  type  in  the  System  Locality  Latency  and  Bandwidth  Information  Structure   of   HMAT
              (Heterogeneous Memory Attribute Table)

              For  more  information about HmatLBDataType, see chapter 5.2.27.4: Table 5-146:  Field "Data Type"
              of ACPI 6.3 spec.

              Valuesaccess-latency -- access latency (nanoseconds)

                     • read-latency -- read latency (nanoseconds)

                     • write-latency -- write latency (nanoseconds)

                     • access-bandwidth -- access bandwidth (Bytes per second)

                     • read-bandwidth -- read bandwidth (Bytes per second)

                     • write-bandwidth -- write bandwidth (Bytes per second)

       Object NumaHmatLBOptions (Since: 5.0)
              Set the system locality latency and bandwidth information between Initiator and  Target  proximity
              Domains.

              For more information about NumaHmatLBOptions, see chapter 5.2.27.4: Table 5-146 of ACPI 6.3 spec.

              Membersinitiator (int) -- the Initiator Proximity Domain.

                     • target (int) -- the Target Proximity Domain.

                     • hierarchy  (HmatLBMemoryHierarchy) -- the Memory Hierarchy.  Indicates the performance of
                       memory or side cache.

                     • data-type (HmatLBDataType) -- presents the type of data, access/read/write latency or hit
                       latency.

                     • latency (int, optional) -- the value  of  latency  from  initiator  to  target  proximity
                       domain, the latency unit is "ns(nanosecond)".

                     • bandwidth  (int,  optional)  --  the  value  of  bandwidth  between  initiator and target
                       proximity domain, the bandwidth unit is "Bytes per second".

       Enum HmatCacheAssociativity (Since: 5.0)
              Cache associativity in the Memory Side Cache Information Structure of HMAT

              For more information of HmatCacheAssociativity, see chapter 5.2.27.5:  Table  5-147  of  ACPI  6.3
              spec.

              Valuesnone  --  None  (no  memory  side  cache in this proximity domain, or cache associativity
                       unknown)

                     • direct -- Direct Mapped

                     • complex -- Complex Cache Indexing (implementation specific)

       Enum HmatCacheWritePolicy (Since: 5.0)
              Cache write policy in the Memory Side Cache Information Structure of HMAT

              For more information of HmatCacheWritePolicy, see chapter  5.2.27.5:  Table  5-147:  Field  "Cache
              Attributes" of ACPI 6.3 spec.

              Valuesnone  --  None  (no  memory  side  cache  in this proximity domain, or cache write policy
                       unknown)

                     • write-back -- Write Back (WB)

                     • write-through -- Write Through (WT)

       Object NumaHmatCacheOptions (Since: 5.0)
              Set the memory side cache information for a given memory domain.

              For more information of NumaHmatCacheOptions, see chapter  5.2.27.5:  Table  5-147:  Field  "Cache
              Attributes" of ACPI 6.3 spec.

              Membersnode-id (int) -- the memory proximity domain to which the memory belongs.

                     • size (int) -- the size of memory side cache in bytes.

                     • level (int) -- the cache level described in this structure.

                     • associativity      (HmatCacheAssociativity)      --      the     cache     associativity,
                       none/direct-mapped/complex(complex cache indexing).

                     • policy (HmatCacheWritePolicy) -- the write policy, none/write-back/write-through.

                     • line (int) -- the cache Line size in bytes.

       Command memsave (Since: 0.14)
              Save a portion of guest memory to a file.

              Argumentsval (int) -- the virtual address of the guest to start from

                     • size (int) -- the size of memory region to save

                     • filename (string) -- the file to save the memory to as binary data

                     • cpu-index (int, optional) -- the index of the virtual CPU  to  use  for  translating  the
                       virtual address (defaults to CPU 0)

              CAUTION:
                 Errors were not reliably returned until 1.1.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "memsave",
                          "arguments": { "val": 10,
                                         "size": 100,
                                         "filename": "/tmp/virtual-mem-dump" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command pmemsave (Since: 0.14)
              Save a portion of guest physical memory to a file.

              Argumentsval (int) -- the physical address of the guest to start from

                     • size (int) -- the size of memory region to save

                     • filename (string) -- the file to save the memory to as binary data

              CAUTION:
                 Errors were not reliably returned until 1.1.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "pmemsave",
                          "arguments": { "val": 10,
                                         "size": 100,
                                         "filename": "/tmp/physical-mem-dump" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Object Memdev (Since: 2.1)
              Information about memory backend

              Membersid (string, optional) -- backend's ID if backend has 'id' property (since 2.9)

                     • size (int) -- memory backend size

                     • merge (boolean) -- whether memory merge support is enabled

                     • dump (boolean) -- whether memory backend's memory is included in a core dump

                     • prealloc (boolean) -- whether memory was preallocated

                     • share (boolean) -- whether memory is private to QEMU or shared (since 6.1)

                     • reserve  (boolean,  optional)  --  whether  swap  space  (or  huge pages) was reserved if
                       applicable.  This corresponds to the user  configuration  and  not  the  actual  behavior
                       implemented  in the OS to perform the reservation.  For example, Linux will never reserve
                       swap space for shared file mappings.  (since 6.1)

                     • host-nodes ([int]) -- host nodes for its memory policy

                     • policy (HostMemPolicy) -- memory policy of memory backend

       Command query-memdev (Since: 2.1)
              Returns information for all memory backends.

              Return [Memdev] -- a list of Memdev.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-memdev" }
                     <- { "return": [
                            {
                              "id": "mem1",
                              "size": 536870912,
                              "merge": false,
                              "dump": true,
                              "prealloc": false,
                              "share": false,
                              "host-nodes": [0, 1],
                              "policy": "bind"
                            },
                            {
                              "size": 536870912,
                              "merge": false,
                              "dump": true,
                              "prealloc": true,
                              "share": false,
                              "host-nodes": [2, 3],
                              "policy": "preferred"
                            }
                          ]
                        }

       Object CpuInstanceProperties (Since: 2.7)
              Properties identifying a CPU.

              Which members are optional and which mandatory depends on the architecture and board.

              For s390x see CPU topology on s390x.

              The ids other than the node-id specify the position of the CPU within the CPU topology (as defined
              by the machine property "smp", thus see also type SMPConfiguration)

              Membersnode-id (int, optional) -- NUMA node ID the CPU belongs to

                     • drawer-id (int, optional) -- drawer number within CPU topology the CPU belongs to  (since
                       8.2)

                     • book-id  (int, optional) -- book number within parent container the CPU belongs to (since
                       8.2)

                     • socket-id (int, optional) -- socket number within parent container the CPU belongs to

                     • die-id (int, optional) -- die number within the  parent  container  the  CPU  belongs  to
                       (since 4.1)

                     • cluster-id  (int, optional) -- cluster number within the parent container the CPU belongs
                       to (since 7.1)

                     • module-id (int, optional) -- module number within the parent container the CPU belongs to
                       (since 9.1)

                     • core-id (int, optional) -- core number within the parent container the CPU belongs to

                     • thread-id (int, optional) -- thread number within the core the CPU  belongs to

       Object HotpluggableCPU (Since: 2.7)

              Memberstype (string) -- CPU object type for usage with device_add command

                     • props (CpuInstanceProperties) -- list of properties to pass for hotplugging  a  CPU  with
                       device_add

                     • vcpus-count (int) -- number of logical VCPU threads HotpluggableCPU provides

                     • qom-path  (string,  optional) -- link to existing CPU object if CPU is present or omitted
                       if CPU is not present.

              NOTE:
                 Management should be prepared to pass through additional properties with device_add.

       Command query-hotpluggable-cpus (Since: 2.7)

              Return [HotpluggableCPU] -- a list of HotpluggableCPU objects.

                 Example:

                        For pseries machine type started with -smp 2,cores=2,maxcpus=4 -cpu POWER8:

                     -> { "execute": "query-hotpluggable-cpus" }
                     <- {"return": [
                          { "props": { "core-id": 8 }, "type": "POWER8-spapr-cpu-core",
                            "vcpus-count": 1 },
                          { "props": { "core-id": 0 }, "type": "POWER8-spapr-cpu-core",
                            "vcpus-count": 1, "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]"}
                        ]}

                 Example:

                        For pc machine type started with -smp 1,maxcpus=2:

                     -> { "execute": "query-hotpluggable-cpus" }
                     <- {"return": [
                          {
                             "type": "qemu64-x86_64-cpu", "vcpus-count": 1,
                             "props": {"core-id": 0, "socket-id": 1, "thread-id": 0}
                          },
                          {
                             "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]",
                             "type": "qemu64-x86_64-cpu", "vcpus-count": 1,
                             "props": {"core-id": 0, "socket-id": 0, "thread-id": 0}
                          }
                        ]}

                 Example:

                        For s390x-virtio-ccw machine type started with -smp 1,maxcpus=2 -cpu qemu (Since: 2.11):

                     -> { "execute": "query-hotpluggable-cpus" }
                     <- {"return": [
                          {
                             "type": "qemu-s390x-cpu", "vcpus-count": 1,
                             "props": { "core-id": 1 }
                          },
                          {
                             "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]",
                             "type": "qemu-s390x-cpu", "vcpus-count": 1,
                             "props": { "core-id": 0 }
                          }
                        ]}

       Command set-numa-node (Since: 3.0)
              Runtime equivalent of '-numa' CLI option,  available  at  preconfigure  stage  to  configure  numa
              mapping before initializing machine.

              Arguments

                     • The members of NumaOptions.

       Command balloon (Since: 0.14)
              Request the balloon driver to change its balloon size.

              Argumentsvalue (int) --

                       the  target logical size of the VM in bytes.  We can deduce the size of the balloon using
                       this formula:
                          logical_vm_size = vm_ram_size - balloon_size

                       From it we have: balloon_size = vm_ram_size - value

              Errors

                     • If the balloon driver is enabled but not functional because the KVM kernel module  cannot
                       support it, KVMMissingCap

                     • If no balloon device is present, DeviceNotActive

              NOTE:
                 This  command  just  issues  a request to the guest.  When it returns, the balloon size may not
                 have changed.  A guest can change the balloon size independent of this command.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "balloon", "arguments": { "value": 536870912 } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

                 With a 2.5GiB guest this command inflated the ballon to 3GiB.

       Object BalloonInfo (Since: 0.14)
              Information about the guest balloon device.

              Membersactual (int) -- the logical size of the VM  in  bytes  Formula  used:  logical_vm_size  =
                       vm_ram_size - balloon_size

       Command query-balloon (Since: 0.14)
              Return information about the balloon device.

              Return BalloonInfo -- BalloonInfo

              Errors

                     • If  the balloon driver is enabled but not functional because the KVM kernel module cannot
                       support it, KVMMissingCap

                     • If no balloon device is present, DeviceNotActive

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-balloon" }
                     <- { "return": {
                              "actual": 1073741824
                           }
                        }

       Event BALLOON_CHANGE (Since: 1.2)
              Emitted when the guest changes the actual BALLOON level.  This value is equivalent to  the  actual
              field return by the 'query-balloon' command

              Membersactual  (int)  --  the  logical  size  of the VM in bytes Formula used: logical_vm_size =
                       vm_ram_size - balloon_size

              NOTE:
                 This event is rate-limited.

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "BALLOON_CHANGE",
                          "data": { "actual": 944766976 },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267020223, "microseconds": 435656 } }

       Object HvBalloonInfo (Since: 8.2)
              hv-balloon guest-provided memory status information.

              Memberscommitted (int) -- the amount of memory in use inside the guest plus the  amount  of  the
                       memory unusable inside the guest (ballooned out, offline, etc.)

                     • available  (int)  --  the  amount  of  the  memory  inside  the  guest  available for new
                       allocations ("free")

       Command query-hv-balloon-status-report (Since: 8.2)
              Returns the hv-balloon driver data contained in the last received "STATUS" message from the guest.

              Return HvBalloonInfo -- HvBalloonInfo

              Errors

                     • If no hv-balloon device is present, guest memory status reporting is not  enabled  or  no
                       guest memory status report received yet, GenericError

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-hv-balloon-status-report" }
                     <- { "return": {
                              "committed": 816640000,
                              "available": 3333054464
                           }
                        }

       Event HV_BALLOON_STATUS_REPORT (Since: 8.2)
              Emitted when the hv-balloon driver receives a "STATUS" message from the guest.

              NOTE:
                 This event is rate-limited.

              Members

                     • The members of HvBalloonInfo.

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "HV_BALLOON_STATUS_REPORT",
                          "data": { "committed": 816640000, "available": 3333054464 },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1600295492, "microseconds": 661044 } }

       Object MemoryInfo (Since: 2.11)
              Actual memory information in bytes.

              Membersbase-memory (int) -- size of "base" memory specified with command line option -m.

                     • plugged-memory  (int,  optional) -- size of memory that can be hot-unplugged.  This field
                       is omitted if target doesn't support memory hotplug (i.e.  CONFIG_MEM_DEVICE not  defined
                       at build time).

       Command query-memory-size-summary (Since: 2.11)
              Return the amount of initially allocated and present hotpluggable (if enabled) memory in bytes.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-memory-size-summary" }
                     <- { "return": { "base-memory": 4294967296, "plugged-memory": 0 } }

       Object PCDIMMDeviceInfo (Since: 2.1)
              PCDIMMDevice state information

              Membersid (string, optional) -- device's ID

                     • addr (int) -- physical address, where device is mapped

                     • size (int) -- size of memory that the device provides

                     • slot (int) -- slot number at which device is plugged in

                     • node (int) -- NUMA node number where device is plugged in

                     • memdev (string) -- memory backend linked with device

                     • hotplugged (boolean) -- true if device was hotplugged

                     • hotpluggable  (boolean)  --  true  if  device  if could be added/removed while machine is
                       running

       Object VirtioPMEMDeviceInfo (Since: 4.1)
              VirtioPMEM state information

              Membersid (string, optional) -- device's ID

                     • memaddr (int) -- physical address in memory, where device is mapped

                     • size (int) -- size of memory that the device provides

                     • memdev (string) -- memory backend linked with device

       Object VirtioMEMDeviceInfo (Since: 5.1)
              VirtioMEMDevice state information

              Membersid (string, optional) -- device's ID

                     • memaddr (int) -- physical address in memory, where device is mapped

                     • requested-size (int) -- the user requested size of the device

                     • size (int) -- the (current) size of memory that the device provides

                     • max-size (int) -- the maximum size of memory that the device can provide

                     • block-size (int) -- the block size of memory that the device provides

                     • node (int) -- NUMA node number where device is assigned to

                     • memdev (string) -- memory backend linked with the region

       Object SgxEPCDeviceInfo (Since: 6.2)
              Sgx EPC state information

              Membersid (string, optional) -- device's ID

                     • memaddr (int) -- physical address in memory, where device is mapped

                     • size (int) -- size of memory that the device provides

                     • memdev (string) -- memory backend linked with device

                     • node (int) -- the numa node (Since: 7.0)

       Object HvBalloonDeviceInfo (Since: 8.2)
              hv-balloon provided memory state information

              Membersid (string, optional) -- device's ID

                     • memaddr (int, optional) -- physical address in memory, where device is mapped

                     • max-size (int) -- the maximum size of memory that the device can provide

                     • memdev (string, optional) -- memory backend linked with device

       Enum MemoryDeviceInfoKind (Since: 2.1)

              Valuesnvdimm -- since 2.12

                     • virtio-pmem -- since 4.1

                     • virtio-mem -- since 5.1

                     • sgx-epc -- since 6.2.

                     • hv-balloon -- since 8.2.

                     • dimm -- Not documented

       Object PCDIMMDeviceInfoWrapper (Since: 2.1)

              Membersdata (PCDIMMDeviceInfo) -- PCDIMMDevice state information

       Object VirtioPMEMDeviceInfoWrapper (Since: 2.1)

              Membersdata (VirtioPMEMDeviceInfo) -- VirtioPMEM state information

       Object VirtioMEMDeviceInfoWrapper (Since: 2.1)

              Membersdata (VirtioMEMDeviceInfo) -- VirtioMEMDevice state information

       Object SgxEPCDeviceInfoWrapper (Since: 6.2)

              Membersdata (SgxEPCDeviceInfo) -- Sgx EPC state information

       Object HvBalloonDeviceInfoWrapper (Since: 8.2)

              Membersdata (HvBalloonDeviceInfo) -- hv-balloon provided memory state information

       Object MemoryDeviceInfo (Since: 2.1)
              Union containing information about a memory device

              Memberstype (MemoryDeviceInfoKind) -- memory device type

                     • When type is dimm: The members of PCDIMMDeviceInfoWrapper.

                     • When type is nvdimm: The members of PCDIMMDeviceInfoWrapper.

                     • When type is virtio-pmem: The members of VirtioPMEMDeviceInfoWrapper.

                     • When type is virtio-mem: The members of VirtioMEMDeviceInfoWrapper.

                     • When type is sgx-epc: The members of SgxEPCDeviceInfoWrapper.

                     • When type is hv-balloon: The members of HvBalloonDeviceInfoWrapper.

       Object SgxEPC (Since: 6.2)
              Sgx EPC cmdline information

              Membersmemdev (string) -- memory backend linked with device

                     • node (int) -- the numa node (Since: 7.0)

       Object SgxEPCProperties (Since: 6.2)
              SGX properties of machine types.

              Memberssgx-epc ([SgxEPC]) -- list of ids of memory-backend-epc objects.

       Command query-memory-devices (Since: 2.1)
              Lists available memory devices and their state

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-memory-devices" }
                     <- { "return": [ { "data":
                                           { "addr": 5368709120,
                                             "hotpluggable": true,
                                             "hotplugged": true,
                                             "id": "d1",
                                             "memdev": "/objects/memX",
                                             "node": 0,
                                             "size": 1073741824,
                                             "slot": 0},
                                        "type": "dimm"
                                      } ] }

       Event MEMORY_DEVICE_SIZE_CHANGE (Since: 5.1)
              Emitted when the size of a memory device changes.   Only  emitted  for  memory  devices  that  can
              actually change the size (e.g., virtio-mem due to guest action).

              Membersid (string, optional) -- device's ID

                     • size (int) -- the new size of memory that the device provides

                     • qom-path (string) -- path to the device object in the QOM tree (since 6.2)

              NOTE:
                 This event is rate-limited.

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "MEMORY_DEVICE_SIZE_CHANGE",
                          "data": { "id": "vm0", "size": 1073741824,
                                    "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[2]" },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1588168529, "microseconds": 201316 } }

       Object BootConfiguration (Since: 7.1)
              Schema for virtual machine boot configuration.

              Membersorder (string, optional) -- Boot order (a=floppy, c=hard disk, d=CD-ROM, n=network)

                     • once (string, optional) -- Boot order to apply on first boot

                     • menu (boolean, optional) -- Whether to show a boot menu

                     • splash  (string,  optional)  -- The name of the file to be passed to the firmware as logo
                       picture, if menu is true.

                     • splash-time (int, optional) -- How long to show the logo picture, in milliseconds

                     • reboot-timeout (int, optional) -- Timeout before guest reboots after boot fails

                     • strict (boolean, optional) -- Whether to attempt booting from devices not included in the
                       boot order

       Object SMPConfiguration (Since: 6.1)
              Schema for CPU topology configuration.  A missing value lets QEMU  figure  out  a  suitable  value
              based on the ones that are provided.

              The members other than cpus and maxcpus define a topology of containers.

              The  ordering  from highest/coarsest to lowest/finest is: drawers, books, sockets, dies, clusters,
              cores, threads.

              Different architectures support different subsets of topology containers.

              For example, s390x does not have clusters and dies, and the socket  is  the  parent  container  of
              cores.

              Memberscpus (int, optional) -- number of virtual CPUs in the virtual machine

                     • maxcpus  (int,  optional)  --  maximum number of hotpluggable virtual CPUs in the virtual
                       machine

                     • drawers (int, optional) -- number of drawers in the CPU topology (since 8.2)

                     • books (int, optional) -- number of books in the CPU topology (since 8.2)

                     • sockets (int, optional) -- number of sockets per parent container

                     • dies (int, optional) -- number of dies per parent container

                     • clusters (int, optional) -- number of clusters per parent container (since 7.0)

                     • modules (int, optional) -- number of modules per parent container (since 9.1)

                     • cores (int, optional) -- number of cores per parent container

                     • threads (int, optional) -- number of threads per core

       Command x-query-irq (Since: 6.2)
              This command is unstable/experimental.

              Query interrupt statistics

              Featuresunstable -- This command is meant for debugging.

              Return HumanReadableText -- interrupt statistics

       Command x-query-jit (Since: 6.2)
              This command is unstable/experimental.Availability: CONFIG_TCG

              Query TCG compiler statistics

              Featuresunstable -- This command is meant for debugging.

              Return HumanReadableText -- TCG compiler statistics

       Command x-query-numa (Since: 6.2)
              This command is unstable/experimental.

              Query NUMA topology information

              Featuresunstable -- This command is meant for debugging.

              Return HumanReadableText -- topology information

       Command x-query-opcount (Since: 6.2)
              This command is unstable/experimental.Availability: CONFIG_TCG

              Query TCG opcode counters

              Featuresunstable -- This command is meant for debugging.

              Return HumanReadableText -- TCG opcode counters

       Command x-query-ramblock (Since: 6.2)
              This command is unstable/experimental.

              Query system ramblock information

              Featuresunstable -- This command is meant for debugging.

              Return HumanReadableText -- system ramblock information

       Command x-query-roms (Since: 6.2)
              This command is unstable/experimental.

              Query information on the registered ROMS

              Featuresunstable -- This command is meant for debugging.

              Return HumanReadableText -- registered ROMs

       Command x-query-usb (Since: 6.2)
              This command is unstable/experimental.

              Query information on the USB devices

              Featuresunstable -- This command is meant for debugging.

              Return HumanReadableText -- USB device information

       Enum SmbiosEntryPointType (Since: 7.0)

              Values32 -- SMBIOS version 2.1 (32-bit) Entry Point

                     • 64 -- SMBIOS version 3.0 (64-bit) Entry Point

                     • auto -- Either 2.x or 3.x SMBIOS version, 2.x if configuration can be described by it and
                       3.x otherwise (since: 9.0)

       Object MemorySizeConfiguration (Since: 7.1)
              Schema for memory size configuration.

              Memberssize (int, optional) -- memory size in bytes

                     • max-size (int, optional) -- maximum hotpluggable memory size in bytes

                     • slots (int, optional) -- number of available memory slots for hotplug

       Command dumpdtb (Since: 7.2)
              Availability: CONFIG_FDT

              Save the FDT in dtb format.

              Argumentsfilename (string) -- name of the dtb file to be created

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "dumpdtb" }
                          "arguments": { "filename": "fdt.dtb" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command x-query-interrupt-controllers (Since: 9.1)
              This command is unstable/experimental.

              Query information on interrupt controller devices

              Featuresunstable -- This command is meant for debugging.

              Return HumanReadableText -- Interrupt controller devices information

       Object CpuModelInfo (Since: 2.8)
              Virtual CPU model.

              A CPU model consists of the name of a CPU definition, to which delta  changes  are  applied  (e.g.
              features  added/removed).   Most  magic values that an architecture might require should be hidden
              behind the name.  However, if required, architectures can expose relevant properties.

              Membersname (string) -- the name of the CPU definition the model is based on

                     • props (value, optional) -- a dictionary of QOM properties to be applied

       Enum CpuModelExpansionType (Since: 2.8)
              An enumeration of CPU model expansion types.

              Valuesstatic -- Expand to a static CPU model, a combination of a static  base  model  name  and
                       property  delta  changes.   As  the static base model will never change, the expanded CPU
                       model will be the same, independent of QEMU version, machine type, machine  options,  and
                       accelerator  options.   Therefore,  the  resulting  model  can be used by tooling without
                       having to specify a compatibility machine - e.g. when displaying the "host"  model.   The
                       static CPU models are migration-safe.

                     • full   --   Expand   all  properties.   The  produced  model  is  not  guaranteed  to  be
                       migration-safe, but allows tooling to get an insight and work with model details.

              NOTE:
                 When a non-migration-safe CPU model is expanded in static mode, some features  enabled  by  the
                 CPU  model  may  be omitted, because they can't be implemented by a static CPU model definition
                 (e.g.  cache  info  passthrough  and  PMU  passthrough  in  x86).   If  you  need  an  accurate
                 representation  of  the  features  enabled by a non-migration-safe CPU model, use full.  If you
                 need a static representation that will keep ABI compatibility even when changing  QEMU  version
                 or machine-type, use static (but keep in mind that some features may be omitted).

       Enum CpuModelCompareResult (Since: 2.8)
              An  enumeration  of CPU model comparison results.  The result is usually calculated using e.g. CPU
              features or CPU generations.

              Valuesincompatible -- If model A is incompatible to model B, model A is not guaranteed  to  run
                       where model B runs and the other way around.

                     • identical -- If model A is identical to model B, model A is guaranteed to run where model
                       B runs and the other way around.

                     • superset -- If model A is a superset of model B, model B is guaranteed to run where model
                       A runs.  There are no guarantees about the other way.

                     • subset  --  If model A is a subset of model B, model A is guaranteed to run where model B
                       runs.  There are no guarantees about the other way.

       Object CpuModelBaselineInfo (Since: 2.8)
              Availability: TARGET_S390X

              The result of a CPU model baseline.

              Membersmodel (CpuModelInfo) -- the baselined CpuModelInfo.

       Object CpuModelCompareInfo (Since: 2.8)
              Availability: TARGET_S390X

              The result of a CPU model comparison.

              Membersresult (CpuModelCompareResult) -- The result of the compare operation.

                     • responsible-properties ([string]) -- List of properties that led to the comparison result
                       not being identical.

              responsible-properties is a list of QOM property names that led to both CPUs not being detected as
              identical.  For identical models, this list is empty.  If a QOM property is read-only, that  means
              there's  no  known  way  to make the CPU models identical.  If the special property name "type" is
              included, the models are by definition not identical and cannot be made identical.

       Command query-cpu-model-comparison (Since: 2.8)
              Availability: TARGET_S390X

              Compares  two  CPU  models,  modela  and  modelb,  returning  how  they  compare  in  a   specific
              configuration.   The results indicates how both models compare regarding runnability.  This result
              can be used by tooling  to  make  decisions  if  a  certain  CPU  model  will  run  in  a  certain
              configuration or if a compatible CPU model has to be created by baselining.

              Usually, a CPU model is compared against the maximum possible CPU model of a certain configuration
              (e.g.  the "host" model for KVM).  If that CPU model is identical or a subset, it will run in that
              configuration.

              The result returned by this command may be affected by:

              • QEMU version: CPU models may look different depending on the  QEMU  version.   (Except  for  CPU
                models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.)

              • machine-type:  CPU  model  may  look  different  depending on the machine-type.  (Except for CPU
                models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.)

              • machine options (including accelerator): in some architectures, CPU models  may  look  different
                depending  on  machine  and accelerator options.  (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in
                query-cpu-definitions.)

              • "-cpu" arguments and global properties: arguments to the -cpu option and global  properties  may
                affect  expansion  of  CPU  models.   Using  query-cpu-model-expansion  while using these is not
                advised.

              Some architectures may not support comparing CPU models.  s390x supports comparing CPU models.

              Argumentsmodela (CpuModelInfo) -- description of the first CPU model to compare,  referred  to  as
                       "model A" in CpuModelCompareResult

                     • modelb  (CpuModelInfo)  -- description of the second CPU model to compare, referred to as
                       "model B" in CpuModelCompareResult

              Return CpuModelCompareInfo -- a CpuModelCompareInfo describing how both CPU models compare

              Errors

                     • if comparing CPU models is not supported

                     • if a model cannot be used

                     • if a model contains an unknown cpu definition name, unknown properties or properties with
                       wrong types.

              NOTE:
                 This command isn't specific to s390x, but is only implemented on this architecture currently.

       Command query-cpu-model-baseline (Since: 2.8)
              Availability: TARGET_S390X

              Baseline two CPU models, modela and modelb, creating a compatible third model.  The created  model
              will always be a static, migration-safe CPU model (see "static" CPU model expansion for details).

              This  interface  can  be used by tooling to create a compatible CPU model out two CPU models.  The
              created CPU model will be identical to or a  subset  of  both  CPU  models  when  comparing  them.
              Therefore, the created CPU model is guaranteed to run where the given CPU models run.

              The result returned by this command may be affected by:

              • QEMU  version:  CPU  models  may  look different depending on the QEMU version.  (Except for CPU
                models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.)

              • machine-type: CPU model may look different depending  on  the  machine-type.   (Except  for  CPU
                models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.)

              • machine  options  (including  accelerator): in some architectures, CPU models may look different
                depending on machine and accelerator options.  (Except for CPU models reported  as  "static"  in
                query-cpu-definitions.)

              • "-cpu"  arguments  and global properties: arguments to the -cpu option and global properties may
                affect expansion of CPU models.   Using  query-cpu-model-expansion  while  using  these  is  not
                advised.

              Some architectures may not support baselining CPU models.  s390x supports baselining CPU models.

              Argumentsmodela (CpuModelInfo) -- description of the first CPU model to baseline

                     • modelb (CpuModelInfo) -- description of the second CPU model to baseline

              Return CpuModelBaselineInfo -- a CpuModelBaselineInfo describing the baselined CPU model

              Errors

                     • if baselining CPU models is not supported

                     • if a model cannot be used

                     • if a model contains an unknown cpu definition name, unknown properties or properties with
                       wrong types.

              NOTE:
                 This command isn't specific to s390x, but is only implemented on this architecture currently.

       Object CpuModelExpansionInfo (Since: 2.8)
              Availability: TARGET_S390X or TARGET_I386 or TARGET_ARM or TARGET_LOONGARCH64 or TARGET_RISCV

              The result of a cpu model expansion.

              Membersmodel (CpuModelInfo) -- the expanded CpuModelInfo.

                     • deprecated-props ([string]) -- a list of properties that are flagged as deprecated by the
                       CPU  vendor.   The  list  depends on the CpuModelExpansionType: "static" properties are a
                       subset of the enabled-properties for the expanded model; "full" properties are a  set  of
                       properties that are deprecated across all models for the architecture.  (since: 9.1).

       Command query-cpu-model-expansion (Since: 2.8)
              Availability: TARGET_S390X or TARGET_I386 or TARGET_ARM or TARGET_LOONGARCH64 or TARGET_RISCV

              Expands  a  given  CPU  model,  model,  (or  a  combination  of CPU model + additional options) to
              different granularities, specified by type, allowing  tooling  to  get  an  understanding  what  a
              specific CPU model looks like in QEMU under a certain configuration.

              This interface can be used to query the "host" CPU model.

              The data returned by this command may be affected by:

              • QEMU  version:  CPU  models  may  look different depending on the QEMU version.  (Except for CPU
                models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.)

              • machine-type: CPU model may look different depending  on  the  machine-type.   (Except  for  CPU
                models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.)

              • machine  options  (including  accelerator): in some architectures, CPU models may look different
                depending on machine and accelerator options.  (Except for CPU models reported  as  "static"  in
                query-cpu-definitions.)

              • "-cpu"  arguments  and global properties: arguments to the -cpu option and global properties may
                affect expansion of CPU models.   Using  query-cpu-model-expansion  while  using  these  is  not
                advised.

              Some  architectures may not support all expansion types.  s390x supports "full" and "static".  Arm
              only supports "full".

              Argumentsmodel (CpuModelInfo) -- description of the CPU model to expand

                     • type (CpuModelExpansionType) -- expansion type, specifying how to expand the CPU model

              Return CpuModelExpansionInfo -- a CpuModelExpansionInfo describing the expanded CPU model

              Errors

                     • if expanding CPU models is not supported

                     • if the model cannot be expanded

                     • if the model contains an unknown CPU definition name, unknown  properties  or  properties
                       with a wrong type

                     • if an expansion type is not supported

       Object CpuDefinitionInfo (Since: 1.2)
              Availability:   TARGET_PPC  or  TARGET_ARM  or  TARGET_I386  or  TARGET_S390X  or  TARGET_MIPS  or
              TARGET_LOONGARCH64 or TARGET_RISCV

              Virtual CPU definition.

              Membersname (string) -- the name of the CPU definition

                     • migration-safe (boolean, optional) -- whether a CPU definition can  be  safely  used  for
                       migration  in  combination  with  a  QEMU  compatibility  machine  when migrating between
                       different QEMU versions and between hosts with different sets of (hardware  or  software)
                       capabilities.   If  not  provided,  information  is  not available and callers should not
                       assume the CPU definition to be migration-safe.  (since 2.8)

                     • static (boolean) -- whether a CPU definition is static and will not change  depending  on
                       QEMU  version,  machine type, machine options and accelerator options.  A static model is
                       always migration-safe.  (since 2.8)

                     • unavailable-features ([string], optional) -- List of  properties  that  prevent  the  CPU
                       model from running in the current host.  (since 2.8)

                     • typename (string) -- Type name that can be used as argument to device-list-properties, to
                       introspect properties configurable using -cpu or -global.  (since 2.9)

                     • alias-of  (string, optional) -- Name of CPU model this model is an alias for.  The target
                       of the CPU model alias may change depending on the machine type.  Management software  is
                       supposed to translate CPU model aliases in the VM configuration, because aliases may stop
                       being migration-safe in the future (since 4.1)

                     • deprecated  (boolean)  --  If true, this CPU model is deprecated and may be removed in in
                       some future version of QEMU according to the QEMU deprecation policy.  (since 5.2)

              unavailable-features is a list of QOM property names that  represent  CPU  model  attributes  that
              prevent  the  CPU from running.  If the QOM property is read-only, that means there's no known way
              to make the CPU model run in the  current  host.   Implementations  that  choose  not  to  provide
              specific  information  return  the  property name "type".  If the property is read-write, it means
              that it MAY be possible to run the CPU model in the current host  if  that  property  is  changed.
              Management  software can use it as hints to suggest or choose an alternative for the user, or just
              to  generate  meaningful  error  messages  explaining  why  the  CPU  model  can't  be  used.   If
              unavailable-features  is  an  empty  list,  the  CPU  model is runnable using the current host and
              machine-type.  If unavailable-features is not present, runnability information for the CPU is  not
              available.

       Command query-cpu-definitions (Since: 1.2)
              Availability:   TARGET_PPC  or  TARGET_ARM  or  TARGET_I386  or  TARGET_S390X  or  TARGET_MIPS  or
              TARGET_LOONGARCH64 or TARGET_RISCV

              Return a list of supported virtual CPU definitions

              Return [CpuDefinitionInfo] -- a list of CpuDefinitionInfo

       Enum S390CpuPolarization (Since: 8.2)
              Availability: TARGET_S390X

              An enumeration of CPU polarization that can be assumed by a virtual S390 CPU

              Valueshorizontal -- Not documented

                     • vertical -- Not documented

       Command set-cpu-topology (Since: 8.2)
              This command is unstable/experimental.Availability: TARGET_S390X and CONFIG_KVM

              Modify the topology by moving the CPU  inside  the  topology  tree,  or  by  changing  a  modifier
              attribute of a CPU.  Absent values will not be modified.

              Argumentscore-id (int) -- the vCPU ID to be moved

                     • socket-id (int, optional) -- destination socket to move the vCPU to

                     • book-id (int, optional) -- destination book to move the vCPU to

                     • drawer-id (int, optional) -- destination drawer to move the vCPU to

                     • entitlement (S390CpuEntitlement, optional) -- entitlement to set

                     • dedicated  (boolean,  optional)  --  whether  the  provisioning of real to virtual CPU is
                       dedicated

              Featuresunstable -- This command is experimental.

       Event CPU_POLARIZATION_CHANGE (Since: 8.2)
              This event is unstable/experimental.Availability: TARGET_S390X and CONFIG_KVM

              Emitted when the guest asks to change the polarization.

              The guest can tell the host (via the PTF instruction) whether the CPUs should be provisioned using
              horizontal or vertical polarization.

              On horizontal polarization the host is expected to provision all vCPUs equally.

              On vertical polarization the host can  provision  each  vCPU  differently.   The  guest  will  get
              information on the details of the provisioning the next time it uses the STSI(15) instruction.

              Memberspolarization (S390CpuPolarization) -- polarization specified by the guest

              Featuresunstable -- This event is experimental.

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "CPU_POLARIZATION_CHANGE",
                          "data": { "polarization": "horizontal" },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1401385907, "microseconds": 422329 } }

       Object CpuPolarizationInfo (Since: 8.2)
              Availability: TARGET_S390X and CONFIG_KVM

              The result of a CPU polarization query.

              Memberspolarization (S390CpuPolarization) -- the CPU polarization

       Command query-s390x-cpu-polarization (Since: 8.2)
              This command is unstable/experimental.Availability: TARGET_S390X and CONFIG_KVM.INDENT 7.0

       Featuresunstable -- This command is experimental.

       Return CpuPolarizationInfo -- the machine's CPU polarization

RECORD/REPLAY

       Enum ReplayMode (Since: 2.5)
              Mode of the replay subsystem.

              Valuesnone -- normal execution mode.  Replay or record are not enabled.

                     • record -- record mode.  All non-deterministic data is written into the replay log.

                     • play  --  replay mode.  Non-deterministic data required for system execution is read from
                       the log.

       Object ReplayInfo (Since: 5.2)
              Record/replay information.

              Membersmode (ReplayMode) -- current mode.

                     • filename (string, optional) -- name of the record/replay log file.  It is present only in
                       record or replay modes, when the log is recorded or replayed.

                     • icount (int) -- current number of executed instructions.

       Command query-replay (Since: 5.2)
              Retrieve the record/replay information.  It includes current instruction count which may  be  used
              for replay-break and replay-seek commands.

              Return ReplayInfo -- record/replay information.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-replay" }
                     <- { "return": { "mode": "play", "filename": "log.rr", "icount": 220414 } }

       Command replay-break (Since: 5.2)
              Set replay breakpoint at instruction count icount.  Execution stops when the specified instruction
              is  reached.   There  can  be  at  most  one breakpoint.  When breakpoint is set, any prior one is
              removed.  The breakpoint may be set only in  replay  mode  and  only  "in  the  future",  i.e.  at
              instruction  counts  greater  than the current one.  The current instruction count can be observed
              with query-replay.

              Argumentsicount (int) -- instruction count to stop at

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "replay-break", "arguments": { "icount": 220414 } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command replay-delete-break (Since: 5.2)
              Remove replay breakpoint which was set with replay-break.  The command is ignored when  there  are
              no replay breakpoints.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "replay-delete-break" }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command replay-seek (Since: 5.2)
              Automatically  proceed to the instruction count icount, when replaying the execution.  The command
              automatically loads nearest snapshot and replays the execution to find  the  desired  instruction.
              When  there  is  no  preceding  snapshot or the execution is not replayed, then the command fails.
              Instruction count can be obtained with the query-replay command.

              Argumentsicount (int) -- target instruction count

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "replay-seek", "arguments": { "icount": 220414 } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

YANK FEATURE

       Enum YankInstanceType (Since: 6.0)
              An enumeration of yank instance types.  See YankInstance for more information.

              Valuesblock-node -- Not documented

                     • chardev -- Not documented

                     • migration -- Not documented

       Object YankInstanceBlockNode (Since: 6.0)
              Specifies which block graph node to yank.  See YankInstance for more information.

              Membersnode-name (string) -- the name of the block graph node

       Object YankInstanceChardev (Since: 6.0)
              Specifies which character device to yank.  See YankInstance for more information.

              Membersid (string) -- the chardev's ID

       Object YankInstance (Since: 6.0)
              A yank instance can be yanked with the yank qmp command to recover from a hanging QEMU.

              Memberstype (YankInstanceType) -- yank instance type

                     • When type is block-node: The members of YankInstanceBlockNode.

                     • When type is chardev: The members of YankInstanceChardev.

              Currently implemented yank instances:

              • nbd block device: Yanking it will shut down the connection to the nbd server without  attempting
                to reconnect.

              • socket chardev: Yanking it will shut down the connected socket.

              • migration:  Yanking it will shut down all migration connections.  Unlike migrate_cancel, it will
                not notify the migration process, so migration will go into failed state, instead  of  cancelled
                state.  yank should be used to recover from hangs.

       Command yank (Since: 6.0)
              Try  to  recover  from hanging QEMU by yanking the specified instances.  See YankInstance for more
              information.

              Argumentsinstances ([YankInstance]) -- the instances to be yanked

              Errors

                     • If any of the YankInstances doesn't exist, DeviceNotFound

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "yank",
                          "arguments": {
                              "instances": [
                                   { "type": "block-node",
                                     "node-name": "nbd0" }
                              ] } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command query-yank (Since: 6.0)
              Query yank instances.  See YankInstance for more information.

              Return [YankInstance] -- list of YankInstance

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-yank" }
                     <- { "return": [
                              { "type": "block-node",
                                "node-name": "nbd0" }
                          ] }

MISCELLANEA

       Command add_client (Since: 0.14)
              Allow client connections for VNC, Spice and socket based character devices to be passed in to QEMU
              via SCM_RIGHTS.

              If the FD associated with fdname is not a socket, the command will fail and the FD will be closed.

              Argumentsprotocol (string) -- protocol name.  Valid names are "vnc",  "spice",  "dbus-display"  or
                       the name of a character device (e.g. from -chardev id=XXXX)

                     • fdname (string) -- file descriptor name previously passed via 'getfd' command

                     • skipauth  (boolean,  optional)  -- whether to skip authentication.  Only applies to "vnc"
                       and "spice" protocols

                     • tls (boolean, optional) -- whether to perform TLS.  Only applies to the "spice" protocol

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "add_client", "arguments": { "protocol": "vnc",
                                                                  "fdname": "myclient" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Object NameInfo (Since: 0.14)
              Guest name information.

              Membersname (string, optional) -- The name of the guest

       Command query-name (Since: 0.14)
              Return the name information of a guest.

              Return NameInfo -- NameInfo of the guest

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-name" }
                     <- { "return": { "name": "qemu-name" } }

       Object IOThreadInfo (Since: 2.0)
              Information about an iothread

              Membersid (string) -- the identifier of the iothread

                     • thread-id (int) -- ID of the underlying host thread

                     • poll-max-ns (int) -- maximum polling time in ns, 0 means polling is disabled (since 2.9)

                     • poll-grow (int) -- how many ns will be added to polling  time,  0  means  that  it's  not
                       configured (since 2.9)

                     • poll-shrink (int) -- how many ns will be removed from polling time, 0 means that it's not
                       configured (since 2.9)

                     • aio-max-batch  (int) -- maximum number of requests in a batch for the AIO engine, 0 means
                       that the engine will use its default (since 6.1)

       Command query-iothreads (Since: 2.0)
              Returns a list of information about each iothread.

              NOTE:
                 This list excludes the QEMU main loop thread, which is not declared using the -object  iothread
                 command-line option.  It is always the main thread of the process.

              Return [IOThreadInfo] -- a list of IOThreadInfo for each iothread

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-iothreads" }
                     <- { "return": [
                              {
                                 "id":"iothread0",
                                 "thread-id":3134
                              },
                              {
                                 "id":"iothread1",
                                 "thread-id":3135
                              }
                           ]
                        }

       Command stop (Since: 0.14)
              Stop guest VM execution.

              NOTE:
                 This  function  will succeed even if the guest is already in the stopped state.  In "inmigrate"
                 state, it will ensure that the guest remains paused once  migration  finishes,  as  if  the  -S
                 option was passed on the command line.

                 In the "suspended" state, it will completely stop the VM and cause a transition to the "paused"
                 state.  (Since 9.0)

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "stop" }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command cont (Since: 0.14)
              Resume guest VM execution.

              NOTE:
                 This command will succeed if the guest is currently running.  It will also succeed if the guest
                 is  in the "inmigrate" state; in this case, the effect of the command is to make sure the guest
                 starts once migration finishes, removing the effect of the -S command line  option  if  it  was
                 passed.

                 If  the  VM was previously suspended, and not been reset or woken, this command will transition
                 back to the "suspended" state.  (Since 9.0)

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "cont" }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command x-exit-preconfig (Since: 3.0)
              This command is unstable/experimental.

              Exit from "preconfig" state

              This command makes QEMU exit  the  preconfig  state  and  proceed  with  VM  initialization  using
              configuration  data  provided  on  the  command  line and via the QMP monitor during the preconfig
              state.  The command is only available during  the  preconfig  state  (i.e.  when  the  --preconfig
              command line option was in use).

              Featuresunstable -- This command is experimental.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "x-exit-preconfig" }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command human-monitor-command (Since: 0.14)
              Execute a command on the human monitor and return the output.

              Argumentscommand-line (string) -- the command to execute in the human monitor

                     • cpu-index (int, optional) -- The CPU to use for commands that require an implicit CPU

              Featuressavevm-monitor-nodes -- If present, HMP command savevm only snapshots monitor-owned nodes
                       if they have no parents.  This allows the use of 'savevm' with -blockdev.  (since 4.2)

              Return string -- the output of the command as a string

              NOTE:
                 This  command only exists as a stop-gap.  Its use is highly discouraged.  The semantics of this
                 command are not guaranteed: this means that command names, arguments and responses  can  change
                 or be removed at ANY time.  Applications that rely on long term stability guarantees should NOT
                 use this command.

                 Known limitations:

                 • This command is stateless, this means that commands that depend on state information (such as
                   getfd) might not work.

                 • Commands that prompt the user for data don't currently work.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "human-monitor-command",
                          "arguments": { "command-line": "info kvm" } }
                     <- { "return": "kvm support: enabled\r\n" }

       Command getfd (Since: 0.14)
              Availability: CONFIG_POSIX

              Receive a file descriptor via SCM rights and assign it a name

              Argumentsfdname (string) -- file descriptor name

              NOTE:
                 If fdname already exists, the file descriptor assigned to it will be closed and replaced by the
                 received file descriptor.

                 The  'closefd' command can be used to explicitly close the file descriptor when it is no longer
                 needed.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "getfd", "arguments": { "fdname": "fd1" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command get-win32-socket (Since: 8.0)
              Availability: CONFIG_WIN32

              Add a socket that was duplicated to QEMU process  with  WSADuplicateSocketW()  via  WSASocket()  &
              WSAPROTOCOL_INFOW  structure  and  assign  it  a  name  (the  SOCKET is associated with a CRT file
              descriptor)

              Argumentsinfo (string) -- the WSAPROTOCOL_INFOW structure (encoded in base64)

                     • fdname (string) -- file descriptor name

              NOTE:
                 If fdname already exists, the file descriptor assigned to it will be closed and replaced by the
                 received file descriptor.

                 The 'closefd' command can be used to explicitly close the file descriptor when it is no  longer
                 needed.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "get-win32-socket",
                          "arguments": { "info": "abcd123..", "fdname": "skclient" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Command closefd (Since: 0.14)
              Close a file descriptor previously passed via SCM rights

              Argumentsfdname (string) -- file descriptor name

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "closefd", "arguments": { "fdname": "fd1" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Object AddfdInfo (Since: 1.2)
              Information about a file descriptor that was added to an fd set.

              Membersfdset-id (int) -- The ID of the fd set that fd was added to.

                     • fd (int) -- The file descriptor that was received via SCM rights and added to the fd set.

       Command add-fd (Since: 1.2)
              Add a file descriptor, that was passed via SCM rights, to an fd set.

              Argumentsfdset-id (int, optional) -- The ID of the fd set to add the file descriptor to.

                     • opaque (string, optional) -- A free-form string that can be used to describe the fd.

              Return AddfdInfo -- AddfdInfo

              Errors

                     • If file descriptor was not received, GenericError

                     • If fdset-id is a negative value, GenericError

              NOTE:
                 The list of fd sets is shared by all monitor connections.

              NOTE:
                 If fdset-id is not specified, a new fd set will be created.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "add-fd", "arguments": { "fdset-id": 1 } }
                     <- { "return": { "fdset-id": 1, "fd": 3 } }

       Command remove-fd (Since: 1.2)
              Remove a file descriptor from an fd set.

              Argumentsfdset-id (int) -- The ID of the fd set that the file descriptor belongs to.

                     • fd (int, optional) -- The file descriptor that is to be removed.

              Errors

                     • If fdset-id or fd is not found, GenericError

              NOTE:
                 The list of fd sets is shared by all monitor connections.

              NOTE:
                 If fd is not specified, all file descriptors in fdset-id will be removed.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "remove-fd", "arguments": { "fdset-id": 1, "fd": 3 } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Object FdsetFdInfo (Since: 1.2)
              Information about a file descriptor that belongs to an fd set.

              Membersfd (int) -- The file descriptor value.

                     • opaque (string, optional) -- A free-form string that can be used to describe the fd.

       Object FdsetInfo (Since: 1.2)
              Information about an fd set.

              Membersfdset-id (int) -- The ID of the fd set.

                     • fds ([FdsetFdInfo]) -- A list of file descriptors that belong to this fd set.

       Command query-fdsets (Since: 1.2)
              Return information describing all fd sets.

              Return [FdsetInfo] -- A list of FdsetInfo

              NOTE:
                 The list of fd sets is shared by all monitor connections.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-fdsets" }
                     <- { "return": [
                            {
                              "fds": [
                                {
                                  "fd": 30,
                                  "opaque": "rdonly:/path/to/file"
                                },
                                {
                                  "fd": 24,
                                  "opaque": "rdwr:/path/to/file"
                                }
                              ],
                              "fdset-id": 1
                            },
                            {
                              "fds": [
                                {
                                  "fd": 28
                                },
                                {
                                  "fd": 29
                                }
                              ],
                              "fdset-id": 0
                            }
                          ]
                        }

       Enum CommandLineParameterType (Since: 1.5)
              Possible types for an option parameter.

              Valuesstring -- accepts a character string

                     • boolean -- accepts "on" or "off"

                     • number -- accepts a number

                     • size -- accepts a number followed by an optional suffix (K)ilo, (M)ega, (G)iga, (T)era

       Object CommandLineParameterInfo (Since: 1.5)
              Details about a single parameter of a command line option.

              Membersname (string) -- parameter name

                     • type (CommandLineParameterType) -- parameter CommandLineParameterTypehelp (string, optional) -- human readable text string, not suitable for parsing.

                     • default (string, optional) -- default value string (since 2.1)

       Object CommandLineOptionInfo (Since: 1.5)
              Details about a command line option, including its list of parameter details

              Membersoption (string) -- option name

                     • parameters ([CommandLineParameterInfo]) -- an array of CommandLineParameterInfo

       Command query-command-line-options (Since: 1.5)
              Query command line option schema.

              Argumentsoption (string, optional) -- option name

              Return [CommandLineOptionInfo]  -- list of CommandLineOptionInfo for all options (or for the given
                     option).

              Errors

                     • if the given option doesn't exist

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-command-line-options",
                          "arguments": { "option": "option-rom" } }
                     <- { "return": [
                             {
                                 "parameters": [
                                     {
                                         "name": "romfile",
                                         "type": "string"
                                     },
                                     {
                                         "name": "bootindex",
                                         "type": "number"
                                     }
                                 ],
                                 "option": "option-rom"
                             }
                          ]
                        }

       Event RTC_CHANGE (Since: 0.13)
              Emitted when the guest changes the RTC time.

              Membersoffset (int) -- offset in seconds between base RTC clock (as specified by -rtc base), and
                       new RTC clock value

                     • qom-path (string) -- path to the RTC object in the QOM tree

              NOTE:
                 This event is rate-limited.  It is not guaranteed that the RTC in the  system  implements  this
                 event, or even that the system has an RTC at all.

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "RTC_CHANGE",
                          "data": { "offset": 78 },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267020223, "microseconds": 435656 } }

       Event VFU_CLIENT_HANGUP (Since: 7.1)
              Emitted when the client of a TYPE_VFIO_USER_SERVER closes the communication channel

              Membersvfu-id  (string)  -- ID of the TYPE_VFIO_USER_SERVER object.  It is the last component of
                       vfu-qom-path referenced below

                     • vfu-qom-path (string) -- path to the TYPE_VFIO_USER_SERVER object in the QOM tree

                     • dev-id (string) -- ID of attached PCI device

                     • dev-qom-path (string) -- path to attached PCI device in the QOM tree

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "VFU_CLIENT_HANGUP",
                          "data": { "vfu-id": "vfu1",
                                    "vfu-qom-path": "/objects/vfu1",
                                    "dev-id": "sas1",
                                    "dev-qom-path": "/machine/peripheral/sas1" },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }

       Command rtc-reset-reinjection (Since: 2.1)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              This command will reset the RTC interrupt reinjection backlog.  Can be used if  another  mechanism
              to synchronize guest time is in effect, for example QEMU guest agent's guest-set-time command.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "rtc-reset-reinjection" }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Enum SevState (Since: 2.12)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              An enumeration of SEV state information used during query-sev.

              Valuesuninit -- The guest is uninitialized.

                     • launch-update -- The guest is currently being launched; plaintext data and register state
                       is being imported.

                     • launch-secret  --  The  guest  is  currently  being  launched;  ciphertext  data is being
                       imported.

                     • running -- The guest is fully launched or migrated in.

                     • send-update -- The guest is currently being migrated out to another machine.

                     • receive-update -- The guest is currently being migrated from another machine.

       Enum SevGuestType (Since: 6.2)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              An enumeration indicating the type of SEV guest being run.

              Valuessev -- The guest is a legacy SEV or SEV-ES guest.

                     • sev-snp -- The guest is an SEV-SNP guest.

       Object SevGuestInfo (Since: 2.12)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              Information specific to legacy SEV/SEV-ES guests.

              Memberspolicy (int) -- SEV policy value

                     • handle (int) -- SEV firmware handle

       Object SevSnpGuestInfo (Since: 9.1)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              Information specific to SEV-SNP guests.

              Memberssnp-policy (int) -- SEV-SNP policy value

       Object SevInfo (Since: 2.12)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              Information about Secure Encrypted Virtualization (SEV) support

              Membersenabled (boolean) -- true if SEV is active

                     • api-major (int) -- SEV API major version

                     • api-minor (int) -- SEV API minor version

                     • build-id (int) -- SEV FW build id

                     • state (SevState) -- SEV guest state

                     • sev-type (SevGuestType) -- Type of SEV guest being run

                     • When sev-type is sev: The members of SevGuestInfo.

                     • When sev-type is sev-snp: The members of SevSnpGuestInfo.

       Command query-sev (Since: 2.12)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              Returns information about SEV

              Return SevInfo -- SevInfo

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-sev" }
                     <- { "return": { "enabled": true, "api-major" : 0, "api-minor" : 0,
                                      "build-id" : 0, "policy" : 0, "state" : "running",
                                      "handle" : 1 } }

       Object SevLaunchMeasureInfo (Since: 2.12)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              SEV Guest Launch measurement information

              Membersdata (string) -- the measurement value encoded in base64

       Command query-sev-launch-measure (Since: 2.12)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              Query the SEV guest launch information.

              Return SevLaunchMeasureInfo -- The SevLaunchMeasureInfo for the guest

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-sev-launch-measure" }
                     <- { "return": { "data": "4l8LXeNlSPUDlXPJG5966/8%YZ" } }

       Object SevCapability (Since: 2.12)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              The struct describes capability for a Secure Encrypted Virtualization feature.

              Memberspdh (string) -- Platform Diffie-Hellman key (base64 encoded)

                     • cert-chain (string) -- PDH certificate chain (base64 encoded)

                     • cpu0-id (string) -- Unique ID of CPU0 (base64 encoded) (since 7.1)

                     • cbitpos (int) -- C-bit location in page table entry

                     • reduced-phys-bits (int) -- Number of physical Address bit reduction when SEV is enabled

       Command query-sev-capabilities (Since: 2.12)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              This command is used to get the SEV capabilities, and is supported on AMD X86 platforms only.

              Return SevCapability -- SevCapability objects.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-sev-capabilities" }
                     <- { "return": { "pdh": "8CCDD8DDD", "cert-chain": "888CCCDDDEE",
                                      "cpu0-id": "2lvmGwo+...61iEinw==",
                                      "cbitpos": 47, "reduced-phys-bits": 1}}

       Command sev-inject-launch-secret (Since: 6.0)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              This command injects a secret blob into memory of SEV guest.

              Argumentspacket-header (string) -- the launch secret packet header encoded in base64

                     • secret (string) -- the launch secret data to be injected encoded in base64

                     • gpa (int, optional) -- the guest physical address where secret will be injected.

       Object SevAttestationReport (Since: 6.1)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              The struct describes attestation report for a Secure Encrypted Virtualization feature.

              Membersdata (string) -- guest attestation report (base64 encoded)

       Command query-sev-attestation-report (Since: 6.1)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              This command is used to get the SEV attestation report, and is  supported  on  AMD  X86  platforms
              only.

              Argumentsmnonce  (string)  --  a  random  16 bytes value encoded in base64 (it will be included in
                       report)

              Return SevAttestationReport -- SevAttestationReport objects.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute" : "query-sev-attestation-report",
                                      "arguments": { "mnonce": "aaaaaaa" } }
                     <- { "return" : { "data": "aaaaaaaabbbddddd"} }

       Command dump-skeys (Since: 2.5)
              Availability: TARGET_S390X

              Dump guest's storage keys

              Argumentsfilename (string) -- the path to the file to dump to

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "dump-skeys",
                          "arguments": { "filename": "/tmp/skeys" } }
                     <- { "return": {} }

       Object GICCapability (Since: 2.6)
              Availability: TARGET_ARM

              The struct describes capability for a specific GIC (Generic Interrupt Controller) version.   These
              bits  are not only decided by QEMU/KVM software version, but also decided by the hardware that the
              program is running upon.

              Membersversion (int) -- version of GIC to be described.  Currently, only 2 and 3 are supported.

                     • emulated (boolean) -- whether current QEMU/hardware supports emulated GIC device in  user
                       space.

                     • kernel  (boolean)  --  whether  current  QEMU/hardware  supports hardware accelerated GIC
                       device in kernel.

       Command query-gic-capabilities (Since: 2.6)
              Availability: TARGET_ARM

              This command is ARM-only.  It will return a  list  of  GICCapability  objects  that  describe  its
              capability bits.

              Return [GICCapability] -- a list of GICCapability objects.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-gic-capabilities" }
                     <- { "return": [{ "version": 2, "emulated": true, "kernel": false },
                                     { "version": 3, "emulated": false, "kernel": true } ] }

       Object SGXEPCSection (Since: 7.0)
              Information about intel SGX EPC section info

              Membersnode (int) -- the numa node

                     • size (int) -- the size of EPC section

       Object SGXInfo (Since: 6.2)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              Information about intel Safe Guard eXtension (SGX) support

              Memberssgx (boolean) -- true if SGX is supported

                     • sgx1 (boolean) -- true if SGX1 is supported

                     • sgx2 (boolean) -- true if SGX2 is supported

                     • flc (boolean) -- true if FLC is supported

                     • sections ([SGXEPCSection]) -- The EPC sections info for guest (Since: 7.0)

       Command query-sgx (Since: 6.2)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              Returns information about configured SGX capabilities of guest

              Return SGXInfo -- SGXInfo

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-sgx" }
                     <- { "return": { "sgx": true, "sgx1" : true, "sgx2" : true,
                                      "flc": true,
                                      "sections": [{"node": 0, "size": 67108864},
                                      {"node": 1, "size": 29360128}]} }

       Command query-sgx-capabilities (Since: 6.2)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              Returns information about SGX capabilities of host

              Return SGXInfo -- SGXInfo

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-sgx-capabilities" }
                     <- { "return": { "sgx": true, "sgx1" : true, "sgx2" : true,
                                      "flc": true,
                                      "section" : [{"node": 0, "size": 67108864},
                                      {"node": 1, "size": 29360128}]} }

       Enum EvtchnPortType (Since: 8.0)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              An enumeration of Xen event channel port types.

              Valuesclosed -- The port is unused.

                     • unbound -- The port is allocated and ready to be bound.

                     • interdomain -- The port is connected as an interdomain interrupt.

                     • pirq -- The port is bound to a physical IRQ (PIRQ).

                     • virq -- The port is bound to a virtual IRQ (VIRQ).

                     • ipi -- The post is an inter-processor interrupt (IPI).

       Object EvtchnInfo (Since: 8.0)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              Information about a Xen event channel port

              Membersport (int) -- the port number

                     • vcpu (int) -- target vCPU for this port

                     • type (EvtchnPortType) -- the port type

                     • remote-domain (string) -- remote domain for interdomain ports

                     • target (int) -- remote port ID, or virq/pirq number

                     • pending (boolean) -- port is currently active pending delivery

                     • masked (boolean) -- port is masked

       Command xen-event-list (Since: 8.0)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              Query the Xen event channels opened by the guest.

              Return [EvtchnInfo] -- list of open event channel ports.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "xen-event-list" }
                     <- { "return": [
                             {
                                 "pending": false,
                                 "port": 1,
                                 "vcpu": 1,
                                 "remote-domain": "qemu",
                                 "masked": false,
                                 "type": "interdomain",
                                 "target": 1
                             },
                             {
                                 "pending": false,
                                 "port": 2,
                                 "vcpu": 0,
                                 "remote-domain": "",
                                 "masked": false,
                                 "type": "virq",
                                 "target": 0
                             }
                          ]
                        }

       Command xen-event-inject (Since: 8.0)
              Availability: TARGET_I386

              Inject a Xen event channel port (interrupt) to the guest.

              Argumentsport (int) -- The port number

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "xen-event-inject", "arguments": { "port": 1 } }
                     <- { "return": { } }

AUDIO

       Object AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (Since: 4.0)
              General audio backend options that are used for both playback and recording.

              Membersmixing-engine  (boolean,  optional) -- use QEMU's mixing engine to mix all streams inside
                       QEMU and convert audio formats when not supported by  the  backend.   When  set  to  off,
                       fixed-settings must be also off (default on, since 4.2)

                     • fixed-settings  (boolean,  optional)  --  use fixed settings for host input/output.  When
                       off, frequency, channels and format must not be specified (default true)

                     • frequency (int, optional) -- frequency to use when using fixed settings (default 44100)

                     • channels (int, optional) -- number of channels when using fixed settings (default 2)

                     • voices (int, optional) -- number of voices to use (default 1)

                     • format (AudioFormat, optional) -- sample format to use when using fixed settings (default
                       s16)

                     • buffer-length (int, optional) -- the buffer length in microseconds

       Object AudiodevGenericOptions (Since: 4.0)
              Generic driver-specific options.

              Membersin (AudiodevPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the capture stream

                     • out (AudiodevPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the playback stream

       Object AudiodevDBusOptions (Since: 10.0)
              Options of the D-Bus audio backend.

              Membersin (AudiodevPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the capture stream

                     • out (AudiodevPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the playback stream

                     • nsamples (int, optional) -- set the number of samples per read/write  calls  (default  to
                       480,

              10ms at 48kHz).

       Object AudiodevAlsaPerDirectionOptions (Since: 4.0)
              Options of the ALSA backend that are used for both playback and recording.

              Membersdev (string, optional) -- the name of the ALSA device to use (default 'default')

                     • period-length (int, optional) -- the period length in microseconds

                     • try-poll  (boolean,  optional)  --  attempt to use poll mode, falling back to non-polling
                       access on failure (default true)

                     • The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions.

       Object AudiodevAlsaOptions (Since: 4.0)
              Options of the ALSA audio backend.

              Membersin (AudiodevAlsaPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the capture stream

                     • out (AudiodevAlsaPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the playback stream

                     • threshold (int, optional) -- set the threshold (in microseconds) when playback starts

       Object AudiodevSndioOptions (Since: 7.2)
              Options of the sndio audio backend.

              Membersin (AudiodevPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the capture stream

                     • out (AudiodevPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the playback stream

                     • dev (string, optional) -- the name of the sndio device to use (default 'default')

                     • latency (int, optional) -- play buffer size (in microseconds)

       Object AudiodevCoreaudioPerDirectionOptions (Since: 4.0)
              Options of the Core Audio backend that are used for both playback and recording.

              Membersbuffer-count (int, optional) -- number of buffers

                     • The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions.

       Object AudiodevCoreaudioOptions (Since: 4.0)
              Options of the coreaudio audio backend.

              Membersin (AudiodevCoreaudioPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the capture stream

                     • out (AudiodevCoreaudioPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the playback stream

       Object AudiodevDsoundOptions (Since: 4.0)
              Options of the DirectSound audio backend.

              Membersin (AudiodevPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the capture stream

                     • out (AudiodevPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the playback stream

                     • latency (int, optional) -- add extra latency to playback in microseconds (default 10000)

       Object AudiodevJackPerDirectionOptions (Since: 5.1)
              Options of the JACK backend that are used for both playback and recording.

              Membersserver-name (string, optional) -- select from among several  possible  concurrent  server
                       instances (default: environment variable $JACK_DEFAULT_SERVER if set, else "default")

                     • client-name  (string,  optional)  -- the client name to use.  The server will modify this
                       name to create a unique variant, if  needed  unless  exact-name  is  true  (default:  the
                       guest's name)

                     • connect-ports  (string,  optional)  --  if  set, a regular expression of JACK client port
                       name(s) to monitor for and automatically connect to

                     • start-server (boolean, optional) -- start a jack server process if  one  is  not  already
                       present (default: false)

                     • exact-name   (boolean,   optional)  --  use  the  exact  name  requested  otherwise  JACK
                       automatically generates a unique one, if needed (default: false)

                     • The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions.

       Object AudiodevJackOptions (Since: 5.1)
              Options of the JACK audio backend.

              Membersin (AudiodevJackPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the capture stream

                     • out (AudiodevJackPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the playback stream

       Object AudiodevOssPerDirectionOptions (Since: 4.0)
              Options of the OSS backend that are used for both playback and recording.

              Membersdev (string, optional) -- file name of the OSS device (default '/dev/dsp')

                     • buffer-count (int, optional) -- number of buffers

                     • try-poll (boolean, optional) -- attempt to use poll mode,  falling  back  to  non-polling
                       access on failure (default true)

                     • The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions.

       Object AudiodevOssOptions (Since: 4.0)
              Options of the OSS audio backend.

              Membersin (AudiodevOssPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the capture stream

                     • out (AudiodevOssPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the playback stream

                     • try-mmap  (boolean,  optional)  --  try  using  memory-mapped  access,  falling  back  to
                       non-memory-mapped access on failure (default true)

                     • exclusive (boolean, optional) -- open device in exclusive mode (vmix won't work) (default
                       false)

                     • dsp-policy (int, optional) -- set the timing policy of the  device  (between  0  and  10,
                       where  smaller  number  means smaller latency but higher CPU usage) or -1 to use fragment
                       mode (option ignored on some platforms) (default 5)

       Object AudiodevPaPerDirectionOptions (Since: 4.0)
              Options of the Pulseaudio backend that are used for both playback and recording.

              Membersname (string, optional) -- name of the sink/source to use

                     • stream-name (string, optional) -- name of the PulseAudio stream created by qemu.  Can  be
                       used  to identify the stream in PulseAudio when you create multiple PulseAudio devices or
                       run multiple qemu instances (default: audiodev's id, since 4.2)

                     • latency (int, optional) --  latency  you  want  PulseAudio  to  achieve  in  microseconds
                       (default 15000)

                     • The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions.

       Object AudiodevPaOptions (Since: 4.0)
              Options of the PulseAudio audio backend.

              Membersin (AudiodevPaPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the capture stream

                     • out (AudiodevPaPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the playback stream

                     • server (string, optional) -- PulseAudio server address (default: let PulseAudio choose)

       Object AudiodevPipewirePerDirectionOptions (Since: 8.1)
              Options of the PipeWire backend that are used for both playback and recording.

              Membersname (string, optional) -- name of the sink/source to use

                     • stream-name  (string,  optional)  -- name of the PipeWire stream created by qemu.  Can be
                       used to identify the stream in PipeWire when you create multiple PipeWire devices or  run
                       multiple qemu instances (default: audiodev's id)

                     • latency  (int, optional) -- latency you want PipeWire to achieve in microseconds (default
                       46000)

                     • The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions.

       Object AudiodevPipewireOptions (Since: 8.1)
              Options of the PipeWire audio backend.

              Membersin (AudiodevPipewirePerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the capture stream

                     • out (AudiodevPipewirePerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the playback stream

       Object AudiodevSdlPerDirectionOptions (Since: 6.0)
              Options of the SDL audio backend that are used for both playback and recording.

              Membersbuffer-count (int, optional) -- number of buffers (default 4)

                     • The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions.

       Object AudiodevSdlOptions (Since: 6.0)
              Options of the SDL audio backend.

              Membersin (AudiodevSdlPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the recording stream

                     • out (AudiodevSdlPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the playback stream

       Object AudiodevWavOptions (Since: 4.0)
              Options of the wav audio backend.

              Membersin (AudiodevPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the capture stream

                     • out (AudiodevPerDirectionOptions, optional) -- options of the playback stream

                     • path (string, optional) -- name of the wav file to record (default 'qemu.wav')

       Enum AudioFormat (Since: 4.0)
              An enumeration of possible audio formats.

              Valuesu8 -- unsigned 8 bit integer

                     • s8 -- signed 8 bit integer

                     • u16 -- unsigned 16 bit integer

                     • s16 -- signed 16 bit integer

                     • u32 -- unsigned 32 bit integer

                     • s32 -- signed 32 bit integer

                     • f32 -- single precision floating-point (since 5.0)

       Enum AudiodevDriver (Since: 4.0)
              An enumeration of possible audio backend drivers.

              Valuesjack -- JACK audio backend (since 5.1)

                     • none -- Not documented

                     • alsa -- Not documented

                     • coreaudio -- Not documented

                     • dbus -- Not documented

                     • dsound -- Not documented

                     • oss -- Not documented

                     • pa -- Not documented

                     • pipewire -- Not documented

                     • sdl -- Not documented

                     • sndio -- Not documented

                     • spice -- Not documented

                     • wav -- Not documented

       Object Audiodev (Since: 4.0)
              Options of an audio backend.

              Membersid (string) -- identifier of the backend

                     • driver (AudiodevDriver) -- the backend driver to use

                     • timer-period (int, optional) -- timer period (in microseconds, 0: use lowest possible)

                     • When driver is none: The members of AudiodevGenericOptions.

                     • When driver is alsa: The members of AudiodevAlsaOptions.

                     • When driver is coreaudio: The members of AudiodevCoreaudioOptions.

                     • When driver is dbus: The members of AudiodevDBusOptions.

                     • When driver is dsound: The members of AudiodevDsoundOptions.

                     • When driver is jack: The members of AudiodevJackOptions.

                     • When driver is oss: The members of AudiodevOssOptions.

                     • When driver is pa: The members of AudiodevPaOptions.

                     • When driver is pipewire: The members of AudiodevPipewireOptions.

                     • When driver is sdl: The members of AudiodevSdlOptions.

                     • When driver is sndio: The members of AudiodevSndioOptions.

                     • When driver is spice: The members of AudiodevGenericOptions.

                     • When driver is wav: The members of AudiodevWavOptions.

       Command query-audiodevs (Since: 8.0)
              Returns information about audiodev configuration

              Return [Audiodev] -- array of Audiodev

ACPI

       Object AcpiTableOptions (Since: 1.5)
              Specify an ACPI table on the command line to load.

              At most one of file and data can be specified.  The list of files specified by any one of them  is
              loaded and concatenated in order.  If both are omitted, data is implied.

              Other  fields  / optargs can be used to override fields of the generic ACPI table header; refer to
              the ACPI specification 5.0, section 5.2.6 System Description Table Header.  If a header  field  is
              not overridden, then the corresponding value from the concatenated blob is used (in case of file),
              or it is filled in with a hard-coded value (in case of data).

              String  fields  are copied into the matching ACPI member from lowest address upwards, and silently
              truncated / NUL-padded to length.

              Memberssig (string, optional) -- table signature / identifier (4 bytes)

                     • rev (int, optional) -- table revision number (dependent on signature, 1 byte)

                     • oem_id (string, optional) -- OEM identifier (6 bytes)

                     • oem_table_id (string, optional) -- OEM table identifier (8 bytes)

                     • oem_rev (int, optional) -- OEM-supplied revision number (4 bytes)

                     • asl_compiler_id (string, optional) -- identifier of the utility that created the table (4
                       bytes)

                     • asl_compiler_rev (int, optional) -- revision number of the utility that created the table
                       (4 bytes)

                     • file (string, optional) -- colon (:) separated list of pathnames to load and  concatenate
                       as  table  data.  The resultant binary blob is expected to have an ACPI table header.  At
                       least one file is required.  This field excludes data.

                     • data (string, optional) -- colon (:) separated list of pathnames to load and  concatenate
                       as  table  data.  The resultant binary blob must not have an ACPI table header.  At least
                       one file is required.  This field excludes file.

       Enum ACPISlotType

              ValuesDIMM -- memory slot

                     • CPU -- logical CPU slot (since 2.7)

       Object ACPIOSTInfo (Since: 2.1)
              OSPM Status Indication for a device For description of possible values of source and status fields
              see "_OST (OSPM Status Indication)" chapter of ACPI5.0 spec.

              Membersdevice (string, optional) -- device ID associated with slot

                     • slot (string) -- slot ID, unique per slot of a given slot-typeslot-type (ACPISlotType) -- type of the slot

                     • source (int) -- an integer containing the source event

                     • status (int) -- an integer containing the status code

       Command query-acpi-ospm-status (Since: 2.1)
              Return a list of ACPIOSTInfo for devices that support status reporting via ACPI _OST method.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-acpi-ospm-status" }
                     <- { "return": [ { "device": "d1", "slot": "0", "slot-type": "DIMM", "source": 1, "status": 0},
                                      { "slot": "1", "slot-type": "DIMM", "source": 0, "status": 0},
                                      { "slot": "2", "slot-type": "DIMM", "source": 0, "status": 0},
                                      { "slot": "3", "slot-type": "DIMM", "source": 0, "status": 0}
                        ]}

       Event ACPI_DEVICE_OST (Since: 2.1)
              Emitted when guest executes ACPI _OST method.

              Membersinfo (ACPIOSTInfo) -- OSPM Status Indication

                 Example:

                     <- { "event": "ACPI_DEVICE_OST",
                          "data": { "info": { "device": "d1", "slot": "0",
                                              "slot-type": "DIMM", "source": 1, "status": 0 } },
                          "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }

PCI

       Object PciMemoryRange (Since: 0.14)
              A PCI device memory region

              Membersbase (int) -- the starting address (guest physical)

                     • limit (int) -- the ending address (guest physical)

       Object PciMemoryRegion (Since: 0.14)
              Information about a PCI device I/O region.

              Membersbar (int) -- the index of the Base Address Register for this region

                     • type (string) -- .INDENT 2.0

                     • 'io' if the region is a PIO region

                     • 'memory' if the region is a MMIO region

              • address (int) -- memory address

              • size (int) -- memory size

              • prefetch (boolean, optional) -- if type is 'memory', true if the memory is prefetchable

              • mem_type_64 (boolean, optional) -- if type is 'memory', true if the BAR is 64-bit

       Object PciBusInfo (Since: 2.4)
              Information about a bus of a PCI Bridge device

              Membersnumber (int) -- primary bus interface number.  This should be the number of the  bus  the
                       device resides on.

                     • secondary  (int)  --  secondary bus interface number.  This is the number of the main bus
                       for the bridge

                     • subordinate (int) -- This is the highest number bus that resides below the bridge.

                     • io_range (PciMemoryRange) -- The PIO range for all devices on this bridge

                     • memory_range (PciMemoryRange) -- The MMIO range for all devices on this bridge

                     • prefetchable_range (PciMemoryRange) -- The range of prefetchable MMIO for all devices  on
                       this bridge

       Object PciBridgeInfo (Since: 0.14)
              Information about a PCI Bridge device

              Membersbus (PciBusInfo) -- information about the bus the device resides on

                     • devices  ([PciDeviceInfo],  optional)  -- a list of PciDeviceInfo for each device on this
                       bridge

       Object PciDeviceClass (Since: 2.4)
              Information about the Class of a PCI device

              Membersdesc (string, optional) -- a string description of the device's class  (not  stable,  and
                       should only be treated as informational)

                     • class (int) -- the class code of the device

       Object PciDeviceId (Since: 2.4)
              Information about the Id of a PCI device

              Membersdevice (int) -- the PCI device id

                     • vendor (int) -- the PCI vendor id

                     • subsystem (int, optional) -- the PCI subsystem id (since 3.1)

                     • subsystem-vendor (int, optional) -- the PCI subsystem vendor id (since 3.1)

       Object PciDeviceInfo (Since: 0.14)
              Information about a PCI device

              Membersbus (int) -- the bus number of the device

                     • slot (int) -- the slot the device is located in

                     • function (int) -- the function of the slot used by the device

                     • class_info (PciDeviceClass) -- the class of the device

                     • id (PciDeviceId) -- the PCI device id

                     • irq (int, optional) -- if an IRQ is assigned to the device, the IRQ number

                     • irq_pin (int) -- the IRQ pin, zero means no IRQ (since 5.1)

                     • qdev_id (string) -- the device name of the PCI device

                     • pci_bridge  (PciBridgeInfo,  optional)  --  if  the  device  is  a PCI bridge, the bridge
                       information

                     • regions ([PciMemoryRegion]) -- a list of the PCI I/O regions associated with the device

       Object PciInfo (Since: 0.14)
              Information about a PCI bus

              Membersbus (int) -- the bus index

                     • devices ([PciDeviceInfo]) -- a list of devices on this bus

       Command query-pci (Since: 0.14)
              Return information about the PCI bus topology of the guest.

              Return [PciInfo] -- a list of PciInfo for each PCI bus.  Each bus is represented by a json-object,
                     which has a key with a json-array of all PCI  devices  attached  to  it.   Each  device  is
                     represented by a json-object.

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "query-pci" }
                     <- { "return": [
                              {
                                 "bus": 0,
                                 "devices": [
                                    {
                                       "bus": 0,
                                       "qdev_id": "",
                                       "slot": 0,
                                       "class_info": {
                                          "class": 1536,
                                          "desc": "Host bridge"
                                       },
                                       "id": {
                                          "device": 32902,
                                          "vendor": 4663
                                       },
                                       "function": 0,
                                       "regions": [
                                       ]
                                    },
                                    {
                                       "bus": 0,
                                       "qdev_id": "",
                                       "slot": 1,
                                       "class_info": {
                                          "class": 1537,
                                          "desc": "ISA bridge"
                                       },
                                       "id": {
                                          "device": 32902,
                                          "vendor": 28672
                                       },
                                       "function": 0,
                                       "regions": [
                                       ]
                                    },
                                    {
                                       "bus": 0,
                                       "qdev_id": "",
                                       "slot": 1,
                                       "class_info": {
                                          "class": 257,
                                          "desc": "IDE controller"
                                       },
                                       "id": {
                                          "device": 32902,
                                          "vendor": 28688
                                       },
                                       "function": 1,
                                       "regions": [
                                          {
                                             "bar": 4,
                                             "size": 16,
                                             "address": 49152,
                                             "type": "io"
                                          }
                                       ]
                                    },
                                    {
                                       "bus": 0,
                                       "qdev_id": "",
                                       "slot": 2,
                                       "class_info": {
                                          "class": 768,
                                          "desc": "VGA controller"
                                       },
                                       "id": {
                                          "device": 4115,
                                          "vendor": 184
                                       },
                                       "function": 0,
                                       "regions": [
                                          {
                                             "prefetch": true,
                                             "mem_type_64": false,
                                             "bar": 0,
                                             "size": 33554432,
                                             "address": 4026531840,
                                             "type": "memory"
                                          },
                                          {
                                             "prefetch": false,
                                             "mem_type_64": false,
                                             "bar": 1,
                                             "size": 4096,
                                             "address": 4060086272,
                                             "type": "memory"
                                          },
                                          {
                                             "prefetch": false,
                                             "mem_type_64": false,
                                             "bar": 6,
                                             "size": 65536,
                                             "address": -1,
                                             "type": "memory"
                                          }
                                       ]
                                    },
                                    {
                                       "bus": 0,
                                       "qdev_id": "",
                                       "irq": 11,
                                       "slot": 4,
                                       "class_info": {
                                          "class": 1280,
                                          "desc": "RAM controller"
                                       },
                                       "id": {
                                          "device": 6900,
                                          "vendor": 4098
                                       },
                                       "function": 0,
                                       "regions": [
                                          {
                                             "bar": 0,
                                             "size": 32,
                                             "address": 49280,
                                             "type": "io"
                                          }
                                       ]
                                    }
                                 ]
                              }
                           ]
                        }

              This example has been shortened as the real response is too long.

STATISTICS

       Enum StatsType (Since: 7.1)
              Enumeration of statistics types

              Valuescumulative -- stat is cumulative; value can only increase.

                     • instant -- stat is instantaneous; value can increase or decrease.

                     • peak -- stat is the peak value; value can only increase.

                     • linear-histogram -- stat is a linear histogram.

                     • log2-histogram -- stat is a logarithmic histogram, with one bucket for each power of two.

       Enum StatsUnit (Since: 7.1)
              Enumeration of unit of measurement for statistics

              Valuesbytes -- stat reported in bytes.

                     • seconds -- stat reported in seconds.

                     • cycles -- stat reported in clock cycles.

                     • boolean -- stat is a boolean value.

       Enum StatsProvider (Since: 7.1)
              Enumeration of statistics providers.

              Valueskvm -- since 7.1

                     • cryptodev -- since 8.0

       Enum StatsTarget (Since: 7.1)
              The kinds of objects on which one can request statistics.

              Valuesvm -- statistics that apply to the entire virtual machine or the entire QEMU process.

                     • vcpu -- statistics that apply to a single virtual CPU.

                     • cryptodev -- statistics that apply to a crypto device (since 8.0)

       Object StatsRequest (Since: 7.1)
              Indicates a set of statistics that should be returned by query-stats.

              Membersprovider (StatsProvider) -- provider for which to return statistics.

                     • names ([string], optional) -- statistics to be returned (all if omitted).

       Object StatsVCPUFilter (Since: 7.1)

              Membersvcpus ([string], optional) -- list of QOM paths for the desired vCPU objects.

       Object StatsFilter (Since: 7.1)
              The  arguments  to the query-stats command; specifies a target for which to request statistics and
              optionally the required subset of information for that target.

              Memberstarget (StatsTarget) -- the kind of objects to query.  Note that each possible target may
                       enable additional filtering options

                     • providers ([StatsRequest], optional) -- which providers to request statistics  from,  and
                       optionally which named values to return within each provider

                     • When target is vcpu: The members of StatsVCPUFilter.

       Alternate StatsValue (Since: 7.1)

              Alternativesscalar (int) -- single unsigned 64-bit integers.

                     • boolean (boolean) -- single boolean value.

                     • list ([int]) -- list of unsigned 64-bit integers (used for histograms).

       Object Stats (Since: 7.1)

              Membersname (string) -- name of stat.

                     • value (StatsValue) -- stat value.

       Object StatsResult (Since: 7.1)

              Membersprovider (StatsProvider) -- provider for this set of statistics.

                     • qom-path  (string, optional) -- Path to the object for which the statistics are returned,
                       if the object is exposed in the QOM tree

                     • stats ([Stats]) -- list of statistics.

       Command query-stats (Since: 7.1)
              Return runtime-collected statistics for objects such as the VM or its vCPUs.

              The arguments are a StatsFilter and specify the provider and objects to return statistics about.

              Arguments

                     • The members of StatsFilter.

              Return [StatsResult] -- a list of StatsResult, one for each provider and object  (e.g.,  for  each
                     vCPU).

       Object StatsSchemaValue (Since: 7.1)
              Schema for a single statistic.

              Membersname (string) -- name of the statistic; each element of the schema is uniquely identified
                       by a target, a provider (both available in StatsSchema) and the name.

                     • type (StatsType) -- kind of statistic.

                     • unit  (StatsUnit,  optional)  -- basic unit of measure for the statistic; if missing, the
                       statistic is a simple number or counter.

                     • base (int, optional) -- base for the multiple of unit in which the statistic is measured.
                       Only present if exponent is non-zero; base and exponent together form a SI prefix  (e.g.,
                       _nano-_  for  base=10 and exponent=-9) or IEC binary prefix (e.g.  _kibi-_ for base=2 and
                       exponent=10)

                     • exponent (int) -- exponent for the multiple of unit in which the statistic is  expressed,
                       or 0 for the basic unit

                     • bucket-size  (int,  optional)  --  Present  when type is "linear-histogram", contains the
                       width of each bucket of the histogram.

       Object StatsSchema (Since: 7.1)
              Schema for all available statistics for a provider and target.

              Membersprovider (StatsProvider) -- provider for this set of statistics.

                     • target (StatsTarget) -- the kind of object that can be queried through the provider.

                     • stats ([StatsSchemaValue]) -- list of statistics.

       Command query-stats-schemas (Since: 7.1)
              Return the schema for all available runtime-collected statistics.

              Argumentsprovider (StatsProvider, optional) -- a provider to restrict the query to.

              NOTE:
                 Runtime-collected statistics and their names fall outside QEMU's  usual  deprecation  policies.
                 QEMU will try to keep the set of available data stable, together with their names, but will not
                 guarantee  stability  at  all  costs;  the  same  is  true  of providers that source statistics
                 externally, e.g. from Linux.  For example, if the same value is being  tracked  with  different
                 names  on  different  architectures or by different providers, one of them might be renamed.  A
                 statistic might go away if an algorithm is changed or some code is removed; changing a  default
                 might  cause  previously  useful  statistics  to  always  report 0.  Such changes, however, are
                 expected to be rare.

VIRTIO DEVICES

       Object VirtioInfo (Since: 7.2)
              Basic information about a given VirtIODevice

              Memberspath (string) -- The VirtIODevice's canonical QOM path

                     • name (string) -- Name of the VirtIODevice

       Command x-query-virtio (Since: 7.2)
              This command is unstable/experimental.

              Returns a list of all realized VirtIODevices

              Featuresunstable -- This command is meant for debugging.

              Return [VirtioInfo] -- List of gathered VirtIODevices

                 Example:

                     -> { "execute": "x-query-virtio" }
                     <- { "return": [
                              {
                                  "name": "virtio-input",
                                  "path": "/machine/peripheral-anon/device[4]/virtio-backend"
                              },
                              {
                                  "name": "virtio-crypto",
                                  "path": "/machine/peripheral/crypto0/virtio-backend"
                              },
                              {
                                  "name": "virtio-scsi",
                                  "path": "/machine/peripheral-anon/device[2]/virtio-backend"
                              },
                              {
                                  "name": "virtio-net",
                                  "path": "/machine/peripheral-anon/device[1]/virtio-backend"
                              },
                              {
                                  "name": "virtio-serial",
                                  "path": "/machine/peripheral-anon/device[0]/virtio-backend"
                              }
                          ]
                        }

       Object VhostStatus (Since: 7.2)
              Information about a vhost device.  This information will only be displayed if the vhost device  is
              active.

              Membersn-mem-sections (int) -- vhost_dev n_mem_sections

                     • n-tmp-sections (int) -- vhost_dev n_tmp_sections

                     • nvqs (int) -- vhost_dev nvqs (number of virtqueues being used)

                     • vq-index (int) -- vhost_dev vq_index

                     • features (VirtioDeviceFeatures) -- vhost_dev features

                     • acked-features (VirtioDeviceFeatures) -- vhost_dev acked_features

                     • backend-features (VirtioDeviceFeatures) -- vhost_dev backend_features

                     • protocol-features (VhostDeviceProtocols) -- vhost_dev protocol_features

                     • max-queues (int) -- vhost_dev max_queues

                     • backend-cap (int) -- vhost_dev backend_cap

                     • log-enabled (boolean) -- vhost_dev log_enabled flag

                     • log-size (int) -- vhost_dev log_size

       Object VirtioStatus (Since: 7.2)
              Full status of the virtio device with most VirtIODevice members.  Also includes the full status of
              the corresponding vhost device if the vhost device is active.

              Membersname (string) -- VirtIODevice name

                     • device-id (int) -- VirtIODevice ID

                     • vhost-started (boolean) -- VirtIODevice vhost_started flag

                     • guest-features (VirtioDeviceFeatures) -- VirtIODevice guest_features

                     • host-features (VirtioDeviceFeatures) -- VirtIODevice host_features

                     • backend-features (VirtioDeviceFeatures) -- VirtIODevice backend_features

                     • device-endian (string) -- VirtIODevice device_endian

                     • num-vqs  (int)  -- VirtIODevice virtqueue count.  This is the number of active virtqueues
                       being used by the VirtIODevice.

                     • status (VirtioDeviceStatus) -- VirtIODevice configuration status (VirtioDeviceStatus)

                     • isr (int) -- VirtIODevice ISR

                     • queue-sel (int) -- VirtIODevice queue_sel

                     • vm-running (boolean) -- VirtIODevice vm_running flag

                     • broken (boolean) -- VirtIODevice broken flag

                     • disabled (boolean) -- VirtIODevice disabled flag

                     • use-started (boolean) -- VirtIODevice use_started flag

                     • started (boolean) -- VirtIODevice started flag

                     • start-on-kick (boolean) -- VirtIODevice start_on_kick flag

                     • disable-legacy-check (boolean) -- VirtIODevice disabled_legacy_check flag

                     • bus-name (string) -- VirtIODevice bus_name

                     • use-guest-notifier-mask (boolean) -- VirtIODevice use_guest_notifier_mask flag

                     • vhost-dev (VhostStatus,  optional)  --  Corresponding  vhost  device  info  for  a  given
                       VirtIODevice.  Present if the given VirtIODevice has an active vhost device.

       Command x-query-virtio-status (Since: 7.2)
              This command is unstable/experimental.

              Poll for a comprehensive status of a given virtio device

              Argumentspath (string) -- Canonical QOM path of the VirtIODevice

              Featuresunstable -- This command is meant for debugging.

              Return VirtioStatus -- VirtioStatus of the virtio device

                 Example:

                        Poll for the status of virtio-crypto (no vhost-crypto active)

                     -> { "execute": "x-query-virtio-status",
                          "arguments": { "path": "/machine/peripheral/crypto0/virtio-backend" }
                        }
                     <- { "return": {
                              "device-endian": "little",
                              "bus-name": "",
                              "disable-legacy-check": false,
                              "name": "virtio-crypto",
                              "started": true,
                              "device-id": 20,
                              "backend-features": {
                                  "transports": [],
                                  "dev-features": []
                              },
                              "start-on-kick": false,
                              "isr": 1,
                              "broken": false,
                              "status": {
                                  "statuses": [
                                      "VIRTIO_CONFIG_S_ACKNOWLEDGE: Valid virtio device found",
                                      "VIRTIO_CONFIG_S_DRIVER: Guest OS compatible with device",
                                      "VIRTIO_CONFIG_S_FEATURES_OK: Feature negotiation complete",
                                      "VIRTIO_CONFIG_S_DRIVER_OK: Driver setup and ready"
                                  ]
                              },
                              "num-vqs": 2,
                              "guest-features": {
                                  "dev-features": [],
                                  "transports": [
                                      "VIRTIO_RING_F_EVENT_IDX: Used & avail. event fields enabled",
                                      "VIRTIO_RING_F_INDIRECT_DESC: Indirect descriptors supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_F_VERSION_1: Device compliant for v1 spec (legacy)"
                                  ]
                              },
                              "host-features": {
                                  "unknown-dev-features": 1073741824,
                                  "dev-features": [],
                                  "transports": [
                                      "VIRTIO_RING_F_EVENT_IDX: Used & avail. event fields enabled",
                                      "VIRTIO_RING_F_INDIRECT_DESC: Indirect descriptors supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_F_VERSION_1: Device compliant for v1 spec (legacy)",
                                      "VIRTIO_F_ANY_LAYOUT: Device accepts arbitrary desc. layouts",
                                      "VIRTIO_F_NOTIFY_ON_EMPTY: Notify when device runs out of avail. descs. on VQ"
                                  ]
                              },
                              "use-guest-notifier-mask": true,
                              "vm-running": true,
                              "queue-sel": 1,
                              "disabled": false,
                              "vhost-started": false,
                              "use-started": true
                          }
                        }

                 Example:

                        Poll for the status of virtio-net (vhost-net is active)

                     -> { "execute": "x-query-virtio-status",
                          "arguments": { "path": "/machine/peripheral-anon/device[1]/virtio-backend" }
                        }
                     <- { "return": {
                              "device-endian": "little",
                              "bus-name": "",
                              "disabled-legacy-check": false,
                              "name": "virtio-net",
                              "started": true,
                              "device-id": 1,
                              "vhost-dev": {
                                  "n-tmp-sections": 4,
                                  "n-mem-sections": 4,
                                  "max-queues": 1,
                                  "backend-cap": 2,
                                  "log-size": 0,
                                  "backend-features": {
                                      "dev-features": [],
                                      "transports": []
                                  },
                                  "nvqs": 2,
                                  "protocol-features": {
                                      "protocols": []
                                  },
                                  "vq-index": 0,
                                  "log-enabled": false,
                                  "acked-features": {
                                      "dev-features": [
                                          "VIRTIO_NET_F_MRG_RXBUF: Driver can merge receive buffers"
                                      ],
                                      "transports": [
                                          "VIRTIO_RING_F_EVENT_IDX: Used & avail. event fields enabled",
                                          "VIRTIO_RING_F_INDIRECT_DESC: Indirect descriptors supported",
                                          "VIRTIO_F_VERSION_1: Device compliant for v1 spec (legacy)"
                                      ]
                                  },
                                  "features": {
                                      "dev-features": [
                                          "VHOST_F_LOG_ALL: Logging write descriptors supported",
                                          "VIRTIO_NET_F_MRG_RXBUF: Driver can merge receive buffers"
                                      ],
                                      "transports": [
                                          "VIRTIO_RING_F_EVENT_IDX: Used & avail. event fields enabled",
                                          "VIRTIO_RING_F_INDIRECT_DESC: Indirect descriptors supported",
                                          "VIRTIO_F_IOMMU_PLATFORM: Device can be used on IOMMU platform",
                                          "VIRTIO_F_VERSION_1: Device compliant for v1 spec (legacy)",
                                          "VIRTIO_F_ANY_LAYOUT: Device accepts arbitrary desc. layouts",
                                          "VIRTIO_F_NOTIFY_ON_EMPTY: Notify when device runs out of avail. descs. on VQ"
                                      ]
                                  }
                              },
                              "backend-features": {
                                  "dev-features": [
                                      "VHOST_USER_F_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Vhost-user protocol features negotiation supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_GSO: Handling GSO-type packets supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_MAC_ADDR: MAC address set through control channel",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_ANNOUNCE: Driver sending gratuitous packets supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_RX_EXTRA: Extra RX mode control supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_VLAN: Control channel VLAN filtering supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_RX: Control channel RX mode supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_VQ: Control channel available",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_STATUS: Configuration status field available",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_MRG_RXBUF: Driver can merge receive buffers",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_UFO: Device can receive UFO",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_ECN: Device can receive TSO with ECN",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_TSO6: Device can receive TSOv6",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_TSO4: Device can receive TSOv4",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_UFO: Driver can receive UFO",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_ECN: Driver can receive TSO with ECN",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_TSO6: Driver can receive TSOv6",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_TSO4: Driver can receive TSOv4",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_MAC: Device has given MAC address",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_GUEST_OFFLOADS: Control channel offloading reconfig. supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_CSUM: Driver handling packets with partial checksum supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_CSUM: Device handling packets with partial checksum supported"
                                  ],
                                  "transports": [
                                      "VIRTIO_RING_F_EVENT_IDX: Used & avail. event fields enabled",
                                      "VIRTIO_RING_F_INDIRECT_DESC: Indirect descriptors supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_F_VERSION_1: Device compliant for v1 spec (legacy)",
                                      "VIRTIO_F_ANY_LAYOUT: Device accepts arbitrary desc. layouts",
                                      "VIRTIO_F_NOTIFY_ON_EMPTY: Notify when device runs out of avail. descs. on VQ"
                                  ]
                              },
                              "start-on-kick": false,
                              "isr": 1,
                              "broken": false,
                              "status": {
                                  "statuses": [
                                      "VIRTIO_CONFIG_S_ACKNOWLEDGE: Valid virtio device found",
                                      "VIRTIO_CONFIG_S_DRIVER: Guest OS compatible with device",
                                      "VIRTIO_CONFIG_S_FEATURES_OK: Feature negotiation complete",
                                      "VIRTIO_CONFIG_S_DRIVER_OK: Driver setup and ready"
                                  ]
                              },
                              "num-vqs": 3,
                              "guest-features": {
                                  "dev-features": [
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_MAC_ADDR: MAC address set through control channel",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_ANNOUNCE: Driver sending gratuitous packets supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_VLAN: Control channel VLAN filtering supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_RX: Control channel RX mode supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_VQ: Control channel available",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_STATUS: Configuration status field available",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_MRG_RXBUF: Driver can merge receive buffers",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_UFO: Device can receive UFO",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_ECN: Device can receive TSO with ECN",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_TSO6: Device can receive TSOv6",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_TSO4: Device can receive TSOv4",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_UFO: Driver can receive UFO",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_ECN: Driver can receive TSO with ECN",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_TSO6: Driver can receive TSOv6",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_TSO4: Driver can receive TSOv4",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_MAC: Device has given MAC address",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_GUEST_OFFLOADS: Control channel offloading reconfig. supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_CSUM: Driver handling packets with partial checksum supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_CSUM: Device handling packets with partial checksum supported"
                                  ],
                                  "transports": [
                                      "VIRTIO_RING_F_EVENT_IDX: Used & avail. event fields enabled",
                                      "VIRTIO_RING_F_INDIRECT_DESC: Indirect descriptors supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_F_VERSION_1: Device compliant for v1 spec (legacy)"
                                 ]
                              },
                              "host-features": {
                                  "dev-features": [
                                      "VHOST_USER_F_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Vhost-user protocol features negotiation supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_GSO: Handling GSO-type packets supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_MAC_ADDR: MAC address set through control channel",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_ANNOUNCE: Driver sending gratuitous packets supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_RX_EXTRA: Extra RX mode control supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_VLAN: Control channel VLAN filtering supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_RX: Control channel RX mode supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_VQ: Control channel available",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_STATUS: Configuration status field available",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_MRG_RXBUF: Driver can merge receive buffers",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_UFO: Device can receive UFO",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_ECN: Device can receive TSO with ECN",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_TSO6: Device can receive TSOv6",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_TSO4: Device can receive TSOv4",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_UFO: Driver can receive UFO",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_ECN: Driver can receive TSO with ECN",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_TSO6: Driver can receive TSOv6",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_TSO4: Driver can receive TSOv4",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_MAC: Device has given MAC address",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_GUEST_OFFLOADS: Control channel offloading reconfig. supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_CSUM: Driver handling packets with partial checksum supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_NET_F_CSUM: Device handling packets with partial checksum supported"
                                  ],
                                  "transports": [
                                      "VIRTIO_RING_F_EVENT_IDX: Used & avail. event fields enabled",
                                      "VIRTIO_RING_F_INDIRECT_DESC: Indirect descriptors supported",
                                      "VIRTIO_F_VERSION_1: Device compliant for v1 spec (legacy)",
                                      "VIRTIO_F_ANY_LAYOUT: Device accepts arbitrary desc. layouts",
                                      "VIRTIO_F_NOTIFY_ON_EMPTY: Notify when device runs out of avail. descs. on VQ"
                                 ]
                              },
                              "use-guest-notifier-mask": true,
                              "vm-running": true,
                              "queue-sel": 2,
                              "disabled": false,
                              "vhost-started": true,
                              "use-started": true
                          }
                        }

       Object VirtioDeviceStatus (Since: 7.2)
              A structure defined to list the configuration statuses of a virtio device

              Membersstatuses ([string]) -- List of decoded configuration statuses of the virtio device

                     • unknown-statuses  (int,  optional)  --  Virtio  device statuses bitmap that have not been
                       decoded

       Object VhostDeviceProtocols (Since: 7.2)
              A structure defined to list the vhost user protocol features of a Vhost User device

              Membersprotocols ([string]) -- List of decoded vhost user protocol  features  of  a  vhost  user
                       device

                     • unknown-protocols (int, optional) -- Vhost user device protocol features bitmap that have
                       not been decoded

       Object VirtioDeviceFeatures (Since: 7.2)
              The  common  fields  that  apply  to  most  Virtio  devices.   Some devices may not have their own
              device-specific features (e.g. virtio-rng).

              Memberstransports ([string]) -- List of transport features of the virtio device

                     • dev-features ([string], optional) -- List of device-specific features (if the device  has
                       unique features)

                     • unknown-dev-features  (int, optional) -- Virtio device features bitmap that have not been
                       decoded

       Object VirtQueueStatus (Since: 7.2)
              Information of a VirtIODevice VirtQueue, including most members of the VirtQueue data structure.

              Membersname (string) -- Name of the VirtIODevice that uses this VirtQueue

                     • queue-index (int) -- VirtQueue queue_index

                     • inuse (int) -- VirtQueue inuse

                     • vring-num (int) -- VirtQueue vring.num

                     • vring-num-default (int) -- VirtQueue vring.num_default

                     • vring-align (int) -- VirtQueue vring.align

                     • vring-desc (int) -- VirtQueue vring.desc (descriptor area)

                     • vring-avail (int) -- VirtQueue vring.avail (driver area)

                     • vring-used (int) -- VirtQueue vring.used (device area)

                     • last-avail-idx (int,  optional)  --  VirtQueue  last_avail_idx  or  return  of  vhost_dev
                       vhost_get_vring_base (if vhost active)

                     • shadow-avail-idx (int, optional) -- VirtQueue shadow_avail_idx

                     • used-idx (int) -- VirtQueue used_idx

                     • signalled-used (int) -- VirtQueue signalled_used

                     • signalled-used-valid (boolean) -- VirtQueue signalled_used_valid flag

       Command x-query-virtio-queue-status (Since: 7.2)
              This command is unstable/experimental.

              Return the status of a given VirtIODevice's VirtQueue

              Argumentspath (string) -- VirtIODevice canonical QOM path

                     • queue (int) -- VirtQueue index to examine

              Featuresunstable -- This command is meant for debugging.

              Return VirtQueueStatus -- VirtQueueStatus of the VirtQueue

              NOTE:
                 last_avail_idx  will not be displayed in the case where the selected VirtIODevice has a running
                 vhost device and the VirtIODevice VirtQueue index (queue) does not exist for the  corresponding
                 vhost  device  vhost_virtqueue.  Also, shadow_avail_idx will not be displayed in the case where
                 the selected VirtIODevice has a running vhost device.

                 Example:

                        Get VirtQueueStatus for virtio-vsock (vhost-vsock running)

                     -> { "execute": "x-query-virtio-queue-status",
                          "arguments": { "path": "/machine/peripheral/vsock0/virtio-backend",
                                         "queue": 1 }
                        }
                     <- { "return": {
                              "signalled-used": 0,
                              "inuse": 0,
                              "name": "vhost-vsock",
                              "vring-align": 4096,
                              "vring-desc": 5217370112,
                              "signalled-used-valid": false,
                              "vring-num-default": 128,
                              "vring-avail": 5217372160,
                              "queue-index": 1,
                              "last-avail-idx": 0,
                              "vring-used": 5217372480,
                              "used-idx": 0,
                              "vring-num": 128
                          }
                        }

                 Example:

                        Get VirtQueueStatus for virtio-serial (no vhost)

                     -> { "execute": "x-query-virtio-queue-status",
                          "arguments": { "path": "/machine/peripheral-anon/device[0]/virtio-backend",
                                         "queue": 20 }
                        }
                     <- { "return": {
                              "signalled-used": 0,
                              "inuse": 0,
                              "name": "virtio-serial",
                              "vring-align": 4096,
                              "vring-desc": 5182074880,
                              "signalled-used-valid": false,
                              "vring-num-default": 128,
                              "vring-avail": 5182076928,
                              "queue-index": 20,
                              "last-avail-idx": 0,
                              "vring-used": 5182077248,
                              "used-idx": 0,
                              "shadow-avail-idx": 0,
                              "vring-num": 128
                          }
                        }

       Object VirtVhostQueueStatus (Since: 7.2)
              Information of  a  vhost  device's  vhost_virtqueue,  including  most  members  of  the  vhost_dev
              vhost_virtqueue data structure.

              Membersname (string) -- Name of the VirtIODevice that uses this vhost_virtqueue

                     • kick (int) -- vhost_virtqueue kick

                     • call (int) -- vhost_virtqueue call

                     • desc (int) -- vhost_virtqueue desc

                     • avail (int) -- vhost_virtqueue avail

                     • used (int) -- vhost_virtqueue used

                     • num (int) -- vhost_virtqueue num

                     • desc-phys (int) -- vhost_virtqueue desc_phys (descriptor area physical address)

                     • desc-size (int) -- vhost_virtqueue desc_size

                     • avail-phys (int) -- vhost_virtqueue avail_phys (driver area physical address)

                     • avail-size (int) -- vhost_virtqueue avail_size

                     • used-phys (int) -- vhost_virtqueue used_phys (device area physical address)

                     • used-size (int) -- vhost_virtqueue used_size

       Command x-query-virtio-vhost-queue-status (Since: 7.2)
              This command is unstable/experimental.

              Return information of a given vhost device's vhost_virtqueue

              Argumentspath (string) -- VirtIODevice canonical QOM path

                     • queue (int) -- vhost_virtqueue index to examine

              Featuresunstable -- This command is meant for debugging.

              Return VirtVhostQueueStatus -- VirtVhostQueueStatus of the vhost_virtqueue

                 Example: Get vhost_virtqueue status for vhost-crypto

                      -> { "execute": "x-query-virtio-vhost-queue-status",
                           "arguments": { "path": "/machine/peripheral/crypto0/virtio-backend",
                                          "queue": 0 }
                         }
                      <- { "return": {
                               "avail-phys": 5216124928,
                               "name": "virtio-crypto",
                               "used-phys": 5216127040,
                               "avail-size": 2054,
                               "desc-size": 16384,
                               "used-size": 8198,
                               "desc": 140141447430144,
                               "num": 1024,
                               "call": 0,
                               "avail": 140141447446528,
                               "desc-phys": 5216108544,
                               "used": 140141447448640,
                               "kick": 0
                           }
                         }

                 Example: Get vhost_virtqueue status for vhost-vsock

                      -> { "execute": "x-query-virtio-vhost-queue-status",
                           "arguments": { "path": "/machine/peripheral/vsock0/virtio-backend",
                                          "queue": 0 }
                         }
                      <- { "return": {
                               "avail-phys": 5182261248,
                               "name": "vhost-vsock",
                               "used-phys": 5182261568,
                               "avail-size": 262,
                               "desc-size": 2048,
                               "used-size": 1030,
                               "desc": 140141413580800,
                               "num": 128,
                               "call": 0,
                               "avail": 140141413582848,
                               "desc-phys": 5182259200,
                               "used": 140141413583168,
                               "kick": 0
                           }
                         }

       Object VirtioRingDesc (Since: 7.2)
              Information regarding the vring descriptor area

              Membersaddr (int) -- Guest physical address of the descriptor area

                     • len (int) -- Length of the descriptor area

                     • flags ([string]) -- List of descriptor flags

       Object VirtioRingAvail (Since: 7.2)
              Information regarding the avail vring (a.k.a. driver area)

              Membersflags (int) -- VRingAvail flags

                     • idx (int) -- VRingAvail index

                     • ring (int) -- VRingAvail ring[] entry at provided index

       Object VirtioRingUsed (Since: 7.2)
              Information regarding the used vring (a.k.a. device area)

              Membersflags (int) -- VRingUsed flags

                     • idx (int) -- VRingUsed index

       Object VirtioQueueElement (Since: 7.2)
              Information  regarding  a  VirtQueue's  VirtQueueElement  including descriptor, driver, and device
              areas

              Membersname (string) -- Name of the VirtIODevice that uses this VirtQueue

                     • index (int) -- Index of the element in the queue

                     • descs ([VirtioRingDesc]) -- List of descriptors (VirtioRingDesc)

                     • avail (VirtioRingAvail) -- VRingAvail info

                     • used (VirtioRingUsed) -- VRingUsed info

       Command x-query-virtio-queue-element (Since: 7.2)
              This command is unstable/experimental.

              Return the information about a VirtQueue's VirtQueueElement

              Argumentspath (string) -- VirtIODevice canonical QOM path

                     • queue (int) -- VirtQueue index to examine

                     • index (int, optional) -- Index of the element in the queue (default: head of the queue)

              Featuresunstable -- This command is meant for debugging.

              Return VirtioQueueElement -- VirtioQueueElement information

                 Example: Introspect on virtio-net's VirtQueue 0 at index 5

                      -> { "execute": "x-query-virtio-queue-element",
                           "arguments": { "path": "/machine/peripheral-anon/device[1]/virtio-backend",
                                          "queue": 0,
                                          "index": 5 }
                         }
                      <- { "return": {
                               "index": 5,
                               "name": "virtio-net",
                               "descs": [
                                   {
                                       "flags": ["write"],
                                       "len": 1536,
                                       "addr": 5257305600
                                   }
                               ],
                               "avail": {
                                   "idx": 256,
                                   "flags": 0,
                                   "ring": 5
                               },
                               "used": {
                                   "idx": 13,
                                   "flags": 0
                               }
                           }
                         }

                 Example: Introspect on virtio-crypto's VirtQueue 1 at head

                      -> { "execute": "x-query-virtio-queue-element",
                           "arguments": { "path": "/machine/peripheral/crypto0/virtio-backend",
                                          "queue": 1 }
                         }
                      <- { "return": {
                               "index": 0,
                               "name": "virtio-crypto",
                               "descs": [
                                   {
                                       "flags": [],
                                       "len": 0,
                                       "addr": 8080268923184214134
                                   }
                               ],
                               "avail": {
                                   "idx": 280,
                                   "flags": 0,
                                   "ring": 0
                               },
                               "used": {
                                   "idx": 280,
                                   "flags": 0
                               }
                           }
                         }

                 Example: Introspect on virtio-scsi's VirtQueue 2 at head

                      -> { "execute": "x-query-virtio-queue-element",
                           "arguments": { "path": "/machine/peripheral-anon/device[2]/virtio-backend",
                                          "queue": 2 }
                         }
                      <- { "return": {
                               "index": 19,
                               "name": "virtio-scsi",
                               "descs": [
                                   {
                                       "flags": ["used", "indirect", "write"],
                                       "len": 4099327944,
                                       "addr": 12055409292258155293
                                   }
                               ],
                               "avail": {
                                   "idx": 1147,
                                   "flags": 0,
                                   "ring": 19
                               },
                               "used": {
                                   "idx": 280,
                                   "flags": 0
                               }
                           }
                         }

       Object IOThreadVirtQueueMapping (Since: 9.0)
              Describes the subset of virtqueues assigned to an IOThread.

              Membersiothread (string) -- the id of IOThread object

                     • vqs ([int], optional) -- an optional array of virtqueue indices that will be  handled  by
                       this   IOThread.    When   absent,   virtqueues   are  assigned  round-robin  across  all
                       IOThreadVirtQueueMappings provided.  Either all IOThreadVirtQueueMappings must  have  vqs
                       or none of them must have it.

       Object DummyVirtioForceArrays (Since: 9.0)
              Not used by QMP; hack to let us use IOThreadVirtQueueMappingList internally

              Membersunused-iothread-vq-mapping ([IOThreadVirtQueueMapping]) -- Not documented

       Enum GranuleMode (Since: 9.0)

              Values4k -- granule page size of 4KiB

                     • 8k -- granule page size of 8KiB

                     • 16k -- granule page size of 16KiB

                     • 64k -- granule page size of 64KiB

                     • host -- granule matches the host page size

       Enum VMAppleVirtioBlkVariant (Since: 9.2)

              Valuesunspecified -- The default, not a valid setting.

                     • root -- Block device holding the root volume

                     • aux -- Block device holding auxiliary data required for boot

VFIO DEVICES

       Enum QapiVfioMigrationState (Since: 9.1)
              An enumeration of the VFIO device migration states.

              Valuesstop -- The device is stopped.

                     • running -- The device is running.

                     • stop-copy -- The device is stopped and its internal state is available for reading.

                     • resuming -- The device is stopped and its internal state is available for writing.

                     • running-p2p -- The device is running in the P2P quiescent state.

                     • pre-copy  -- The device is running, tracking its internal state and its internal state is
                       available for reading.

                     • pre-copy-p2p -- The device is running in the P2P quiescent state, tracking  its  internal
                       state and its internal state is available for reading.

       Event VFIO_MIGRATION (Since: 9.1)
              This event is emitted when a VFIO device migration state is changed.

              Membersdevice-id (string) -- The device's id, if it has one.

                     • qom-path (string) -- The device's QOM path.

                     • device-state (QapiVfioMigrationState) -- The new changed device migration state.

                 Example:

                     <- { "timestamp": { "seconds": 1713771323, "microseconds": 212268 },
                          "event": "VFIO_MIGRATION",
                          "data": {
                              "device-id": "vfio_dev1",
                              "qom-path": "/machine/peripheral/vfio_dev1",
                              "device-state": "stop" } }

CRYPTOGRAPHY DEVICES

       Enum QCryptodevBackendAlgoType (Since: 8.0)
              The supported algorithm types of a crypto device.

              Valuessym -- symmetric encryption

                     • asym -- asymmetric Encryption

       Enum QCryptodevBackendServiceType (Since: 8.0)
              The supported service types of a crypto device.

              Valuescipher -- Symmetric Key Cipher service

                     • hash -- Hash service

                     • mac -- Message Authentication Codes service

                     • aead -- Authenticated Encryption with Associated Data service

                     • akcipher -- Asymmetric Key Cipher service

       Enum QCryptodevBackendType (Since: 8.0)
              The crypto device backend type

              Valuesbuiltin -- the QEMU builtin support

                     • vhost-user -- vhost-user

                     • lkcf -- Linux kernel cryptographic framework

       Object QCryptodevBackendClient (Since: 8.0)
              Information about a queue of crypto device.

              Membersqueue (int) -- the queue index of the crypto device

                     • type (QCryptodevBackendType) -- the type of the crypto device

       Object QCryptodevInfo (Since: 8.0)
              Information about a crypto device.

              Membersid (string) -- the id of the crypto device

                     • service ([QCryptodevBackendServiceType]) -- supported service types of a crypto device

                     • client ([QCryptodevBackendClient]) -- the additional information of the crypto device

       Command query-cryptodev (Since: 8.0)
              Returns information about current crypto devices.

              Return [QCryptodevInfo] -- a list of QCryptodevInfo

CXL DEVICES

       Enum CxlEventLog (Since: 8.1)
              CXL  has  a  number  of separate event logs for different types of events.  Each such event log is
              handled and signaled independently.

              Valuesinformational -- Information Event Log

                     • warning -- Warning Event Log

                     • failure -- Failure Event Log

                     • fatal -- Fatal Event Log

       Command cxl-inject-general-media-event (Since: 8.1)
              Inject an event record for a General Media Event (CXL  r3.0  8.2.9.2.1.1).   This  event  type  is
              reported via one of the event logs specified via the log parameter.

              Argumentspath (string) -- CXL type 3 device canonical QOM path

                     • log (CxlEventLog) -- event log to add the event to

                     • flags  (int)  -- Event Record Flags.  See CXL r3.0 Table 8-42 Common Event Record Format,
                       Event Record Flags for subfield definitions.

                     • dpa (int) -- Device Physical Address (relative to path device).  Note lower bits  include
                       some flags.  See CXL r3.0 Table 8-43 General Media Event Record, Physical Address.

                     • descriptor  (int)  --  Memory  Event Descriptor with additional memory event information.
                       See CXL r3.0 Table 8-43 General Media Event  Record,  Memory  Event  Descriptor  for  bit
                       definitions.

                     • type  (int) -- Type of memory event that occurred.  See CXL r3.0 Table 8-43 General Media
                       Event Record, Memory Event Type for possible values.

                     • transaction-type (int) -- Type of first transaction that caused the event to occur.   See
                       CXL r3.0 Table 8-43 General Media Event Record, Transaction Type for possible values.

                     • channel  (int,  optional)  --  The channel of the memory event location.  A channel is an
                       interface that can be independently accessed for a transaction.

                     • rank (int, optional) -- The rank of the memory event location.  A rank is a set of memory
                       devices on a channel that together execute a transaction.

                     • device (int, optional) -- Bitmask that represents all devices in the rank associated with
                       the memory event location.

                     • component-id (string, optional) -- Device specific component identifier  for  the  event.
                       May describe a field replaceable sub-component of the device.

       Command cxl-inject-dram-event (Since: 8.1)
              Inject  an  event record for a DRAM Event (CXL r3.0 8.2.9.2.1.2).  This event type is reported via
              one of the event logs specified via the log parameter.

              Argumentspath (string) -- CXL type 3 device canonical QOM path

                     • log (CxlEventLog) -- Event log to add the event to

                     • flags (int) -- Event Record Flags.  See CXL r3.0 Table 8-42 Common Event  Record  Format,
                       Event Record Flags for subfield definitions.

                     • dpa  (int) -- Device Physical Address (relative to path device).  Note lower bits include
                       some flags.  See CXL r3.0 Table 8-44 DRAM Event Record, Physical Address.

                     • descriptor (int) -- Memory Event Descriptor with  additional  memory  event  information.
                       See CXL r3.0 Table 8-44 DRAM Event Record, Memory Event Descriptor for bit definitions.

                     • type  (int)  --  Type  of memory event that occurred.  See CXL r3.0 Table 8-44 DRAM Event
                       Record, Memory Event Type for possible values.

                     • transaction-type (int) -- Type of first transaction that caused the event to occur.   See
                       CXL r3.0 Table 8-44 DRAM Event Record, Transaction Type for possible values.

                     • channel  (int,  optional)  --  The channel of the memory event location.  A channel is an
                       interface that can be independently accessed for a transaction.

                     • rank (int, optional) -- The rank of the memory event location.  A rank is a set of memory
                       devices on a channel that together execute a transaction.

                     • nibble-mask (int, optional) -- Identifies one or more nibbles that the error affects

                     • bank-group (int, optional) -- Bank group of the memory event  location,  incorporating  a
                       number of Banks.

                     • bank (int, optional) -- Bank of the memory event location.  A single bank is accessed per
                       read or write of the memory.

                     • row (int, optional) -- Row address within the DRAM.

                     • column (int, optional) -- Column address within the DRAM.

                     • correction-mask  ([int], optional) -- Bits within each nibble.  Used in order of bits set
                       in the nibble-mask.  Up to 4 nibbles may be covered.

       Command cxl-inject-memory-module-event (Since: 8.1)
              Inject an event record for a Memory Module Event (CXL r3.0 8.2.9.2.1.3).  This  event  includes  a
              copy of the Device Health info at the time of the event.

              Argumentspath (string) -- CXL type 3 device canonical QOM path

                     • log (CxlEventLog) -- Event Log to add the event to

                     • flags  (int)  -- Event Record Flags.  See CXL r3.0 Table 8-42 Common Event Record Format,
                       Event Record Flags for subfield definitions.

                     • type (int) -- Device Event Type.  See CXL r3.0 Table 8-45 Memory Module Event Record  for
                       bit definitions for bit definiions.

                     • health-status  (int)  --  Overall  health  summary  bitmap.  See CXL r3.0 Table 8-100 Get
                       Health Info Output Payload, Health Status for bit definitions.

                     • media-status (int) -- Overall media health summary.  See CXL r3.0 Table 8-100 Get  Health
                       Info Output Payload, Media Status for bit definitions.

                     • additional-status  (int)  --  See  CXL  r3.0  Table 8-100 Get Health Info Output Payload,
                       Additional Status for subfield definitions.

                     • life-used (int) -- Percentage (0-100) of factory expected life span.

                     • temperature (int) -- Device temperature in degrees Celsius.

                     • dirty-shutdown-count (int) -- Number of times the device has  been  unable  to  determine
                       whether data loss may have occurred.

                     • corrected-volatile-error-count  (int)  --  Total number of correctable errors in volatile
                       memory.

                     • corrected-persistent-error-count  (int)  --  Total  number  of  correctable   errors   in
                       persistent memory

       Command cxl-inject-poison (Since: 8.1)
              Poison  records  indicate  that  a  CXL memory device knows that a particular memory region may be
              corrupted.  This may be because of locally detected errors (e.g. ECC failure) or  poisoned  writes
              received  from other components in the system.  This injection mechanism enables testing of the OS
              handling of poison records which may be queried via the CXL mailbox.

              Argumentspath (string) -- CXL type 3 device canonical QOM path

                     • start (int) -- Start address; must be 64 byte aligned.

                     • length (int) -- Length of poison to inject; must be a multiple of 64 bytes.

       Enum CxlUncorErrorType (Since: 8.0)
              Type of uncorrectable CXL error to inject.  These errors are reported  via  an  AER  uncorrectable
              internal error with additional information logged at the CXL device.

              Valuescache-data-parity -- Data error such as data parity or data ECC error CXL.cache

                     • cache-address-parity  -- Address parity or other errors associated with the address field
                       on CXL.cache

                     • cache-be-parity -- Byte enable parity or other byte enable errors on CXL.cache

                     • cache-data-ecc -- ECC error on CXL.cache

                     • mem-data-parity -- Data error such as data parity or data ECC error on CXL.mem

                     • mem-address-parity -- Address parity or other errors associated with the address field on
                       CXL.mem

                     • mem-be-parity -- Byte enable parity or other byte enable errors on CXL.mem.

                     • mem-data-ecc -- Data ECC error on CXL.mem.

                     • reinit-threshold -- REINIT threshold hit.

                     • rsvd-encoding -- Received unrecognized encoding.

                     • poison-received -- Received poison from the peer.

                     • receiver-overflow -- Buffer overflows (first 3 bits of header log indicate which)

                     • internal -- Component specific error

                     • cxl-ide-tx -- Integrity and data encryption tx error.

                     • cxl-ide-rx -- Integrity and data encryption rx error.

       Object CXLUncorErrorRecord (Since: 8.0)
              Record of a single error including header log.

              Memberstype (CxlUncorErrorType) -- Type of error

                     • header ([int]) -- 16 DWORD of header.

       Command cxl-inject-uncorrectable-errors (Since: 8.0)
              Command to allow injection of multiple errors in one go.  This allows testing of  multiple  header
              log handling in the OS.

              Argumentspath (string) -- CXL Type 3 device canonical QOM path

                     • errors ([CXLUncorErrorRecord]) -- Errors to inject

       Enum CxlCorErrorType (Since: 8.0)
              Type of CXL correctable error to inject

              Valuescache-data-ecc -- Data ECC error on CXL.cache

                     • mem-data-ecc -- Data ECC error on CXL.mem

                     • crc-threshold -- Component specific and applicable to 68 byte Flit mode only.

                     • retry-threshold -- Retry threshold hit in the Local Retry State Machine, 68B Flits only.

                     • cache-poison-received -- Received poison from a peer on CXL.cache.

                     • mem-poison-received -- Received poison from a peer on CXL.mem

                     • physical -- Received error indication from the physical layer.

       Command cxl-inject-correctable-error (Since: 8.0)
              Command  to inject a single correctable error.  Multiple error injection of this error type is not
              interesting as there is no associated header  log.   These  errors  are  reported  via  AER  as  a
              correctable internal error, with additional detail available from the CXL device.

              Argumentspath (string) -- CXL Type 3 device canonical QOM path

                     • type (CxlCorErrorType) -- Type of error.

       Object CxlDynamicCapacityExtent (Since: 9.1)
              A  single  dynamic  capacity extent.  This is a contiguous allocation of memory by Device Physical
              Address within a single Dynamic Capacity Region on a CXL Type 3 Device.

              Membersoffset (int) -- The offset (in bytes) to the start of the region where the extent belongs
                       to.

                     • len (int) -- The length of the extent in bytes.

       Enum CxlExtentSelectionPolicy (Since: 9.1)
              The policy to use for selecting which extents comprise the added capacity, as defined  in  Compute
              Express Link (CXL) Specification, Revision 3.1, Table 7-70.

              Valuesfree -- Device is responsible for allocating the requested memory capacity and is free to
                       do this using any combination of supported extents.

                     • contiguous -- Device is responsible for allocating the requested memory capacity but must
                       do so as a single contiguous extent.

                     • prescriptive  --  The precise set of extents to be allocated is specified by the command.
                       Thus allocation is being managed by the issuer of the allocation command, not the device.

                     • enable-shared-access -- Capacity has already been allocated to  a  different  host  using
                       free, contiguous or prescriptive policy with a known tag.  This policy then instructs the
                       device  to  make  the  capacity  with  the specified tag available to an additional host.
                       Capacity is implicit as it matches that already associated with the tag.  Note  that  the
                       extent  list (and hence Device Physical Addresses) used are per host, so a device may use
                       different representations on each host.  The ordering of the  extents  provided  to  each
                       host  is indicated to the host using per extent sequence numbers generated by the device.
                       Has a similar meaning for temporal sharing, but in that case there may be only  one  host
                       involved.

       Command cxl-add-dynamic-capacity (Since: 9.1)
              This command is unstable/experimental.

              Initiate  adding dynamic capacity extents to a host.  This simulates operations defined in Compute
              Express Link  (CXL)  Specification,  Revision  3.1,  Section  7.6.7.6.5.   Note  that,  currently,
              establishing  success  or  failure  of  the  full  Add  Dynamic Capacity flow requires out of band
              communication with the OS of the CXL host.

              Argumentspath (string) -- path to the CXL Dynamic Capacity Device in the QOM tree.

                     • host-id (int)  --  The  "Host  ID"  field  as  defined  in  Compute  Express  Link  (CXL)
                       Specification, Revision 3.1, Table 7-70.

                     • selection-policy  (CxlExtentSelectionPolicy) -- The "Selection Policy" bits as defined in
                       Compute Express Link (CXL) Specification, Revision 3.1, Table  7-70.   It  specifies  the
                       policy to use for selecting which extents comprise the added capacity.

                     • region  (int)  --  The  "Region  Number"  field  as defined in Compute Express Link (CXL)
                       Specification, Revision 3.1, Table 7-70.  Valid range is from 0-7.

                     • tag (string, optional) -- The "Tag" field  as  defined  in  Compute  Express  Link  (CXL)
                       Specification, Revision 3.1, Table 7-70.

                     • extents  ([CxlDynamicCapacityExtent])  --  The  "Extent List" field as defined in Compute
                       Express Link (CXL) Specification, Revision 3.1, Table 7-70.

              Featuresunstable -- For now this command is subject to change.

       Enum CxlExtentRemovalPolicy (Since: 9.1)
              The policy to use for selecting which extents comprise  the  released  capacity,  defined  in  the
              "Flags" field in Compute Express Link (CXL) Specification, Revision 3.1, Table 7-71.

              Valuestag-based  --  Extents  are  selected by the device based on tag, with no requirement for
                       contiguous extents.

                     • prescriptive -- Extent list of capacity to release is included in the request payload.

       Command cxl-release-dynamic-capacity (Since: 9.1)
              This command is unstable/experimental.

              Initiate release of dynamic capacity extents from a host.  This simulates  operations  defined  in
              Compute  Express Link (CXL) Specification, Revision 3.1, Section 7.6.7.6.6.  Note that, currently,
              success or failure of the full Release Dynamic Capacity flow requires out  of  band  communication
              with the OS of the CXL host.

              Argumentspath (string) -- path to the CXL Dynamic Capacity Device in the QOM tree.

                     • host-id  (int)  --  The  "Host  ID"  field  as  defined  in  Compute  Express  Link (CXL)
                       Specification, Revision 3.1, Table 7-71.

                     • removal-policy (CxlExtentRemovalPolicy) -- Bit[3:0] of the "Flags" field  as  defined  in
                       Compute Express Link (CXL) Specification, Revision 3.1, Table 7-71.

                     • forced-removal (boolean, optional) -- Bit[4] of the "Flags" field in Compute Express Link
                       (CXL)  Specification, Revision 3.1, Table 7-71.  When set, the device does not wait for a
                       Release Dynamic Capacity command from the host.  Instead,  the  host  immediately  looses
                       access to the released capacity.

                     • sanitize-on-release (boolean, optional) -- Bit[5] of the "Flags" field in Compute Express
                       Link (CXL) Specification, Revision 3.1, Table 7-71.  When set, the device should sanitize
                       all  released  capacity as a result of this request.  This ensures that all user data and
                       metadata is made permanently unavailable by whatever means is appropriate for  the  media
                       type.  Note that changing encryption keys is not sufficient.

                     • region   (int)  --  The  "Region  Number"  field  as  defined  in  Compute  Express  Link
                       Specification, Revision 3.1, Table 7-71.  Valid range is from 0-7.

                     • tag (string, optional) -- The "Tag" field  as  defined  in  Compute  Express  Link  (CXL)
                       Specification, Revision 3.1, Table 7-71.

                     • extents  ([CxlDynamicCapacityExtent])  --  The  "Extent List" field as defined in Compute
                       Express Link (CXL) Specification, Revision 3.1, Table 7-71.

              Featuresunstable -- For now this command is subject to change.

UEFI VARIABLE STORE

       The qemu efi variable store implementation (hw/uefi/) uses this to store non-volatile variables  in  json
       format on disk.

       This  is  an  existing  format  already  supported  by  (at  least)  two  other  projects, specifically ‐
       https://gitlab.com/kraxel/virt-firmware and https://github.com/awslabs/python-uefivars.

       Object UefiVariable (Since: 10.0)
              UEFI Variable.  Check the UEFI specifification for more detailed information on the fields.

              Membersguid (string) -- variable namespace GUID

                     • name (string) -- variable name, in UTF-8 encoding.

                     • attr (int) -- variable attributes.

                     • data (string) -- variable value, encoded as hex string.

                     • time (string, optional) -- variable modification time.  EFI_TIME struct, encoded  as  hex
                       string.       Used      only      for      authenticated     variables,     where     the
                       EFI_VARIABLE_TIME_BASED_AUTHENTICATED_WRITE_ACCESS attribute bit is set.

                     • digest (string, optional) -- variable certificate digest.  Used to verify  the  signature
                       of  updates  for authenticated variables.  UEFI has two kinds of authenticated variables.
                       The secure boot variables ('PK',  'KEK',  'db'  and  'dbx')  have  hard  coded  signature
                       checking  rules.   For  other authenticated variables the firmware stores a digest of the
                       signing certificate at variable creation time, and any updates must be  signed  with  the
                       same certificate.

       Object UefiVarStore (Since: 10.0)

              Membersversion (int) -- currently always 2

                     • variables ([UefiVariable]) -- list of UEFI variables

COPYRIGHT

       2025, The QEMU Project Developers

10.0.2                                            Jul 02, 2025                                   QEMU-QMP-REF(7)